SlideShare a Scribd company logo
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 1
www.nabcep.org
V.5.0 / 10.11
Prepared by: 	 William Brooks, PE	 James Dunlop, PE
	 Brooks Engineering	 Jim Dunlop Solar
N A B C E P
PV Installation Professional Resource Guide
	
v.6/2013 www.nabcep.org Raising Standards. Promoting Confidence
2 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 3
Thank you to our Resource Guide Sponsors
Acknowledgements:
NABCEP wishes to thank the companies and individuals who
have made this Resource Guide possible. This document is the
result of the efforts of its principal authors: Bill Brooks (Brooks
Engineering) and Jim Dunlop (Jim Dunlop Solar). It is also the
result of the tireless and myriad contributions of the Study
Guide Committee. We are grateful to the following individuals
for their contributions:
	 Johan Alfsen (Quick Mount PV)
	 Jason Fisher (SunPower Corp)
	 Brian Goldojarb (Itron Corp)
	 Mike Holt (Mike Holt Enterprises)
	 Tommy Jacoby (Jacoby Solar Consulting)
	 Mark Mrohs (EchoFirst)
	 Mark Skidmore (Solon)
	 Richard Stovall (SolPowerPeople, Inc.)
We could not have produced a document of such high qual-
ity without the support of our sponsors. We wish to thank the
following companies who made financial contributions for the
production of this guide:
SMA
Affordable Solar
Quick Mount PV
Solar Pro
North Carolina Solar Center at NCSU
North Carolina State University
OnGrid Solar
Renewable Energy World
Solar Energy International
Solectria, LLC
Spec Tech Materials
and Enclosures
Stahlin Enclosures
Morningstar Corporation
Outback Power
Renova Solar
Non Endorsement Statement: The North American Board of Certified Energy Practi-
tioners (NABCEP) does not assume any legal liability or responsibility for the products
and services listed or linked to in NABCEP publications and website. Reference to any
specific commercial product, process, or service by trade name, trademark, manufacturer,
or otherwise, does not constitute or imply NABCEP’s endorsement or recommendation.
NABCEP 	
56 Clifton Country Road, Suite 202
Clifton Park, NY 12065
800-654-0021 / info@nabcep.org
www.nabcep.org
Design: Brownstone Graphics / ALBANY, NY
Forward/Scope
This document was developed to provide an overview
of some of the basic requirements for solar photovol-
taic (PV) system installations and those who install
them. Readers should use this document along with the
2011 National Electrical Code®
(NEC®
), the governing
building codes and other applicable standards. These
codes and standards are referenced often throughout
this document, and are the principal rules that govern
the installation of PV systems and any other electrical
equipment. A thorough understanding of these require-
ments is essential for PV system designers and installers.
This document is a collaborative effort, and is consid-
ered a work in progress. Future editions of this guide
will incorporate comments, corrections and new content
as appropriate to reflect new types of products, instal-
lation methods or code requirements. Public comments
are welcomed and can be directed to the following:
www.pvstudyguide.org.
Units of Measure
Both the International System of Units (SI) and the U.S./
Imperial customary units of measure are used through-
out this document. While SI units are generally used for
solar radiation and electrical parameters, U.S./Impe-
rial customary units are used most commonly in the
U.S. construction industry for weights or measure. PV
professionals are expected to be comfortable with using
both systems of measurement and converting between
the two given the appropriate unit conversion factors.
4 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
1	 Introduction.........................................................................8
2	 Verify System Design...............................................10
3	 Managing the Project................................................82
4	 Installing Electrical Components.................93
5	 Installing Mechanical Components.........104
6	 Completing System Installation.................108
7	 Conducting Maintenance and
	 Troubleshooting Activities...............................113
8	 Appendixes.......................................................................123
	 References..............................................................................123
	 Case Study Examples.......................................................149
	 Sample NABCEP Exam Questions..........................156
Table of Contents
Welcome to the 2013-14 edition of the NABCEP Certified PV Installation Professional Study and Resource
Guide. This edition follows the most recent version of the NABCEP PV Installation Professional Job Task
Analysis, which can be found at www.nabcep.org.
Over the years we have received many suggestions for improving our Resource Guide. We often receive
suggested corrections to perceived inaccuracies in the copy. With the publication of the 2012 resource guide,
NABCEP launched an on-line forum (www.pvstudyguide.org/) where comments and suggestions can be post-
ed. NABCEP Study Guide Committee members monitor this forum. As a result, the newest edition of the PV
Installation Professional Study Guide includes the most relevant and appropriate suggestions we have received.
We think that this open comment approach ultimately improved the Study Guide and we hope that you will
find the guide to be relevant and useful. We also hope that you will contribute to our online forum if you have
suggestions for improving the 2013 version. We always welcome your thoughts and constructive feedback.
As ever, we wish to remind all readers of this Study and Resource Guide that it is in no way intended to be the
definitive word on PV installation and design. The guide is not intended to be viewed as the sole study resource
for the NABCEP PV Installation Professional Certification Examination preparation. The text and the resources
in the appendix of this document are an excellent starting point for candidates preparing for the exam, however
all candidates should recognize that there are many other sources of good information on the topics covered by
the JTA, and they should use them. You may also find a list of references on the “resource” page at nabcep.org.
The preferred method of preparation for the NABCEP exam is to review the Job Task Analysis (Exam Blueprint)
to see what areas in the body of knowledge are required to pass the exam, and do an honest and thorough
self-evaluation to determine what areas you may need to study the most.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 5
What makes our Classic Comp Mount the industry’s most
trusted protection against roof leaks?
The QBlock Elevated Water Seal
Our patented QBlock technology
encloses the EPDM rubber seal – the
ultimate barrier between the rafter and
the rain –  inside a cast-aluminum block
and raises it 7/10 of an inch above the
flashing where the rainwater flows. This
completely protects the rubber seal
from the elements for the life of the
solar array.
925-478-8269 www.quickmountpv.com MADEIN THEUSA
See how our patented QBlock technology prevents future roof leaks at quickmountpv.com/noleaks
Don’t risk disastrous roof leaks with inadequate solar mounting products and methods. Insist
on Quick Mount PV and install it right – and enjoy peace of mind for the full life of every
PV system you install.
Rubber seal raised .7"
above the flashing
and rainwater
above the flashing
and rainwater
6 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 7
Introduction
This Photovoltaic (PV) Installation Professional Resource
Guide is an informational resource intended for individu-
als pursuing the PV Installation Professional Certification
credential offered by North American Board of Certified
Energy Practitioners (NABCEP). This guide covers some of
the basic requirements for the design and installation of PV
systems. Additionally, it includes numerous references to
books, articles, websites, and other resources. Individuals
should use this guide in conjunction with other resources
in preparation for the NABCEP exam.
In order to qualify for the exam, candidates should first
carefully read the NABCEP Certification Handbook, which
outlines certain prerequisites for education, training, and
system installation experience in a responsible role, to qual-
ify for the certification exam. For further information on the
certification program, and how to apply, and to download
the latest NABCEP Certification Information Handbook, go
to: http://www.nabcep.org/certification/how-to-apply-2.
This guide is organized and closely associated with the
NABCEP PV Installation Professional Job Task Analysis
(JTA). The JTA outlines the expected duties of a qualified
PV installation professional, and defines the general knowl-
edge, skills, and abilities required of those who specify,
install and maintain PV systems. The JTA is the basis for
the NABCEP PV Installation Professional Certification pro-
gram and examination content, and should be referenced
often when reviewing this document. The JTA is available
for download from the NABCEP website, at: http://www.
nabcep.org/certification/pv-installer-certification.
The objectives of this guide are to provide general informa-
tion, and additional resources concerning the key areas of
the JTA. Following are the major content areas addressed in
the JTA and in this guide, which serve as the specification
for developing the professional examinations. The percent-
ages indicate the relative numbers of exam items based on
each content area.
• Verify System Design			 (30%)
• Managing the Project 			 (17%)
JTA Job Description
for NABCEP Certified PV Installation Professional
Given a potential site for a solar PV system
installation, and given basic instructions, major
components, schematics, and drawings, the PV
installation professional will: specify, adapt,
implement, configure, install, inspect, and maintain
any type of photovoltaic system, including grid-
connected and stand-alone systems with or without
battery storage, that meet the performance and
reliability needs of customers by incorporating
quality craftsmanship and complying with all
applicable codes, standards, and safety requirements.
• Installing Electrical Components 	 (22%)
• Installing Mechanical Components 	 (08%)
• Completing System Installation 	 (12%)
• Conducting Maintenance and
	 Troubleshooting Activities 		 (11%)
This guide is not an all-inclusive or definitive study
guide for the exam, and exam questions are not nec-
essarily based on the contents in this resource guide.
Sample problems and scenarios are presented solely
for example purposes, and are not to be considered
representative of exam questions. A limited number
of actual exam items that have been retired from the
item bank are contained at the end of this document.
8 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
PV systems are electrical power generation systems that
produce energy. They vary greatly in size and their applica-
tions, and can be designed to meet very small loads from
a few watts or less up to large utility-scale power plants
producing tens of megawatts or more. PV systems can be
designed to supply power to any type of electrical load at
any service voltage.
The major component in all PV systems is an array of PV
modules that produces dc electricity when exposed to
sunlight. Other major components may include power
conditioning equipment, energy storage devices, other
power sources and the electrical loads. Power conditioning
equipment includes inverters, chargers, charge and load
controllers, and maximum power point trackers. Energy
storage devices used in PV systems are mainly batteries,
but may also include advanced technologies like flywheels
or other forms of storing electrical energy or the product,
such as storing water delivered by a PV water pumping
system. Other energy sources coupled with PV systems
may include electrical generators, wind turbines, fuel cells
and the electric utility grid. See Fig. 1.
Balance-of-system (BOS) components include all mechanical
or electrical equipment and hardware used to assemble
and integrate the major components in a PV system
together. Electrical BOS components are used to conduct,
distribute and control the flow of power in the system.
Examples of BOS components include:
•	 Conductors and wiring methods
•	 Raceways and conduits
•	 Junction and combiner boxes
•	 Disconnect switches
•	 Fuses and circuit breakers
•	 Terminals and connectors
•	 Grounding equipment
•	 Array mounting and other structural hardware
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 2
PV System Components
1. PV modules and array
2. Combiner box
3. DC disconnect
4. Inverter (charger & controller)
5. AC disconnect
6. Utility service panel
7. Battery (optional)
1
2
3
4
5
7
6
An Introduction to Photovoltaic Systems
Figure 1. - PV system components
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 9
Types of PV systems are classified based on the loads they
are designed to operate, and their connections with other
electrical systems and sources. The specific components
needed depend on the type of system and its functional
and operational requirements.
Stand-alone PV systems operate independently of other
electrical systems, and are commonly used for remote
power or backup applications, including lighting, water
pumping, transportation safety devices, communications,
off-grid homes and many others. Stand-alone systems may
be designed to power dc and/or ac electrical loads, and
with a few exceptions, use batteries for energy storage. A
stand-alone system may use a PV array as the only power
source, or may additionally use wind turbines, an engine-
generator, or another auxiliary source. Stand-alone PV
systems are not intended to produce output that operates
in parallel with the electric utility system or other sources.
See Fig. 2.
Interactive PV systems operate in parallel and are intercon-
nected and synchronized with the electric utility grid.
When connected to local distribution systems, interactive
systems supplement utility-supplied energy to a building
or facility. The ac power produced by interactive systems
either supplies on-site electrical loads or is back-fed to
the grid when the PV system output is greater than the
site load demand. At night, during cloudy weather or any
other periods when the electrical loads are greater than
the PV system output, the additional power required is
received from the electric utility. Interactive PV systems
are required to disconnect from the grid during utility
outages or disturbances for safety reasons. Only special
battery-based interactive inverters can provide stand-alone
power for critical loads independent from the grid during
outages. See Fig. 3. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar System Components and Configurations: 4 - 2
Figure 2. Stand-alone PV systems operate autonomously and are designed to meet specific
electrical loads.
DC LoadPV Array
Battery
Charge
Controller
Inverter/
Charger
AC Load AC Source
(to Charger Only)
Figure 2. Stand-alone PV systems operate autonomously and are designed to meet specific
electrical loads.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar System Components and Configurations: 4 - 3
Figure 3. Utility-interactive PV systems operate in parallel with the electric utility grid and
supplement site electrical loads.
Load
Center
PV Array Inverter
AC Loads
Electric
Utility
Figure 3. Utility-interactive PV systems operate in parallel with the electric utility grid and
supplement site electrical loads.
PV systems can be designed to
supply power to any type of electrical
load at any service voltage.
10 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
	
2. Verify System Design
While the PV installer may not actually design PV systems, they must know how to
interpret and review system designs and effectively execute the installation based on
the plans. They must also be able to evaluate site issues affecting the design, identify
discrepancies in the design or with code compliance, and recommend and implement
appropriate corrective actions or alternatives. Experienced PV installers have a thorough
understanding of system designs, including their major components, functions and
installation requirements.
2.1	 Determine Client Needs
An accurate assessment of the customer’s needs is the starting point for specifying, de-
signing and installing PV systems. Developing and planning PV projects requires an un-
derstanding of the customer’s expectations from both financial and energy perspectives.
Companies and individuals offering PV installation services must interpret the customer’s
desires, and based on the site conditions, clearly explain the options, their trade-offs and
costs. They must also explain the functions and operating principles for different types of
PV systems, and estimate their performance relative to the customer’s electrical loads.
Customer development includes addressing all other issues affecting the proposed instal-
lation, such as applicable incentives, legal matters, location of equipment and appearance.
Fundamentally, knowledge of the client’s needs and desires become the basis for prepar-
ing proposals, quotations, and construction contracts.
There are several public domain and commercial software resources available in the PV
industry that address different aspects of project development and systems design. The
capabilities of these tools range from simple solar resource and energy production es-
timates, to site survey and system design tools, to complex financial analysis software.
Some tools also provide assistance with rebate programs applications and tax incentives,
while other programs and worksheets focus on the technical aspects of system sizing
and design.
The following lists some of the popular software tools used in the PV industry:
Public Domain (NREL/DOE)
	 • PVWATTS: www.nrel.gov/rredc/pvwatts/
	 • In My Back Yard (IMBY): www.nrel.gov/eis/imby/
	 • System Advisor Model (SAM): www.nrel.gov/analysis/sam/
NABCEP PV
Technical Sales
Certification
The NABCEP PV Techni-
cal Sales Certification is a
credential offered for those
specifically engaged in
marketing and the customer
development process for PV
installations. Further infor-
mation on this certification
program is available on the
NABCEP website:
http://www.nabcep.org/
certification/pv-technical-
sales-certification
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 11
Commercial
	 • Clean Power Estimator: www.cleanpower.com
	 • PVSYST: www.pvsyst.com
	 • OnGrid: www.ongrid.net
	 • PVSol: www.solardesign.co.uk/
	 • PV F-Chart: www.fchart.com
	 • Maui Solar Software: www.mauisolarsoftware.com/
	 • HOMER: www.homerenergy.com/
Manufacturers and Integrators
	 • Inverter string sizing and various system sizing and design tools
Assessing Energy Use
Knowledge of the customer’s electrical loads and energy use are important considerations for
any type of PV installation. The energy produced by PV systems will offset energy derived
from another source, and represents a return on the customer’s financial investment.
Be prepared to evaluate and discuss the customer’s energy use relative to the PV system
options and their expected performance. This can be as simple as reviewing electrical bills
for the past year or longer if available. See Fig 5. For new construction or off-grid applications,
the energy use can be estimated from equipment ratings and expected load use profiles, but
estimates can be highly inaccurate. Actual measurements are always preferred, and there are a
number of low-cost electronic watt-hour meters available that can be readily installed to mea-
sure specific loads, branch circuits or entire electrical services. Load information is used to size
and design PV systems, estimate their performance and to conduct financial evaluations.
For stand-alone PV applications, load energy consumption dictates the size and cost of the
PV system required, and is a critical design parameter. For these systems, accurate load as-
DSIRE
Many websites provide
information concern-
ing local and state
regulations for PV
installations, including
incentive programs,
utility interconnection
rules, and require-
ments for contractor
licensing, permitting
and inspection. The
Database of State
Incentives for Renew-
able Energy (DSIRE) is
an excellent source for
this information, and
includes up-to-date
summary information
and numerous links to
federal, state and local
websites. For addition-
al details, see: www.
dsireusa.org
Figure 4. The Database of State
Incentives for Renewable Energy
(DSIRE) contains information on rules,
regulations and policies for renewable
energy and energy efficiency programs
in all states.
Figure 5. Electric bills are reviewed as part of a site survey to evaluate
customer energy use.
System Components and Configurations: 4 - 5
Figure 5. Electric bills are reviewed as part of a site survey to evaluate customer energy use.
sessments are a must. In many cases, a
customer could have a greater benefit
in changing equipment or practices to
minimize their energy use, rather than
installing a larger PV system to offset
inefficient loads or habits.
Interactive (grid-connected) PV systems
may be designed to satisfy a portion of
existing site electrical loads, but gen-
erally no more than the total energy
requirements on a net basis. Systems us-
ing energy storage (batteries) for off-grid
and utility back-up applications require
a detailed load analysis, to adequately
size the array, battery and inverter for
stand-alone operation. Many PV system
12 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Power and Energy Basics
An understanding of power and energy fundamentals is essential for the
PV professional.
Electrical power is expressed in units of watts (W):
1 megawatt (MW) = 1,000 kilowatts (kW) = 1,000,000 watts (W)
Electrical energy is expressed in units of watt-hours (Wh):
1 kilowatt-hour (kWh) = 1000 Wh
Power and energy are related by time. Power is the rate of transferring
work or energy, and analogous to an hourly wage ($/hr) or the speed of a
vehicle (mi/hr). Energy is the total amount of work performed over time,
and analogous to total income earned ($) or distance traveled (mi). Simply
stated, energy is equal to the average power multiplied by time:
Energy (Wh) = Avg. Power (W) × time (hr)
sizing worksheets and software tools incorporate means to input a given electrical
load and estimate the PV to load energy contribution in the results.
Electrical loads are any type of device, equipment or appliance that consumes electri-
cal power. Electrical loads are characterized by their voltage, power consumption
and use profile. Many types of electrical loads and appliances are available in high-
efficiency models. Alternating-current (ac) loads are powered by inverters, generators
or the utility grid. Direct-current (dc) loads operate from a dc source, such as a bat-
tery. Some small off-grid PV system applications use only dc loads, and avoid having
to use an inverter to power ac loads.
2.2 	 Review Site Survey
Site surveys are used to collect information about the local conditions and issues affect-
ing a proposed PV installation. This information is documented through records, notes,
photographs, measurements and other observations and is the starting point for a PV
project. Ultimately, information from site surveys is used in combination with the cus-
tomer desires as the basis for preparing final quotations, system designs, and planning
the overall installation.
There are many aspects to conducting a thorough site survey. The level of detail
depends on the size and scope of the project, the type of PV system to be installed,
and where and how it will be installed. Greater considerations are usually associated
with commercial projects, due to the larger equipment and increased safety hazards
involved. Obtaining the necessary information during a site survey helps plan and
execute PV installations in a timely and cost-effective manner. It also begins the process
of assembling the system manuals and project documentation.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 13
A number of tools, measuring devices, special equipment and safety gear may be re-
quired for conducting site surveys. See Fig. 6. Some of the basic equipment includes:
	 • 	 Appropriate PPE including hardhats, safety glasses, safety shoes, gloves
		 and fall protection equipment
	 • 	 Basic hand tools, ladders, flashlights, mirrors and magnifying glasses
	 • 	 Tape measures, compasses, levels, protractors and solar shading calculators
	 • 	 Voltmeters, ammeters, watt and watt-hour meters, and power quality analyzers
	 • 	 Graph paper, calculator, audio recorders, cameras and electronic notebooks
A PV installer must evaluate whether a proposed site will be suitable for the installation
and proper operation of the system. In general, a site assessment involves determining:
	 • 	 A suitable location for the array
	 • 	 Whether the array can operate without being shaded during critical times
	 • 	 The mounting method for the array
	 • 	 Where the balance-of-system (BOS) components will be located
	 • 	 How the PV system will be interfaced with existing electrical systems
2.2.1	 Array Location	
PV arrays can be mounted on the ground, rooftops or any other suitable support struc-
ture. The primary considerations for optimal PV array locations include the following:
	 • 	 Is there enough surface area available to install the given size PV array?
	 • 	 Can the array be oriented to maximize the solar energy received?
	 • 	 Is the area minimally shaded, especially during the middle of the day?
	 • 	 Is the structure strong enough to support the array and installers?
	 • 	 How will the array be mounted and secured?
	 • 	 How far will the array be from other system equipment?
	 • 	 How will the array be installed and maintained?
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar System Components and Configurations: 4 - 6
Figure 6. A variety of tools and equipment may be required for a site survey.
Figure 6. A variety of tools and equipment may be required for a site survey.
14 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
	 • 	 Will the array be subjected to damage or accessible to unqualified persons?
	 • 	 Are there local fire codes or wind load concerns that limit rooftop areas
		 for PV installations?
	 • 	 Are there additional safety, installation or maintenance concerns?
The answers to these and other questions will help determine the best possible locations
for installing PV arrays. There are many trade-offs, and designers and installers need to
evaluate potential locations based on the site conditions and other available information,
and determine if a PV installation is feasible.
Array Area
Individual PV module characteristics and their layout dictate the overall surface area
required for a PV array with a specified peak power output rating. The surface area
required for a given array depends on many factors, including the individual module
dimensions, their spacing in the array, and the power conversion efficiency of the mod-
ules used. Fire safety codes, wind loads and accessibility to the array for installation and
maintenance must also be considered when evaluating suitable array locations and lay-
outs, and may limit possible locations to install PV arrays. PV arrays installed in multiple
rows of tilted racks or on trackers require additional spacing between each array mount-
ing structure to prevent row to row shading.
Power densities for PV arrays can vary between 6 and 15 watts per square foot (W/sf)
and higher, depending on module efficiency and array layout. For example, the power
density of a 175 watt crystalline silicon PV module with a surface area of 14.4 sf is calcu-
lated by:
		 175 W ÷ 14.4 sf = 12.2 W/sf
For a 4 kW PV array, the total module surface area required would be:
		 4000 W ÷ 12.2 W/sf = 328 sf
This is approximately the area of 10
sheets of plywood. Additional area is
usually required for the overall PV array
installation and other equipment. All
things considered, it usually takes about
80 to 100 sf of surface area for a 1 kWdc
rated PV array using standard crystalline
silicon PV modules. For example, assum-
ing an array power density of 10 W/sf,
a 1 MW PV array would require 100,000
sf of array area, slightly larger than two
acres and the approximate size of the
rooftops on big box retail establishments.
See Fig. 7.
Figure 7. For a power density of 10 watts per square foot, a 500 kW PV array can be installed in a
50,000 square foot area.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar System Components and Configurations: 4 - 7
Figure 7. For a power density of 10 watts per square foot, a 500 kW PV array can be installed in a
50,000 square foot area.
270 ft
370 ft
Total roof area:
100,000 sq. ft.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 15
Sun Position and the Solar Window
The location of the sun relative to any point on earth is defined by two ever-changing
angles. The solar azimuth angle defines the direction of the sun’s horizontal projection
relative to a point on earth, usually symbolized by the Greek letter Psi (c). For example,
with compass headings, north is 0° or 360°, east is 90°, south is 180° and west is 270°.
However, some solar equipment and computer programs use due south as the zero de-
gree reference because it simplifies the complex equations used to calculate sun position.
In these cases, solar azimuth angles west of south are typically represented by negative
angles (due west is -90°), and east of south is represented as a positive angle (due east
is +90°).
The solar altitude angle defines the sun’s elevation above the horizon, and commonly
symbolized by the Greek letter alpha (a). At sunrise and sunset, when the sun is on the
horizon, the sun’s altitude is 0°. If the sun is directly overhead, then its altitude is 90°
(at the zenith). The sun will be directly overhead at noontime some point during the
year only between the Tropic of Cancer and Tropic of Capricorn. This range of tropical
latitudes (23.45° north and south of the equator, respectively) is defined by the limits
of solar declination and sun position, which also define the beginnings of the seasons.
See Fig. 8.
A sun path or sun position diagram is a graphical representation of the sun’s altitude
and azimuth angles over a given day of the year, for the specified latitude. These charts
can be used to determine the sun’s position in the sky, for any latitude, at any time of
the day or year. Sun path diagrams are the basis for evaluating the effects of shading
on PV arrays and other types of solar collectors.
Typically, these charts include the sun paths for the solstices and at the equinoxes, and
sometimes the average monthly sun paths or for different seasons. At the equinoxes,
Figure 8. Sun position is defined by the azimuth and altitude angles. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 8
Figure 8. Sun position is defined by the azimuth and altitude angles.
North
West
South
East
Zenith
Horizontal
Plane
Altitude
Angle
Azimuth
Angle
Zenith
Angle
Solar Noon
Solar noon is the local time
when the sun is at its
highest point in the sky
and crossing the local
meridian (line of longi-
tude). However, solar noon
is not usually the same as
12 p.m. local time due to
offsets from Daylight
Savings Time, and the site
longitude relative to the
time zone standard meridi-
an, and eccentricities in the
earth-sun orbit. A simple
method to determine solar
noon is to find the local
sunrise and sunset times
and calculate the midpoint
between the two.
16 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
the sun paths are identical, and define the average sun path for the year. The equinox-
es define the first days of spring and fall, and everywhere on earth, the sun rises due
east and sets due west, and the sun is above the horizon for exactly 12 hours. On the
equinoxes, the sun is directly overhead (solar altitude is 90°), at solar noon everywhere
along the equator.
A sun path chart shows all possible sun positions over a day and the year. See Fig. 9.
This chart indicates that on the first day of winter (December 21), the sun rises at about
7 a.m. solar time and sets at about 5 p.m. On December 21, the sun’s highest altitude
is about 37° at noontime. On March 21 and September 21, the first days of spring and
fall, the sun rises at 6 a.m. at an azimuth of 90° and the highest sun altitude is 60° at
solar noon. On June 21, the first day of summer, the sun rises at about 5 a.m., reaches
a maximum altitude of about 83° and sets at about 7 p.m. At 9 a.m. on June 21, the
azimuth is approximately 95° (slightly north of east) and the altitude is approximately
49° (about half way between the horizon and zenith).
The winter and summer solstices define the minimum and maximum solar altitude
angles and the range of sun paths over a year. For any location on earth, the maximum
solar altitude at solar noon is a function of the solar declination and the local latitude.
Since we know solar altitude at solar noon on the equator is 90° at the equinoxes, the
solar altitude angle will be lower at higher latitudes by an amount equal to that lati-
tude plus the solar declination. For example, at 40° N latitude on the winter solstice,
the solar altitude angle at solar noon would be 90° - 40° + (-23.45°) = 26.55°. Converse-
ly, on the summer solstice at the same latitude, the maximum solar altitude would be
approximately 47° higher or about 73.5°, since the solar declination varies between
±23.45°. At the winter solstice, the sun is directly overhead along the Tropic of Capri-
corn (23.45° S) at solar noon, and at the summer solstice, the sun is directly overhead
along the Tropic of Cancer (23.45° N). See Figs. 10 a-c.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 9
Figure 9. A sun path chart shows the annual range of sun position for a given latitude.
Sun Position for 30o
N Latitude
8 AM
8 AM
8 AM
10 AM
10 AM
10 AM
Noon
Noon
Noon
11 AM
11 AM
11 AM
1 PM
1 PM
1 PM
2 PM
2 PM
2 PM
4 PM
4 PM
4 PM
0
15
30
45
60
75
90
(180)(150)(120)(90)(60)(30)0306090120150180
<< East (positive) << Azimuth Angle >> West (negative) >>
AltitudeAngle(positiveabovehorizon)
Winter Solstice Summer Solstice Vernal and Autumnal Equinox
Figure 9. A sun path chart shows the annual range of sun position for a given latitude.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 17
The solar window represents the range of sun paths for
a specific latitude between the winter and summer
solstices. Wherever possible, PV arrays should be ori-
ented toward the solar window for maximum solar
energy collection. As latitudes increase to the north
from the equator, the solar window is inclined at a
closer angle to the southern horizon. The sun paths
and days are longer during summer and shorter dur-
ing winter. For any location, the maximum altitude
of the sun paths at solar noon varies 47° between the
winter and summer solstices.
Figures 10a -10c. The solar window is defined by the limits of sun paths between the winter
and summer solstices.
Figure 10c.
Figure 10b.
Solar Declination
Solar declination (d) is the ever changing
angle between the earth’s equatorial plane
and the sun’s rays. This is the primary geo-
metric factor affecting the sun position and
the solar energy received at any point on
earth. Solar declination varies continuously
from –23.45° to +23.45° over the year in a
sinusoidal fashion, due the earth’s constant
tilt and elliptical orbit around the sun. The
limits of solar declination define the tropi-
cal and arctic latitudes, and the range of
sun position in the sky relative to any point
on earth. The winter and summer solstices
are defined by the minimum and maximum
limits of solar declination, respectively.
Solar declination is 0° at the equinoxes,
when the earth’s equatorial plane is aligned
directly toward the sun’s rays.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 11
Figure 10b.
Winter Solstice
Equinoxes
Summer Solstice
N
W S
E
Zenith
47
Tropic of Cancer
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 12
Figure 10c.
Winter Solstice
Equinoxes
Summer Solstice
N
W
S
E
Zenith
47
47° N
Figure 10a.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 10
Figure 10. The solar window is defined by the limits of sun paths between the winter and summer
solstices.
Winter Solstice
Equinoxes
Summer Solstice
N
W
S
E
Zenith
47
Equator
2.2.2	 Array Orientation
PV arrays should be oriented toward the solar window to receive the
maximum amount of solar radiation available at a site, at any time. The
closer an array surface faces the sun throughout every day and over a
year without being shaded, the more energy that system will produce,
and the more cost-effective the PV system becomes with respect to
alternative power options.
Similar to sun position, the orientation of PV arrays is defined by two
angles. The array azimuth angle is the direction an array surface faces
based on a compass heading or relative to due south. North is 0° or
360°, east is 90°, south is 180° and west is 270°. Unless site shading or
local weather patterns dictate otherwise, the optimal azimuth angle
for facing tilted PV arrays is due south (180° compass heading) in the
Northern Hemisphere, and due north in the Southern Hemisphere.
The array tilt angle is the angle between the array surface and the
horizontal plane. Generally, the higher the site latitude, the higher the
optimal tilt angle will be to maximize solar energy gain. A horizontal
18 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
array has a zero degree tilt angle, and a vertical array has a 90° tilt
angle. The array azimuth angle has no significance for horizontal
arrays, because they are always oriented horizontally no matter how
they are rotated. See Fig. 13.
nlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 13
Figure 11. Magnetic compass readings must be corrected for magnetic declination.
West East
Geographic
North
South - 180
Magnetic
North
270 90
0
180
Magnetic Declination
(Positive, Eastern)
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 14
Figure 12. The western U.S. has positive (easterly) declination, and will cause a compass needle
to point east of geographic north.
USGS
East Declination
(positive)
West Declination
(negative)
Figure 11. Magnetic compass readings must be corrected for
magnetic declination.
Figure 12. The western U.S. has positive (easterly) declination, and will cause a compass needle to point east of
geographic north.
For unshaded locations, the maximum annual solar energy is received
on a surface that faces due south, with a tilt angle slightly less than the
local latitude. This is due to longer days and sun paths and generally
sunnier skies during summer months, especially at temperate lati-
tudes. Fall and winter performance can be enhanced by tilting arrays
at angles greater than the local latitude, while spring and summer per-
formance is enhanced by tilting arrays at angles lower than the local
latitude. Adjustable-tilt or sun-tracking arrays can be used to increase
the amount of solar energy received on a daily, seasonal or annual
basis, but have higher costs and complexity than fixed-tilt arrays.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 1
Figure 13. The orientation of PV arrays is defined by the surface azimuth and tilt angles.
West
North
East
South
Zenith
South-facing array
Southwest-facing array
Tilt
Angle
Azimuth
Angle
Surface
Normal
Surface
Direction
Figure 13. The orientation of PV arrays is defined by the surface azimuth and tilt angles.
Magnetic Declination
Magnetic declination is the angle between mag-
netic north and the true geographic North Pole,
and varies with location and over time. Magnet-
ic declination adjustments are made when using
a magnetic compass and with some solar shad-
ing devices to accurately determine due south.
Magnetic compasses and devices incorporating
them usually have a revolving bezel to adjust
for magnetic declination. See Fig. 11.
Magnetic declination is considered positive
when magnetic north is east of true north and
negative when magnetic north is west of true
north. The western U.S. has positive (easterly)
declination, and the eastern U.S. has negative
(westerly) declination. Magnetic declination is
near zero on a line running through Pensacola,
FL, Springfield, IL and Duluth, MN, called an
agonic line. The greatest magnetic declination
occurs in the northeastern and northwestern
most parts of the U.S. and North America. For
example, a compass needle points 15° east of
geographic north in Central California. Con-
versely, a compass needle points about 13° west
of geographic north in New Jersey. In most of
the central and southern U.S., magnetic declina-
tion is small and can usually be neglected, espe-
cially considering the small effects of changing
array azimuth angle by a few degrees. See Fig. 12.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 19
Varying the array tilt angle results in significant seasonal differences in the amount of
solar energy received, but has a smaller impact on the total annual solar energy received.
See Fig 14. For stand-alone PV systems installed at higher than tropical latitudes, the
optimal tilt angle can significantly reduce the size and cost of the system required to meet
a given load. For systems that have winter-dominant loads, arrays should be tilted at an
angle of latitude +15°. If the array is being designed to meet a summer-dominant load,
the array should to be tilted at an angle of latitude –15° to maximize solar energy
collection during summer months.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 16
Figure 14. Array tilt angle affects seasonal performance.
West
North
East
South
Winter Solstice
Equinoxes
Summer Solstice
Zenith
Latitude+15 tilt maximizes fall
and winter performance
Close to Latitude tilt maximizes
annual performance
Latitude-15 tilt maximizes spring
and summer performance
Figure 14. Array tilt angle affects seasonal performance.
The effects of non-
optimal array orienta-
tion are of particular
interest to PV installers
and customers, be-
cause many potential
array locations, such as
rooftops do not have
optimal solar orienta-
tions. When trade-offs
are being made be-
tween orientation and
aesthetics, having this
information available
can help the prospec-
tive owner and in-
staller make decisions
about the best possible
array locations and
their orientation.
Multiplication factors can be used to adjust PV system annual energy production for
various tilt angles relative to the orientation that achieves the maximum annual energy
production, and are region specific. See Table 1. These tables help provide a better un-
derstanding of the impacts of array orientation on the amount of solar energy received,
and the total energy produced by a PV system. In fact, the amount of annual solar energy
received varies little with small changes in the array azimuth and tilt angles.
For south-facing arrays, array tilt angles close to 30º (a 7:12 pitch roof) produce nearly the
maximum amount of energy on an annual basis for much of the continental U.S. How-
ever, arrays oriented within 45º of due south (SE and SW) produce very close to the same
energy (within 7%) as a south-facing array. Since shading losses are often much higher,
these orientation losses tend to be smaller than one might expect. Even horizontally
mounted (flat) arrays will produce more energy than systems using tilted arrays facing to
the east or west.
For some utility-interactive PV system installations, it may be desirable to face an array
toward the southwest or even due west, provided that the array tilt is below 45º. West-
20 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
erly orientations tend to shift the peak array power output to the afternoon during utility
peak hours, but do not necessarily maximize the energy production or financial benefit
to the system owner if they are not the utility. Some net metering programs offer time-
of-use rate structures to encourage the production of energy during utility peak hours. A
careful analysis using an hourly computer simulation program is necessary to determine
the cost benefit of these orientations. A minimum of six hours of unshaded operation is
still important for best system performance.
Note: The tables and charts showing the effects array orientation on the solar energy received and the energy produced by PV arrays were derived with data generated
from PVWatts running simulations for various locations with different array tilt and azimuth angles.
Table 1. Array orientation factors can be used to adjust the maximum available solar radiation for non-optimal orientations.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 18
Figure 16. PVWatts is an online tool used to estimate the performance of interactive PV systems.
NREL
PVWatts™
PVWatts™ is an online software model produced by the National
Renewable Energy Laboratory to estimate the performance of
grid-connected PV systems. See Fig 16. The user defines the site
location, the maximum power for the PV array, the array mount-
ing and orientation, and selects the appropriate derating factors.
The software models the PV system output at each hour over a
typical year, using archived solar resource and weather data. This
tool can be used to evaluate the solar energy collected and energy
produced by grid-tied PV systems for any location and for any
array azimuth and tilt angles. To run PVWatts™ online, see:
http://rredc.nrel.gov/solar/calculators/PVWATTS/version1/.
Figure 16. PVWatts is an online tool used to estimate the
performance of interactive PV systems.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 21
Contour charts may also be used to plot similar data comparing the effects of array
orientation on the amount of solar energy received. See Fig. 15. These charts clearly show
that for lower latitudes and array tilt angles closer to horizontal, array azimuth angles
as much as 90º from due south have a minimal effect on the solar energy received. The
reduction in solar energy received for off-azimuth orientations increases with increasing
tilt angles and at higher latitudes. Generally, for most of the central and southern U.S.,
fixed-tilt arrays with azimuth angles ±45 degrees from due south and tilt angles ±15 of
the local latitude will receive at least 90% of the annual solar energy as for optimally
tilted south-facing surfaces.
2.2.3	 Perform a Shading Analysis
A shading analysis evaluates and quantifies the impacts of shading on PV arrays. Shad-
ing may be caused by any obstructions in the vicinity of PV arrays that interfere with
the solar window, especially obstructions to the east, south and west of an array. This
includes trees, towers, power lines, buildings and other structures, as well as obstruc-
tions close to and immediately around the array, such as antennas, chimneys, plumbing
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 17
270 240 210 180 150 120 90
0
15
30
45
60
Azimuth (deg)
Tilt(deg)
Available Irradiation (% of maximum)
95-100
90-95
85-90
80-85
75-80
70-75
270 240 210 180 150 120 90
0
15
30
45
60
Azimuth (deg)
Tilt(deg)
Available Irradiation (% of maximum)
95-100
90-95
85-90
80-85
75-80
70-75
Miami, FL Boston, MA
Figure 15. The effects of varying array tilt and azimuth angles are location dependent.
Figure 17. Shading of PV arrays can be caused by any
obstructions interfering with the solar window.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 1
Figure 17. Shading of PV arrays can be caused by any obstructions interfering with the solar
window.
LADWP
vents, dormer windows and even from other parts of
the array itself. See Fig 17. Shading of PV arrays can also
be caused by accumulated soiling on the array surface,
which can be particularly severe in more arid regions
like the western U.S., requiring regular cleaning to en-
sure maximum system output.
PV arrays should be unshaded at least 6 hours during
the middle of the day to produce the maximum energy
possible. Ideally, there should be no shading on arrays
between the hours of 9 a.m. and 3 p.m. solar time over
the year, since the majority of solar radiation and peak
system output occur during this period. However, this is
not always achievable and tradeoffs are made concern-
ing the specific array location, or mitigating the shad-
ing obstructions if possible (e.g., trimming or removing
22 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
trees, etc.). Even a small amount of shading on PV arrays during peak generation times
can dramatically reduce the output of the system.
Sun path charts are the basis for conducting shading evaluations. By measuring the
worst-case altitude and azimuth angles of a shading object from an array location, a scale
image of the obstruction can be plotted on a sun position chart for the given latitude.
This shows the portion of the solar window that is obstructed by shading. Knowing the
amount of receivable solar energy during different periods of a day, the shading analysis
can be used to estimate the reduction in solar radiation received during the shaded times
of the day and year, and ultimately estimate the reduced energy production for a PV
system. These are the fundamental principles used for a shading analysis. Most system
design and performance estimating tools also incorporate shading factors to derate the
system output accordingly.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 20
Figure 18. Various devices are used to determine the extent of shading for potential PV array
locations.
Solar Pathfinder
Solmetric SunEye
Wiley ASSET
Figure 18. Various devices are used to determine the extent of shading for potential PV array locations.
To simplify shading evaluations, several
devices and software tools have been com-
mercially developed. See Fig. 18. These
devices are all based on sun path charts
and viewing the solar window at pro-
posed array locations. The devices project
or record obstructions in the solar window,
and estimate the net solar energy received
after shading. PV installers should be
familiar with these tools, their principles
of operation and how to obtain accurate
results. More elaborate architectural
software tools, such as Google Sketch-up
and CAD programs can allow designers to
simulate complex shading problems and
provide detailed designs and renderings
of proposed PV installations.
Sources for shading evaluation tools and software include:
	 • Solar Pathfinder™: www.solarpathfinder.com
	 • Solmetric SunEye™: www.solmetric.com
	 • Wiley ASSET™: www.we-llc.com
	 • Google SketchUp™: sketchup.google.com
For larger PV systems with multiple parallel rows one in front of another in the array,
one row of modules can shade the one in back during winter months if the rows are
too closely spaced. A six-inch shadow from an adjacent row of modules is capable
of shutting down an entire string or row of modules depending on the direction of
the shadows and the electrical configuration of the array. A simple rule for minimum
spacing between rows is to allow a space equal to three times the height of the top
of the row or obstruction in front of an array. This rule applies to the spacing for any
obstructions in front of an array.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 23
For example, if the height of an array is three (3) feet, the minimum separation distance
should be nine (9) feet since the height of the adjacent row if it is three feet above the
front of the next row. See Fig. 19. In the southern half of the United States, a closer spac-
ing may be possible, depending on the prescribed limits to avoid shading. However,
even at the lowest latitudes the spacing should not be less than two times the height
of the top of the adjacent module. Multiple rows of PV arrays can also be more closely
spaced using lower tilt angles, and even with the orientation penalty of a lesser tilt angle,
it is usually a better option than to suffer shading losses.
The minimum required separation distances between PV array rows and other obstruc-
tions depends on latitude, the height of the obstruction, and the time of day and year that
shading is desired to be avoided. To avoid shading at the winter solstice between
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 21
Figure 19. Multiple rows of rack-mounted PV arrays must be separated far enough apart to
prevent shading.
D
Sun
PV Array H
β
Figure 19. Multiple rows of rack-mounted PV arrays must be separated far enough apart to prevent shading.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 22
Figure 20. The minimum required separation distances between PV array rows and other
obstructions depends on latitude, the height of the obstruction, and the time of day and year.
D
Separation Factor vs. Latitude for South-Facing Array Rows
To Avoid Shading on Winter Solstice at Specified Solar Time
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60
Latitude (deg N)
SeparationFactor,Distance/Height(D/H)
8 am - 4 pm
9 am - 3 pm
10 am - 2 pm
11 am - 1 pm
Figure 20. The minimum required separation distances between PV array rows or other obstructions depends on
latitude, the height of the obstruction, and the time of day and year to avoid shading.
9 a.m. and 3 p.m. solar time,
the separation distance
between PV arrays and ob-
structions should be at least
2 times the height of the ob-
struction at latitudes around
30°, 2-1/2 times the height at
latitudes around 35°, 3 times
the height at 40° latitude
and 4 times the height at 45°
latitude. See Fig. 20.
24 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
2.2.4	 Array Mounting Methods
PV arrays can be mounted on the ground, rooftops and other structures that provide
adequate protection, support and solar access. The site conditions usually dictate the
best mounting system location and approach to use.
Rooftops are very popular locations for installing PV arrays. Because they are elevated,
roof mounts offer some physical protection and limited access to the array for safety, and
usually provide better sun exposure. Rooftop PV installations also do not occupy space
on the ground that might be needed for other purposes. Rooftop and other building-
mounted PV arrays must be structurally secured and any attachments and penetrations
must be properly weathersealed. Available rooftop areas for mounting PV arrays may be
limited by any number of factors, including required spaces about the array for instal-
lation and service, pathways and ventilation access for fire codes, wind load setbacks,
and spaces for other equipment. Sloped roofs also present a significant fall hazard, and
require appropriate fall protection systems and/or personal fall arrest systems (PFAS) for
installers and maintenance workers.
The layout of a PV array can have a significant effect on its natural cooling and operating
temperatures. A landscape (horizontal) layout may have a slight benefit over a portrait
(vertical) layout when considering the passive cooling of the modules. Landscape is
when the dimension parallel to the eaves is longer than the dimension perpendicular to
the eaves. In a landscape layout, air spends less time under the module before escap-
ing and provides more uniform cooling. Standoff mounts operate coolest when they are
mounted at least 3 inches above a roof.
Key items to evaluate during a site survey for roof-mounted PV arrays include:
	 • Building type and roof design
	 • Roof dimensions, slope and orientation
	 • Roof surface type, condition and structural support
	 • Fall protection methods required
	 • Access for installation and maintenance
 
Ground-mounted PV arrays are commonly used for larger systems, or where rooftop in-
stallations are not possible or practical. Ground-mounts can use a variety of racks, poles
and other foundations to support the arrays. Ground-mounted arrays are generally more
susceptible to damage than roof-mounted arrays, although their location and orientation
is less constrained than for rooftop installations. If an array is mounted at ground level,
NEC 690.31(A) requires that the wiring be protected from ready access. Several options
may be possible to meet this requirement, including protecting the wiring with non-
conductive screening like PVC, limiting access with security fencing, or by elevating the
array. Elevating arrays also provides physical protection, and usually helps avoid shad-
ing concerns that may exist at lower heights.
Site surveys for ground-mounted PV arrays should consider:
	 • Zoning and land use restrictions
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 25
	 • Terrain, elevations and grading requirements
	 • Soil type and array ground-cover
	 • Water table, flood zones and drainage
	 • Array foundation requirements
	 • Security requirements and fencing
	 • Access for vehicles, equipment and maintenance
The following are common types of PV array mounting systems:
Integral mounting systems are where modules are integrated into the roofing or
building exterior. These systems are sometimes referred to as building-integrated PV
or BIPV.
Standoff mounting, referred to by some as flush mounting, uses standoffs attached to
the roof to support rails on which PV modules are attached. This is the most common
method for residential installations. See Fig. 21.
Figure 21. Standoff mounts are the most common way PV arrays are attached to sloped rooftops.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 23
Figure 21. Standoff mounts are the most common way PV arrays are attached to sloped rooftops.
Gary Lee Sharp Solar
op Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 23
Figure 21. Standoff mounts are the most common way PV arrays are attached to sloped rooftops.
y Lee Sharp Solar
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 23
Figure 21. Standoff mounts are the most common way PV arrays are attached to sloped rooftops.
Gary Lee Sharp Solar
Ballasted mounting systems are often used in large-scale flat roof commercial projects.
These mounting systems require engineering for roof structural loading and ballast re-
quirements. Often roof tethers augment the ballast for seismic concerns or excessive wind
requirements. See Fig. 22.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 24
Figure 22. Self-ballasted PV arrays are a type of rack mount that relies on the weight of a the PV
modules, support structure and additional ballast material to secure the array.
Ascension Technology
University of Wyoming
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 24
Figure 22. Self-ballasted PV arrays are a type of rack mount that relies on the weight of a the PV
modules, support structure and additional ballast material to secure the array.
Ascension Technology
University of Wyoming
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 24
Figure 22. Self-ballasted PV arrays are a type of rack mount that relies on the weight of a the PV
modules, support structure and additional ballast material to secure the array.
Ascension Technology
University of Wyoming
Figure 22. Self-ballasted PV arrays are a type of rack mount that relies on the weight of a the PV modules, support
structure and additional ballast material to secure the array.
Rack mounting is typically used for non-tracking systems at ground level and on flat
rooftops. This method is typical on large commercial or utility-scale arrays.
Pole mounting, is typically used with manufactured racks mounted on top or attached to
the side of a steel pole. Pole-top arrays are common for off-grid residential PV systems,
26 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
since the weight of the array is
balanced over the pole, allow-
ing easy seasonal adjustment.
Side-of-pole mounts are most
common in small one- or two-
module applications where
the entire system, such as remote
telemetry application, is mount-
ed on a single pole. See Fig. 23.
Tracking mounting systems are
systems that follow the sun on
a daily or seasonal basis. Track-
ing may increase summer gain
by 30% or more, but winter gain
may be 15% or less. Tracking
may be two-axis for maximum
performance or single-axis for
simplicity and reliability.
See Fig. 24.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 25
Figure 23. Pole-mounted arrays use either fixed, adjustable, or sun-tracking arrays installed on a rigid metal pipe.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 26
Figure 24. Sun-tracking arrays are typically mounted on poles and increase the amount of solar
energy received.
NREL, Warren Gretz
Figure 24. Sun-tracking arrays are typically mounted on poles and increase the amount of solar energy received.
Roof Structure and Condition
An important consideration for roof-mounted PV arrays is to assess the condition of the
roofing system and determine whether the roof and its underlying structure can support
the additional load.
Structural loads on buildings are due to the weight of building materials, equipment and
workers, as well as contributions from outside forces like hydrostatic loads on founda-
tions, wind loads and seismic loads. The requirements for determining structural loads
on buildings and other structures are given in the standard ASCE 7 – Minimum Design
Loads for Buildings and other Structures, which has been adopted into the building codes.
A structural engineer should be consulted if the roof structure is in question, or if specific
load calculations are required for local code compliance.
Common stand-off roof-mounted PV arrays, including the support structures generally
weigh between 3 and 5 pounds per square foot (psf), which should be fine for most roofs
designed to recent standards. Generally, houses built since the early 1970’s have been
through more rigorous inspection and tend to have more standard roof structures than
those built prior to that period. If the attic is accessible, a quick inspection of the type of
roof construction is worthwhile, and will help determine the appropriate attachment
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 27
system to use for the array. Span tables are available in various references, which
can help quantify the load-bearing capabilities of roof trusses or beams. For further
information see: www.solarabcs.org/permitting
Wind loads are a primary concern for PV arrays, especially in hurricane-prone
regions. The design wind loads for PV arrays in some Atlantic and Gulf coastal re-
gions can exceed 50 PSF and greater on certain portions of a roof or structure. While
common stand-off PV arrays do not generally contribute to any additional wind
loads on a structure, the array attachment points to the structure or foundation
must be of sufficient strength to withstand the design loads.
For example, a 15 square-foot PV module could impose an uplift load of 750 pounds
under a design load of 50 psf. A panel of four of these modules can impose a load
of 3,000 pounds on the entire mounting structure. If the panel is secured by six roof
attachments, and if the forces are distributed equally, there would be a 500-pound
force on each attachment, and it must be designed and installed to resist this maxi-
mum uplift force. Several manufacturers of roof mounting systems provide engi-
neering analysis for their mounting systems and attachment hardware. Without this
documentation, local inspectors may require that a custom mounting system have
a structural analysis from a professional engineer for approval. This engineering
documentation easily justifies the additional costs of purchasing mounting hard-
ware from a qualified mounting system manufacturer.
 
The age and condition of the roof covering must also be evaluated. If the roof cover-
ing is due for replacement within the next 5 to 10 years, it typically makes sense
to roof the building before installing the PV system, as the array would need to be
removed and replaced before and after the roofing work.Different types of roof
coverings have different lifetime expectations and degradation mechanisms, and
wherever roofing issues are a concern for PV installation, it is highly advisable to
engage a licensed roofing contractor in the project.
Before recommending or deciding on any PV array mounting system, verify with
the mounting system supplier that the hardware is appropriate for the given ap-
plication.Also, it is generally not advisable to try to fabricate or copy a mounting
system design for smaller projects. This usually costs much more than purchasing a
pre-engineered system, and may not meet the structural or environmental require-
ments of the application. PV array mounting structures also must be electrically
connected to the equipment grounding system, and special bonding jumpers and
connectors are available to maintain electrical continuity across separate structural
components. Oftentimes, local jurisdictions require engineering documentation to
certify the structural integrity of the mounting system and attachments.
Commercial Roof Mounting Options
PV arrays are mounted on large commercial buildings with flat composition roofs
using a variety of racking systems. These mounting structures may be secured by
fasteners and physical attachments to the building structure, or by using ballasted
racking, or a combination of both to hold the array in place.
28 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Ballasted mounting systems are significantly heavier than mounting systems de-
signed for direct structural attachments, depending on the weight of ballast used,
and usually require special load calculations. The main advantages of ballasted
mounts include easier installation, and by eliminating direct structural attachments
and penetrations into the structure, the possibility of roof leaks is greatly dimin-
ished. Ballasted mounting systems are engineered for specific wind loads and roof
structures, and have very specific requirements on how to install the array. Even
when wind loading is not a concern, additional restraints may be required on
ballasted arrays for seismic loads.
 
2.2.5	 BOS Locations
Any site survey also includes identifying proposed locations for all BOS compo-
nents, including inverters, disconnects, overcurrent devices, charge controllers,
batteries, junction boxes, raceways, conductors and any other electrical apparatus or
mechanical equipment associated with the system. The PV installer must ensure that
all equipment locations are suitable for the intended equipment.
Considerations for BOS locations include providing for accessibility to the equip-
ment for installation and maintenance. Some BOS components may need to be
installed in weather-resistant or rain-tight enclosures if they are not installed in-
doors. Other components, including many utility-interactive inverters, may already
be rated for wet and outdoor locations. Minimum clearances and working spaces are
required for electrical equipment that may be serviced in an energized state. Dedi-
cated clear spaces are also required above and in front of all electrical equipment.
These and many other installation requirements are outlined in Article 110 of the
NEC: Requirements for Electrical Installations.
Avoid installing electrical equipment in locations exposed to high temperatures and
direct sunlight wherever possible, and provide adequate ventilation and cooling
for heat-generating equipment such as inverters, generators and chargers. Consid-
erations should also be taken to protect equipment from insects, rodents, and other
debris. All electrical equipment must be properly protected from the environment
unless the equipment has applicable ratings. This includes protection from dust, rain
and moisture, chemicals and other environmental factors. All electrical equipment
contains instructions on the proper installation of the equipment, and for the
environmental conditions for which it is rated.
Some equipment has special considerations, covered under different sections of the
electrical and building codes, and in manufacturer’s instructions. For example, bat-
tery locations should be protected from extreme cold, which reduces their available
capacity. Battery containers and installation must follow the requirements in NEC
480. Major components are generally located as close together as possible, and to
the electrical loads or services that they supply, in order to minimize the length of
conductors, voltage drop and the costs for the installation.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 29
2.3	 Confirm System Sizing
2.3.1 Size the Module Mounting Area
If a roof is selected for the array location, then it is necessary to determine whether the
roof is large enough for the proposed number of PV modules. For roof areas with non-
rectangular shapes, determining the amount of useable roof area can be a challenge.
When laying out a plan for mounting modules on a roof, access to the modules must be
provided for maintenance. For easiest access, a walkway should be provided between
rows of modules. However, this consumes valuable roof area, so a balance needs to be
made between the area for the array and access. New requirements in the 2012 Inter-
national Fire Code [IFC 605.11] require clear space at the edges and peaks of roofs for
firefighter access. This poses a challenge to roof-mounted PV systems. Often, only 50%
to 80% of the roof area that has a suitable orientation can be used for mounting modules
when room for maintenance, wiring paths, firefighter access and aesthetic considerations
are taken into account.
To determine the size of the PV array (ultimately the power rating of the system) that can
be installed, the usable roof area must be first established. The dimensions and orien-
tation of individual modules may allow various layouts for the array that ultimately
need to fit within the usable areas of the roof. The location of structural attachments, the
desired electrical configuration, and wire routing are also important considerations when
determining the best layout. Computer-aided drawing tools can be helpful in determin-
ing possible acceptable array layouts given module and roof dimensions.
Smaller array surface areas are required to generate the same amount of power with
higher efficiency modules. By definition, a 10% efficient PV module has a power density
of 100 W/m2
(approximately 10 W/sf) peak power output when exposed to 1000 W/m2
solar irradiance. Crystalline silicon PV modules may have efficiencies 12% to 15% and
higher for special higher-price models. Higher efficiency modules means less support
structure, wiring methods and other installation hardware are required for an array. Most
thin-film PV module technologies have efficiencies below 10%, and require correspond-
ingly larger array areas to produce an equal amount of power.
For example, consider a roof with overall dimensions of 14’ by 25’ (350 sf) with a usable
area of 250 sf (71% of total). This roof area would be sufficient for a 2.5 kW crystalline
silicon array (250 sf x 10 W/sf= 2500 W) or an 8% efficient thin film array of about 2 kW.
2.3.2	 Arrange Modules in Mounting Area
Siting the PV array in the available mounting area can have a large impact on the per-
formance of a PV array. In addition to shading and orientation, the array layout must be
consistent with the electrical string layout. A string is a series-connection of PV modules
in an array. Each set of modules in a series string must be oriented in the same direction
if the string is to produce its full output potential. For example, if a string has 12 modules
in series, all 12 modules must be in the same or parallel planes of a roof and ideally be
30 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
shade-free at the same time. It is possible to split a string between two roof faces, pro-
vided the modules face the same direction. The outputs of multiple strings having similar
voltage but using different current output modules, or facing different directions may be
connected in parallel.
	
This characteristic of string inverters poses a design challenge on many residential proj-
ects. For instance, a roof may be large enough to hold 24 modules on the south and west
faces together. However, the south face may be large enough to mount 16 modules and
the west face only large enough to mount 8 modules. If the inverter requires 12 modules
in series, the west face is not usable and the south face will only permit 12 modules to be
installed. This means that only half the potential array area can be utilized by that string
inverter system. This example suggests that it might be reasonable to find an inverter
with lower input voltage that only requires 8 modules in series, or consider using module
level micro-inverters to avoid string sizing requirements altogether.
 
2.4	 Review Design Energy Storage Systems
A battery converts chemical energy to electrical energy when it is discharged, and con-
verts electrical energy to chemical energy when it is charged. Because the power pro-
duced by PV arrays does not always coincide with electrical loads, batteries are common-
ly used in most stand-alone PV systems to store energy produced by the PV array, for
use by system loads as required. Batteries also establish the dc operating voltage for
the PV array, charge controllers and dc utilization equipment, including inverters and
dc loads, as applicable.
Batteries are sometimes used in interactive systems, but only with special types of
battery-based inverters intended for interactive operation, also called multi-mode invert-
ers. These inverters operate as diversionary charge controllers and dump excess PV array
energy to the grid when it is energized [NEC 690.72]. When there is a loss of grid voltage,
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 27
Figure 25. Utility-interactive systems with battery storage are similar to uninterruptible power
supplies, and have many similar components.
Inverter/
Charger
Critical Load
Sub Panel
Backup
AC Loads
Main Panel
Primary
AC Loads
Electric
Utility
Bypass circuit
BatteryPV Array
AC Out AC In
DC
In/out
Charge
Control
Figure 25. Utility-interactive systems with battery storage are similar to uninterruptible power supplies, and
have many similar components.
these inverters transfer loads from
the grid to operate in stand-alone
mode. Interactive systems with
battery backup cost significantly
more to install than simple inter-
active systems without batteries,
due to the additional equipment
required (special inverters, batteries
and charge controllers). The design
and installation of these systems
is also more complex, and usually
involves conducting a load analysis
and reconfiguring branch circuits in
dedicated subpanels. See Fig. 25.
 
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 31
The lead-acid cell is the most common type of storage battery used in PV systems. Oc-
casionally nickel-cadmium or other battery technologies are used. Newer battery types
like lithium-ion are also becoming possible as the costs of these battery systems continue
to decrease and performance improves.
A motive power or traction battery is a type of lead-acid battery designed for use in deep
discharge applications, such as electric vehicles. Motive power batteries are robust and
are commonly used in stand-alone PV systems. A starting, lighting and ignition (SLI) bat-
tery has a larger number of thinner plates to provide a greater surface and can deliver
higher discharge currents, but are damaged by frequent and deep discharges, and are sel-
dom used in PV systems. Deep discharge-type batteries differ from automobile starting
batteries in several respects, mainly their designs use heavier, thicker plates and stronger
inter-cell connections to better withstand the mechanical stresses on the battery under
frequent deep discharges.
Flooded batteries have a liquid electrolyte solution. Open-vent flooded types have
removable vent caps and permit electrolyte maintenance and water additions. Valve-reg-
ulated lead-acid (VRLA) batteries have an immobilized electrolyte in gel form or absorbed
in fiberglass separator mats between the plates. VRLA batteries are spill proof and do not
require electrolyte maintenance, however they are more expensive and less tolerant of
overcharging and higher operating temperatures than flooded types. Charge controllers
must use appropriate charge regulation settings for the type of battery used. See Fig 26.
Vented lead-acid batteries release hydrogen and oxygen gases, under normal charging
conditions. This is due to electrolysis of the electrolyte solution during final charging
stages, and results in water loss. Consequently, adequate ventilation must be provided
for both vented and sealed battery systems [NEC 480.9 and 480.10]. While it is difficult to
determine adequate ventilation requirements, it is generally advisable to provide greater
2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Batteries: 6 - 28
Figure 26. Both flooded and sealed lead-acid batteries are commonly used in PV systems.
BATTERY TYPE ADVANTAGES DISADVANTAGES
FLOODED LEAD-ACID
Lead-Antimony
low cost, wide availability, good deep cycle
and high temperature performance, can
replenish electrolyte
high water loss and maintenance
Lead-Calcium Open-Vent
low cost, wide availability, low water loss,
can replenish electrolyte
poor deep cycle performance, intolerant to
high temperatures and overcharge
Lead-Calcium Sealed-Vent
low cost, wide availability, low water loss poor deep cycle performance, intolerant to
high temperatures and overcharge, can not
replenish electrolyte
Lead-Antimony/Calcium Hybrid
medium cost, low water loss limited availability, potential for stratification
VALVE-REGULATED
LEAD-ACID
Gelled
medium cost, little or no maintenance, less
susceptible to freezing, install in any
orientation
fair deep cycle performance, intolerant to
overcharge and high temperatures, limited
availability
Absorbed Glass Mat
medium cost, little or no maintenance, less
susceptible to freezing, install in any
orientation
fair deep cycle performance, intolerant to
overcharge and high temperatures, limited
availability
NICKEL-CADMIUM
Sealed Sintered-Plate
wide availability, excellent low and high
temperature performance, maintenance free
only available in low capacities, high cost,
suffer from ‘memory’ effect
Flooded Pocket-Plate
excellent deep cycle and low and high
temperature performance, tolerance to
overcharge
limited availability, high cost, water additions
required
Figure 26. Both flooded and
sealed lead-acid batteries
are commonly used in PV
systems.
32 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
ventilation than necessary. A good rule is to provide similar ventilation to a battery room
as is required for a combustion water heater. VRLA batteries do not release gasses under
normal charging, and have lower ventilation requirements than flooded open vent types.
Capacity is a measure of battery energy storage, commonly rated in ampere-hours (Ah)
or kilowatt-hours (kWh). For example, a nominal 6-volt battery rated at 220 Ah stores
1.32 kWh of energy. Battery design features that affect battery capacity include the quan-
tity of active material, the number, design and physical size of the plates, and electrolyte
specific gravity. Usable capacity is always less than the rated battery capacity. Opera-
tional factors that affect the usable battery capacity include discharge rate, cut-off voltage,
temperature and age of the battery. See Fig. 27.
The rate of charge or discharge is expressed as a ratio of the nominal battery capacity (C) to
the charge or discharge time period in hours. For example, a nominal 100 ampere-hour
battery discharged at 5 amps for 20 hours is considered a C/20, or 20-hour discharge rate.
The higher the discharge rate and lower the temperature, the less capacity that can be
withdrawn from a battery to a specified cutoff voltage. See Fig. 28.
State-of-charge is the percentage of available battery capacity compared to a fully charged
state. Depth-of-discharge is the percentage of capacity that has been removed from a bat-
tery compared to a fully charged state. The state-of-charge and depth-of-discharge for a
battery add to 100 percent. The allowable depth-of-discharge is the maximum limit of battery
discharge in operation. The allowable depth-of-discharge is usually limited to no more
than 75 to 80% for deep cycle batteries, and must also be limited to protect lead-acid bat-
teries from freezing in extremely cold conditions.
 
Specific gravity is the ratio of the density of a solution to the density of water. Sulfuric-
acid electrolyte concentration is measured by its specific gravity, and related to battery
state of charge. A fully charged lead-acid cell has a typical specific gravity between 1.26
and 1.28 at room temperature. The specific gravity may be increased for lead-acid batteries
Batteries: 6 - 29
Voltage(V)
Capacity (Ah)
Cut off voltage
High discharge rate
Low discharge rate
Figure 27. Battery capacity is a measure of the stored energy
that a battery can deliver under specified conditions.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
100
110
120
-30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50
C/500 C/120
C/50 C/5
C/0.5
Battery Operating Temperature ( o
C )
Percentof25o
CCapacity
Figure 28. The higher the discharge rate and the lower the temperature, the less capacity that can be
withdrawn from a battery to a specified cutoff voltage.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 33
used in cold weather applications. Conversely, the specific gravity may be decreased for
applications in warm climates to prolong battery life.
In very cold climates, batteries must be protected from freezing by installing in a suit-
able enclosure, or by limiting the depth of discharge. Because the density of electrolyte
decreases with increasing temperature, specific gravity readings must be adjusted for
temperature. Inconsistent specific gravity readings between cells in a flooded lead-acid
battery indicate the need for an equalizing charge.
Many factors and trade-offs are considered in battery selection and systems design, and
are often dictated by the application or site requirements. Among the factors to consider
in the specification and design of battery systems include:
	 • Electrical properties: voltage, capacity, charge/discharge rates
	 • Performance: cycle life vs. DOD, system autonomy
	 • Physical properties: Size and weight, termination types
	 • Maintenance requirements: Flooded or VRLA
	 • Installation: Location, structural requirements, environmental conditions
	 • Safety and auxiliary systems: Racks, trays, fire protection, electrical BOS
	 • Costs, warranty and availability
Most PV systems using batteries require a charge controller to protect the batteries from
overcharge by the array. Only certain exceptions apply for special self-regulated systems,
which are designed using very low charge rates, special lower voltage PV modules,
larger batteries and well-defined, automated loads. If the maximum charge rates from the
PV array multiplied by one hour is equal to 3% of the battery nominal amp-hour capacity
or greater, a charge controller is required [NEC 690.72]. If a battery is overcharged, it can
create a hazardous condition and its life is generally reduced, especially for sealed, valve-
regulated lead-acid (VLRA) batteries. Many charge controllers also include overdischarge
protection for batteries, by disconnecting loads at a predetermined low-voltage, low
state-of-charge condition.
Battery installations in dwellings must operate less than 50 volts nominal, unless live
parts are not accessible during routine battery maintenance. This requirement generally
limits the voltage of lead-acid batteries to no more than 48 volts, nominal. This equates to
either 24 series-connected nominal 2-volt lead-acid cells, or 40 series-connected nominal
1.2-volt alkali type nickel cadmium cells. All battery installations in dwellings must have
live parts guarded. Live parts must also be guarded for any battery installations 50 volts
or greater by elevation, barriers or location in rooms accessible to only qualified persons.
Sufficient working spaces and clearances must be provided for any battery installations
[NEC 110.26].
If the nominal voltage of a battery bank exceeds 48 V, then the batteries shall not be
installed in conductive cases, unless they are VRLA batteries designed for installation
with metal cases [NEC 690.71(D)]. Note that 48 V nominal battery banks typically operate
above 50 V and exceed the 50 V limit for ungrounded PV systems [NEC 690.41]. Battery
systems either must have a system grounded conductor or meet the requirements for
ungrounded systems [NEC 690.35].
34 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Racks and trays are used to support battery systems and provide electrolyte contain-
ment. Racks can be made from metal, fiberglass or other structural nonconductive
materials. Metal racks must be painted or otherwise treated to resist degradation
from electrolyte and provide insulation between conducting members and the bat-
tery cells [NEC 480.9]. Due to the potential for ground faults, metal or other conduc-
tive battery racks, trays and cases are not allowed for open-vent flooded lead-acid
batteries more than 48 volts nominal. In addition, conductive racks are not permitted
to be located within 150 mm (6 in.) of the tops of the nonconductive battery cases
[NEC 690.71(D)]. These requirements do not apply to sealed batteries that are manu-
factured with conductive cases. Any conductive battery racks, cases or trays must
also have proper equipment grounding [NEC 250.110].
If batteries are connected in series to produce more than 48 V (nominal), then the bat-
teries must be connected in a manner that allows the series strings of batteries to be
separated into strings of 48 V or less for maintenance purposes [NEC 690.71(D-G)].
The means of disconnect may be non-load-break, bolted, or plug-in disconnects. For
strings greater than 48 V, there must also be a means of disconnecting the grounded
circuit conductors of all battery strings under maintenance without disconnecting the
grounded conductors of operating strings.
Whenever the available fault current of a battery exceeds the interrupt ratings of nor-
mal overcurrent devices, disconnect means or other equipment in a circuit, special
current-limiting overcurrent devices must be installed [NEC 690.9, 690.71]. While
many dc-rated circuit breakers do not have sufficient interrupt ratings, current limit-
ing fuses are available with interrupt rating 20,000 A and higher. Whenever these
fuses may be energized from both sides, a disconnect means is required to isolate the
fuse from all sources for servicing [NEC 690.16]. A disconnecting means must also be
provided for all ungrounded battery circuit conductors, and must be readily acces-
sible and located within sight of the battery system [NEC 690.17].
To prevent battery installations from being classified as hazardous locations, venti-
lation of explosive battery gasses is required. However, the NEC does not provide
specific ventilation requirements. Vented battery cells must incorporate a flame arres-
tor to help prevent cell explosions from external ignition sources, and cells for sealed
batteries must have pressure relief vents [NEC 480.9, 480.10].
Special safety precautions, equipment and personal protective equipment (PPE) are
required when installing and maintaining battery systems. Hazards associated with
batteries include caustic electrolyte, high short-circuit currents, and explosive poten-
tial due to hydrogen and oxygen gasses produced during battery charging. Insulated
tools should be used when working on batteries to prevent short-circuiting. High-
voltage battery systems may present arc flash hazards, and special PPE, disconnect-
ing means and equipment labeling may apply [See NFPA 70E]. Batteries are also very
heavy and should only be lifted or supported by methods approved by the manu-
facturer. Battery installations over 400 lbs may also have to meet certain engineering
requirements in seismic regions for the design of non-structural electrical compo-
nents [See ASCE 7-10].
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 35
2.4.1	 Determine Loads
The sizing of batteries or any other energy storage system is based on the magnitude
and duration of the applied electrical loads. The average power consumption of the elec-
trical loads defines the maximum discharge rates as well as the total energy withdrawn
from the battery on an average daily basis. The size of the battery (total capacity) is
selected based on these system parameters and the desired maximum and average daily
depth-of-discharge. The maximum battery depth-of-discharge in actual system opera-
tion is determined by the low-voltage load disconnect, the discharge rate, temperature
and other factors..
Identify all existing and planned electrical loads that will be connected to the system,
including their ac or dc operating voltage, their power or current consumption, and
their expected average daily use. List all loads and multiply the power use by the aver-
age daily time of operation to determine daily energy consumption and peak power
demand. See Fig. 29. In practice, the inverter should be large enough to power the
total connected load, but is only required to be as large as the single largest load [NEC
690.10(A)].
2.4.2	 Identify Circuits for Required Loads
Load circuits supplied by stand-alone PV systems must be clearly identified and limited
to the design loads. Additional loads beyond what the system has been designed to
supply will ultimately result in decreasing battery state-of-charge and reduced battery
lifetime. Ensure that only critical loads are connected and that the most efficient loads
and practices are used wherever possible. In all cases, do not exceed the load estimates
for which the system was designed unless additional generation resources are used.
Multiwire Branch Circuits
Many stand-alone PV systems use inverters with 120 Vac output, with the hot leg con-
nected to both sides (phases) of a common 120/240 V split-phase load center. Normally
with 240 V service, the current on one phase is 180 degrees opposed to the current on
the other phase, and results in neutral conductor currents equal to the difference be-
tween the two phase currents.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Batteries: 6 - 31
Electrical Load Power (W) Avg. Daily Time of Use (hr) Avg. Daily Energy (watt-
hours)
Lighting 200 6 1200
Refrigerator 300 9.6 (40% duty cycle) 2880
Microwave 1200 0.5 600
Pumps 1000 1 1000
TV and entertainment
equipment
400 4 1600
Fans 300 6 1800
Washer 400 0.86 (3 hours 2 times per
week)
344
Miscellaneous plug loads 200 12 2400
Total all loads 4000 W (4 kW) 11,824 Wh (11.8 kWh)
Figure 29. A load assessment evaluates the magnitude and duration of electrical loads.
OSHA requirements
for battery installations
include the following:
• Unsealed batteries must be
installed in ventilated enclo-
sures to prevent fumes, gases,
or electrolyte spray entering
other areas, and to prevent the
accumulation of an explosive
mixture.
• Battery racks, trays and floors
must be of sufficient strength
and resistant to electrolyte.
• Face shields, aprons, and
rubber gloves must be provided
for workers handling acids or
batteries, and facilities for quick
drenching of the eyes and body
must be provided within 25 feet
of battery handling areas.
• Facilities must be provided
for flushing and neutralizing
spilled electrolyte and for fire
protection.
• Battery charging installations
are to be located in designated
areas and protected from dam-
age by trucks.
• Vent caps must be in place
during battery charging and
maintained in a functioning
condition.
36 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
When the two phases (buses) in the panel are connected together to distribute the
120 V source, the currents on both sides of the panel are now in phase with each other
and are additive. If multiwire branch circuits that share a neutral conductor for two
branch circuits are connected to this modified distribution panel, the neutral conductor
can potentially become overloaded and create a fire hazard. For these installations, a
special warning sign is required on the panel to prohibit the connection of multiwire
branch circuits [NEC 690.10(C)].
 
2.4.3	 Batteries and Battery Conductors
The goal of battery wiring is to create a circuit that charges and discharges all batteries
equally. If batteries are connected in series, this is automatic, but if batteries are connected
in parallel, the currents may be unequal due to subtle differences in cable resistance and
connections. All batteries used in a battery bank must be the same type, same manufac-
turer, the same age, and must be maintained at equal temperatures. Batteries should have
the same charge and discharge properties under these circumstances.
Series batteries connections build voltage while capacity stays the same as for one battery.
See Fig. 30. Parallel battery connections build capacity while voltage stays the same. See
Fig. 31. Parallel connections are made from opposite corners of the battery bank to help
equalize the voltage drop and current flow through each string. In general, no more than
four batteries or series strings of batteries should be connected in parallel. It is better to
use larger batteries with higher ampere-hour ratings than to connect batteries in parallel.
Large conductors, such as 2/0 AWG, 4/0 AWG or larger, are typically used to minimize
voltage drop in battery connections.
Figure 30. Series battery connections increase voltage.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Batteries: 6 - 32
Figure 30. Series battery connections increase voltage.
Battery 2
12 volts
100 amp-hours
24 volts
100 amp-hours
Total:
+ -
+ -
Battery 1
12 volts
100 amp-hours
+ -
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 33
Figure 31. Parallel battery connections increase capacity.
Battery 2
12 volts
100 amp-hours
12 volts
200 amp-hours
Total:
+ -
Battery 1
12 volts
100 amp-hours
+ -
+
-
Figure 31. Parallel battery connections increase capacity.
Listed flexible cables rated for hard service usage are permitted to be used for battery
conductors, and can help reduce excessive terminal stress that can occur with standard
stranded conductors [NEC 690.74, Art. 400]. Welding cable (listed or not listed), automo-
tive battery cables, diesel locomotive cables (marked DLO only) and the like may not
meet NEC requirements for battery connections. Properly rated cable will have a conduit
rating such as THW or RHW to meet building wiring requirements.
Size Batteries for Loads
Battery sizing in most PV systems is based on the average daily electrical load and a de-
sired number of days of battery storage. The number of days of storage is selected based
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 37
on the importance of the application,
and the desired average daily depth-
of-discharge for the battery.
Autonomy is defined as the number
of days that a fully charged battery
can meet system loads without any
recharging. Autonomy is calculated
by the nominal battery capacity, the
average daily load and the maximum
allowable depth-of-discharge. Larger
autonomy means a larger battery with
higher costs, and shallower aver-
age daily depth-of-discharge, lower
charge and discharge rates, and usu-
ally longer battery life.
Figure 32. A charge controller is required in most PV systems that use
battery storage to regulate battery state-of-charge.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 34
Charge controller protects battery
from overcharge by PV array
Charge
Controller
BatteryPV Array
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 35
Figure 33. Charge controllers used in PV systems vary widely in their size, functions and features.
Morningstar TriStar controller
Morningstar ProStar controller
Morningstar lighting controller
Outback MPPT controller
Xantrex C-series controller
Figure 33. Charge controllers used in PV systems vary widely in their size, functions and features.
For example, consider a system load that is 100 Ah per day. A 400 Ah battery is selected,
with a desired allowable depth-of-discharge of 75% (300 Ah usable). This battery design
would deliver 3 days of autonomy in this system (3 days × 100 Ah/day = 300 Ah). Critical
applications, such as vaccine refrigeration systems, telecommunications or defense and
public safety applications may be designed for greater than 3 days of autonomy to help
improve system reliability. PV hybrid systems using generators or other backup sources
may require less autonomy to achieve the same level of system availability.
Charge Controller Operation
A battery charge controller limits the voltage and or current delivered to a battery from a
charging source to regulate state-of-charge [NEC 690.2]. See Fig 32. A charge controller is
required in most PV systems that use battery storage, to prevent damage to the batteries
or hazardous conditions resulting from overcharging [NEC 690.72(A)]. Many charge con-
trollers also provide overdischarge protection for the battery by disconnecting dc loads
at low state-of-charge. Additional functions performed by charge controllers include
controlling loads or backup energy source and providing monitoring and indicators of
battery voltage and other system parameters. Special controllers are also available that
regulate battery charge by diverting excess power to auxiliary loads. See Fig 33.
Many charge controllers protect the battery from overdischarge by disconnecting dc loads
at low battery voltage and state-of-charge, at the allowable maximum depth of discharge
limit. See Fig. 34. Some smaller charge controllers incorporate overcharge and overdis-
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 35
Figure 33. Charge controllers used in PV systems vary widely in their size, functions and features.
Morningstar TriStar controller
Morningstar ProStar controller
Morningstar lighting controller
Outback MPPT controller
Xantrex C-series controller
38 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
charge functions within a single controller. Generally, for larger dc load currents, separate
charge controllers or relays are used. If two charge controllers are used, it is possible that
they may be the same model but simply installed with different settings for different pur-
poses; one on the array side for charge regulation and one on the load side of the battery
for load control.
Battery-based inverters usually have programmable set-points for the low voltage load
disconnect and load reconnect voltages. An alarm or indicator usually notifies the opera-
tor when the batteries are getting close to or have reached the LVD. It is also possible to
employ multiple LVD controllers on the load side of the batteries, to have different LVD
settings based on load priorities. Factory defaults for LVDs are often set at a low level
so it may be desirable to raise the settings to provide greater protection of the batteries,
however this reduces available capacity.
Charge controllers have maximum input voltage and current ratings specified by the
manufacturer and the listing agency. The PV array must not be capable of generating
voltage or current that will exceed the charge controller input voltage and current limits.
The charge controller rated continuous current (sometimes specified as input current,
sometimes as output current) must be at least 125% of the PV array short-circuit output
current, and the charge controller maximum input voltage must be higher than the maxi-
mum system voltage [NEC 690.7].
Set points are the battery voltage levels at which a charge controller performs regula-
tion or control functions. The proper regulation set points are critical for optimal battery
charging and system performance.
 
The regulation voltage (VR) is the maximum voltage set point the controller allows the
battery to reach before the array current is disconnected or limited. For interrupting type
controllers, the array reconnect voltage (ARV) is the voltage set point at which the array is
again reconnected to charge the battery. PWM and constant-voltage type controllers do
not have a definable ARV.
The low-voltage disconnect (LVD) is the battery voltage set point at which the charge
controller disconnects the system loads to prevent overdischarge. The LVD defines the
Figure 34. Charge controllers are also used to protect a battery from excessively deep discharges.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 36
This controller
protects battery
from overcharge
This controller
protects battery
from overdischarge
PV Array
Battery
DC Load
Load
Controller
Charge
Controller
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 39
maximum battery depth-of-discharge at the given discharge rate. The load reconnect volt-
age (LRV) set point is the voltage that load are reconnected to the battery. A higher LRV
allows a battery to receive more charge before loads are reconnected to the battery.
Low-voltage disconnect set points are selected based on the desired battery depth-of-dis-
charge and discharge rates. High discharge rates will lower battery voltage by a greater
amount than lower discharge rates at the same battery state-of-charge. For a typical lead-
acid cell, a LVD set point of 1.85 VPC to 1.91 VPC corresponds to a depth-of-discharge of
70% to 80% at discharge rates C/20 and lower.
Some PV charge controllers and battery chargers use three-stage charging algorithms to
more effectively deliver power to the battery. Bulk charging occurs when the battery is
below around 90% state-of-charge, and all available PV current is delivered to the batter-
ies. During the bulk charge stage, battery voltage increases as the battery charges. Once
the regulation voltage is reached, the charging current is limited to maintain the regula-
tion voltage. Absorption charging is a finishing charge that occurs for a specified period
after the regulation voltage is reached, usually for a few hours. This charging time at
higher regulation voltages helps fully charge the battery, but if sustained for too long
can overcharge the battery. Charging current continues to decrease throughout the
absorption charge. Float charging is a maintenance charge that maintains the battery at a
lower float voltage level and minimal current, essentially offsetting battery self-discharge
Figure 35. Advanced battery chargers and controllers use multi-stage charging algorithms. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Batteries: 6 -
Figure 35. Advanced battery chargers and controllers use multi-stage charging algorithms.
Reducing
Absorption
Current Float Current
Float Voltage
Maximum
Charge
Current
Increasing
Voltage
Bulk Charge -
Constant
Voltage
Bulk Stage
Battery
Voltage
Absorption Stage Float Stage
Battery
Current
Time 
Figure 36. Optimal
charge regulation
set points depend
on the type of
battery and control
method used.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Batteries: 6 - 38
Figure 36. Optimal charge regulation set points depend on the type of battery and control method
used.
Battery Type
Regulator
Design Type
Charge
Regulation
Voltage at 25
o
C
Flooded
Lead-
Antimony
Flooded
Lead-
Calcium
Sealed,
Valve
Regulated
Lead-Acid
Flooded
Pocket Plate
Nickel-
Cadmium
On-Off,
Interrupting
Per nominal 12
volt battery
14.6 - 14.8 14.2 - 14.4 14.2 - 14.4 14.5 - 15.0
Per Cell 2.44 - 2.47 2.37 - 2.40 2.37 - 2.40 1.45 - 1.50
Constant-Voltage,
PWM, Linear
Per nominal 12
volt battery
14.4 - 14.6 14.0 - 14.2 14.0 - 14.2 14.5 - 15.0
Per Cell 2.40 - 2.44 2.33 - 2.37 2.33 - 2.37 1.45 - 1.50
losses. See Fig. 35.
The optimal charge regulation set points
depend on the type of battery and control
method used. Higher charge regulation
voltages are required for all types of bat-
teries using interrupting type controllers,
compared to more effective constant-volt-
age, PWM or linear designs. See Fig. 36.
Equalization charging is a periodic over-
charge to help restore consistency among
battery cells. Equalization charging is per-
formed on flooded, open-vent batteries
to help minimize differences and restore
40 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
consistency in capacity between individual cells, and can help reduce sulfation and strati-
fication. Some charge controllers provide the capability for manual or automatic or equal-
ization charging. Flooded lead-acid batteries are normally equalized at approximately 2.6
volts per cell (VPC) at 25°C for 1-3 hour periods once or twice a month. Equalization is
generally not recommended for VRLA batteries; see manufacturer’s instructions.
Temperature compensation is a feature of charge controllers that automatically adjusts the
charge regulation voltage for battery temperature changes. Charge controllers may have
internal temperature compensation, or use external sensors attached to the batteries.
Where battery temperatures vary seasonally more than 10°C, compensation of the charge
regulation set point is normally used. Temperature compensation is recommended for
all types of sealed batteries, which are much more sensitive to overcharging than flooded
types. Temperature compensation helps to fully charge a battery during colder condi-
tions, and helps protect it from overcharge and excessive electrolyte loss during warmer
conditions.
The standard temperature compensation coefficient for lead-acid cells is -5 mV/°C. When
the battery is cold, the charge regulation voltage is increased, and conversely when the
battery is warm, the charge regulation voltage is reduced. For example, consider a nomi-
nal 24 V charge controller with a regulation voltage of 28.2 V at 25°C. When the battery
temperature is 10°C, the temperature compensated regulation voltage is 29.7 V. Con-
versely, if the battery temperature is 40°C, the charge regulation voltage will be reduced
to 27.3 volts.
Figure 37. Multiple charge controllers may be used on individual subarrays for larger systems. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Batteries: 6 - 39
Figure 37. Multiple charge controllers may be used on individual subarrays for larger systems.
PV Subarray #1 Charge
Controller #1
One subarray may be directly connected
to battery without charge control if
charge current x 1 hr is less than 3% of
battery capacity.
PV Subarray #2 Charge
Controller #2
PV Subarray #3 Charge
Controller #3
PV Subarray #4
Battery
DC Load
Note: No overdischarge
protection shown.
Figure 38. A diversionary charge controller diverts excess PV array power to auxiliary loads.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 40
Figure 38. A diversionary charge controller diverts excess PV array power to auxiliary loads.
PV Array
Charge
Controller
Battery
Diversion
Controller
Diversion
Load
This controller protects the battery when
the diversion load is unavailable
Diversionary controller protects the
battery from overcharge by diverting
power to a diversionary load
For larger systems, the output of multi-
ple charge controllers may be connected
in parallel and used to charge a single
battery bank. See Fig. 37. Depending
on the specific controller, the multiple
controllers may regulate independently
or through a master-slave arrangement.
One subarray may be left unregulated if
the maximum charge current multiplied
by one hour is less than 3% of the bat-
tery capacity. This can help improve the
finishing charge.
A diversionary charge controller diverts
excess PV array power to auxiliary loads
when the primary battery system is
fully charged, allowing a greater utili-
zation of PV array energy. Whenever a
diversionary charge controller is used, a
second independent charge controller is
required to prevent battery overcharge in
the event the diversion loads are unavail-
able or the diversion charge controller
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 41
fails [NEC 690.72]. The additional charge controller uses a higher regulation voltage, and
permits the diversionary charge controller to operate as the primary control. See Fig 38.
Several requirements apply to PV systems using dc diversionary loads and dc diversion
charge controllers. Typical dc diversionary loads include resistive water heating ele-
ments, dc water pumps or other loads that can utilize or store the energy in some other
form.These requirements are intended to help prevent hazardous conditions and protect
the battery if the diversion controller fails or the dc loads are unavailable.
	 • 	 The dc diversion load current must be no greater than the controller
		 maximum current rating.
	 • 	 The dc diversion load must have a voltage rating greater than the
		 maximum battery voltage.
	 • 	 The dc diversion load power rating must be rated at least 150 percent of
		 the maximum PV array power output.
	 • 	 The conductors and overcurrent protection for dc diversion load circuits
		 must be sized for at least 150 percent of controller maximum current rating.
Some interactive PV systems use battery-based inverters as a backup power source when
the utility is de-energized. Normally, these systems regulate the battery charge by divert-
ing excess PV array dc power through the inverter to produce ac power to feed site loads
or the grid. When the grid de-energizes, an automatic transfer switch disconnects loads
from the utility network and the system operates in stand-alone mode. If all loads have
been met and the grid is not available, the battery can be overcharged. These systems must
also have a second independent charge controller to prevent battery overcharge when the
grid or loads are not available to divert excess power [NEC 690.72(C)(3)]. See Fig. 39.
 
Figure 39. Battery-based interactive inverters operate as diversionary charge controllers to regulate
battery state-of-charge.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 41
Figure 39. Battery-based interactive inverters operate as diversionary charge controllers to
regulate battery state-of-charge.
PV Array
Charge
Controller
Battery
Interactive
Inverter
Utility Grid
This controller protects the battery
when the grid is unavailable
The inverter normally protects the
battery from overcharge by
diverting power to the grid
Power may flow in reverse
directions if inverter also
includes a battery charger
Maximum Power Point Tracking MPPT
Charge Controllers
Maximum power point tracking (MPPT)
charge controllers operate PV arrays at
maximum power under all operating
conditions independent of battery volt-
age. Typically, the PV array is configured
at higher voltages than the battery, and
dc to dc power conversion circuits in the
controller automatically provides a lower
voltage and higher current output to the
battery. MPPT controllers can improve
array energy utilization and allow non-standard and higher array operating voltages,
requiring smaller conductors and fewer source circuits to charge lower voltage battery
banks. MPPT charge controllers are advantageous on cold sunny days in the winter
when stand-alone systems have lower battery voltage and the array voltage is high due
to the cold operating temperature.
Normally, the output current of a charge controller will be less than or equal to the input
current. The exception to this rule is a MPPT charge controller, in which the output cur-
42 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
rent may exceed the input current but at lower voltage. If a MPPT charge controller
is used, it is important to consult the manufacturer’s specifications to determine the
maximum output current. The maximum rated output current of the charge controller
must be posted on a sign at the dc disconnect [NEC 690.53].
 
2.4.4	 Generators
Electrical generators are often interfaced with PV systems to supplement the PV array
when it cannot produce enough energy alone to meet the system loads or charge the
batteries. These are often referred to as hybrid systems, because they use more than
one energy source. Generators may be directly interfaced with stand-alone systems
or with battery-based utility-interactive systems. In regions where the summer solar
resource is significantly more than the winter resource, an auxiliary electric genera-
tor may be useful to reduce the size of the PV array and battery required to meet the
wintertime loads alone.
Many battery-based PV inverters have built-in battery chargers that permit the con-
nection of an auxiliary ac source, such as a generator, to provide supplemental battery
charging, or to directly power ac loads.Some of these inverters are programmable and
have relay circuits that can automatically start the generator whenever the batteries
reach a prescribed low voltage. When the batteries have been recharged to an ad-
equate state of charge, defined by the inverter programming, the inverter will auto-
matically shut down the generator. Most of these advanced inverters can also exercise
the generator on a regular basis to ensure that it will start when needed.
Utility-interactive PV systems without batteries require a separate generator trans-
fer switch to isolate the electrical loads from the grid and the PV system when the
generator is operated, because most generators alone cannot interface directly to the
grid without additional synchronizing and protective equipment. In this design, the
generators are either started automatically or manually in the event of a utility outage.
Charging Batteries with a Generator
Typically, PV-generator hybrid systems may be designed to fully charge the batter-
ies in 5 to 10 hours, or at a C/5 to C/10 rate. This means that if the batteries are 80%
discharged and the generator is programmed to charge the batteries until they are
only 30% discharged, that it would take 5 hours to do so at the C/10 rate. Generally, it
is not advantageous to fully charge batteries with the generator, which can be inef-
ficient, and can result in wasting valuable PV energy that may have been available to
contribute to the charge. The basic idea to optimize generator run time is to load the
generator as high a power level and minimum operation time as possible, to minimize
fuel consumption and maintenance.
 
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 43
2.5	 Confirm String Size Calculations
PV array source circuits are usually designed to meet the voltage requirement of connect-
ed dc utilization equipment, such as batteries, charge controllers, or interactive inverters.
All dc equipment must also have appropriate current ratings for the given PV array and
source circuit currents. The PV array must also operate within acceptable voltage limits
for the dc equipment, over all temperatures.
Battery charging applications require the PV array maximum power voltage to be greater
than the battery regulation voltage at the highest array operating temperatures. This
helps ensure that the maximum PV array current is delivered to the battery. Maximum
power point tracking charge controllers permit the use of much higher array voltages
than the battery voltage. See Fig. 40.
The experienced PV installer should be able to identify the advantages and disadvantag-
es of systems that operate at different dc voltages, ranging from 12 V systems to systems
operating up to 600 V and greater where permitted. The major disadvantage of lower
voltage systems are much higher currents for the same power levels, requiring much
larger and more expensive conductors, overcurrent devices and switchgear. For example,
the currents in a 12 V system are twice as high as currents in a 24 V system, and four
times as high as for 48 V systems. These higher currents require significantly larger wire
sizes. In fact, to maintain a voltage drop within certain limits, say 3%, for the same load
at 24 V as opposed to at 12 V, the allowable wire resistance is 4 times as high as for the
12 V loads because the 24 V system reduces the current by half and the percentage volt-
age drop is based on twice the voltage as 12 V.
 
Interactive inverters can usually handle PV array dc power input levels 110% to 130% or
more of the continuous ac output power rating, especially in warmer climates. Inverters
thermally limit array dc input and array power tracking at high temperatures and
power levels. PV array must also not exceed the maximum dc input current limits for
the inverter.
Figure 40. Generally, 36 series-connected silicon solar cells are needed to provide adequate maximum power
voltage to fully charge a lead acid-battery.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 42
Figure 40. Generally, 36 series-connected silicon solar cells are needed to provide adequate
maximum power voltage to fully charge a lead acid-battery.
PV module maximum power voltage must be higher
than battery voltage at highest operating temperature
Voltage (V)
Current(A)
Module with 36 series-connected cells
operating at temperature of 50 C (optimal)
10 20
Operating voltage range for 12-volt lead-acid battery:
11.5 to 14.5 volts.
Maximum power points
Module with 30 series-connected
cells at 50 C (voltage too low to
deliver maximum current to battery)
Module with 42 series-connected cells at 50 C
(voltage is more than adequate for charging,
but power is wasted)
44 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Array voltage requirements the most critical part of sizing arrays for interactive in-
verters. Array voltage is affected by the site ambient temperature range and the array
mounting system design. The array voltage must be above the minimum inverter oper-
ating and MPPT voltage during hottest operating conditions, factoring in annual array
voltage degradation of 0.5% to 1% per year. Array voltage must also not exceed 600 dc
or the maximum inverter operating voltage during the coldest operating conditions.
Exceeding maximum voltage limits violates electrical codes and voids manufacturer
warranties. Use record lows or preferably ASHRAE 2% minimum design temperatures
to determine maximum array voltage. See Fig. 41.
2.6	 Review System Components Selection
The PV installer is often required to make judgments and recommendations concern-
ing the system design based on a variety of factors including site considerations and
customer needs. The installer is often required to review or modify designs based on the
application requirements, and they must ensure that the overall installation meets code
requirements. It is not unusual for something to be left out of a design, and the installer
may be responsible for identifying these discrepancies in the design review process. The
installer should also know when and where to consult an experienced system designer
when design issues extend beyond the installer’s capabilities.
2.6.1	 Differentiating Among Available Modules and Inverters
Both PV modules and inverters used in PV systems are subject to UL standards and
must be listed and approved for the application to meet code compliance. Inverters in-
tended for use in interactive PV systems, or with ungrounded PV arrays must be special-
ly labeled. Likewise ac modules, special modules manufactured with built-in inverters
much be clearly labeled as ac modules with the appropriate specifications.
Product approval usually only provides a measure of safety and is not indicative of field
performance or reliability. There are relatively few resources to find comprehensive and
unbiased analyses on the field performance of these products, but certain periodicals
Figure 41. Properly configuring PV arrays for interactive inverters involves an understanding the array
I-V characteristics and temperature effects. 
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 43
Figure 41. Properly configuring PV arrays for interactive inverters involves an understanding the
array I-V characteristics and temperature effects.
Voltage
Array voltage decreases with
increasing temperature
25 C
50 C
0 C
-25 C
STC
DC Input Operating Range
Inverter MPPT Range
PV Array IV Curves at
Different Temperatures
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 45
provide annual reviews, results from independent testing, and comments from
installers. Online forums are another good place to find out more about products.
Manufacturer’s specifications are based on laboratory tests, and it is important to
recognize that field performance is far more dynamic. A given product may perform
quite well under one set of conditions but under-perform in other conditions (e.g. at given
temperatures, voltages, etc.). Reference: CEC eligible equipment website: www.consume-
renergycenter.org 
In addition to electrical safety listing, the selection of PV modules for a given project may
be based on any number of factors, including:
	 • Physical characteristics (dimensions and weight)
	 • Electrical specifications (power tolerance and guaranteed power output)
	 • Warranties, reliability and reputation of the manufacturer
	 • Manufacturer certification to quality standards (ISO 9000)
	 • Module warranty and design qualification (IEC 61215/61216)
	 • Customer satisfaction and field results
	 • Costs and availability
In addition to electrical safety listing, specifying inverters for PV installations includes the
following considerations:
	 • Interactive or stand-alone
	 • Power rating and maximum current
	 • Power conversion efficiency
	 • Location environment rating
	 • Size and weight
	 • Nominal dc input and ac output voltages and limits of operation
	 • Protective and safety features (array ground and arc faults, reverse polarity, etc.)
	 • Warranties and reliability
	 • Costs and availability
	 • Additional features (monitoring, chargers, controls, MPPT etc.)
PV Modules
Photovoltaic or solar cells convert sunlight to dc electricity. They are often referred to as
direct energy conversion devices because they convert one basic form of energy to another
Figure 42. PV modules produce a specified electrical output. 
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 44
Figure 42. PV modules produce a specified electrical output.
Single (mono) crystallinePolycrystalline
36 cell modules
60 cell polycrystalline module
in a single step. PV modules have no mov-
ing parts, and produce no noise or emis-
sions during normal operation. Generally
speaking, commercial PV modules are very
reliable products with expected lifetimes
exceeding 20-25 years in normal service.
See Fig 42.
PV cells are made from a variety of semi-
conductor technologies. Most PV cells are
made from multi (poly) or single crystalline
silicon (mono) that is doped with certain
46 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
elements to produce desirable properties. Thin-film technologies, including amorphous
silicon, cadmium-telluride (CdTe), copper-indium-diselenide (CIS), and others continue
to be developed, and presently make up about 10% to 15% of the current market. Thin
film PV modules are generally less expense than conventional crystalline silicon modules,
but also less efficient and less proven that crystalline silicon.
PV modules are commonly flat-plate types that respond to both direct and diffuse solar
radiation. Concentrating PV (CPV) modules are special designs that use optics (lenses or
reflectors) to concentrate the solar power received through a larger aperature area onto a
small-area PV device.
Individual silicon solar cells are manufactured in sizes up to and over 200 in2
in area. The
electrical current output of a solar cell is directly related to cell area, the cell efficiency,
and the amount of solar radiation incident on the cell surface. Modern silicon solar cells
may be up to 8 inches in diameter and greater, and produce currents in excess of 8 A.
 
A common crystalline silicon solar cell produces about 0.5 V to 0.6 V independent of cell
area, but decreases with increasing temperature. The temperature effects on voltage have
important ramifications for designing PV arrays to meet the voltage requirements of
inverters and other dc utilization equipment in different climates. See Fig 43.
Usually, 36, 60, 72 or greater number of individual cells are connected in series to produce
higher voltage PV modules. PV modules using 36 series-connected cells are optimally
suited for charging a 12 V battery. Higher voltage modules are used for higher-voltage
grid connected systems, to minimize the numbers of module connections required for an
installation. However, PV modules are now becoming so large that they are reaching the
Figure 43. Silicon solar cells produce about 0.5 V to 0.6 volt independent of cell
area, depending on temperature.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 45
Figure 43. Silicon solar cells produce about 0.5 to 0.6 volt independent of cell area, depending on
temperature.
Monocrystalline cell Polycrystalline cell
Figure 44. Standard Test Conditions (STC) is the universal rating condition for PV
modules and arrays.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 46
Figure 44. Standard Test Conditions (STC) is the universal rating condition for PV modules and
arrays.
 The electrical performance of PV
modules is rated at Standard Test
Conditions (STC):
 Irradiance: 1,000 W/m2 , AM 1.5
 Cell temperature: 25 C
Source: SolarWorld USA
m Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 45
Figure 43. Silicon solar cells produce about 0.5 to 0.6 volt independent of cell area, depending on
temperature.
Monocrystalline cell Polycrystalline cell
limits of safe handling by one person. A 230-watt PV module
made of crystalline silicon PV cells typically has an area of
about 17 sf, and weighs 35 pounds or more. See Fig 44.
Solar Energy Fundamentals
The principles of solar radiation, the solar resource and its
units of measureare very important for the PV designer and
installer to understand, especially as it concerns the perfor-
mance of PV modules and arrays. This includes quantifying
the amount of solar power incident on a PV array at any given
point in time, as well as estimating the total solar energy
received on monthly and annual basis. Solar radiation is the
basic source of energy that drives a PV system. It must be ac-
curately measured and quantified to make reasonable perfor-
mance estimates in the design, in order to verify the proper
operation of modules, arrays and complete systems.
 
Solar radiation is electromagnetic radiation ranging from about
0.25 mm to 4.5 mm in wavelength, including the near ultravio-
let (UV), visible light, and near infrared (IR) portions of the
spectrum. The sun produces immense quantities of electro-
magnetic radiation as a product of fusion reactions at its core.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 47
The tiny fraction reaching the earth’s surface amounts to approximately 170 million
gigawatts (GW), many thousands of times greater than all of the electrical power used
on earth.
Reference: U.S. Energy Information Administration, Annual Energy Outlook 2011:
http://www.eia.gov/forecasts/aeo/pdf/0383(2011).pdf
Solar irradiance (solar power) is the sun’s radiant power incident on a surface of unit area,
commonly expressed in units of kW/m2
or W/m2
. Due to atmospheric effects, typical
peak values of terrestrial solar irradiance are on the order of 1000 W/m2
on surfaces at
sea level facing the sun’s rays under a clear sky around solar noon. Consequently, 1000
W/m2
is used as a reference condition for rating the peak output for PV modules and
arrays. This value of solar irradiance is often referred to as peak sun. However, higher val-
ues of irradiance are common at higher altitudes and on exceptionally clear days during
winter months when the sun is closest to earth. In these cases, solar irradiance can reach
1250 W/m2
or higher for several hours during the middle of a day.
For south-facing fixed (non-tracking) tilted surfaces on a clear day, the incident solar ir-
radiance varies along a bell-shaped curve, peaking at solar noon when the surface faces
most directly toward the sun. Local weather patterns and cloud cover affect the receiv-
able radiation accordingly. See Fig 45.
Solar Energy
Powers the World
The U.S. currently has
just over 1100 GW of peak
electrical power generation
capacity, supplying a total
annual electrical consump-
tion of about 3,700 billion
kWh. To produce this much
energy would require
about 2,500 GW of peak
PV generation distributed
throughout the U.S. Using
a reference PV module
efficiency of 15% (power
density 150 W/m2
), the total
array surface area required
would be about 4 million
acres (about 6400 square
miles), or about 0.2% of the
continental U.S. land area.
Considering over 50% of
U.S. land area is already
dedicated to the extraction
of natural resources and fos-
sil fuels, including agricul-
ture, forestry, mining and
public lands, a significant
contribution from PV in
meeting our national energy
needs is not an unrealistic
expectation.
Figure 45. For fixed south-facing surfaces on a clear day, the incident solar
irradiance varies in a bell-shaped curve, peaking at solar noon.
Figure 46. The amount of solar energy received on a surface over a given period of
time is equal to the average solar power multiplied by the time.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 47
Figure 45. For fixed south-facing surfaces on a clear day, the incident solar irradiance varies over
the day in a bell-shaped curve, peaking at solar noon.
Time of Day
SolarIrradiance(W/m2)
Sunrise Noon Sunset
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 48
Figure 46. The amount of solar energy received on a surface over a given period of time is equal
to the average solar power over the period multiplied by the time.
Time of Day
SolarIrradiance(W/m2)
Sunrise Noon Sunset
Solar irradiation (energy)
is the area under the solar
irradiance (power) curve
Solar irradiance (power)
Solar irradiation (solar energy) is the
sun’s radiant energy incident on
a surface of unit area, commonly
expressed in units of kWh/m2
. Solar
irradiation is sometimes called solar
insolation. Similar to electrical power
and energy, solar power and solar
energy are related by time. The
amount of solar energy received on
a surface over a given period of time
is equal to the average solar irradi-
ance multiplied by the time. Graphi-
cally, solar irradiation (energy) is
the area under the solar irradiance
(power) curve. See Fig 46.
For example, if the solar irradiance
(power) averages 400 W/m2
over
a 12 hour period, the total solar
irradiation (energy) received is 400
W/m2
× 12 hr = 4800 Wh/m2
= 4.8
kWh/m2
. Conversely, if the total
solar energy received over an 8 hour
period is 4 kWh, the average solar
power would be 4 kWh ÷ 8 hr = 0.5
kW/m2
= 500 W/m2
.
48 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Solar irradiation (energy) can be represented as a total for the year (kwh/m2
-yr), or com-
monly on an average daily basis for a given monthor annually (kWh/m2
-day). When solar
energy is represented on an average daily basis, the total daily energy can be equivocated
to the same amount of energy received at a peak irradiance level of 1 kW/m2
, for a specific
number of hours.
Peak Sun Hours (PSH) represents the average daily amount of solar energy received on a
given surface, and is equivalent to the number of hours that the solar irradiance would
need to be at a peak level of 1 kW/m2
to accumulate the total amount of daily energy
received. See Fig 47.
Since the power output PV modules and arrays are rated at 1 kW/m2
solar irradiance,
Peak Sun Hours simply represents the equivalent number of hours that a PV module or
array will operate at its peak rated output. For example, consider a PV array that produces
a peak power output of 6 kW when exposed to 1 kW/m2
irradiance, at average operating
temperatures. If the array surface receives 5 PSH per day on average, the expected daily
energy production for this array would be 6 kW × 5 hrs/day = 30 kWh/day. Coinciden-
tally, the average daily residential energy use in the U.S is about 30 kWh/day, and a 6 kW
PV system is about the typical size that can be installed on an average residential rooftop.
Solar radiation measurements made over past years throughout the U.S. and around the
world have been processed and archived in databases, and this data is used by designers
to estimate the expected performance of PV systems. See Fig 48. The Renewable Resource
Data Center (RReDC) at the National Renewable Energy Laboratory (NREL) maintains an
extensive collection of renewable energy data, maps, and tools for solar radiation, as well
as biomass, geothermal, and wind resources.
Reference: The National Solar Radiation Database includes data for over 1,400 sites in the
U.S. and its territories, and many other sites around the world, see: www.nrel.gov/rredc/
Figure 47. Peak sun hours
(PSH) represents the average
daily amount of solar energy
received on a surface, and
equivalent to the number of
hours that the solar irradiance
would be at a peak level of 1
kW/m2
.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 49
Figure 47. Peak sun hours (PSH) represents the average daily amount of solar energy received on
a surface, and equivalent to the number of hours that the solar irradiance would be at a peak level
of 1 kW/m2.
Time of Day (hrs)
SolarIrradiance(W/m2)
1000 W/m2
Sunrise Noon Sunset
Peak Sun Hours
Solar Insolation
Solar
IrradianceArea of box equals
area under curve
Solar Constant
The Solar Constant is the
average value of solar ir-
radiance outside the earth’s
atmosphere on a surface
facing the sun’s rays, at the
average earth-sun distance
of 1 Astronomical Unit (AU),
equal to about 93 million
miles. The Solar Constant
represents the average value
of extraterrestrial solar ir-
radiance, which is approxi-
mately 1366 W/m2
. Due to
the earth’s slightly elliptical
orbit around the sun, the
actual values for extrater-
restrial irradiance vary from
the average value by about
7% between the aphelion
and perihelion (points in the
earth’s orbit furthest and
closest to the sun, respec-
tively). Approximately 30%
of the extraterrestrial irradi-
ance is reflected or absorbed
by the atmosphere before it
reaches the earth’s surface.
hrs
Peak Sun Hours ( ) =
Avg. Daily Irradiation (kWh/m2
∙ day)
day Peak Sun (1 kW/m2
)
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 49
Solar radiation data can be represented in tables, databases or in graphical form. See Fig.
49. Standard solar radiation data tables give several key sets of data for different fixed
and tracking surfaces. The major limitation of the data tables is that they only provide
data for south-facing fixed surfaces. Other tools, such as PVWatts™ can be used to pre-
dict the solar energy received on fixed-tilt surfaces facing directions other than due south.
The standard format spreadsheets provide minimum and maximum data for each month
and annual averages for the following solar resource data and surface orientations:
	 • 	 Total global solar radiation for fixed south-facing flat-plate collectors tilted at
		 angles of 0°, Lat-15°, Lat, Lat+15°, and 90°.
	 • 	 Total global solar radiation for single-axis, north-south tracking flat-plate
		 collectors at tilt angles of 0°, Lat-15°, Lat, Lat+15°.
	 • 	 Total global solar radiation for dual-axis tracking flat-plate collectors.
	 • 	 Direct beam radiation for concentrating collectors.
	 • 	 Average meteorological conditions.
Figure 48. The National Solar Radiation Database
includes data for over 1,400 sites in the U.S.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 50
 NSRDB 1961-1990
 30 years of solar radiation and
meteorological data from 239 NWS
sites in the U.S.
 TMY2 hourly data files
 NSRDB 1991-2005 Update
 Contains solar and meteorological
data for 1,454 sites.
 TMY3 hourly data files
NREL
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 51
Figure 49. Solar radiation data tables gives the total global solar radiation for fixed south-facing
flat-plate collectors tilted at angles of 0, Lat-15°, Lat, Lat+15° and 90°.
City: DAYTONA BEACH
State: FL
WBAN No: 12834
Lat(N): 29.18
Long(W): 81.05
Elev(m): 12
Pres(mb): 1017
Stn Type: Primary
SOLAR RADIATION FOR FLAT-PLATE COLLECTORS FACING SOUTH AT A FIXED-TILT (kWh/m2/day), Percentage Uncertainty = 9
Tilt(deg) Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec Year
0 Average 3.1 3.9 5.0 6.2 6.4 6.1 6.0 5.7 4.9 4.2 3.4 2.9 4.8
Minimum 2.7 3.2 4.2 5.6 5.3 5.4 5.5 4.8 4.3 3.5 2.9 2.4 4.6
Maximum 3.7 4.4 5.5 6.8 7.0 7.0 6.6 6.3 5.5 4.8 3.7 3.3 5.1
Lat - 15 Average 3.8 4.5 5.5 6.4 6.4 6.0 5.9 5.8 5.2 4.7 4.1 3.6 5.2
Minimum 3.2 3.7 4.5 5.8 5.3 5.3 5.4 4.8 4.5 3.8 3.4 2.8 4.8
Maximum 4.6 5.2 6.1 7.1 7.0 6.8 6.4 6.5 6.0 5.5 4.6 4.1 5.5
Lat Average 4.3 4.9 5.7 6.3 6.0 5.5 5.5 5.6 5.3 5.0 4.6 4.1 5.2
Minimum 3.6 4.0 4.6 5.7 5.0 4.9 5.1 4.6 4.5 4.0 3.8 3.1 4.9
Maximum 5.4 5.8 6.3 7.0 6.6 6.3 6.0 6.3 6.1 5.9 5.2 4.9 5.7
Lat + 15 Average 4.6 5.1 5.6 5.9 5.4 4.8 4.9 5.1 5.1 5.1 4.8 4.4 5.1
Minimum 3.8 4.1 4.5 5.3 4.5 4.3 4.5 4.2 4.3 4.0 3.9 3.3 4.7
Maximum 5.8 6.0 6.3 6.5 5.8 5.5 5.3 5.7 5.9 6.0 5.6 5.3 5.5
90 Average 3.9 3.8 3.6 2.9 2.1 1.8 1.9 2.4 3.0 3.6 4.0 3.9 3.1
Minimum 3.1 3.1 2.9 2.7 2.0 1.6 1.8 2.0 2.5 2.7 3.1 2.8 2.8
Maximum 5.1 4.7 4.0 3.1 2.2 1.9 2.0 2.6 3.4 4.3 4.7 4.7 3.3
NREL
Figure 49. Solar radiation data tables gives the total global solar radiation for fixed south-facing flat-plate collectors tilted at
angles of 0°, Lat-15°, Lat, Lat+15° and 90°.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 50
Figure 48. The National Solar Radiation Database includes data for over 1400 sites in the U.S.
 NSRDB 1961-1990
 30 years of solar radiation and
meteorological data from 239 NWS
sites in the U.S.
 TMY2 hourly data files
 NSRDB 1991-2005 Update
 Contains solar and meteorological
data for 1,454 sites.
 TMY3 hourly data files
NREL
50 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
PV Module Performance
Photovoltaic module electrical performance is characterized by its current-voltage (I-V)
characteristic. I-V curves represent an infinite number of current and voltage operating
point pairs for a PV device, at a given solar irradiance and temperature operating condi-
tion. Certain electrical parameters representing key points along the I-V curve are rated
by the manufacturer at the specified conditions, affixed on product labels, and are the
basis for the designing the photovoltaic source and output circuits. See Fig. 50.
Figure 50. An I-V curve represents the electrical performance for PV modules and arrays.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 52
Figure 50. An I-V curve represents the electrical performance for PV modules and arrays.
 PV device performance is
specified by the following I-V
parameters at a given
temperature and solar irradiance
condition:
 Open-circuit voltage (Voc)
 Short-circuit current (Isc)
 Maximum power point (Pmp)
 Maximum power voltage (Vmp)
 Maximum power current (Imp)
Voltage (V)
Isc
Voc
Imp
Vmp
Pmp
Area = Pmp
Figure 51. Current-voltage curves can also be expressed as power-voltage curves
where the maximum power point (Pmp) is clearly shown. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 53
Figure 51. Current-voltage curves can also expressed as power-voltage curves where the
maximum power point (Pmp) is clearly shown.
Voltage (V)
Isc
Imp
Vmp Voc
Pmp = Imp x Vmp
Pmp
Current vs. voltage
Power vs. voltage
PV module performance is
sometimes represented by
power versus voltage curves,
which contain the same infor-
mation as I-V curves. Power
versus voltage curves provide
a clearer illustration of how
the power output is affected
by the operating voltage, and
where peak power output oc-
curs. See Fig. 51.
Key Module Parameters
Open-circuit voltage (Voc) is the maximum dc voltage on an I-V curve, and is the operating
point for a PV device with no connected load. Voc corresponds to an infinite resistance
or open-circuit condition, and zero current and zero power output. Open-circuit voltage
is independent of cell area and increases with decreasing cell temperature, and is used to
determine maximum circuit voltages for PV modules and arrays. For crystalline silicon
solar cells, the open-circuit voltage is typically on the order of 0.5 V to 0.6 V at 25°C. Thin-
film technologies have slightly higher cell voltages and different temperature coefficients,
but lower current density than crystalline silicon cells.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 51
 
Short-circuit current (Isc) is the maximum current on an I-V curve. Isc corresponds to a
zero resistance and short-circuit condition, at zero voltage and zero power output. Short-
circuit current is directly proportional to solar irradiance, and rated values are used in
calculations to size PV circuit conductors and overcurrent devices. Because PV modules
are inherently current-limited, PV modules can be short-circuited without harming the
modules using an appropriately rated shorting device. In fact, measuring the short-circuit
current of a module or string when it is disconnected from the rest of the system is one
way to test modules and strings. Some PV charge controllers regulate battery charging by
short-circuiting the module or array. Note that short circuits for extended periods of time
(greater than several minutes under high irradiance) may damage some thin-film mod-
ules. Manufacturers’ data sheets provide applicable cautions.
The maximum power point (Pmp) of a PV device is the operating point on its I-V curve
where the product of current and voltage is at its maximum. The maximum power voltage
(Vmp) is the corresponding operating voltage at Pmp, and is typically 70% to 80% of the
open-circuit voltage. The maximum power current (Imp) is the operating current at Pmp,
and typically 90% of the short-circuit current. The maximum power point is located on
the “knee” of the I-V curve, and represents the highest efficiency operating point for a PV
device under the given conditions of solar irradiance and cell temperature.
Operating Point
The specific operating point on an I-V curve is determined by the electrical load accord-
ing to Ohm’s Law. Consequently, the load resistance to operate a PV module or array at
its maximum power point is equal to the maximum power voltage divided by the maxi-
mum power current (Vmp/Imp). For example, consider a PV module with maximum
power voltage (Vmp) = 35.8 V, and maximum power current (Imp) = 4.89 A. The load
resistance required to operate this module at maximum power is equal to Vmp ÷ Imp =
35.8 V ÷ 4.89 A = 7.32 Ω. The maximum dc power produced is simply the product of the
maximum power current and voltage. See Fig. 52.
In application, the operating point on the I-V curve is determined by the specific equip-
ment connected to the output of the PV array. If the load is a battery, the battery voltage
Figure 52. The specific operating point on an I-V curve is determined by the electrical
load resistance according to Ohm’s Law. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 54
Figure 52. The specific operating point on an I-V curve is determined by the electrical load
resistance according to Ohm’s Law.
Voltage
Decreasing
resistance
Constant Temperature
Increasing
resistance
R = 0
R = ∞
Load lines of constant
resistance
sets the operating point on the I-V curve,
and sets the operating current. If the PV
array is connected to an interactive in-
verter, the inverter circuits seek to operate
the PV at its maximum power point as
long as the array voltage operates within
the inverter specifications. Maximum power
point tracking (MPPT) refers to the process
or electronic equipment used to operate
PV modules or arrays at their maximum
power point under varying conditions.
MPPT circuits are integral to interactive
inverters, some charge controllers and also
available as separate equipment or part of
PV array source circuit combiner boxes.
52 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Response to Irradiance
Changes in solar radiation have a direct linear and proportional effect on the current and
maximum power output of a PV module or array. See Fig. 53. Therefore, doubling the so-
lar irradiance on the surface of the array doubles the current and maximum power output
(assuming constant temperature). Changing irradiance has a smaller effect on voltage,
mainly at lower irradiance levels. Because voltage varies little with changing irradiance at
higher levels, PV devices are well-suited for battery charging applications. See Fig. 54.
The short-circuit current (Isc), maximum power current (Imp), and maximum power
(Pmp) at one condition of solar irradiance may be translated to estimate the value of these
parameters at another irradiance level:
Isc2
= Isc1
× (E2
/E1
)
Pmp2
= Pmp1
× (E2
/E1
)
Imp2
= Imp1
× (E2
/E1
)
where
Isc1
= rated short-circuit current at irradiance E1
(A)
Isc2
= short-circuit current at new irradiance E2
(A)
E1
= rated solar irradiance (W/m2
)
E2
= new solar irradiance (W/m2
)
Pmp1
= rated maximum power at irradiance E1
(W)
Pmp2
= new maximum power at new irradiance E2
(W)
Imp1
= rated maximum power current at irradiance E1
(A)
Imp2
= new maximum power current at new irradiance E2
(A)
PV installers verify performance of PV systems in the field by measuring the solar irradi-
ance incident on arrays with simple handheld meters, and correlating with the actual
system power output. For example, if it has been established that the peak output of a PV
array is 10 kW under incident radiation levels of 1000 W/m2
at normal operating tem-
peratures, then the output of the array should be expected to be around 7 kW if the solar
irradiance is 700 W/m2
, assuming constant temperature.
Figure 53. Changes in solar radiation have a direct linear and proportional effect on
the current and maximum power output of a PV module or array. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 55
Figure 53. Changes in solar radiation have a direct linear and proportional effect on the current
and maximum power output of a PV module or array.
Voltage
1000 W/m2
750 W/m2
500 W/m2
250 W/m2
Current increases with
increasing irradiance
Voc changes little
with irradiance
Maximum power increases
with increasing irradiance
Maximum power voltage
changes little with irradiance
Constant Temperature
Figure 54. PV module current and voltage are affected differently by solar irradiance. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays:
Figure 54. PV module current and voltage are affected differently by solar irradianc
Irradiance (W/m2)
1000
Isc increases with
increasing irradiance
Voc changes little with
irradiance above 200 W/m2
Constant Temperature
8006004002000
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 53
Response to Temperature
The current and voltage output of a PV module are temperature dependent. For crystal-
line silicon PV devices, increasing cell temperature results in a measureable decrease in
voltage and power, and a slight increase in current. Higher cell operating temperatures
also reduce cell efficiency and lifetime. The temperature effects on current are an order of
magnitude less than on voltage, and neglected as far as any installation or safety issues
are concerned.
Temperature coefficients relate the effects of changing PV cell temperature on its voltage,
current and power output. For crystalline silicon PV devices, the temperature coefficient
for voltage is approximately -0.4%/°C, the temperature coefficient for short-circuit cur-
rent is approximately +0.04 %/°C, and the temperature coefficient for maximum power is
approximately -0.45 %/°C. Note that the power and voltage temperature coefficients are
negative, as these parameters decrease with increasing temperature. Thin-film PV mod-
ules have different temperature coefficients than crystalline silicon modules. See Fig. 55.
Since PV modules achieve their highest voltages at the lowest temperatures, this voltage
determines the minimum voltage ratings required for the modules and associated dc cir-
cuit components [NEC 690.7]. For crystalline silicon PV modules, the maximum voltage
for PV systems is determined by multiplying the module rated open-circuit voltage (Voc)
by the number of modules in series, and by a voltage correction factor [NEC Table 690.7].
See Fig. 56. Where other than crystalline silicon (thin-film) PV modules are used, or if
temperature coefficients are provided with manufacturer’s instructions, manufacturer’s
instructions must be used to calculate maximum system voltage.
The following three methods are used to calculate maximum system voltage. The
example uses a PV module with rated open-circuit voltage (Voc) = 37.3 V, installed in a
location with a -12°C lowest expected ambient temperature. The array design uses 14
series-connected PV modules.
Figure 55. For crystalline silicon PV devices, increasing cell temperature results in a
decrease in voltage and power, and a small increase in current.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 57
Figure 55. For crystalline silicon PV devices, increasing cell temperature results in a decrease in
voltage and power, and a small increase in current.
Voltage
T = 25°C
T = 50°C
T = 0 C
Increasing temperature
reduces voltage
Increasing temperature
reduces power output
Increasing
temperature
increases current
Figure 56. Voltage-temperature correction factors for crystalline silicon PV
modules increase with decreasing temperatures.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 58
Figure 56. Voltage-temperature correction factors for crystalline silicon PV modules increase with
decreasing temperatures.
 Voltage-temperature correction
factors for crystalline silicon PV
modules increase with
decreasing temperatures.
 Manufacturer’s listed instructions
must be used if:
 The minimum temperatures are
below -40 C,
 Other than crystalline silicon PV
modules are used, or
 Coefficients are provided with listed
instructions.
Minimum Ambient
Temperature (oC)
Correction
Factor
24 to 20 1.02
19 to 15 1.04
14 to 10 1.06
9 to 5 1.08
4 to 0 1.10
-1 to -5 1.12
-6 to -10 1.14
-11 to -15 1.16
-16 to -20 1.18
-21 to -25 1.20
-26 to -30 1.21
-31 to -35 1.23
-36 to -40 1.25
Adapted from NEC Table 690.7
54 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Rating Conditions
Standard Test Conditions (STC) is a
universal rating condition for PV
modules and arrays, and specifies the
electrical output at a solar irradiance
level of 1000 W/m2
at AM 1.5 spectral
distribution, and 25°C cell tempera-
ture. The conditions are conducive to
testing indoors in a manufacturing
environment but tend to overestimate
actual field performance, as PV arrays
rarely at a temperature of 25°C and
an irradiance of 1000 W/m2
at the
same time. An operating temperature
of 50°C at Peak Sun is much more
common when the module is at mild
ambient temperatures. See Fig. 57.
Method 1 —
Module Manufacturer’s Temperature Correction Factor—Percentage Method
	Temperature Coefficient for VOC
= aVOC
= -0.37% / °C = -0.0037 / °C
	Temperature Correction Factor 	 = 1 + aVOC
(%) x (TempLOW
– TempRATED
)
		 = 1 + (-0.0037/°C) x (-12°C – 25°C)
		 = 1 + 0.137 = 1.137
	VMAX
= 37.3V x 14 x 1.137 = 593.7 V < 600 V (compliant for a 600VMAX
inverter)
Method 2 —
Module Manufacturer’s Temperature Correction Factor—Voltage Method
Temperature Coefficient for VOC
= aVOC
= x -137mV/°C = -0.137 V/°C
Temperature Correction Factor	 = 1 + [aVOC
(V/°C) x (TempLOW
– TempRATED
) ÷VOC
]
		 = 1+ [-0.137 V/°C x (-12°C – 25°C) ÷ 37.3V]
		 = 1+ [5.069V ÷ 37.3V] = 1.136
VMAX
= 37.3 V x 14 x 1.136 = 593 V < 600 V (compliant for a 600VMAX
inverter)
Method 3 —
Table 690.7 Temperature Correction Factor
From row for ambient temperature = -11°C to -15°C 1.16
VMAX
= 37.3V x 14 x 1.16 = 605.8 V > 600 V (this is less accurate and yields a value
that exceeds the allowable 600 VMAX
for the inverter, only 13 modules in series would be
permitted.)
Maximum System
Voltage
The maximum system volt-
age is the PV array open-
circuit voltage at the lowest
expected ambient tem-
perature at a site. The NEC
defines lowest expected
ambient temperature in an
informational note in Art.
690.7 as the Extreme Annu-
al Mean Minimum Design
Dry Bulb Temperature from
the ASHRAE Handbook—
Fundamentals. A table of
these values for the United
States is available in the
appendix of the Expedited
Permit Process: www.solar-
abcs.org/permitting.
The ASHRAE temperatures
represent statistically valid
expected low temperatures,
and fall midway between
the record low and the
average low for a location.
The record low tempera-
ture for a location is overly
conservative to use for PV
module voltage-tempera-
ture corrections, and mod-
ule voltage really doesn’t
reach its maximum until
irradiance levels exceed
200 W/m2
, well after the
record low temperature has
occurred. Most PV module
manufacturers now publish
the temperature coefficient
for Voc in their specifica-
tions.
Figure 57. The differences between rating conditions can be clearly
shown by the I-V curves.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Array
Figure 57. The differences between rating conditions can be clearly shown by the I-V cur
Voltage
STC
SOC
PTC
NOC
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 55
PV module performance is sometimes represented at other test conditions, including:
	 • Standard Operating Conditions (SOC)
		 Irradiance: 1,000 W/m2
		 Cell temperature: NOCT
	 • Nominal Operating Conditions (NOC)
		 Irradiance: 800 W/m2
		 Cell temperature: NOCT
	 • Nominal Operating Cell Temperature (NOCT)
		 Irradiance: 800 W/m2
		 Ambient Temp: 20°C
		 PV Array: open-circuit
		 Wind Speed: 1.0 m/s
	 • PVUSA Test Conditions (PTC)
		 1000 W/m², 45°C, 1 m/s
A number of standards have been developed to address the safety, reliability and perfor-
mance of PV modules. PV modules are classified as electrical equipment, and hence must
conform to accepted product safety standards, and according to the NEC, they must be
listed or approved by a recognized laboratory.
In the U.S., PV modules are listed for electrical safety to UL1703 “Safety Standard for Flat-
Plate Photovoltaic Modules and Panels”. These requirements cover flat-plate photovoltaic
modules intended for installation in accordance with the NEC and for use in systems
with a maximum system voltage of 1000 volts or less. The standard also covers compo-
nents intended to provide electrical connections and for the structural mounting of PV
modules. The corresponding international standard is IEC61730, which has been harmo-
nized with UL 1703.
PV Module Labels
Certain key I-V parameters at Standard Test Conditions are required to be labeled on ev-
ery listed PV module [NEC 690.51]. These nameplate electrical ratings govern the circuit
design and application limits for the module, and must include the following information
and ratings:
	 • polarity of terminals
	 • maximum overcurrent device rating for module protection
	 • open-circuit voltage (Voc)
	 • short-circuit current (Isc)
	 • maximum permissible systems voltage
	 • operating or maximum power voltage (Vmp)
	 • operating or maximum power current (Imp)
	 • maximum power (Pmp)
56 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Other items found on PV modules labels include fire classification ratings, minimum
conductor sizes and ratings, and additional design qualification and type testing certifica-
tion [IEC 61215 or IEC 61646]. Additional information related to PV module installation
is found in the installation instructions included with listed PV modules. All installers
should thoroughly read this information before working with or installing any PV mod-
ules or arrays [NEC 110.2]. See Fig. 59.
PV modules may be evaluated for external fire exposure for building roof covering
materials. The fire class is identified in the individual Recognitions as class A, B or C in
accordance with UL’s Roofing Materials and Systems Directory. Modules not evaluated
for fire exposure are identified as NR (Not Rated), and cannot be installed on buildings. 
Air Mass
Air mass (AM) is the relative path length of direct
solar radiation through the atmosphere. Air mass
affects the amount and spectral content of the solar
radiation reaching the earth’s surface, and varies
with sun position and altitude (barometric pressure).
AM 1.5 defines the spectral irradiance characteristic
for testing and rating the electrical performance of
PV cells and modules, and is representative of a
solar altitude angle of about 42°. Air mass is equal
to 1/cosUz
, where Uz
is the zenith angle (90°-altitude
angle). AM 0 is taken outside the earth’s atmo-
sphere, and represents extraterrestrial radiation.
When the sun is directly overhead in the tropics,
air mass is equal to one (AM 1). Air mass is also
corrected for higher altitudes by average pressure
ratios. See Fig 58.
Figure 58. Air mass (AM) 1.5 defines the
spectral irradiance characteristic for testing
and rating the electrical performance of PV
cells and modules.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar C
1
cos z o
where
AM air mass
zenith angle (degz
P local pressure (Pa
P sea level pressureo
Air mass is calac
P
AM
P
θ
θ
=
=
=
=

= 
Earth
Sun directly overhead
(zenith)
Sun at mid-morning
or mid-afternoon
Earth’s Surface
Limits of Atmosphere
Air Mass = 0
(AM0)
Air Mass = 1
(AM1.0)
Zenith Angle
θz = 48.2 deg
Air Mass = 1.5
(AM1.5)
Horizon
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 60
Figure 58. Air mass (AM) 1.5 defines the spectral irradiance characteristic for testing and rating
the electrical performance of PV cells and modules.
1
cos z o
where
AM air mass
zenith angle (deg)z
P local pressure (Pa)
P sea level pressure (Pa)o
Air mass is calaculated by the following:
P
AM
P
θ
θ
=
=
=
=
 
=  
 Earth
Sun directly overhead
(zenith)
Sun at mid-morning
or mid-afternoon
Earth’s Surface
Limits of Atmosphere
Air Mass = 0
(AM0)
Air Mass = 1
(AM1.0)
Zenith Angle
θz = 48.2 deg
Air Mass = 1.5
(AM1.5)
Horizon
Figure 59. PV module nameplate
electrical ratings govern the circuit
design and application limits for
the product.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 61
Figure 59. PV module nameplate electrical ratings govern the circuit design and application limits
for the product.
 All PV modules must be marked
with the following information
[690.51]:
 Open-circuit voltage
 Short-circuit current
 Operating voltage
 Operating current
 Maximum power
 Polarity of terminals
 Maximum overcurrent device
rating
 Maximum permissible system
voltage
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 57
Series/Parallel Connections
PV arrays consist of building blocks of individual PV
modules connected electrically in series and parallel
to achieve the desired operating voltage and current.
PV modules are usually connected in series first to
build voltage suitable for connection to dc utilization
equipment, such as interactive inverters, batteries,
charge controllers or dc loads. PV source circuits are
then connected in parallel at combiner boxes to build
current and power output for the array.
A string is a series connection of PV devices. PV cells
or modules are configured electrically in series by
connecting the negative terminal of one device to
the positive terminal of the next device, and so on.
For the series connection of similar PV modules, the
voltages add and the resulting string voltage is the
sum of the individual module voltages. The resulting
string current output remains the same as the current
output of an individual module. See Figs. 60 & 61.
Connecting PV modules in series with dissimilar cur-
rent ratings results in loss of power, similar in effect
to partially shading an array, or having parts of a
series source circuit located on surfaces facing differ-
ent directions and receiving different solar irradiance.
The resultant current output for a string of dissimilar
current output devices is ultimately limited to the
lowest current output device in the entire string, and
should be avoided. However, it is perfectly acceptable
to connect PV modules with different voltage output
in series, as long as each module has the same rated
current output. See Fig. 62.
Series strings of PV modules are configured electri-
cally in parallel by connecting the negative termi-
nals of each string together and the positive strings
together. Usually, an overcurrent device is required in
each string. For the parallel connection of strings, the
string currents add and the resulting string voltage is
the average of the individual string voltages. Parallel
connections of strings with different current output, or
from strings in different planes are acceptable, but may
require different circuit sizing. See Figs. 63, 64 & 65.
Monopole PV arrays consist of two output circuit
conductors, a positive and negative. Bipolar PV ar-
rays combine two monopole arrays with a center tap.
Figure 60. PV cells or modules are configured electrically in series by connecting the
negative terminal of one device to the positive terminal of the next device, and so on. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 62
Figure 60. PV cells or modules are configured electrically in series by connecting the negative
terminal of one device to the positive terminal of the next device, and so on.
(-)
Pos (+) Neg (-)
1 2(+) (-)(+) n (-)(+)
Vseries string = V1 + V2 ….. + Vn
Vseries string = V1 x n
Iseries string = I1 = I2 ….. = In (for similar
devices)
Figure 61. Connecting similar PV devices in series increases voltage while current stays
the same.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 63
Figure 61. Connecting similar PV devices in series increases voltage while current stays the
same.
For similar PV devices in series:
Vseries = V1 + V2 ….. + Vn
Vseries = V1 x n
Iseries = I1 = I2 ….. = In
Voltage (V)
Current(A)
1 device
2 devices
in series
“n” devices
in series
Figure 63. PV cells or modules are connected in parallel by connecting the negative
terminals together and the positive terminals together at a common point.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 65
Figure 63. PV cells or modules are connected in parallel by connecting the negative terminals
together and the positive terminals together at a common point.
For PV devices in parallel:
Vparallel = V1 = V2 ….. = Vn (for similar devices)
Vparallel = (V1 + V2 … + Vn) / n
Iparallel = I1 + I2 ….. + In
Pos (+)
Neg (-)
n
(-)
(+)
1
(-)
(+)
2
(-)
(+)
Figure 62. Connecting dissimilar PV devices in series must be avoided. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 64
Figure 62. Connecting dissimilar PV devices in series must be avoided.
 When dissimilar PV devices are connected in series, the voltages
still add, but the current is limited by the lowest current output
device in series.
 Not acceptable.
Vseries = VA + VB
Iseries = IA < IB
Pos (+) (-) (+) Neg (-)
Pos (+) Neg (-)
A B
58 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Certain inverters require the use of bi-polar arrays.
See Fig. 66.
Bypass diodes are connected in parallel with series
strings of cells to prevent cell overheating when cells
or parts of an array are shaded. See Fig. 67. Bypass
diodes are essentially electrical check valves that
permit the flow of current in only one direction.
When modules in series strings are partially shaded,
it may cause reverse voltage across the shaded
cells or modules. The bypass diode shunts current
around the shaded area and prevents cell overheat-
ing. Most listed PV modules are equipped with
factory installed bypass diodes. Bypass diodes may
or may not be serviceable via module junction boxes
in the field. See Fig. 68.
PV Inverters
Inverters are used in PV systems to produce ac
power from a dc source, such as a PV array or
batteries. Inverter sizes range from module-level
inverters rated a few hundred watts to utility-scale
inverters 1 MW and larger. Similar to the way PV
systems are classified, types of PV inverters are also
defined based on their application in stand-alone,
utility-interactive, or a combination of both types of
systems.
Stand-alone inverters operate from batteries and
supply power independent of the electrical utility
system. These inverters may also include a battery
charger to operate from an independent ac source,
such as the electric utility or a generator. See Fig 69.
Utility-interactive or grid-connected inverters operate
from PV arrays and supply power in parallel with
an electrical production and distribution network.
They do not supply PV array power to loads during
loss of grid voltage (energy storage is required). See
Fig. 70.
Multi-mode inverters are a type of battery-based
interactive inverter that act as diversionary charge
controllers by producing ac power output to regu-
late PV array battery charging, and sends excess
power to the grid when it is energized. During grid
outages, these inverters transfer backup loads off-
grid, and operate in stand-alone mode. They can
Figure 64. Connecting similar PV devices in parallel increases current while voltage stays
the same.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 66
Figure 64. Connecting similar PV devices in parallel increases current while voltage stays the
same.
Voltage (V)
Current(A)
Device 1+2
independently
Devices 1+2
in parallel
For PV devices in parallel:
Vparallel = V1 = V2 ….. = Vn (for similar
devices)
Vparallel = (V1 + V2 … + Vn) / n
Iparallel = I1 + I2 ….. + In
Figure 65. Dissimilar current PV modules and strings having similar voltage may be
connected in parallel.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 67
Connecting Dissimilar PV
Devices in Parallel
 When dissimilar devices are connected in parallel, the individual
currents add, and the voltage is the average of devices.
Vparallel = (VA + VB) / 2
Iparallel = IA + IB
B
A
Pos (+)Neg (-)
Figure 66. Monopole PV arrays consist of two output circuit conductors; bipolar PV
arrays combine two monopole arrays with a center tap.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 68
Figure 65. Monopole PV arrays consist of two output circuit conductors; while bipolar PV arrays
combine two monopole arrays with a center tap.
Bipolar ArrayMonopole Array
PV Array
Positive (+) Negative (-) Center Tap
PV Array
Positive (+) Negative (-)
PV Array
Figure 67. Bypass diodes are connected in parallel with series strings of cells to prevent
cell overheating when cells or parts of an array are shaded. 2012 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 2
Bypass Diodes
When cells are not shaded, the
bypass diode is reverse biased and
does not conduct current
Shaded cell
When a cells is shaded, the bypass
diode is forward biased and conducts
current
Pos (+)Neg (-)
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 59
operate either in interactive or stand-alone mode, but not
simultaneously.
Although stand-alone and interactive PV inverters both
produce ac power from dc power input, they have differ-
ent applications and functions. See Fig. 71.
The following list different types of utility-interactive
inverters and their applications:
Module-level inverters include ac modules and micro in-
verters installed integral to or adjacent to individual PV
modules. These small inverters are rated 200 W to 300
W maximum ac power output, which is consistent with
standard PV module sizes. The ac outputs of multiple
inverters are connected in parallel to a dedicated branch
circuit breaker. Advantages of module-level inverters
include individual module MPPT and better energy har-
vest from partially shaded and multi-directional arrays.
They also minimizes field-installed dc wiring and dc
source circuit design issues, and they are inherently safer
as the maximum dc voltages on the array are for a single
module (35-60 V) as opposed to a series connection of
several hundred volts for string inverters. See Fig. 72.
String inverters are small inverters in the 1 kW to 12 kW
size range, intended for residential and small commercial
applications. They are generally single-phase and usually
limited to 1 to 6 parallel-connected source circuits. Some
integrate source circuit combiners, fuses and disconnects
into a single unit. Larger systems using multiple string
inverters offer a number of advantages in systems design
and installation. Multiple inverters can be distributed at
Figure 68. Bypass diodes are often located in module junction
boxes. 
Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 70
Figure 67. Bypass diodes are often located in module junction boxes.
Figure 69. Stand-alone inverters supply power to ac loads isolated from the grid, and
the inverter power rating dictates the maximum load.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 71
Figure 68. Stand-alone inverters supply power to ac loads isolated from the grid, and the inverter
power rating dictates the maximum load.
DC LoadPV Array
Battery
Charge
Controller
Stand-Alone
Inverter/Charger
AC Load AC Source
(to Charger Only)
Figure 70. Interactive inverters use PV arrays for dc power input, and supply synchro-
nized ac output power in parallel with the utility grid, supplementing power to the local
ac distribution system.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 72
Figure 69. Interactive inverters use PV arrays for dc power input, and supply synchronized ac
output power in parallel with the utility grid, supplementing power to the local ac distribution
system.
Load
Center
PV Array
Interactive
Inverter
AC Loads
Electric
Utility
Figure 71. Stand-alone inverters use a battery for the dc power source, while interactive
inverters use a PV array as the dc source.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 73
Figure 70. Stand-alone inverters use a battery for the dc power source, while interactive inverters
use a PV array as the dc source.
Battery
Stand-Alone
Inverter
AC Load
PV Array
Interactive
Inverter
Utility Grid
Interactive Operation with PV Array as DC Power Source
AC load is limited by
inverter power rating
PV array size is limited by
inverter power rating
Stand-Alone Operation with Battery as DC Power Source
Vs.
60 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 57
mperature results in a decrease in
r, and a small increase in current.
temperature
ower output
subarray locations, avoiding long dc circuits, and can be interconnect-
ed at distributed points in an electrical system. Multiple inverters also
provide redundancy in the event of an individual inverter or subarray
failure, and provide MPPT and monitoring at the subarray level, facili-
tating fault finding and optimizing the output of individual subarrays
of different size, type, orientation or partially shaded. The ac output
of multiple string inverters can be distributed equally across the three
phases networks to avoid phase imbalance. See Fig. 73A and 73B.
Central inverters start at 30 kW to 50 kW up to 500 kW, and interconnect
to 3-phase grids. They are best suited for homogeneous PV arrays hav-
ing all the same modules and source circuit configurations, and aligned
and oriented in the same direction with no shading.
Utility-scale inverters are very large equipment with power ratings 500
kW to 1 MW and higher, designed for solar farms. These types may
also include medium-voltage (MV) transformers and switchgear, and
are interconnected to the grid at distribution voltages up to 38 kV. For
utility-controlled sites, certain variances with the NEC and product
listing requirements may apply. Both utility-scale and central inverter
installations require heavy equipment handling, larger conduit and
switchgear, and should be installed by competent individuals having
experience with the installation of large electrical equipment.
See Fig. 74.
Special controls may be used for utility-scale inverters that differ
from smaller inverters due to their impact on grid operations. Smaller
inverters are designed for near unity power factor output with tighter
anti-islanding and power quality controls. Utility-scale inverters may
be designed to deliver reactive power or low voltage ride through
(LVRT), or provide other dynamic controls for grid support.
Multi-mode inverters are battery-based interactive inverters that provide
grid backup to critical loads, typical with rated ac power output 2 kW
to 10 kW. They can operate in either interactive or stand-alone mode,
but not simultaneously, and many can interface and control auxiliary
Figure 72. AC modules and micro inverters are small inverters
installed integral to or adjacent to individual PV modules.
Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 74
micro inverters are small inverters installed integral to or adjacent to
individual PV modules.
Enphase Micro Inverter
Figure 73B. String inverters are small inverters in the 1 to 12 kW size range, intended
for residential and small commercial applications.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 75
Figure 73A. Stand-alone inverters convert DC power from
batteries into AC power.
Morningstar SureSine SMA Sunny Island
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 61
source, such as generators for hybrid system applications. These types of inverters and
systems are used where a backup power supply is required for critical loads. Under nor-
mal circumstances when the grid is energized, the inverter acts as a diversionary charge
controller, limiting battery voltage and state-of charge by supplying output power to ac
loads or the grid. When the primary power source is lost, a transfer switch internal to the
inverter opens the connection with the utility, and the inverter operates dedicated loads
that have been disconnected from the grid. An external bypass switch is usually provided
to allow the system to be taken off-line for service or maintenance, while not interrupting
the operation of electrical loads. These inverters may also be used in hybrid system ap-
plications to control loads, battery charging, and generator starting.
Inverter circuits use high-speed switching transistors to convert dc to ac power. Large
thyristors are used in high power applications up to several MW for HVDC power trans-
mission at grid-interties. Most PV inverters use metal-oxide semiconductor field-effect
transistors (MOSFETs) or insulated gate bi-polar transistors (IGBTs). Power MOSFETs
operate at lower voltages with high efficiency and low resistance compared to IGBTs.
They switch at very high speeds (up to 800 kW) and are generally used in medium to
low-power applications from 1 kW to 10 kW. IGBTs handle high current and voltage,
but switch at lower speeds (up to 20 kHz), and are more common for high-voltage, large
power applications up to an over 100 kW. Switching elements are connected in parallel to
increase the current and power capability of an inverter.
Sine waves, square waves and modified square waves are examples of common inverter
ac waveforms. Listed utility-interactive inverters produce utility-grade sine wave output.
Some small, lower cost stand-alone inverters produce modified square wave or square
wave output. See Fig. 75.
Figure 74. Utility-scale inverters use higher DC input and AC output voltages to reduce losses, and the size and costs of the conductors
and switchgear required.
Figure 73. Utility-scale inverters use higher DC input and AC output voltages to reduce loss
and the size and costs of the conductors and switchgear requir
62 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Selecting and specifying the best inverter for a given application involves considering
the system design and installation requirements. Inverter specification sheets are critical.
Inverter selection is often the first consideration in system design, and based on the type
of loads or electrical service and voltage, and the size and location of the PV array.
AC Waveforms
For a pure sine wave, the peak voltage is related to the RMS voltage by a factor of
the square root of 2:
Vpeak = Vrms × √2 = Vrms × 1.414
Vrms = Vpeak × 0.707
For example, a typical AC voltage sine wave with peak voltage of 170 V has an
RMS voltage of 170 × 0.707 = 120 V.
For pure sine waves, the average voltage is also related to RMS and peak voltage
by:
Vrms = 1.11 × Vavg, or Vavg = 0.9 × Vrms.
Vavg = 0.637 × Vpeak, or Vpeak = 1.57 × Vavg.
For a square wave, Vavg, Vrms, and Vpeak are all equal. See Fig. 76.
Figure 75. For a pure sine wave, the peak voltage is related to the RMS voltage by a factor of the square root of 2. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 77
Figure 74. Sine waves, square waves and modified square waves are examples of common
inverter ac waveforms.
Time >
Sine Wave
0
Modified Square Wave
Square Wave
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 63
Specifications for inverters typically include:
DC Input
	 • Maximum array or dc voltage (open-circuit, cold)
	 • Recommended maximum array power
	 • Start voltage and operating range (interactive inverters only)
	 • MPPT voltage range (interactive inverters only)
	 • Maximum usable input current (interactive inverters)
	 • Maximum array and source circuit current
	 • Array ground fault detection
AC Output
	 • Nominal voltage
	 • Maximum continuous output power
	 • Maximum continuous output current
	 • Maximum output overcurrent device rating
	 • Power conversion efficiency
	 • Power quality
	 • Anti-islanding protection
Performance
	 • Nominal and weighted efficiencies
	 • Stand-by losses (nighttime)
	 • Monitoring and communications interface
Physical
	 • Operating temperature range
	 • Size and weight
	 • Mounting locations, enclosure type
	 • Conductor termination sizes and torque specifications
	 • Conduit knockout sizes and configurations
Other Features
	 • Integral dc or ac disconnects
	 • Number of source circuit combiner and fuse/circuit ratings
	 • Standard and extended warranties
Figure 76. Sine waves, square waves and modified square waves are examples of common inverter ac waveforms.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 78
Figure 75. For a pure sine wave, the peak voltage is related to the RMS voltage by a factor of the
square root of 2:
One cycle: 360
Time >>
0
Sine wave has Vpeak = VRMS x √2
120
Voltage
170 Square wave has Vpeak = VRMS
-170
-120
Inverter efficiency is calculated by
the ac power output divided by the
dc power input. Inverter efficiency
varies with power level, input volt-
age and temperature, among other
factors. For example, an inverter
having an input power of 6000 Wdc
and producing and output of 5700
Wac has an efficiency of 5700 ÷ 6000
= 0.95 = 95%. See Fig 77.
64 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
In addition to product safety testing and listing to the UL1741 standard, the California
Energy Commission (CEC) has established requirements for independent inverter ef-
ficiency testing by an NRTL to be approved as eligible equipment. Incentive programs in
other states also require the use of PV modules and inverters on the CEC list. A complete
list of eligible inverters and test results are available online.
 
Inverter efficiency testing is conducted over the entire power range of the inverter, and at
minimum, maximum and nominal dc operating voltages. Inverter efficiency rises quickly
with a low power levels, and most inverters reach at least 90% efficiency at only 10% of
their maximum continuous output power rating. See Fig 78.
Reference: List of Eligible Inverters per SB1 Guidelines, California Energy Commission:
http://www.gosolarcalifornia.org/equipment/inverters.php
Figure 77. Inverter efficiency is calculated by the ac power output divided by the dc power input.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 79
Figure 76. Inverter efficiency is calculated by the AC power output divided by the DC power input.
5700
0.95 95%
6000
where
= inverter efficiency
= AC power ouput (W)
= DC power input (W)
AC
inv
DC
inv
AC
DC
P
P
P
P
η
η
= = = =
AC Output:
5700 W
DC Input:
6000 W
Losses:
300 W
Inverter
Inverter Standards
The following standards apply to inverters used in PV systems, including requirements
for product listing, installation and interconnection to the grid.
UL 1741 Inverters, Converters, Controllers and Interconnection System Equipment for Use with
Distributed Energy Resources addresses requirements for all types of distributed generation
equipment, including inverters and charge controllers used in PV systems, as well as the
interconnection of wind turbines, fuel cells, microturbines and engine-generators.
IEEE 1547 Standard for Interconnecting Distributed Resources with Electric Power Sys-
tems, and IEEE 1547.1 Standard for Conformance Test Procedures for Equipment Inter-
connecting Distributed Resources with Electric Power Systems are the basis for UL 1741
certification for interactive inverters.
Inverter installation requirements are governed by the NEC Articles 690 and 705. These
articles cover inverter installation requirement including sizing conductors and overcur-
rent protection devices, disconnect means, grounding, and for connecting interactive
inverters to the electric utility grid.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 65
 
2.7	 Review Wiring and Conduit Size
	 Calculations
There are several circuits in PV systems depending on the
type of system installed. Some circuits are dc and others
are ac, operating at different voltages and currents, and
of varying length and environmental exposure. Some of
these circuits have special requirements for sizing the
circuit conductors and overcurrent protection. The PV
installer should be able to clearly identify the different
circuits in a PV system and their installation requirements
[NEC 690.2]. See Figs. 79, 80 & 81.
Figure 78. Inverter efficiency testing is conducted over a range of operating voltages and power levels.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 80
California Energy Commission
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 81
Figure 78. The PV power source consists of the complete PV array dc power generating unit,
including PV source circuits, PV output circuits, and overcurrent protection devices as required.
PV Module
PV Output Circuit
Photovoltaic Power Source
PV Array
PV Source Circuits
To disconnect means
and DC equipment
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 82
Figure 79. For simple interactive PV systems, the PV array is connected to the dc input of
inverters, and there is no energy storage.
Interactive System
PV Array
Source Circuit
Combiner Box
DC Fused
Disconnect
Ground Fault
Protection
AC Fused
Disconnect
Electric Utility
Utility
Disconnect
Integral components in many
small string inverters < 12 kW
PV Source Circuits
PV Output
Circuit Inverter Input Circuit Inverter Output Circuit
Inverter Main
Service
Panel
Figure 81. For stand-alone PV systems the
PV array charges the battery, and the battery
provides dc power to the inverter which can
produce ac power output at any time.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 83
Figure 80. For stand-alone PV systems the PV array charges the battery, and the battery provides
dc power to the inverter which can produce ac power output at any time.
Stand-Alone System
PV Array
Source Circuit
Combiner Box
PV Fused
Disconnect
Ground Fault
Protection
Inverter Fused
Disconnect
Auxiliary
AC Source
PV Source Circuits
PV Output Circuit
Inverter DC
input Circuit
Inverter/
Charger
Battery
Charge
Controller
Battery Fused
Disconnect
Inverter
Output
Circuit
AC
Loads
DC
Loads
Figure 79. The PV power source consists of the complete PV array dc power generating unit,
including PV source circuits, PV output circuits, and overcurrent protection devices as required.
Figure 80. For simple interactive PV systems, the
PV array is connected to the dc input of inverters,
and there is no energy storage.
66 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
2.7.1	 Determine Circuit Currents
PV Source Circuit Maximum Current
The required ampacity of the source circuit wiring, or conductors from modules to source
circuit combiner box, depends upon the rated PV module short-circuit current (Isc). The
maximum current for PV source circuits is determined by 125% of the sum of the module
rated short-circuit currents in parallel [NEC 690.8(A)]. Since most crystalline silicon ar-
rays only have one series string per source circuit, there is normally no need to account
for parallel circuits in the source circuit calculation. The reason for the 125% factor is
that in certain locations and times of the year, it is possible for the modules to operate at
125% of the STC short-circuit current rating for 3 hours or more around solar noon. For
example, consider a module with short circuit rating of 8.41 A. The maximum continuous
current rating of that module is 125% of the STC short-circuit current rating, or 1.25 × 8.41
A = 10.5 A.
PV Output Circuit Maximum Current
The maximum current for the PV output circuit and the entire PV power source is the
sum of all parallel source circuits supplying dc power. The maximum circuit current for a
typical PV array with three series strings is the sum of the three source circuit maximum
currents. For the example with a maximum source circuit current of 10.5 A, the maximum
current for the PV output circuit having three of these source circuits in parallel would be
3 × 10.5 A = 31.5 A.
Inverter Output Circuit Maximum Current
The inverter output circuit is defined as the ac circuit from the inverter output to the
utilization load. In the case of utility-interactive installations, the inverter output circuit
is the ac output that connects to the interactive point of utility connection. This point
of connection in residential PV systems is often a simple circuit breaker in a utility-fed
service panel. The maximum current of the inverter output circuit is the continuous cur-
rent capability of the inverter (continuous = 3-hour rating). The maximum continuous
current of an inverter may be listed on the product specification sheet. If it is not available
on the specification sheet, then the current can be calculated by taking the continuous
power rating at 40°C and dividing that value by the nominal ac voltage. For example, the
maximum current for an inverter with maximum continuous power output of 7,000 W at
240 Vac would be 29 A.
 
Battery Circuit Current
Battery circuits are unique in that they carry not only the dc current required to run the
inverter at full load continuously (for 3 hours), but they must also carry ac current. This
may surprise some installers, but all inverters require an ac input in order to create and
ac output. Since dc sources such as a PV array do not naturally provide these ac currents,
a short-term storage device is necessary. In utility-interactive inverters, these storage
devices are capacitors. Each time the ac power goes to zero, when the ac voltage goes to
zero, the power from the PV array is stored in the capacitor. That energy is rereleased at
the peak of the next waveform. Therefore current is stored and removed from the capaci-
tor two times every cycle. When the required frequency is 60 Hertz, the frequency on the
capacitors is 120 Hertz. This storage is sometimes called half-wave storage.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 67
In battery-based inverters, rather than installing capacitors, the battery is used for half-
wave storage. Current that is needed to create the sine wave is stored and removed from
the battery. This means that additional current is travelling on the battery input conduc-
tors that must be accounted for.
2.72	 Calculate Required Ampacity of Conductors
Temperature and Conduit Fill Corrections for Ampacity of Conductors
The required ampacity of conductors is based on the maximum circuit current, the size
of the overcurrent protection device, the ambient temperature of the conductor, the type
of conductor and insulation, the conduit fill of the conductor, and any limitations that
the terminals may place on the conductor. PV systems are some of the most complex
wiring systems to determine wire sizing due to the large number of factors that must be
considered when choosing an adequate wire size. Fortunately, the 2011 NEC has clearer
direction on this subject that should help installers and system designers more accurately
specify wire sizes. To illustrate the proper code-approved method, it is beneficial to do an
example using NEC 690.8 from the 2011 NEC.
 
EXAMPLE:
A residential rooftop PV system has 3 pairs of conductors in a sunlit raceway mounted 1½” above the roof surface
in Palm Springs, California. The short-circuit current of each source circuit is 8.41 amps. What is the minimum size
conductor for this scenario?
Answer:
Step 1: Calculate Maximum Circuit Current [690.8(A)(1)]: Imax = Isc x 1.25 = 8.41 A x 1.25 = 10.5 A
Step 2: Calculate the minimum overcurrent protective device (OCPD) [690.8(B)(1)(a)]:
OCPD = Imax x 1.25 = 10.5 A x 1.25 = 13.1 A 14 A [690.9(C)]
Step 3: Calculate minimum conductor size without conditions of use [690.8(B)(2)(a)]
Minimum conductor ampacity = Imax x 1.25 = 13.1A 14 AWG (minimum bldg wire, Table 310.15(B)16)
Step 4: Calculate minimum conductor size based on Imax with conditions of use [690.8(B)(2)(b)]:
Conditions of use include conduit fill, sunlit conduit temperature adder, and ambient temperature adjustment factors.
Conduit fill adjustment factor 0.8 according to Table 310.15(B)(3)(a)
Sunlit conduit temperature adder 22°C according to Table 310.15(B)(3)(c)
Ambient temperature adjustment factor 22°C + 44°C = 66°C 0.58 [Table 310.15(B)(2)(a)]
Minimum conductor ampacity = Imax ÷ conduit fill adj factor ÷ temp adj factor = 10.5 ÷ 0.8 ÷ 0.58 = 22.6 A 12 AWG
Step 5: Determine if 15 Amp overcurrent protection can protect the conductor under conditions of use [690.8(B)(2)(c)]
12 AWG ampacity = 30 A x 0.8 x 0.58 = 13.92 A (fails because 14 A fuse will not protect this conductor under
conditions of use)
10 AWG ampacity = 40 A x 0.8 x 0.58 = 18.56 A (okay)
 
68 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
PV Source Circuits
Outside Conduit
Exposed outdoor cables are common in PV systems and in industrial conventional electri-
cal systems, but they are less common in commercial and residential electrical systems.
Conductors as single conductor cables, or bundles of three conductors or less, are com-
monly run in PV arrays from a few kilowatts up to megawatts. Since these conductors are
often run for some distance in free air, it would be possible to claim free air ampacities
for those exposed lengths of cables [NEC Table 310.15(B)(17)]. However, these exposed
conductors are often run into raceways for physical protection and support. As long as the
sections of raceway protection are not more than 10 ft or 10% of the circuit length, then free
air ampacities can be used [NEC 310.15(A)(2)].
Bundled or Inside Conduit
In almost all cases, wiring behind modules will be exposed to elevated temperatures,
sometimes as high as 75°C. The NEC also recognizes the fact that conductors installed in
conduit exposed to direct sunlight, as is common in PV systems, can operate at tempera-
tures that are 17ºC or more above the ambient temperature [Table 310.15(B)(3)(c)]. This
means that a conduit in an outdoor temperature of 40ºC should actually be sized based
on a 57ºC operating temperature due to sunlight exposure. Suppose the conductors are
exposed to 57°C and that 14 AWG THWN, with insulation rated at 75°C, is being consid-
ered. According to NEC Table 310.15(B)(16), when THWN wire is operated at 30°C or less,
its ampacity is 20 A. But the correction factor associated with Table 310.15(B)(2)(a) requires
that the ampacity of the wire be derated to 58% of its 30°C value if it is operated at 57°C.
This reduces the ampacity of the 14 AWG THWN wire to 20 A x 0.58 = 11.6 A.
Wherever 4-6 current carrying conductors are bundled or enclosed in the same conduit or
raceway, according to NEC Table 310.15(B)(3)(a), a further adjustment of 80% is needed
for conduit fill. This reduces the ampacity of the 14 AWG THWN conductors to 11.6 A x
0.8 = 9.28 A. The ampacity of the conductor, after the application of these “conditions of
use” factors must be equal to or greater than the maximum circuit current, or a larger size
conductor is required.
The fuse protecting the conductors must also be rated at 1.25 times the maximum current
(1.56 Isc), which is 13.1 A, and that fuse must provide overcurrent protection for the con-
ductor under its conditions of use. The fuse rating can be rounded up to the next higher
standard value (14 A), but this will not protect the cable, which has a corrected ampacity of
only 9.28 A. The 14 AWG THWN conductor therefore is not acceptable due to the mini-
mum size of the overcurrent protection required.
However, if a 14 AWG THWN-2 copper wire is used, the 30°C ampacity is 25 A. Further-
more, the temperature correction factor for 57°C operation is 0.71. The resulting ampacity
of the 14 AWG THWN-2 conductor, when corrected for temperature and for conduit fill
becomes 25 x 0.71 x 0.8 = 14.2 A, which is adequate to handle the maximum source circuit
current. It can also be protected with a 14 A fuse.
When using conductors with insulation temperature ratings higher than the terminal
temperature rating of the connected devices, a check must be made to ensure that the
conductor temperature during normal operation does not exceed the maximum tempera-
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 69
Prepare for the new grid.
With the“Masters of the Off-Grid.”
www.outbackpower.com
OutBack Power’s Certificate Training Program: NABCEP-
approved comprehensive course covers all aspects of
energy storage-based systems. Puts you well on your way
to PV Installation Professional Certification or Solar PV
Re-Certification.
Two west-coast training locations in Washington and
Arizona. Contact training@outbackpower.com or call
360-435-4030 and ask for Certificate Training Program.
Delivering our Customers with the Best
Overall Value. For Off-Grid Applications
When Every WATT Counts!
www.morningstarcorp.com/products
Products Built From the Inside Out
NABCEP PV Installation Professional Certification looks a little
different these days, but our promise has not changed. As the
industry’s mark of excellence, NABCEP certification continues
to provide unparalleled opportunity for job advancement,
salary growth and consumer trust.
Experience. Quality. Professionalism. Our promise has
never changed. And our new look only makes certification
more attractive.
PV Installation
Professional
NABCEP PV Installation
Professional Certification
Visit nabcep.org
The new look
of expertise.
70 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
NABCEP CAREER PATHWAYS:
 PV INSTALLATION PROFESSIONAL
 PV TECHNICAL SALES
 PV CONTINUING EDUCATION
We’ll get you there.
go.ncsu.edu/pvtraining
Solar
Congratulations to NABCEP
for making strides in our industry.
We are proud to support your
dedicated mission to responsible energy.
r e n o v a s o l a r . c o m America’s first professionally accredited company.
PV Installation
Company
Renova Energy Corp.
California – 2012
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 71
The World’s #1 News Source
for Solar Installers!
Keeping you informed.
Featuring award-winning online
content and the world’s largest
Solar Energy e-Newsletter.
Register Today!
www.RenewableEnergyWorld.com
72 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
SCHOLARSHIPS AVAILABLE
SO NO COST TO YOU!
CONTACT TODAY:
www.spectechedu.com
PHONE:
616-794-7536
E-MAIL:
info@spectechedu.com
STAHLIN – The World’s Most Specified Non-Metallic Enclosure
“ B E C AU S E P E R F O R M A N C E M AT T E R S ”
SpecTECH is the only nationally-recognized educational
program developed specifically to provide a comprehensive
understanding of material sciences as relates to the proper
selection of enclosures for diverse applications.
This two-day hands on educational opportunity is accredited for
12 NABCEP CEU’s & 16 PDH hours!
SpecTECH Enclosures &
Material Education
ALONG WITH
Stahlin Non-Metallic
Enclosures
TWO RESOURCES DEDICATED TO YOUR
SUCCESS IN THE SOLAR ENERGY INDUSTRY!
NEED NABCEP CONTINUING
EDUCATION CREDITS?
STAHLIN NON-METALLIC
ENCLOSURES
www.stahlin.com
500 Maple St. • Belding, MI 48809 • Phone: 616-794-0700 • Fax: 616-794-3378
• COST EFFECTIVE
• UV RESISTANT
• CORROSION RESISTANT
• UL1741 APPROVED
• TYPE 4X AND 6P
TYPICAL APPLICATIONS:
• COMBINER BOXES
• JUNCTION
• INSTRUMENTATION
• CONTROLS
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 73
ture rating of the terminals of these devices. In this case the module terminals are rated
at 90°C and the fuse terminals are rated at 60°C or 75°C. The ampacity of the 14 AWG
conductor taken from the 75°C or 60°C insulation column in NEC Table 310.15(B)(16) is
20 A. The continuous current in this circuit is only 10.5 A so it is assured that the 14 AWG
conductor will operate at temperatures well below 60°C at the fuse terminals if the ter-
minals are in an ambient temperature of 30ºC. If the fuse terminals are in a 40ºC environ-
ment, similar to conduit not exposed to sunlight, the maximum allowable current must
be corrected by the 40ºC correction factor of 0.82 (0.82 x 20 A = 16.4 A). Fortunately, the
maximum continuous current is only 10.5 A which is well below the maximum of 16.4 A.
If the terminals are in a box on the roof exposed to direct sunlight, they would have to be
rated for 75ºC minimum in order to not overheat on a hot sunny day since the tempera-
tures could reach 57ºC similar to inside the conduit.
PV Output Circuit
Bundled or Inside Conduit
PV power source circuits, similar to feeder circuits in conventional ac distribution in
buildings are typically run inside conduit. Occasionally these circuits are bundled to-
gether and run in cable trays. In either case, adjustment factors must be applied to the
allowable ampacity of the conductors to prevent the insulation from being damaged by
overheating. Table 310.15(B)(3)(a) covers the adjustment factors required for conductors
in raceways or multi-conductor cables. Bundles of single conductor cables would also be
required to use these adjustment factors.
Inverter Output Circuit
The inverter output circuit is sized according to 690.8(A)(3), which states that the conduc-
tor shall be sized according to the maximum continuous current output of the inverter.
The overcurrent device protecting the wire must be sized at least 1.25 times the continu-
ous current. The chosen overcurrent device should be the sized according to the conduc-
tor ampacity after conditions of use or the next standard size above that ampacity. If
the overcurrent device is sized larger than the next available size, when the max OCPD
rating for the inverter allows a larger size, then the conductor size must be increased to
match the OCPD rating.
Battery Circuit
To properly calculate the required ampacity of the inverter input circuit in a battery-
based inverter system, the maximum input current needs of the inverter must be calcu-
lated and then the RMS ac current of the inverter operation must be numerically added.
EXAMPLE: A 6000 Watt (Volt-Amp) inverter is connected to a large battery bank at 48
Volts. Inverter is operating at full capacity and lowest dc operating voltage of 44 Volts.
What is the total current flowing through the inverter input circuit conductors for a 90%
efficient inverter with 45 amps of ac ripple current on the battery?
Step 1: Calculate dc current: Idc
= inverter power ÷ inverter efficiency ÷ dc voltage at
minimum operating voltage = 6000 VA ÷ 0.9 ÷ 44 V = 152 A [690.8(A)(4)]
Step 2: Total current = Idc
+ Iac ripple
= 152 A + 45 A = 197 A
74 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Size Equipment Grounding Conductor for Each Circuit
The equipment grounding conductor (EGC) for the dc side of the PV system is sized
according to NEC 690.45. Since most PV systems related to residential and commercial
buildings must have ground-fault protection systems [NEC 690.5]. NEC 690.45(A) re-
quires the minimum size EGC to be based on Table 250.122. For systems without ground-
fault protection, the EGC is sized according to 690.45(B) and must be a minimum of twice
the rated short circuit current of the largest circuit it is protecting.
2.7.3	 Calculate Voltage Drop
Voltage Drop for Circuits
It is wasteful to dissipate energy to heat wires when the cost of larger wires is usually
minimal compared with the cost of PV modules. Voltage drop is often the determining
factor in wire sizing particularly for systems operating below 100 Volts. Voltage drop is
not a safety issue, therefore it is not covered in great detail in the NEC. However PV sys-
tems with excessive voltage drop are inefficient and can perform poorly.
Once the NEC requirements for ampacity have been met, the voltage drop must be veri-
fied that it is within acceptable limits for efficiency and quality performance. For any
given wire size, voltage drop increases with increasing currents and/or increasing wire
lengths. Therefore circuits with high current and/or long lengths deserve close scrutiny
with respect to voltage drop. This is particularly true of systems operating at 12 V, 24 V,
or 48 V, but even higher voltage systems can have significant voltage drop issues as a
result of long circuits.
 
There is no specified code compliance limit for voltage drop in any given circuit. Gener-
ally accepted practices within the industry limit overall system voltage drop within a
range of 2% to 5% of the circuit operating voltage. The PV system designer must use their
best judgment considering performance and economics.
Five percent is generally considered a maximum overall acceptable voltage drop from
source to load. In order to achieve this 5% limit you will have to limit intermediate runs
within a circuit to a lesser percentage voltage drop. For instance, intermediate circuit runs
such as “PV array to PV combiner box” and “PV Combiner box to PV charge controller”
must be limited to less than 2 % each in order to stay within 5% overall.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 75
Determining Voltage Drop
If the one-way distance between two points is expressed as length (d) in feet, recognize
that the total wire length of a circuit between these two points will be 2 x d. Ohm’s Law
(Vd
= I x R) provides the basic equation to find voltage drop in conductors, where Vd
is
the amount of voltage drop in the conductor at the highest expected current level. The Ω/
kft term is the resistance of the conductor in ohms/1000 feet and is presented in the NEC
Chapter 9, Table 8.
					
 
Where I is the circuit current in Amperes, which for source circuits is usually taken as the
maximum power current, Imp
, Vnom
is the nominal system voltage, which, in this case, is
24V, and Ω/kft is found from NEC Chapter 9, Table 8, “Conductor Properties.”
The resistance for 14 AWG stranded copper uncoated wire is 3.14, Ω/kft. Assuming the
distance from junction box to source circuit combiner box to be 40 ft, the %Vdrop
is found,
after substituting all the numbers into the formula, to be
Clearly a value of 7.3% is high and is well above the recommended target of 1-3%. Even
though 14 AWG THWN wire may meet the ampacity requirements of the NEC, it falls
quite short of meeting the voltage drop requirements for system performance. If the tar-
get % Vdrop
is less than 2% from junction box to combiner box, what would be the correct
conductor size? To find the correct conductor size, substitute in the Ω/kft values for other
wire sizes until a size is found that will meet the voltage drop requirements. Substituting
the value for Ω/kft for 12 AWG stranded copper gives % Vdrop
= 4.62%, which is still too
high. For 10 AWG stranded copper, the result is % Vdrop
= 2.89%, and for 8 AWG stranded
copper, the result is % Vdrop
= 1.82%, which meets the performance requirement.
The distance from source-circuit combiner box to charge controller also must be calcu-
lated. Assuming a distance of 10 feet, the %Vdrop can be calculated using the equation
below to be:
%100
/1000
2
%100%
/1000
2
1000
2
×





 Ω
×
××
=×=





 Ω
×
××
=





 Ω
××=
×=
nomnom
d
drop
d
d
V
kftkftft
Id
V
V
V
kftkftft
dI
V
kftft
kft
dR
RIV
%3.7%100
24
14.3
/1000
7402
% =×





 Ω
×
××
=
V
kftkftft
Aft
Vdrop
%45.1%100
24
24.1
/1000
14102
% =×





 Ω
×
××
=
V
kftkftft
Aft
Vdrop
%3.7%100
24
14.3
/1000
7402
% =×





 Ω
×
××
=
V
kftkftft
Aft
Vdrop
%45.1%100
24
24.1
/1000
14102
% =×





 Ω
×
××
=
V
kftkftft
Aft
Vdrop
76 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
This voltage drop is high for such a short wire run, and as 8 AWG is being used for the
wire runs from the junction box to the source-circuit combiner box, it is recommend that
6 AWG be used between the combiner box and the charge controller. The voltage drop
over this circuit will then be reduced to 0.9%. This exercise shows how large the conduc-
tors must be in 24 V systems to carry small amounts of current.
To achieve overall system voltage drops that are within 3% to 5%, individual circuits
must have much lower voltage drops. To illustrate the need to keep these voltage drops
at reasonable levels, the following table (Table 2) shows one way of tracking voltage
drop to maintain it within appropriate levels. Not all systems will have all these differ-
ent circuits, but it becomes easy to see how voltage drops can add up if care is not taken
throughout the wire sizing process. The following table shows how a typical wire sizing
exercise would proceed.
Table 3. Conductor voltage drop example using diagram from Figure 9.
Circuit Name Total
Distance(kft)
Current
(amps
Wire Size Ω/kft Vdrop %Vdrop
Dc circuits (@ 24 V)
Module wiring 0.012 7 12AWG 1.98 0.166 V 0.69 %
Array to J-box 0.02 7 10AWG 1.24 0.174 V 0.72%
J-box to Combiner 0.08 7 8AWG 0.778 0.436 V 1.82%
Combiner to CC 0.01 21 6AWG 0.491 0.103 V 0.43%
CC to Disco 0.006 21 6AWG 0.491 0.062 V 0.26%
Disconnect to
inverter
0.006 21 6AWG 0.491 0.062 V 0.26%
Dc Vdrop total 1.003 V 4.18%
Ac Circuits (120 V)
Inverter to
disconnect
0.01 6 amps 10AWG 1.2 0.072 V 0.06%
Disconnect to
Service Panel
0.05 6 amps 10AWG 1.2 0.36 V 0.3%
Ac Vdrop total 0.36%
Overall Vdrop total 4.54%
Table 2. Conductor voltage drop example.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 77
The example in this table is very typical of a well-designed, 24 V PV system. It also il-
lustrates where increasing wire size will initially have the most impact—in the J-box to
combiner circuit. By increasing this circuit size from 8 AWG to 6 AWG, the voltage drop
will reduce by about 0.7% overall. However, the larger size wire will require the next size
larger conduit to accommodate these circuits. An overall voltage drop of less than 5% for
a 24 V system is a good target and getting voltage drop below 3% is extremely difficult
for these very low voltage systems. A 48 V system will drop the dc voltage drop impact to
25% of that seen with 24 V systems for the same wire sizes shown in the table, yielding an
overall system voltage drop near 1%. This is one of the main reasons why 48 V battery-
based systems are generally recommended over 24 V systems. Other unavoidable voltage
drops not calculated in this table include voltage drops in fuses, circuit breakers, and
switches which can add up to 0.5% for a 24 V system. Additionally, charge controllers can
cause another 1% to 4% voltage drop depending on the product.
If the wiring from the modules to the junction box is exposed, the NEC requires the wire
must be listed as or marked “sunlight-resistant.” A suitable insulation type for this ap-
plication is USE-2. Even if exposed wiring is used, the ampacities of NEC Table 310.15(B)
(16) must still be used if the conductors terminate at equipment (PV modules). As a final
note on voltage drop, it is common practice to use smaller wiring between modules and
junction boxes, and then increase the wire size between the junction box and the string
combiner box. As the wire size is increased to meet voltage drop requirements, then it
is important to be sure that lugs or terminals in each of the boxes can accommodate the
larger wire size. It is required that the box itself be large enough for the wire. If wire sizes
in junction boxes are 6 AWG and smaller, the minimum box size is found from either
NEC Table 314.16(A) or Table 314.16(B). If conductors larger than 6 AWG are in the box,
then the installation must comply with NEC 300.4(F), and the box size should be deter-
mined in accordance with NEC 314.28(A). Listed PV combiner boxes will have terminals
and wire bending space consistent with the current ratings of the device. Some will ac-
commodate the larger wires necessary to address voltage-drop requirements.
2.7.4	 Select Size and Type of Conductor Based on Location,
Required Ampacity, and Voltage Drop
The previous sections have described how to determined the required size of a conductor
based on the ampacity and voltage drop requirements. The NEC states that all conduc-
tors in conduit installed in exposed locations (outdoors, on rooftops), or underground
must be rated for wet locations (NEC 300.9 and 300.5(B) respectively). A common miscon-
ception is that conductors in watertight conduit do not have to be wet rated. All outdoor
and underground conduit systems have moisture in them that will condense under the
right conditions.
 
When selecting conductors for outdoor conduit systems, the conductor should have a
“W” in the wire designation for wet rating. Since rooftops are high temperature environ-
ments, it is often necessary to select 90°C rated conductors. The most commonly selected
conductors for rooftop conduit in PV systems are THWN-2, XHHW-2, and RHW-2. The
THHN designation, while rated for 90°C, is not rated for wet locations. The THWN and
XHHW designations, while rated for wet locations are not rated for 90°C in wet locations.
78 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
USE-2 often run from the PV modules to the inverter in conduit. This is acceptable as
long as the conduit run is exterior to the building, or if run interior, the conductor car-
ries an indoor conductor designation such as XHHW-2 or RHW-2. Most conductors carry
multiple designations, which causes some confusion for installers. All that matters when
reviewing conductor designations is that the one designation needed for the location is
listed on the conductor insulation. Just because one designation, like USE-2, is prohibited
indoors does not exclude the conductor from being installed indoors as long as the con-
ductor has one of the allowed indoor designations.
2.7.5	 Select Conduit for Conductors
Select Conduit Type Based on Application
When using conduit as the wiring method, the type of conduit selected is based on a va-
riety of factors including physical protection, sunlight resistance, temperature extremes,
and corrosion resistance. In tropical climates where the temperature differences are small
and corrosion is severe, PVC conduit systems are common. PVC is also commonly used
underground because of its corrosion resistance and the fact that ground temperature
does not fluctuate as much as air temperature. However, in climates with large tempera-
ture swings and less corrosion concerns like desert areas, steel conduit systems are much
more common such as EMT and IMC. Occasionally, the physical protection needs of the
installation are high in places like parking garages and hospitals. These locations often re-
quire rigid steel RMC conduit. Locations with large expansion and contraction concerns
due to long conduit runs may favor IMC over EMT since the pipe is threaded and less
susceptible to compression fittings vibrating loose over time.
 
Ultimately, whatever wiring method is selected will require some maintenance over
time. The type and amount of maintenance will depend on the local conditions and the
response of the selected conduit to those conditions. Life-cycle costs for conduit and wir-
ing systems must be considered when selecting the most appropriate conduit for a PV
project.
Select Conduit Size Based on Type and Conductor Fill
The NEC states that the maximum fill for a conduit based on the ratio of the sum of the
cross-sectional area of the wires to the inner cross-sectional area of the conduit can be
no more than 40% (NEC Chapter 9, Table 1). There is no differentiation made based on
conduit type or conductor type. However, conductors with thicker rubberized insula-
tion generally need more room than slicker thermoplastic insulations. Regardless of the
conductor type, it is best for a goal of 25% conduit fill for easier pulling of conductors
through conduit.
Select Expansion Joints Based on Type, Temperature, and Fixed Distance
Expansion fittings are required on straight runs between fixed points depending on the
straight distance, the temperature fluctuations, and the type of conduit. PVC has the larg-
est expansion rate of commonly used wiring methods having 5 times the expansion of
steel conduit. Given the temperature changes in much of the United States, PVC rooftop
conduit systems will require expansion fittings for all constrained straight runs over 20
feet (not a misprint) and require one 4 in expansion fitting every 75 ft in the run [Table
352.44]. Steel conduit, such as IMC, requires expansion fittings for all constrained runs
over 100 ft and requires one 4 in fitting every 375 ft in the straight run.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 79
 
2.8	 Review Overcurrent Protection Selection
Once the wire size from the junction box to the source-circuit combiner box has been
determined, the source-circuit fuse sizes need to be determined. These fuses or circuit
breakers (both known as overcurrent protective devices (OCPD)) are installed to pro-
tect the PV modules and wiring from excessive reverse current flow that can damage
cell interconnects and wiring between the individual PV modules. The maximum size
fuse is specified by the PV module manufacturer and approved as part of the module
listing. The fuse size marked on the back of the module must be at least 156% (1.25
x Imax) of the STC-rated module short-circuit current to meet NEC requirements for
overcurrent protection. It can be larger if the module manufacturer has tested and list-
ed the module with a larger value. The fuse will generally be a dc-rated cartridge-type
fuse that is installed in a finger-safe pullout-type fuse holder. The finger-safe holder is
necessary, as each end of the fuse holder will typically be energized at a voltage close
to the maximum system voltage. These fuses are available in 1-amp increments from
1 A to 15 A, with other larger sizes as provided for in NEC 240.6(A). However, even
though the code may state the standard fuse sizes, fuse manufactures may not make all
standard sizes.
 
2.9	 Review Fasteners Selection
If the chosen design calls for installation on a sloped roof, most mounting systems are
fastened solidly to the roof trusses or rafters rather than the roof decking. Depending
upon the type of roof, the mounts need to be attached in a manner that will ensure that
the roof will not leak at the penetrations. The residential building code now requires
that all roof penetrations be flashed to prevent roof leakage. Products exist for flashing
any roof type so compliance with this requirement is possible regardless of the roof
type. Methods that do not attach directly to structural members require engineering
and preferably product certification by the appropriate organization. For mounting
systems, the ICC Evaluation Service is a typical choice for these types of certifications.
Commercial rooftop PV systems often use ballasted mounting systems to secure the
PV array on the roof. These ballasted systems require detailed engineering reports and
evaluations to ensure that the wind loading and dead loading issues of the system have
been properly addressed. Several companies that manufacture these systems provide
professional engineering services to certify the drawings for submittal to the local ju-
risdiction. Some locations cannot use ballasted systems because of excess design wind
speeds. Some designs allow for a combination of ballast and roof attachments to allow
installation in high wind zones and high seismic zones.
Materials used for mounting structures and fasteners must be suitable for the environ-
ment and compatible with other materials they contact. In dry areas such as South-
western United States, a plated steel fastener may not degrade much with time. In
high corrosion environments, such as Florida, it is essential that fasteners be corrosion-
resistant stainless steel. Manufacturers of commercial array mounts and racks generally
supply the mounts with stainless steel hardware to be sure it will be adequate for most
installation locations and site conditions.
80 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Materials for array mounts can also vary widely depending upon environmental require-
ments. In some areas, painted wooden mounts may be acceptable, while other locations
require mounts made of galvanized steel or aluminum. A common structural material
used for commercial array mounts is corrosion resistant aluminum of various alloys such
as 6061 or 6063 aluminum. Aluminum develops a thin oxide coating very quickly, and
this coating prevents further oxidation. Anodizing is common with aluminum extru-
sions and can improve the corrosion resistance and aesthetics. Stainless steel is generally
too expensive for structural materials, even though it is highly corrosion resistant. The
combination of aluminum structural members and stainless steel fasteners is a practical
solution to minimizing the cost while maximizing long-term structural reliability.
2.92	 Lag Screw Fasteners
The withdrawal load is the force required to remove a screw by pulling in line with the
screw. The pull strength increases as the diameter of the screw increases and is directly
proportional to the length of the screw thread imbedded in the wood. When a lag screw
must pass through a metal L-bracket, then roof shingles and roof membrane, nearly one
inch of the length of the screw does not enter rafter or truss. Also note that many lag
screws in lengths over one inch are not threaded the entire length of the screw. Pilot
or lead holes must be drilled for lag screws, typically in the range of 67%-80% of the
lag screw shank diameter. Larger pilot holes are required for hard woods than for soft
woods. Note that actual pull strengths will vary depending upon the wood that is used,
and this is why using safety factors of four or more is not unusual. A safety factor of four
simply means that if withdrawal strength of X pounds is needed, then the design requires
withdrawal strength of 4X pounds. The allowable withdrawal loads for various lag screw
sizes driven into the side grain of four common types of kiln-dried wood can be easily
calculated. See Fig. 82.
The minimal wind loading of a PV array occurs when the array is mounted parallel to the
roof surface at height of 6 inches or less and at least three feet away from the edges of the
roof. In regions with high design wind speeds, it is best to keep the modules away from
the edges of the roof.
Some roof structures above cathedral ceilings have structural insulated panels (SIPS) and
may require the mounting screws to penetrate a sandwich of foam insulation between
two layers of decking before the screw will enter a support beam. Other cathedral roof
structures are built over scissors trusses with the insulation above the ceiling rather than
under the roof decking. If there is any uncertainty over the roof composition, roof loads,
uplift loads, or roof materials, the installer should consult with a structural engineer,
professional roofer, or building contractor.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 81
2.10	 Review Plan Sets
A complete plan set is a necessary component of an effective permit application.
More complex projects require more detailed plan sets. Specific details need to be
outlined to the extent that portions of the installation are not standard industry
practice or require specific direction. The Expedited Permit Process, published by
the Solar America Board for Codes and Standards has provided simple interactive
pdf drawings (www.solarabcs.org/permitting) that allow installers to fill in blanks
in the form and print good quality plans for residential-sized PV systems. These
SolarABCs plans include several standard templates for string inverter systems,
micro-inverter systems, and ac module systems. More complex systems may require
structural drawings and more detailed electrical drawings.
Figure 82. Allowable with-
drawal loads for lag screws in
lumber depend on the density
and species of the wood, the
diameter of the screw, and
the thread penetration depth. 
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 84
Lumber Type > Douglas Fir Southern Yellow
Pine
White Spruce
Screw Nominal
Shank Diameter (in) Specific Gravity
0.51 0.58 0.45
1/4 232 281 192
5/16 274 332 227
3/8 314 381 260
Allowable Withdrawal Loads for Lag Screws (lb/in)
Includes a factor of safety of 4 X
82 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
3	 Managing the Project
Project management is a key aspect of any construction project. Once a contract has been
signed with the customer, the project schedule can commence for the construction of the
PV system. Longer lead time system components such as modules, inverters, and com-
biner boxes can be ordered while drawings are being finalized and the permit package is
being assembled for submittal. The construction foreman must be informed of the project
plans and be given the opportunity to provide their input to the process to implement
any necessary improvements to the construction process. A healthy feedback mechanism
should be in place to make continual process improvements and learn from the mistakes
of past projects. Failure to make process improvements when managing projects will lead
to a loss of morale with the construction crew and ultimately result in high labor turn-
over rates.
In summary, planning a PV installation utilizes information gathered during a site sur-
vey, and includes the following considerations:
	 • 	Reviewing, completing and adapting the system design
	 • 	Submitting applications for permits, utility interconnection and incentives
	 • 	Defining the project schedule, manpower and equipment needs
	 • 	Identifying and resolving construction activity conflicts such as power
		 outages or alterations to the site
	 • 	Coordinating other logistics with the customer such as site access,
		 worker facilities, waste collection and storage areas
3.1	 Secure Permits and Approvals
A complete permit package is critical to an expeditious permitting and approval process.
When working with jurisdictions for the first time, it is always valuable to schedule a
meeting with the building department and develop an understanding of the expectations
of the jurisdiction on the contents of a permit package. Jurisdictions that are new to PV
systems will require more time and effort in processing the paperwork for construction
approval. While it is rarely a problem to provide too much information, the information
must be relevant and well organized so the plan reviewer can perform their review as
efficiently as possible.
The benefit of having a positive and helpful attitude when working with jurisdictional
personnel is hard to understate. Most jurisdictional employees are overworked, under-
paid, and underappreciated. Showing an appreciation for their role in the construction
process can make big difference in how a permit package is received. Too often contrac-
tors get a bad attitude about having to work through the bureaucracy of local govern-
ment. That attitude often comes across loud and clear to the jurisdictional employees
causing them to lose any possible motivation they might have had to process the paper-
work in a timely manner. For a plan checker with little or no PV experience, offering to be
available for questions and clarifications can help move the process more quickly.
A high quality permit package is one of the most effective methods of establishing a good
rapport with the local jurisdiction. The contents of a high quality permit package include:
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 83
• 	A title page with the project address, brief project description, list of project specifica-
tions, and a table of contents.
• 	Completed forms that the local jurisdiction requires to process a permit.
• 	A site plan that shows the location of major components on the property including
array layout, location of access pathways for rooftop system for fire department
review, setbacks to property lines for ground mounted systems, and location of the
utility disconnect if required.
• 	Detailed electrical diagram showing and specifying all major components used in the
electrical portion of the PV system. This diagram must show the configuration of the
PV array, the location and ratings of overcurrent protection and disconnecting means,
callout conduit and wire size, type, and ratings. The electrical diagrams should also
include specifications and content for the required signs and labels.
• 	Mounting structure information including manufacturer, model, installation docu-
mentation and details.
• 	Specification sheets for all major electrical equipment including PV modules,
inverters, combiner boxes, and any other unique components that are not common
in conventional electrical installations.
 
Some jurisdictions may handle the entire approval process by submitting a single pack-
age of materials with multiple copies for distribution to several internal departments.
Other jurisdictions may require separate submittals to be filed with the building depart-
ment, planning and zoning department, fire department, and any other relevant depart-
ment. Knowing and understanding how to navigate the approval process takes time and
focus so that projects can work their way through the process as quickly as possible.
3.2	 Preconstruction
The proper preparation for construction is as important as the actual construction process
itself. Making sure all required material is on hand or procured to be available by the
time it is needed on the site requires significant planning and project experience. All PV
projects require a safety plan, and safety equipment must be on hand prior to construc-
tion. The safety equipment must be inspected to insure that it is in good repair and has
no missing pieces. Any necessary equipment rentals need to be planned, budgeted, and
deliveries scheduled. Often large amounts of materials may need to be staged and moved
into position in preparation for construction, requiring special equipment. A number of
software tools are available to assist construction managers in planning and allocating
project resources.
3.3	 Project Labor
Determining the amount and proper allocation of project labor is critical to a smooth
and efficient construction project. In the pressure and busyness of project preparations,
a commonly overlooked aspect of the construction process is good communication with
the construction crew as to their roles and reasonable expectations. A key component of
that process is training the crew for the specific job needs of the project. Even experienced
project labor needs continuing education on aspects of the project that may slightly dif-
ferent than previous projects. Since materials, mounting systems, modules, and inverters
are constantly changing in the dynamic PV world, some level of personnel training will
be involved in each project, including site-specific safety hazards, at a minimum.
 
84 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Assuming that a crew has all the knowledge and materials to carry out the project is an
all too common mistake in a construction project. This requires checking with project
labor to make sure they are comfortable with their responsibilities and making sure that
they are comfortable expressing recommendations for process improvement. Managing
the morale of project labor requires a good understanding of the personalities in the crew
and good motivational skills so that laborers are recognized and appreciated for a job
well done.
3.4	 Adapting System Design
In the early stages of a construction project it is often necessary to make adjustments to
the project plan to address discrepancies between the site and system design, and un-
foreseen project obstacles. This may require adaptations to the system design. It is rare
for a project to go completely as planned. Even with the best preplanning, issues beyond
the control of the project manager invariably arise that require flexibility, such as making
material substitutions due to product availability.
 
3.5	 Implement a Site Safety Plan
A safe PV system is installed according to applicable building codes and standards. PV
installer safety includes considerations for a safe work area, safe use of tools and equip-
ment, safe practices for personnel protection, and awareness of safety hazards and how
to avoid them. The installation of PV systems involves a number of safety hazards, prin-
cipally electrical and fall hazards.
Working safely with PV systems requires a fundamental understanding of electrical sys-
tems and the safety hazards involved, in addition to normal work site and construction
hazards. The common sense aspects for jobsite safety can be summarized as follows:
	 • 	 If the workplace is cluttered, the possibility of tripping over something is
		 significantly increased.
	 • 	 If the workplace is a sloped roof with clutter, the possibility of falling off the
		 roof is significantly increased.
	 • 	 If tools are left lying out on a roof, the chance of the tools falling off the roof
		 and injuring someone below is increased.
	 • 	 If the workplace is a rooftop in bright sunshine, the chance of sunburn and
		 heat exhaustion is increased, so workers should take appropriate precautions
		 like using sunscreen, keeping well-hydrated and wearing light-colored clothing.
There are the usual subtle hazards, as well. These include nicks, cuts, and burns from
sharp or hot components. Gloves should be used when handling anything that might be
sharp, hot, rough, or that might splinter. Special insulating gloves are required for work-
ing with live voltages. There is always the possibility of dropping tools or materials on
either oneself, someone else, or on sensitive equipment or materials. Dropping conduc-
tive tools across battery terminals is an especially dangerous hazard. When a PV system
is being assembled, it presents the possibility of shock to personnel. Proper procedure
during installation can reduce, and often eliminate hazards including electrical shock.
Improperly installed systems may result in shock or fire hazards developing over time
due to wiring or arcing faults.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 85
 
3.5.1	 OSHA Regulations
All individuals working on or contracting installation services for PV systems should be
familiar with standards established by the Occupational Safety and Health Administra-
tion (OSHA), contained in Volume 29 of the U.S. Code of Federal Regulations (29 CFR).
OSHA regulations are applicable in all U.S. states and territories and enforced by federal
or local authorities. States with OSHA-approved programs must set standards at least as
effective as federal standards. These standards apply to private employers and general
industry, for construction, maritime, agricultural and other occupations. The broad scope
of OSHA regulations includes health standards, electrical safety, fall protection systems,
stairways and ladders, hand and power tools, cranes and lifts, excavations, scaffolding,
and other potential hazards likely to be encountered in constructing PV systems.
OSHA regulations require that employers provide a safe and healthful workplace free
of hazards, and follow the applicable OSHA standards. Employers must provide safety
training addressing all probable hazards on a construction site, and employers of 11 or
more employees must maintain records of occupational injuries and illnesses. All em-
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules
Figure 82. The OSHA 10-Hour Construction Industry Training Program is strongly
fo
OSHA
ployers must display the OSHA poster, and report
to OSHA within 8 hours any accident that results in
a fatality or hospitalization of three or more em-
ployees. Workers are responsible for following the
employer’s safety and health rules and wear or use
all required safety gear and equipment, reporting
hazardous conditions to OSHA if employers do not
fix them, and cooperating with OSHA inspectors.
Large construction projects often require workers to
complete 10 hour training on OSHA regulations and
have a valid course completion card for insurance
purposes.
 
Safety and Health Regulations for Construction
(29 CFR Part 1926) applies to general construction,
including several subparts applicable to the installa-
tion of PV systems:
OSHA 10
The OSHA 10-Hour Construction Industry Training
Program is intended to provide entry-level con-
struction workers with a general awareness on rec-
ognizing and preventing hazards on a construction
site. Many projects require all construction workers
on a jobsite to have a current OSHA 10 training.
Workers must also receive additional training on
hazards specific to their job. See Fig. 83.
Figure 83. The OSHA 10-Hour Construction Industry Training Program is strongly
recommended and may be required for PV installers.
Subpart C - 	 General Safety and Health Provisions
Subpart D - 	 Occupational Health and Environmental
		 Controls
Subpart E - 	 Personal Protective and Life Saving
		 Equipment
Subpart I - 	 Tools, Hand and Power
Subpart K - 	 Electrical
Subpart M - 	 Fall Protection
Subpart X - 	 Stairways and Ladders
86 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
3.5.2	 Fall Protection
Falls are the leading cause of
deaths in the construction industry.
Because most PV systems involve
climbing ladders, or working on
rooftops, it is essential that PV
installers are familiar with OSHA
fall protection regulations. Most
fatalities occur when employees
fall from open-sided floors and
through floor openings. Conse-
quently, OSHA requires that fall
protection be used for walkways
and ramps, holes and excavations,
roofs, wall openings or skylights
where an employee or worker can
fall 6 feet or more. Employers must
provide training to employees on
how to recognize and minimize fall
hazards, and the use of fall protec-
tion systems and devices. See Figs.
84, 85 & 86.
Fall protection options include Per-
sonal Fall Arrest Systems (PFAS),
guardrails and safety nets, and
must be in place before work com-
mences. See Figs. 87 & 88. Train-
Figure 85. Skylights must be protected from fall hazards by barriers or covers.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 86
Figure 83. Fall protection is a primary safety concern for PV installers.
Alameda County JATC/Mel
Switzer
NREL/Rob Williamson
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 87
Figure 84. Skylights must be protected from fall hazards by barriers or covers.
California Dept. of Public Health
A PV installer fell to his death
through this skylight.
National Electric
Figure 86. Warning lines designate safe areas in which work may
take place without the use of PFAS.
Figure 87. A personal fall arrest system (PFAS) consists of an anchorage and connectors, a body harness,
and a lanyard/deceleration device.
op Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 88
Figure 85. Warning lines designate safe areas in which work may take place without the use of
PFAS.
Warning Line
National Electric
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 89
Figure 86. A personal fall arrest system (PFAS) consists of an anchorage and connectors, a body
harness, and a lanyard/deceleration device.
Lanyard, Lifeline and Roof Anchors
Body Harnesses
Jim Dunlop
Jim Dunlop
Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 86
Figure 83. Fall protection is a primary safety concern for PV installers.
Alameda County JATC/Mel
Switzer
NREL/Rob Williamson
Figure 84. Fall protection is a primary safety concern for PV installers.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 87
ing is required on how to properly use and maintain PFAS, including the anchorages,
lifelines and body harnesses. Guardrails used to protect open-sided floors and platforms
must have top rails between 39 and 45 in tall, a mid-rail, and toe boards at least 3-1/2 in
high. Safety nets must be deployed no further than 30 ft below where work is performed,
preferably closer. In certain applications, the use of designated safety monitors and
warning lines may meet the requirements, but is the least desirable of all fall protection
systems. In any case, it is best practice to perform work at ground level if possible, such
as pre-assembly of PV panels and arrays.
Figure 88. Safety line anchorages
must be independent of any platform
anchorage and capable of supporting
at least 5,000 pounds per worker.
Figure 89. A stairway or ladder is required at points of access to a construction site where there is a break in
elevation of 19 inches or more.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 90
Figure 87. Safety line anchorages must be independent of any platform anchorage and capable of
supporting at least 5,000 pounds per worker.
Removable/Reusable Roof Anchors
Permanent Roof Anchor with Cap
Concrete Dee-ring Anchor
Guardian Fall Protection
Figure 90. Stairrails and handrails must be able to withstand 200 pound force.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 91
Figure 88. A stairway or ladder is required at points of access to a construction site where there is
a break in elevation of 19 inches or more.
OSHA
3.5.3	 Stairways and Ladders
OSHA requires that a stairway or ladder
be used at points of access where there is
an elevation break of 19 in or more on a
jobsite. See Fig. 89. Stairways with four or
more risers, or higher than 30 in, must be
equipped with at least one handrail, capa-
ble of withstanding a force of 200 pounds.
See Fig. 90. Stairways with four or more
risers or more than 30 in high must have
a stair rail along each unprotected side or
edge. Stairs must be installed between 30
and 50 degrees, must have uniform riser
height and tread depth, with less than a
1/4-in variation. Stairways landings must
be at least 30 in deep and 22 in wide at ev-
ery 12 ft or less of vertical rise. Unprotected
sides of landings must have standard 42
inch guardrail systems. Where doors or
gates open directly on a stairway, a plat-
form must be used that extends at least 20
in beyond the swing of the door.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 92
Figure 89. Stairrails and handrails must be able to withstand 200 pound force.
OSHA
88 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Ladders must be kept in a safe working condition. Keep the area around the top and bot-
tom of a ladder clear, and ensure rungs, cleats, and steps are level and uniformly spaced
10 in to 14 in apart. Use ladders only for their designed purpose. Never tie ladders
together to make longer sections, or load ladders beyond the maximum load for which
they are rated. A competent person must inspect ladders for visible defects, like broken or
missing rungs, and if a defective ladder is found, immediately mark it defective or tag it
“Do Not Use”, and withdraw defective ladders from service until repaired.
Ladders should be used on stable and level surfaces, and secured to prevent accidental
movement due to workplace activity. Do not use ladders on slippery surfaces unless
secured or provided with slip-resistant feet. Ladders, particularly wooden ones, should
never be painted which can conceal defects. A double-cleated ladder (with center rail),
or two or more ladders are required when ladders are the only way to enter or exit a
working area with 25 or more employees, or when a ladder will serve simultaneous
two-way traffic.
Non-self-supporting ladders (those that lean against a wall or other support) must be
positioned at an angle where the horizontal distance from the top support to the foot of
the ladder is 1/4 the working length of the ladder (the distance along the ladder between
the foot and the top support). See Fig. 91. When using a portable ladder for access to an
upper landing surface, the side rails must extend at least 3 ft above the upper landing
surface. For step ladders, the top and top step should never be used as a step, and never
use crossbracing on the rear of a stepladder for climbing — unless the ladder is designed
for that purpose. Tall fixed ladders 24 ft or longer must be equipped with either: a ladder
safety device; self-retracting lifelines with rest platforms every 150 ft or less; or cage or
well, and multiple ladder sections, each section not exceeding 50 ft.
Figure 91. Ladders must
be used with the proper
angle and secured at the
appropriate height.
If using ladders where the employee or the ladder
could contact exposed energized electrical equip-
ment, such as transformers or overhead services,
ladders must have nonconductive side rails such
as wood or fiberglass. Face the ladder when going
up or down, and use at least one hand to grab the
ladder when going up or down. Do not carry any
object or load that could cause you to lose balance
while climbing ladders.
Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 4
Ladder Angle
Min 3 ft
4 ft
16 ft
OSHA
Tie-off
points
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 89
3.5.4	 Hand and Power Tools
Power tools are extremely hazardous when used or maintained improperly. Workers
using hand and power tools may be exposed to a number of hazards, including objects
that fall, fly, are abrasive, or splash; harmful dusts, fumes, mists, vapors, and gases; and
frayed or damaged electrical cords, hazardous connections and improper grounding.
Eye protection is usually always required.
All hand and power tools and similar equipment, whether furnished by the employer or
the employee, shall be maintained in a safe condition. All power tools must be fitted with
factory guards and safety switches, and hand-held power tools must be equipped with
a constant pressure switch or on-off switch. Hazards are usually caused by misuse and
improper maintenance.
Additional guidelines and precautions for using power tools include the following:
	 • Follow manufacturers’ instructions
	 • Use the proper personal protective equipment (PPE)
	 • Disconnect tools when not in use, for cleaning, and when changing accessories
	 • Secure work with clamps or a vise, freeing both hands to operate the tool
	 • Inspect tools regularly before use and maintain in sharp, clean condition
	 • Do not wear loose clothing and jewelry that can get caught in moving parts
	 • Do not use electric cords to carry, hoist or lower tools
	 • Keep cords and hoses away from heat, oil, and sharp edges
	 • Remove damaged electric tools & tag them: “Do Not Use.”
3.5.5	 Personal Protective Equipment (PPE)
Personal protective equipment (PPE) includes protective clothing, gloves, footwear,
helmets, goggles, respirators, aprons or other garments designed to protect workers from
injury to the body by impacts, electrical hazards, heat and chemicals, and other job-relat-
ed safety hazards. PPE is the last measure of control when worker exposure to the safety
hazards cannot be totally eliminated by feasible work practices or engineering controls.
Responsibilities of the employer include assessing the workplace for hazards, providing
PPE, determining when to use it, and providing training for affected employees.
Employee responsibilities include using PPE in accordance with training received and
other instructions, and inspecting daily and maintaining the PPE in a clean and reliable
condition.
The employer shall ensure that each affected employee wears a protective helmet when
working in areas where there is a potential for injury to the head from falling objects,
or exposure to electrical hazards. See Fig. 92. Type I hard hats provide protection from
blows only to the top of the head. Type II hard hats have a full brim and provide protec-
tion from blows to the top or sides of the head. Class G (General) hardhats are intended
to reduce the danger of contact exposure to low voltage conductors and are proof tested
to 2,200 volts. Class E (Electrical) hardhats are intended to reduce the danger of exposure
to high voltage conductors and are proof tested to 20,000 volts. Class C (Conductive)
90 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
hardhats provide no electrical insulation and not intended to provide protection
against contact with electrical conductors.
Eye protection must be provided to protect against hazards such as dust and other
flying particles, corrosive gases, vapors, and liquids, and welding operations.
See Fig. 93. The selection of eye protection is based on protection from a specific
hazard, its comfort, and must not restrict vision or movement, or interfere with
other PPE. Types of eye and face protection include:
	 • 	Safety glasses: Single or double lens; close and comfortable fit important.
			 Prescription lenses available.
	 • 	Goggles: Offer the most complete protection from impacts, chemicals and
			 vapors by sealing around the eye area. Vented types allow air flow and
			 reduce the chance for fogging, but protect from impacts only. Non-vented
			 and indirect-vent types protect from impacts as well as splash, vapors or
			 particles; use lens coatings for better anti-fog performance. Many types fit
			 over prescription eyeglasses.
	 • 	Face shields: A supplementary, secondary protective device to protect a
			 worker’s face from certain chemical and welding radiation hazards. Must
			 use with safety glasses for impact protection. Special lenses and shade
			 number required for specific welding operations.
Hearing protection must be used whenever an employee’s noise exposure exceeds
an 8-hour time-weighted average (TWA) sound level of 90 dBA. Noise levels above
115 dBA require control measures for any duration. OSHA also recognizes an 85 dBA
TWA as an action level to monitor noise levels. Noise levels likely exceed 85dBA if
one has to raise their voice to converse with another person 3 feet away. Hearing pro-
tection options include earmuffs that fit over the ear and seal against the side of the
head, disposable and reusable earplugs inserted directly into the ear canal, or hearing
bands. See Fig 94. All approved hearing protectors have an assigned Noise Reduction
Rating (NRR) in decibels.
 
Figure 92. Hard hats protect the head from blows and energized
electrical conductors.
Figure 93. Types of eye and face protection include safety glasses, goggles and face shields.
nlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 94
Type II, Class E Hard Hat
Lab Safety Supply
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 95
Figure 92. Types of eye and face protection include safety glasses, goggles and face shields.
Vented and Indirect-Vent Goggles
Impact Splash-Resistant Goggles
Safety Glasses
Face Shield
Lab Safety Supply
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 91
When employees are exposed to harmful atmospheres, dust or vapors, the employer shall
provide respirators which are applicable and suitable for the purpose intended. Although
not generally required, certain construction tasks related to a PV installation may require
respiratory protection, such as working in insulated attics.
Foot protection must be used when any of the following conditions are present: heavy
objects such as barrels or tools that might roll onto or fall on employees’ feet; sharp
objects such as nails or spikes that might pierce ordinary shoes; molten metal that might
splash on feet; or working on hot, wet or slippery surfaces. Safety shoes have impact-re-
sistant toes and heat-resistant soles, and may be electrically conductive for use in explo-
sive atmospheres, or nonconductive to protect from electrical hazards.
All types of protective footwear must include an identification label listing the applicable
standard, manufacturer, and specifications. All protective footwear must provide impact
and compression resistance. Impact resistance (I) is rated for 75, 50 or 30 foot-pounds.
Compression resistance (C) is rated for 75, 50 or 30 which correlates to 2500, 1750 or 1000
pounds of compression resistance.
Protective footwear may also meet the following specifications as labeled:
	 • 	 Metatarsal resistance (Mt) is rated for 75, 50 or 30 foot-pounds.
	 • 	 Conductive (Cd) footwear is used to dissipate static electricity in
		 explosive environments.
	 • 	 Electrical hazard (EH) footwear has non-conductive soles and provides
		 secondary protection from live electrical equipment.
	 • 	 Puncture resistant (PR) footwear provides integral protection from sharp
		 objects penetrating the sole.
	 • 	 Static dissipative (SD) footwear reduces the accumulation of excess static
		 electricity for electronics environments.
	 • 	 Chain saw cut resistant (CS) footwear.
	 • 	 Dielectric insulation (DI) footwear is designed to provide additional
		 insulation for contact with energized electrical conductors.
Figure 94. Hearing protection should be used
whenever using machinery or power tools with
noise levels exceeding 85 dB.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 96
Figure 93. Hearing protection should be used whenever using machinery or power tools with
noise levels exceeding 85 dB.
 Earmuffs
 Fit over the ear and seal against
the side of the head.
 Earplugs
 Inserted directly into the ear canal.
 All approved hearing protectors
have an assigned Noise
Reduction Rating (NRR) in
decibels.
 Reduces decibel exposure.
Reusable Earplugs
Ear Muffs
Hearing Bands
Disposable Foam Plugs
Lab Safety Supply
92 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Employers shall select and require employees to use appropriate hand protection when
employees’ hands are exposed to hazards such as harmful substances; severe cuts or
lacerations; severe abrasions; punctures; chemical burns; thermal burns; and temperature
extremes. See Fig. 95. Employers shall base the selection of the appropriate hand protec-
tion on an evaluation of the performance characteristics of the hand protection relative
to the tasks to be performed, conditions present, duration of use, and the hazards and
potential hazards identified.
Types of gloves vary widely in materials and application, including:
	 • 	 Durable gloves made of mesh, leather or high-performance materials like
		 Kevlar® to protect from cuts, burns and heat.
	 • 	 Chemical-resistant rubber gloves to protect from burns and irritation
	 • 	 Electrical insulating gloves for exposure to live voltages
Correct glove size and fit is important for comfort and dexterity. Glove size is determined
by diameter of the hand at its widest point. Common men’s sizes are: Small: 7½-8”,
Medium: 8½-9”, Large: 9½-10”, and Extra Large: 10 ½-11”.
Figure 95. Gloves are rated for six levels of abrasion, cut and puncture resistance tested to
ANSI/ASTM standards.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 97
Figure 94. Gloves are rated for six levels of abrasion, cut and puncture resistance tested to
ANSI/ASTM standards.
Level 2 Cut-Resistant Kevlar® Gloves Level 5 Cut-Resistant Leather Gloves
Chemical-Resistant Gloves
Class 0, Low Voltage Gloves
Lab Safety Supply
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 93
4	 Installing Electrical Components
4.1	 Mitigate Electrical Hazards
About 5 workers are electrocuted every week in the U.S., causing 12% of all young
worker workplace deaths. It takes very little electrical energy to cause personal injury;
and electrical hazards also pose a significant fire danger — further compounding the risk
to life and property. Electrical accidents are caused by a combination of three factors:
1) unsafe equipment and/or installation, 2) workplaces made unsafe by the environment,
and 3) unsafe work practices.
Preventing electrical hazards on the job involves the following practices:
	 • 	 Wearing nonconductive Class E hardhat
	 • 	 Wearing electrical hazard (EH) rated foot protection
	 • 	 Using properly grounded or double-insulated power tools maintained
		 in good condition
	 • 	 Avoiding overhead power lines and buried electrical conductors
	 • 	 Working on electrical equipment and circuits in a de-energized state
	 • 	 Maintaining an orderly job site and cautious work flow
Lockout and tagging is used to prevent unknowing individuals from energizing electrical
circuits or other hazardous machinery while they are being serviced or maintained. See
Fig 96. Lockout refers to the physical locking of the power source disconnect with a pad-
lock in the “off” or open position. Tagging refers to the labeling of deactivated controls,
de-energized equipment and circuits at all points where they can be energized, and must
identify equipment or circuits being worked on. When working on energized equipment
is unavoidable, use the appropriate PPE, including helmets, face shields, gloves and
flame-resistant clothing.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 98
Figure 95. Employer must provide policies, procedures, documentation, equipment, training,
inspection and maintenance for lock out and tag out programs to authorized employees.
Figure 96. The employer must provide policies, procedures, documentation, equipment, training, inspection
and maintenance for lock out and tag out programs to authorized employees.
To protect workers from electrical
hazards use barriers and guards
to prevent passage through areas
of exposed energized equipment;
pre-plan work, post hazard warn-
ings and use protective measures;
and keep working spaces and
walkways clear of cords. Test GF-
CIs regularly, and check switches
and insulation. Flexible extension
cords for temporary use on con-
struction projects must be 3-wire
type (with ground) and designed
for hard or extra-hard use.
94 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
4.2	 Install Electrical Equipment
The installer should pay careful attention to the location of module junction
boxes so the lengths of electrical wiring can be minimized and organized
into source circuits as needed, once modules are mounted. Modules are
normally installed in groups that produce the desired source-circuit volt-
age. Junction boxes do not have to be readily accessible, but must permit
ready access by temporarily removing modules connected by flexible wiring
methods [NEC 690.34].
The layout of BOS components should be done in a neat and professional
manner that provides for convenient access, testing, and disconnecting
of system components. If the array is on a residential roof, it is generally
preferable to install combiner boxes containing source-circuit fuses or
circuit breakers in a more accessible location. Because most PV modules
carry warranties of 20 years or more, any other components installed on the
roof should be also be capable of operating for 20 years without significant
maintenance. The BOS layout should minimize distances for dc wiring if the
system operates at 48 V or less. However, residential PV arrays operating
at more than 300 V dc may use longer dc runs without significant voltage
drop. Keeping the ac voltage drop as low as reasonably possible will im-
prove system performance by reducing the likelihood of inverters tripping
offline due to high utility voltage.
4.2.1	 Working Space for Electrical Systems
Working spaces must be allowed for installers and maintenance personnel
to safely work on electrical equipment [NEC 110.26]. Proper working spaces
are the first priority when locating balance of system hardware for a PV
system. Generally, clearances in front of equipment that may be serviced in
an energized state must be at least 3 ft, but several qualifiers determine the
appropriate clearance to use. Voltages from 150 V to 600 V require greater
clearances if live parts are on one side and grounded parts on the other or
if live parts are on both sides of the working space. The width of working
spaces must be the width of the equipment or 30 in, whichever is wider.
For equipment operating at dc voltages less than 60 V, smaller working
spaces may be permitted by special permission of the AHJ. Although this is
allowed in the code, permission must be secured prior to mounting equip-
ment should smaller clearances be sought.
Some PV installations may involve working in attic spaces, which usually
requires wearing a breathing mask, eye protection, and clothing that will
protect skin from irritating insulation. Ensure that the attic floor will
support the weight of a worker, and take care to step only on structural
members to prevent falling through the ceiling. Attics can be extremely
hot and workers should limit their exposures and maintain hydration.
Additional lighting is also usually required when working in attics or other
confined spaces.
Electrical Injuries
There are four main types of
electrical injuries. Direct types of
injuries include electrocution (death
due to electrical shock), electrical
shock, and burns. Indirect electri-
cal injuries include falls due to
electrical shock. Other common
electrical injuries include burns and
concussions resulting from arcing
explosions, as well as eye damage
due to arc flash. Working on or near
exposed energized conductors or
electrical equipment requires spe-
cial personal protective equipment
(PPE). Means to assess the electri-
cal hazards that exist, and the PPE
and other precautions required are
addressed in NFPA 70E, Electrical
Safety in the Workplace.
The severity of the shock depends
on the path of current flow through
the body, the amount of current,
and the duration of the exposure.
Low voltage does not mean low
hazard. Currents above 10 mA can
paralyze or “freeze” muscles. Cur-
rents of more than 75 mA ac can
cause a rapid, ineffective heartbeat,
and can result in death in minutes
unless a defibrillator is used. 75
mA is not much current — a small
power drill uses 30 times as much.
Electrical burns are the most com-
mon shock-related injury, which can
occur by touching electrical wiring
or equipment that is improperly
used or maintained, and typically
occurs on the hands. Electrical
burns are often very serious injuries
and require immediate attention.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 95
4.3	 Install Wiring Methods
Wiring methods include all conductors, cables, conduits, raceways, fittings, connectors,
terminals, junction boxes and other equipment used for electrical connections between
system components. The installation requirements for wiring methods are covered in
Chapter 3 of the NEC: Wiring Methods and Materials. Manufacturers provide additional
product-specific instructions, and installation of many wiring methods requires special-
ized training and experience.
Much of the installation work in all electrical systems is mechanical in nature. Conduit
systems are the most common wiring methods for circuits leaving the vicinity of PV
arrays. Conduit is used to support and protect string conductors and to install the PV
output circuits from combiner boxes to inverters. Each type of conduit or raceway system
has specific application and installation requirements [NEC Chap 3].
Conduit runs must be supported properly at the intervals required by the specific con-
duit type. While the NEC does not require conduit to be held at any specific distance
above the roof surface, the building code does not permit items on a rooftop that could
cause damming of leaves and other debris. Although the building code does not specifi-
cally address electrical conduit systems, it is wise to keep a minimum of 0.75 in of air-
space beneath conduit runs, to help prevent smaller debris from being trapped under the
conduit. The 0.75 in airspace also has the advantage of reducing the conduit temperature
[NEC Table 310.15(B)(3)(c)].
Since in conventional ac systems it is uncommon to have long rooftop feeders, like those
in large PV systems, there exists little field experience from electrical workers on install-
ing these wiring methods on rooftops. Setting up a conduit run with multiple expansion
fittings is not trivial and requires painstaking adherence to manufacturer’s directions that
account for the conduit temperature and where in the expansion process that tempera-
ture falls. Expansion joints must be held in place so that the conduit moves relative to the
joint. In addition to the concerns over the conduit system, the conductors inside the con-
duit also move relative to the conduit system and the end terminations. Several systems
in recent history have not properly accounted for this relative motion which has caused
significant conductor insulation damage resulting in fires in some cases. Since this type
of damage is likely in large conduit systems, operation and maintenance programs must
periodically check for this damage.
4.4	 Install Grounding Systems
Proper grounding of PV systems reduces the risk of electrical shock to personnel and the
effects of lightning and surges on equipment. There are two basic types of grounding.
System grounding connects a current-carrying conductor in an electrical system to ground,
or earth potential. Equipment grounding connects non-current carrying metal parts to
ground, such as PV module frames, racks, enclosures, junction boxes, conduit and other
metallic components. Bonding is electrically connecting metal parts together so that they
stay at the same voltage. All PV systems require equipment grounding, and most also
require system grounding. The grounding and bonding requirements for PV systems are
covered in NEC Article 690 Part V and Article 250.
96 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
System grounding is the intentional connection of a
current-carrying conductor in an electrical system to
ground (earth). Commonly, this connection is made
at the supply source, such as a transformer or at the
main service disconnecting means. For PV arrays,
one conductor of a 2-wire system, or the center tap
conductor of a bipolar system must be grounded if
the maximum PV system voltage is over 50 V [NEC
690.41]. An exception is allowed for ungrounded ar-
rays meeting all of the requirements in NEC 690.35.
The dc system grounding connection must be made at
a single point on the PV output circuit [NEC 690.42].
Locating this connection point as close as practicable
to the photovoltaic source better protects the system
from voltage surges due to lightning. Typically, for
PV systems requiring ground-fault protection, the
single point of grounding for a dc current-carrying
conductor is usually made internal to a ground-fault
protection device within utility-interactive inverters,
and additional external bonding connections are not
permitted.
Figure 97. Devices listed and identified for bonding the exposed metallic frames of PV modules
to grounded mounting structures are permitted, but are not approved for all modules and
mounting structures.
11 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 99
Figure 96. Devices listed and identified for bonding the exposed metallic frames of PV modules to
grounded mounting structures are permitted, but are not approved for all modules and mounting
structures.
Unirac
“WARNING - ELECTRIC SHOCK HAZARD.
THE DIRECT CURRENT CIRCUIT CONDUCTORS
OF THIS PHOTOVOLTAIC POWER SYSTEM ARE
UNGROUNDED BUT MAY BE ENERGIZED WITH
RESPECT TO GROUND DUE TO LEAKAGE PATHS
AND/OR GROUND FAULTS.”
PV arrays are permitted to have ungrounded source and output circuits only when the
following conditions are met [NEC 690.35]:
	 • 	 Both ungrounded conductors (positive and negative) must have a
		 disconnecting means and overcurrent protection.
	 •	 Array ground fault-protection for all conductors must be provided.
	 •	 All PV source and output circuit conductors must be either installed in
		 raceways, use jacketed multi-conductor cables, or use listed and labeled
		 PV wire where used for single-conductor exposed PV module connections.
Inverters or charge controllers used with ungrounded PV arrays must be listed and
identified for use with ungrounded arrays. The PV power source must be marked at each
disconnect, junction box or other device that may be serviced with the following label:
Equipment grounding is the connection of normally non-current carrying metal parts to
ground. Equipment grounding requires electrical bonding of PV module frames, racks,
enclosures, junction boxes, conduit and other metallic components. This ensures that
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 97
metal components in the system will be at equipotential, thus reducing the risk of electri-
cal shock. The installation of an equipment grounding conductor (EGC) is required for all
metal framed PV module systems and any PV array that has exposed conductors in con-
tact with metal support structures, regardless of system voltage [NEC 250, 690.43]. The
EGC can be a conductor, busbar, metallic raceway, or structural component. EGCs must
be installed in the same raceway as the PV circuit conductors upon leaving the vicinity of
an array. System grounding and equipment grounding conductors are separate and only
connected together (bonded) at the source of supply.
Several methods are permitted to provide equipment grounding for PV modules. Tradi-
tional methods use self-tapping screws and cup washers, or lay-in lugs attached to the
module frames to connect the EGC. Other methods include using bonding washers or
clips between module frames and supports, and the EGC is connected to the support
structure. EGCs smaller than 6 AWG must be protected from physical damage, and cop-
per grounding conductors should never be allowed to directly touch aluminum module
frames or supports. Special washers or lugs are used to make the connection between
copper and aluminum. Refer to PV module and mounting system manufacturer’s
installation instructions for specific grounding requirements. See Fig. 97.
For most utility-interactive systems, the grounded dc conductor, the dc equipment
grounding conductor, and the ac equipment grounding conductor are terminated in the
inverter. The EGC is connected to the dc grounded circuit conductor through the GFID
circuit. The premises grounding system serves as the ac grounding system, and the dc
GEC is combined with the ac EGC.
The proper and safe grounding of PV systems has been the subject of much discussion in
recent years, especially the grounding of PV module frames to support structures.Con-
sequently, PV module manufacturers are now required to provide details for equipment
grounding in their listed installation instructions per the UL 1703 standard.
While indoor grounding means are plentiful in the electrical industry, products designed
for outdoor use are not nearly as available. Couple this issue with the fact that much of
the electrical industry uses steel for wiring methods and support structures, as opposed
to aluminum in the PV industry and now the usable products are much less. Grounding
and bonding of steel is relatively straightforward since bolted connections and welding
accomplishes the bonding requirements. Readily available copper lugs can be mounted
to steel structures for connecting to equipment grounding conductors. Aluminum, on the
other hand, is a different story. Simple bolting of aluminum structures will not necessary
create effective bonding. This is due to the fact that aluminum either has an anodized
coating to reduce corrosion or a thick layer of oxidation as in the case of non-anodized
aluminum. In either case, simple bolting of modules to structures, or lugs to modules or
structures, will not necessarily provide the necessary bonding and grounding. The NEC
generally requires that the installer remove non-conductive coatings prior to making
electrical connections. This means that in order to call two aluminum surfaces electrically
connected, one must remove the non-conductive coating on both surfaces.
Using a grinder on an array of 500,000 modules, or even a few dozen modules is not
very practical. Alternative means exist, but these means must be compatible with the
98 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
products being installed. One common method of electrically connecting two aluminum
structural pieces is to have stainless fasteners with serrations. Stainless star washers can
also be used to break through the non-conductive coatings and establish effective bond-
ing. The typical PV module has an aluminum frame that must be bonded and grounded.
Module manufacturers may provide hardware and fasteners for making electrical con-
nections to the frame metal. Some modules will simply have directions on how to make
such connections. Some modules have multiple methods available for grounding while
others may only specifically mention a single method (more common). According the UL
safety standard for modules (UL1703), the manufacturer is required to provide informa-
tion on all approved grounding methods. Since it can be expensive to specifically test each
grounding method, many module manufacturers limit the number of options to reduce
testing costs.
Generic grounding methods that bond adjacent modules together and bond modules to
their support structures is specifically mentioned in NEC Article 690 as of the 2005 edi-
tion. See Fig. 98. Products exist that can perform these functions and many module manu-
facturers list these options in their installation manuals. While these methods work well
with most PV modules manufactured today, problems arise when module instructions
do not specifically mention these options. Many jurisdictions take a strict interpretation
of the requirement that all products must be installed according to the supplied manufac-
turer’s instructions [NEC 110.3(B)]. For those jurisdictions, only the specifically mentioned
methods will likely be allowed. Many module installation manuals will allow any code-
approved grounding method. The UL1703 module standard and a new standard UL2703
for module racking systems are being revised to allow better accommodation of generic
grounding systems.
A grounding electrode system consists of a rod, pipe, plate, metal water pipe, building
steel or concrete-encased electrode, and includes all grounding electrodes at a building
or structure that must be bonded together. The grounding electrode conductor (GEC)
connects the grounded system conductor or the equipment grounding conductor (EGC)
to a grounding electrode system. The GEC must be a continuous length without splices
except for irreversible connections. A 6 AWG GEC may be secured to and run along build-
ing surfaces where protected from damage. GECs smaller than 6 AWG must be in metal
raceways or use armored cables [NEC 250].
Specific requirements are given for the grounding electrode system used for PV installa-
tions [NEC 690.47]. The requirements are given ac systems, dc systems, and system with
both ac and dc grounding requirements. The existing grounding electrode system should
Figure 98. Special bonding jumpers,
stainless-steel bonding washers and lay-in
lugs may be used to electrically connect
separate components or attach equipment
grounding conductors.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 100
Figure 97. Special bonding jumpers, stainless-steel bonding washers and lay-in lugs may be used
to electrically connect separate components or attach equipment grounding conductors.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 99
be checked as part of any PV installation, particularly for older facilities that may have
degraded grounding systems. Verify that all available grounding electrodes at the facility
are bonded together, and that the grounding electrode conductors are properly installed
and sized.
Battery systems are considered to be grounded when the PV power source is grounded
[NEC 690.71, 690.41]. Battery systems over 48 volts are permitted without grounding a
current-carrying conductor but have several requirements [NEC 690.71(G)]. First, the PV
source and output circuits must have a grounded current-carrying conductor or meet the
requirements for ungrounded arrays and have overcurrent protection for each ungrounded
conductor [NEC 690.35]. The dc and ac load circuits for the system must also be solidly
grounded. Both the positive and negative ungrounded battery circuit conductors must
have a switched disconnect means and overcurrent protection, or dc-rated circuit breaker.
A ground-fault detector-indicator is also required for ungrounded battery systems over
48 V.
Utility Interconnection
Interconnection refers to the technical and procedural matters associated with operating
interactive PV systems and other distributed generation sources in parallel with the electric
utility system. Technical interconnection issues include safety, power quality, and impacts
on the utility system, and are addressed in national codes and standards. Interconnection
procedures are based on state and utility policies, and include the application process and
schedule, customer agreements, and permitting and inspection. Contractual aspects of in-
terconnection policies include fees, metering requirements, billing arrangements, and size
restrictions on the distributed generator.
IEEE 1547 Standard for Interconnection of Distributed Resources with Electrical Power Systems
establishes the technical requirements for interconnecting all types of distributed genera-
tion equipment, including photovoltaics, fuel cells, wind generators, reciprocating engines,
microturbines, and larger combustion turbines with the electrical power system. It also es-
tablishes requirements for testing, performance, maintenance and safety of the interconnec-
tion, as well as response to abnormal events, anti-islanding protection and power quality.
The focus of IEEE 1547 is on distributed resources with capacity less than 10 MVA, and
interconnected to the electrical utility system at primary or secondary distribution voltages.
The standard provides universal requirements to help ensure a safe and technically sound
interconnection. It does not address limitations or impacts on the utility system in terms of
energy supply, nor does it deal with procedural or contractual issues associated with the
interconnection.
UL 1741 Inverters, Converters, Controllers and Interconnection System Equipment for Use with
Distributed Energy Resources addresses requirements for all types of distributed generation
equipment, including inverters, charge controllers and combiner boxes used in PV systems,
as well as equipment used for the interconnection of wind turbines, fuel cells, microtur-
bines and engine-generators. This standard covers requirements for the utility interface,
and is intended to supplement and be used in conjunction with IEEE 1547. The products
covered by the UL 1741 listing are intended to be installed in accordance with the National
Electrical Code, NFPA 70.
100 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
All inverters and ac modules that are specifically
intended to be used in utility-interactive PV systems
must be listed and identified for interactive operations,
and this information must be marked on the product
label. Battery-based inverters intended only for stand-
alone off-grid applications do not have these special
identification markings, and may not be used for grid-
connected applications. However, all inverters used
in PV systems must be listed to the UL 1741 standard,
whether they are used for stand-alone or interactive
systems. See Fig 99.
NEC Article 690 Part VII addresses the connection of
PV systems to other power sources, and applies to all
interactive PV systems connected to the utility grid.
For the 2011 NEC, many of the common interconnec-
tion requirements applicable to all distributed genera-
tors, including PV systems, fuel cells and wind tur-
bines were moved to Article 705.
The point of connection, or point of common coupling, is
the point where a distributed generator interfaces with
the electric utility system. The point of connection may
be located on the load side or the supply side of a facil-
ity service disconnecting means. See Fig. 100.
The output of interactive PV inverters may be connect-
ed to either the supply side or load side of the service
disconnecting means [NEC 690.64, 705.12].
For many smaller systems, the point of connection is
usually made on the load side of the service disconnect
at any distribution equipment on the premises, usually
at a panelboard. See Fig 101.
For load side connections, where the distribution
equipment is supplied by both the utility and one or
more utility-interactive inverters, and where the dis-
tribution equipment is capable of supplying multiple
branch circuits or feeders, or both, load side connec-
tions must comply with the following seven require-
ments [705.12(D)]: See Fig 102.
1. Each source (inverter) must have a dedicated discon-
nect and overcurrent protection device. This can be a
fusible disconnect or circuit breaker and need not be
service rated. PV systems using more than one inverter
Figure 99. Inverters and ac modules used in utility-interactive PV systems
must be listed and identified for interactive operations.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 101
Figure 98. Inverters and AC modules used in utility-interactive PV systems must be listed and
identified for interactive operations.
Figure 100. Interactive inverters may be connected to either the load side or
the supply side of the service disconnecting means. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 102
Figure 99. Interactive inverters may be connected to either the load side or the supply side of the
service disconnecting means.
Distribution
Equipment
To
Utility
To
Branch
Circuits
Service
Disconnect
Supply Side
Load Side
Figure 102. Load side connections require that the sum of the ampere ratings of overcurrent
devices supplying power to a busbar or conductor does not exceed 120% of busbar or
conductor rating.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 104
Figure 101. Load side connections require that the sum of the ampere ratings of overcurrent
devices supplying power to a busbar or conductor does not exceed 120% of busbar or conductor
rating.
Distribution
Equipment
To
Utility
To
Branch
Circuits
Service
Disconnect
Interactive
Inverter
Backfed Circuit
Breaker
200 A
40 A
Figure 101. Many small residential and commercial PV systems can be interconnected by adding
backfed circuit breakers to distribution panels as long as certain conditions are met.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 103
Figure 100. Many small residential and commercial PV systems can be interconnected by adding
backfed circuit breakers to distribution panels as long as certain conditions are met.
Distribution
Equipment
To
Utility
To
Branch
Circuits
Service
Disconnect
Interactive
Inverter
Backfed Circuit
Breaker
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 101
are considered multiple sources, and require a dedicated disconnect and overcurrent de-
vice for each inverter. A single disconnecting means can be additionally provided for the
combination of multiple parallel inverters connected to subpanels. This requirement does
not apply ac modules or micro inverters where the output of multiple inverters is permit-
ted for one disconnect and overcurrent device.
2. Load side connections require that the sum of the ampere ratings of overcurrent
devices supplying power to a busbar or conductor does not exceed 120% of busbar or
conductor rating. For a typical 200 A residential service with a 200 A panel busbar, up to
40 A of backfed PV breakers would be allowed, allowing a maximum inverter continuous
output current rating of 32 A. For interactive PV systems with energy storage intended
to supply a backup load during grid outages, the bus or conductor loading is evaluated
at 125% of the inverter maximum continuous current output rather than the overcurrent
device rating.
EXAMPLE:
What is the highest rated inverter continuous AC output current that can be interconnected to a 125 A
panel supplied from the grid by a 100 A overcurrent device?
The OCP devices supplying power to the panel (PV and grid) cannot exceed 120% of the panel bus rat-
ing. The allowable OCP devices is 1.2 × 125 A = 150 A. The allowable PV breaker would then be 150 A
– 100 A = 50 A. Since the PV OCP device needs to be 125% of the inverter maximum continuous output
current ratings, the maximum inverter continuous output current would be 50 A / 1.25 = 40 A.
3. Interactive inverters must be interconnected on the line side of all ground-fault protec-
tion equipment. Most ground-fault protection breakers are not listed for backfeeding,
and may damage them and prevent proper operation. Supply side interconnections are
usually required for larger facilities incorporating ground-fault protection devices at the
service if they are not listed and approved for backfeeding.
4. Distribution equipment used for interconnecting inverters must have markings to
identify the connection for all sources. This requires labels for backfed PV breakers and
main supply breakers.
5. Circuit breakers used for inverter connections must be suitable for backfeeding. Break-
ers without “Line” and “Load” side marking have been evaluated in both directions, and
considered to be identified as suitable for backfeeding.
6. Fastening normally required for supply breakers is not required for breakers supplied
by interactive inverters. Bolt-in connections, or panel covers normally render breakers
not readily accessible for removal. The requirement for listed interactive inverters to de-
energize output upon loss of utility voltage also makes these breakers safer for removal
and service.
102 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
7. If the sum of the overcurrent device ratings supplying a panelboard is greater than
100% of the bus rating, the inverter output breakers must be installed at the opposite
end of the bus from the utility supply breaker, and have a permanent label stating:
WARNING: INVERTER OUTPUT CONNECTION – DO NOT RELOCATE THIS
OVERCURRENT DEVICE.
EXAMPLE:
Consider a 7 kW PV inverter with 240 V output. Can this inverter be connected to a 150 A
panel bus supplied by a 150 A main service breaker?
The inverter maximum continuous output current is:
7,000 W ÷ 240 V = 29.2 A
The required overcurrent device rating is:
29.2 A × 125% = 36.5 A rounded up to next standard breaker size, 40 A
The 150 A panelboard permits 120% × 150 A = 180 of supply breakers:
180 A – 150 A main leaves 30 A maximum allowable PV supply breakers.
A 7 kW inverter requires a 40 A breaker and may not be connected to this panel.
Ultimately, the ratings of distribution equipment and overcurrent protection devices limit
the size of load side interconnections. To allow the load side connection of a 7 kW inverter
for the previous example, possible solutions include:
• Upgrading the panel rating to 200 A with a 200 A main breaker would allow a 40 A back-
fed breaker from the PV systems.
• Keeping the main breaker at 150 A would allow even more PV capacity to be intercon-
nected, and not require a utility service upgrade.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 103
When the requirements for load side connection become impractical, interactive PV
systems and other interconnected power sources may be connected to the supply side
of the service disconnecting means [NEC 705.12(A), 230.82(6)]. These requirements are
similar to installing another service, which involves tapping the service conductors or
bus, or installing new service equipment. Supply side interconnections are often re-
quired for larger installations. The sum of the ratings for overcurrent devices supplying
a service must not exceed the service ratings. See Fig 103.
Supply side connections must have a service-rated disconnect and overcurrent device,
with a minimum rating of at least 60 A, and have an interrupt rating sufficient for the
maximum available fault current.The connection can be made by tapping the service
conductors at the main distribution panel prior to the existing service disconnect, or it
may be made on the load side of the meter socket if the terminals permit. Additional
pull boxes may be installed to provide sufficient room for the tap. Service equipment
for larger commercial facilities often have busbars with provisions for connecting tap
conductors.
In cases of very large PV installations, existing service conductor ampacity or distribu-
tion transformers may not be sufficient and separate services may be installed. Power
flow can occur in both directions at the point of connection, and the interface equip-
ment and any metering must be sized and rated for the operating conditions.
Systems larger than 100 kW may be interconnected at other points in a facility provided
qualified persons operate and maintain the systems, and that appropriate safeguards,
procedures and documentation are in place [NEC 705.12(C)].
Figure 103. Supply side connections are made on the utility side of the service disconnecting means.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 105
Figure 102. Supply side connections are made on the utility side of the service disconnecting
means.
Distribution
Equipment
To
Utility
To
Branch
Circuits
Service
Disconnect
Interactive
Inverter
Service Rated
Fused Disconnect
104 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
5	 Installing Mechanical
	 Components
PV modules and array mounting systems are installed in accordance with manufacturer’s
instructions. Not following these instructions may void product warranties or listings.
Specialized training and experience may be required to install certain products and sys-
tems, such as large area modules, building-integrated products or large tracking arrays.
5.1	 Install Mounting System
PV arrays are constructed from building blocks of individual PV modules, panels and
sub arrays that form a mechanically and electrically integrated dc power generation unit.
The mechanical and electrical layout and installation of PV arrays involves many interre-
lated considerations and tradeoffs. Some of the many factors to consider include:
	 • 	 Module physical and electrical characteristics
	 • 	 Array electrical design and output requirements
	 • 	 Mounting location, orientation and shading
	 • 	 Type of mounting surface (roof or ground mount)
	 • 	 Access and pathways for installation, maintenance and fire codes
	 • 	 Structural loads on modules, mounting structures and attachments
	 • 	 Thermal characteristics of modules and effects of mounting system
	 • 	 Weathersealing of building penetrations and attachments
	 • 	 Materials and hardware compatibilities with the application environment
	 • 	 Aesthetics
Mounting system designs have a strong effect on average and peak array operating
temperatures. Higher operating temperatures reduce array voltage, power output and
energy production, and accelerate degradation of modules and their performance over
many years.
Rack mounted arrays have the greatest passive cooling and lowest operating tempera-
tures, with temperature rise from 15°C to 25°C above ambient temperatures under solar
irradiance levels of 1000 W/m2
. Direct mounts have the highest operating temperatures,
with temperature rise coefficients of 35 to 40°C/kW/m2
. Standoff mounts have moderate
operating temperatures, depending on the standoff height. Maximum passive cooling
gains are generally achieved with the tops of PV modules 3 to 6 inches above the roof
surface.
Common standoff PV arrays are mounted slightly above and parallel to rooftops. PV
modules are typically bolted or clamped with their long dimension across two structural
rails or beams for support. The rails are then fastened and weathersealed to the building
structure at defined points along the rails with special brackets designed for a specific
type of roof. PV arrays installed in higher wind regions require stronger rails, or smaller
spans between rail attachments (more attachment points) to avoid excessive rail and
module deflections. These brackets support the entire structural loads on the PV array at
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 105
the attachment points, which are either screwed of bolted to the roof trusses or structure.
Lag screws are commonly used for screwed attachments to residential roof types.
The point attachments must be installed properly to structural members. See Figs. 104 &
105. Where lag screws are used, they must be centered into a truss generally only 1-1/2
inches in width. To find the exact center of trusses, special deep-penetrating stud find-
ers can be used. With practice, the trusses on a shingled residential roof can usually be
located by hitting the roof with a hammer. The center of the truss can be located by driv-
ing a small nail through the roof covering, deck and into the truss, then moving over 1/8
inch or so at a time until the nail does not penetrate into the truss, locating the truss edge.
Backing up ¾ in then defines the center of the truss. A drill alignment tool can help center
the appropriate size pilot holes prior to screw installation. Weather sealant and flashings
are then used to seal the entire area around the attachment point, including any small
nail holes used to find the trusses.
When structural members are not present or cannot be located for array attachment
points, the installer may be required to add additional blocking in the attic between the
roof trusses. This is commonly required toward the edges of hip roofs. Typically a solid
anchor between trusses can use pairs of 2x6 boards that are attached between rafters or
trusses. The 2x6 pairs provide three inches of wood into which a lag screw can penetrate,
as well as a relatively large area for mounting the bracket on top of the roof. In order to
Figure 105. Point attachments connect the array assembly to a building or structure at
distributed locations, and are usually the critical design point of the entire mounting system.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 107
Figure 104. Structural considerations for PV arrays include attachments of modules and supports
to structures.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 106
to structures.
Trusses or beams
Point attachments to structure
Roof surface
PV Modules
Module support rails
Module attachments
Figure 106. Additional blocking may
be required for some installations to
adequately secure point attachments to
the structure.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 108
Figure 105. Additional blocking may be required for some installations to adequately secure point
attachments to the structure.
106 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
provide proper support for the array, the boards must be nailed or screwed securely onto
the rafters or trusses with at least two fasteners on each side of each board. See Fig. 106.
PV array mounting system designs and all components must be able to withstand the
maximum forces expected in any given application. Oftentimes, independent engineer-
ing or test results may be required to certify PV array structural designs for local building
code compliance. The critical design area is usually the point attachments of the array
mounting system to a structure.
A number of pre-engineered standoff mounts are available commercially. When installed
according the manufacturer’s directions, engineers or test laboratories certify these
mounts to be capable of withstanding specified wind loads. If engineered mounting sys-
tems are used, it is necessary follow the instructions to ensure that the system is installed
properly to address the design wind load requirements. During inspection, it should be
pointed out that the directions were followed to meet the loading requirements.
Figure 108. PV module specifications give the maximum mechanical loads that the module
can support using specified supports and attachments.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 110
Figure 107. PV module specifications give the maximum mechanical loads that the module can
support using specified supports and attachments.
SolarWorld
Figure 107. PV modules are commonly attached to underlying rails or beams
using bolted attachments or clamps to the module frame.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 109
Figure 106. PV modules are commonly attached to underlying rails or beams using bolted
attachments or clamps to the module frame.
Bolted Attachments
Bottom Clamps
Top Clamps
5.2	 Install PV Modules
Most standard flat-plate PV modules are glass laminates
enclosed in an aluminum frame. The frame provides
mechanical support for the laminate, and a means to
structurally attach the module to a mounting system and
for electrical grounding. PV modules are either bolted with
fasteners or clamped to the top or bottom of supporting
rails or beams. See Fig. 107.
In common sloped rooftop applications, the rails are
usually laid out with the length in an east-west direction
across the roof, which permits variable width attachments
to the underlying roof structural members, such as rafters
or trusses. As the spacing between rafters or trusses is
usually fixed, this may constrain the installation of rails
up and down the roof slope (in a north-south direction).
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 107
This is because PV modules require the support rails to be located at certain points on the
module frame to support the specified mechanical loads. Refer to the mounting hardware
manufacturer’s data on maximum allowable loads and deflection on module support
beams. See Fig. 108.
Manufacturer’s instructions should be carefully followed whenever handling or install-
ing PV modules. Although PV modules are designed to withstand environmental ex-
tremes for many years, they can be damaged if improperly stored, handled or installed.
Some modules are more durable than others, but care should be taken to ensure that the
module edges are not chipped or impacted. Unframed laminates are particularly suscep-
tible to edge damage and require significantly more care in handling. Small chips or nicks
in the glass result in high stress points that become cracks that destroy the module. Since
clamps are commonly used to fasten PV modules, it is important to install the proper
clamps for the modules used, and torque to the proper values so that the clamps stay
firmly in place but do not crush the module frame. Follow the PV module manufacturer’s
installation instructions for the allowable mounting points to structurally secure modules
and meet the maximum design loads.
Working safely with PV modules involves taking precautions to avoid electrical shock
from potentially high dc voltages, especially when several modules are connected in
series. Wiring faults may also lead to hazardous conditions and high voltages on metal
components.
Care in handling, transporting, storing and installing PV modules includes the following:
	 • 	 Leave modules in packaging until they are to be installed.
	 • 	 Carry modules with both hands, do not use connectors as a handle
	 • 	 Do not stand modules on hard ground or on their corners
	 • 	 Do not place modules on top of each other or stand on them
	 • 	 Do not mark or work on them with sharp objects
	 • 	 Keep all electrical contacts clean and dry
	 • 	 Do not install modules in high winds
General safety precautions for installing PV modules include the following:
	 • 	 Use the appropriate safety equipment (insulated tools/gloves,
		 fall protection, etc.)
	 • 	 Never insert electrically conducting parts into the plugs or sockets
	 • 	 Never connect non-load break connectors under load, or if dirty or wet
	 • 	 Never use damaged modules
	 • 	 Do not dismantle modules.
	 • 	 Do not remove any part or label fitted by the manufacturer
	 • 	 Never treat the rear of the laminate with paint, adhesives or mark it
		 using sharp objects
	 • 	 Do not artificially concentrate sunlight on modules
108 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
6	 Completing System Installation
Once PV systems are installed, they are inspected and commissioned to verify the instal-
lation matches the plans and code requirements, and to verify that performance expecta-
tions are met.
6.1	 Commission the System
Commissioning of PV systems follows similar requirements to any electrical installation,
involving visual observations, testing and measurements to verify the safety and quality
of the installation in accordance with the plans and applicable codes and standards, and
to verify the proper operation and performance of the system.
Key steps of a commissioning procedure include:
	 •	 Completing final installation details
	 •	 Completing a system checkout and visual inspections
	 •	 Verifying wiring insulation integrity and proper termination torques
	 •	 Completing system documentation and labeling requirements
	 •	 Perform initial start-up and operations
	 •	 Demonstrate and verify shutdown and emergency procedures
	 •	 Verifying expected output and performance
	 •	 Conducting user training and orientation
A final checkout confirms that the installation is complete before beginning operations. A
punch list can help check off items as they are completed, and should include the follow-
ing items:
	 •	 Verifying disconnects are open and lockout/tagout procedures are in place
	 •	 Visually inspecting all components and connections (structural and electrical)
	 •	 Verifying terminal torque specifications and insulation integrity
	 •	 Verifying consistency of overall installation with system design and
		 code compliance
	 •	 Identifying and completing any unresolved items
Numerous markings, labels and signs are required to identify PV systems and their com-
ponents, and to warn operators, service personnel or emergency responders of hazardous
conditions. Manufacturer markings and labels identify the size, type, specifications and
ratings for PV modules, inverters, controllers, combiner boxes, conductors, raceways,
overcurrent devices, switchgear and all other electrical components. These markings are
placed on the product at the time of manufacture, and include listing marks from the
testing laboratory, such as UL. Code officials may verify these markings during final
inspections, and use them for the basis of their approval.
Additional markings and labels are required for the overall system and certain compo-
nents, and are to be provided and placed by the installer. These include additional labels
on conductors, connectors, conduits, disconnecting means, and at the point of utility
connection. Special labeling is also required for bipolar arrays, ungrounded PV arrays,
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 109
battery storage systems, and stand-alone inverters providing a single 120-volt supply.
The initial startup for a PV system is conducted after all inspections and checks have been
completed with all outstanding items resolved. Typical startup procedures include:
	 •	 Installing overcurrent devices
	 •	 Closing all DC and AC disconnects and turning on inverter
	 •	 Verifying system output
6.2	 Visual Inspection
Visual inspections should be performed as part of commissioning and routinely over the
system lifetime to verify and ensure that the system remains in a satisfactory condition for use.
Prior to operation, PV systems should be inspected for full compliance with the many NEC
requirements, including verifying appropriate:
	 •	 Circuit voltages and currents
	 •	 Conductor and overcurrent device sizes and ratings
	 •	 Disconnecting means
	 •	 Wiring methods and connectors
	 •	 Equipment and system grounding
	 •	 Markings and labels
	 •	 Connections to other sources
	 •	 Battery and charge controller installation
An inspection checklist is an indispensible tool for contractors and regulators, and provides
an organized process to review and help ensure code compliance for PV installations. The basic
purposes for an inspection checklist include:
	 •	 Verification of appropriate equipment listings and labeling, intended for
		 the conditions of use, and installed in accordance with instructions.
	 •	 Verification of appropriate sizes and ratings for major components and
		 balance-of-systems equipment.
	 •	 Verification of proper grounding and bonding.
	 •	 Verification that all equipment and the overall installation is completed in
		 a workmanlike manner in compliance with all applicable codes.
Some sources for PV system inspection checklists include:
www.nmsu.edu/~tdi/Photovoltaics/Codes-Stds/Codes-Stds.html
http://irecusa.org/wp-content/uploads/2010/07/PV-Field-Inspection-Guide-June-2010-F-1.pdf
www.jimdunlopsolar.com/vendorimages/jdsolar/PVInspectionChecklist.pdf
6.3	 Test the System
Testing PV systems requires qualified persons with knowledge of electrical systems measure-
ments, the test equipment used, and the specifications and characteristics of the equipment or
systems under test. PV systems should be thoroughly tested at the time of commissioning and
periodically over the system life to ensure proper and safe operations.
110 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Electrical testing on interactive PV systems includes the following measurements and
verifications:
	 •	 Test ac circuits for continuity, phasing, voltage
	 •	 Test dc circuits for continuity of grounding conductors
	 •	 Verify correct dc polarity
	 •	 Test string open-circuit voltage
	 •	 Test string short circuit current
	 •	 Verify system functionality
	 •	 Test insulation resistance for PV arrays source and output circuits
Insulation Resistance Testing
Insulation resistance testing measures the resistance from ungrounded circuits to ground,
and is used to verify and demonstrate integrity of wiring systems [NEC 110.7]. These
tests can be used to identify damage or insulation faults for PV modules and interconnect
wiring, to locate ground faults, or to assess the degradation of array wiring, PV modules
and other system circuits. The insulation tester can be a variable dc power supply or
megohmmeter that provides a test voltage of 500 V.
Damage to wiring insulation can be due to improper installation, or from vermin chew-
ing the wires. Older PV arrays may have significantly higher leakage current than when
they were new. Proper insulating gloves and other applicable PPE should be used when-
ever touching a PV array or associated conductive surfaces to protect against electrical
shock, especially when ground-fault conditions are indicated.
Insulation resistance testing measures the resistance between the system circuits and
ground. Insulation resistance for large PV arrays is generally measured at source circuit
combiner boxes, where the individual source circuits can be accessed for disconnection
and testing. The tests can be conducted dry, or a wetting agent can be sprayed on por-
tions of an array to better pinpoint fault locations.
All circuits must be isolated from others for testing and grounding or bonding connec-
tions are left connected. Any surge suppression equipment must be removed from the
circuits. Connect the positive and negative output leads of the array together, and to the
positive terminal of the insulation tester. A short-circuiting device is required suitable for
the source circuit or array maximum current. Connect the negative terminal of the insula-
tion tester to the grounding point for the array or source circuit. Apply a dc test voltage
of 500 V and wait for capacitive effects to subside and readings to stabilize. Measure and
record the insulation resistance in megohms. Observe and listen to the array during the
tests for evidence of arcing or flashover. Generally, when a fault exists, resistance mea-
surements will decrease significantly. Tests conducted during system commissioning may
be used as a baseline for which later measurements can be compared.
6.3.1	 Complete System Documentation
Adequate documentation for PV systems is an essential part of the approval process, and
helps ensure safe and reliable operation over decades of operation. Complete documen-
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 111
tation is particularly important for safety concerns, routine maintenance, later modifica-
tions, and for systems having a change in ownership or those responsible for operating
and maintaining the system. In most jurisdictions, system documentation is required by
the building officials for the plan review and permitting process, and also for intercon-
nection approval from the local utility. In some cases, incentive programs may require
additional documentation, such as a shading analysis and system performance estimates.
Final system documents should always be provided to the owners and caretakers and
should be accessible at the system site for future reference. The installation contactor
should also keep a copy of the system documentation materials for their records and
follow-on service as required.
A complete system documentation package is a well-organized collection of all relevant
documents depicting the as-built system design, major components and relevant infor-
mation on safety, operations, and maintenance. While the details may vary with the size
and scope of specific projects, key components of a final PV system documentation pack-
age should include the following:
• 	General information should include the system dc and ac power ratings; the manu-
facturer, model and quantity of PV modules, inverters, batteries, controllers and all
other major components, as applicable. The dates of the system installation, commis-
sioning and inspection should also be noted.
• 	Contact information should include the names, postal addresses, phone numbers and
email addresses for the customer/owner, system designer, installation contractor and
any other responsible parties or subcontractors.
• 	A site layout drawing is often required by local jurisdictions for permitting purposes,
to identify equipment locations on buildings or relative to property lines or ease-
ments. In some cases, a shading analysis and performance estimates may be provided
with project proposals, and should also be including with the final system docu-
ments.
• 	A single line diagram should be provided depicting the overall system design, includ-
ing the types of modules, total number of modules, modules per string and total
number of strings; the types and number of inverters; and any other major compo-
nents. For larger projects, complete as-built electrical and mechanical drawings are
usually required.
• 	The types, sizes and ratings for all balance-of-system components should also be an-
notated on the single line diagram, or noted and provided in a separate table, includ-
ing specifications for all conductors, raceways, junction boxes, source circuit combiner
boxes, disconnects, overcurrent protection devices, and grounding equipment, as
applicable.
• 	Data sheets and specifications should be provided for PV modules, inverters and
other major components, including module mounting systems. For most products,
installation and user/operator manuals are available and provide important
information regarding the safe operation and maintenance of the equipment.
• 	Operation and maintenance information should include procedures for verify-
ing proper system operation and performance, and how to determine if there is a
problem and what to do. Procedures for isolating/disconnecting equipment and
emergency shutdown procedures should also be provided. A maintenance plan and
intervals should be provided for all routine (scheduled) system maintenance, such as
112 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
array cleaning as required. Operating and maintenance guidelines should differenti-
ate what tasks can be performed by the owner or caretakers, from those that require
professional service due to the complexity of the tasks, special equipment needs, or
safety concerns. Maintenance agreements, plans and recordkeeping forms or sheets
should also be provided to document maintenance activities over time.
• 	Warranty details on major components should be clearly identified, indicating the
terms and conditions, and how the warranty process is handled and by whom.
System warranties should also be addressed, including quality of workmanship, roof
weathersealing or performance warranties as applicable.
• 	Copies of all commissioning test reports and verification data shall be provided as
applicable.
• 	Contracting and financial details are also an important part of system documentation,
and may be included with the technical items discussed above or under a separate
file. These documents should include construction contracts, invoices and payments
for materials and labor, building permits, inspection certificates, interconnection
agreements, and applications and approvals from incentive programs, such as rebates
and tax forms.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 113
7	 Conducting Maintenance and
	 Troubleshooting Activities
PV systems require periodic maintenance to ensure safe and reliable operations over the
long-term, and to maximize performance. Although most PV systems usually require
little maintenance, a maintenance plan ensures that essential service is performed on a
regular schedule. Maintenance helps identify and avoid potential problems that affect
system functions, performance, or safety. When problems do occur, a systematic
troubleshooting process is used to diagnose and identify the problems, and take
corrective actions.
All PV systems require some maintenance. A maintenance plan includes a list and
schedule for all required system maintenance and service, such as:
	 •	 Inspections of components and wiring systems
	 •	 Evaluation of structural attachments and weathersealing
	 •	 Cleaning and removing debris around arrays
	 •	 Performing battery maintenance
	 •	 Conducting electrical tests and verifying performance
	 •	 Replacement of damaged or failed system components
7.1	 Perform Visual Inspection
Visual inspections of the complete system should be performed with regular mainte-
nance, similar to the initial inspection prior to commissioning. The main difference is that
during maintenance inspections, the code compliance aspects of the system do not neces-
sarily need to be evaluated, as the equipment would not normally have been changed.
However, the integrity of the electrical installation must be carefully evaluated for deteri-
orating effects over time, due to the site conditions, or even for poor quality components
or damage for outside influences. Visual inspections and observations are supplemented
with electrical tests and measurements to fully verify system integrity and performance.
PV modules should be visually inspected for signs of any physical damage, including
bent frames or broken glass. See Fig. 109. Modules with fractured or damaged laminates
Figure 109. Inspect PV arrays for any signs of physical damage, such as impacts or fractures.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 111
Figure 108. Inspect PV arrays for any signs of physical damage, such as impacts or fractures.
Obvious impact damage Less obvious fractured glass
will eventually admit moisture and de-
velop high leakage currents, and should
be removed from the array and replaced.
Most PV modules use tempered glass,
which shatters into small pieces when
stressed or impacted. Physical damage
may be quite obvious in the case of im-
pacts, but fractured glass in a PV module
may not be clearly evident from
a distance.
114 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
More subtle signs of module degradation include delamination, moisture or corrosion
within modules, particularly near cell busbar connections and edges of laminates. Discol-
orations inside module laminates may be an indicator of a failing edge seal, or damage
to the back of the module laminate. Degradation of solder bonds at internal cell connec-
tions can lead to hot spots and ultimately burn through the back of the module, resulting
in module failure, reduced system performance and creating a fire hazard. See Fig.110.
Burned bus bars, delaminated modules and damaged wiring systems are likely to show
faults during insulation resistance testing. Thermal imaging can be a useful diagnostics
tool for identifying faults in wiring systems or poor connections, especially for PV arrays.
Figure 111. Operating parameters in PV systems are
measured to verify expected performance.
lar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 113
Figure 110. Operating parameters in PV systems are measured to verify expected performance.
Figure 110. PV modules should be carefully inspected for any signs of discoloration, corrosion or delamination.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 112
Figure 109. PV modules should be carefully inspected for any signs of discoloration, corrosion or
delamination.
Back Surface
Front Surface
Burned Busbars
Delamination and Corrosion
7.2	 Verify System Operation
Performance data can be used to verify output expectations and identify
problems that require service or maintenance. See Fig. 111. Most invert-
ers and charge controllers provide some indication of performance and
operating status, such as power output or energy production, and fault
or error indications. This information is extremely helpful in verifying
proper system operation. Also ensure that the system can be disconnected
and shut down safely and that it starts properly. Knowledge of the specific
equipment used and the product installation and operation instructions
are crucial to verifying their safe and proper operation.
For simple interactive PV systems without energy storage, the key indi-
cators for system performance are ac power output (kW) and ac energy
production (kWh). The ac power output for an interactive system is
determined by the rated dc power output of the array, the inverter ef-
ficiency and systems losses, and is proportional to solar irradiance on the
array. Measurement of ac power output is usually given on inverter output
displays, or can be recorded over time and accessed remotely. Power mea-
surements may be an instantaneous (snap-shot) measurement, or averaged
over a certain interval.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 115
The ac power output of an interactive PV system at any moment can be com-
pared with expectations, using the basic translation formulas for solar irradiance
and temperature. The ac power output can be read from inverter displays or
by additional power meters, and the array temperatures and solar radiation in
the plane of the array can be measured with simple handheld meters without
working on energized equipment. Power verification can be done any time when
the system is operating under steady sunlight conditions, preferably at higher
irradiance levels.
Generally, the maximum ac power output for interactive systems can be related
to the rated maximum dc power output rating for the array and adjusted by a
number of derating factors. The factors include several types of dc and ac system
losses and power conversion efficiencies, which in combination result in ac
power output varying between 70% to 85% of the PV array dc rating at Standard
Test Conditions (STC), depending on temperature.
The ac energy production (kWh) for grid-connected PV systems is measured
over periods of months and years to compare with sizing and long-term perfor-
mance expectations. The ac energy production for grid-connected PV systems
with no energy storage can be estimated using popular tools such as PVWATTS.
PVWATTS performs an hour-by-hour simulation for a typical year to estimate
average power output for each hour and totals energy production for the entire
year. PVWATTS uses an overall dc to ac derate factor to determine the rated ac
power at STC. Power corrections for PV array operating temperature are per-
formed for each hour of the year as PVWATTS reads the meteorological data for
the location and computes the performance. A power correction of -0.5%/°C for
crystalline silicon PV modules is used.
Actual solar irradiation (insolation) and array temperatures can be used to more
precisely compare with the ac energy produced. The average daily ac energy
production divided by the product of the PV array dc peak power rating at STC
and peak sun hours is a key indicator of system performance:
	 ac kWh / (dc kWp x PSH) = 0.7 to 0.85
	 (depending on temperature and system losses)
The installer must be capable of making a good estimate of the PV array power
output based on the system design and environmental conditions. System
adjustment factors for module mismatch and dc and ac wire losses vary based
upon the actual installation. Another factor that can limit irradiance is soiling on
the array. This is particularly a concern in climates in the western U.S. that can
go for several months without rain.
Solar Radiation
Measurements
A pyranometer measures
total global solar irradiance
(solar power). Irradiance
measurements are used in
the field to translate the
actual output of PV array
and systems to a reference
condition to verify perfor-
mance. Small inexpensive
meters using calibrated PV
cells as sensors are avail-
able from $150 and up. See
Fig 112. A small PV mod-
ule with calibrated short-
circuit current can also be
used to approximate solar
radiation levels.
Figure 112. Handheld solar meters use a
small PV cell to measure solar irradiance.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar
Figure 111. Handheld solar meters use a small PV
Daystar
116 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Example:
How much power should a 4,800 Watt (STC) crystalline silicon array produce when the
array temperature is 45°C and the irradiance is 840 W/m2
? The inverter efficiency is 95%;
module mismatch and the dc and ac wiring losses are 2% and 3% respectively, and soil-
ing is minimal.
System Adjustment Factors:
	 1. 	 Temperature: [1 - (45°C–25°C) x (–0.005/°C)] = 0.90
	 2.	 Irradiance: (IRR ÷ 1000W/m2
) = 840 ÷ 1000 = 0.84
	 3.	 Inverter Efficiency: 0.95
	 4.	 Mismatch and dc and ac wire losses: 5% total = 0.95
	 5.	 Soiling: 0% = 1.0
	
Inverter Output Power = 4800 x (0.9) x (0.84) x (0.95) x (0.95) x (1.0) = 3275 W
STC array rating
Temperature
Irradiance
Inverter Efficiency
Mismatch and wiring
	 Soiling
For a utility-interactive system with battery backup, the calculation of expected
voltages, currents, and powers is more complicated. The difference between a bat-
tery backup system and a system without batteries is that the PV array does not
operate at its maximum power voltage unless a MPT charger is used. The battery
also requires constant charging to remain fully charged. The output power of the
system can be estimated when the system is operating in utility-interactive mode,
and if the batteries are fully charged.
Typical maximum power tracking controlled battery-based systems will lose 2%
(0.98) for maximum power tracking losses and about 5% (0.95) for additional
inverter losses. These systems will operate at about 93% of the same size PV sys-
tems without batteries. Battery-based systems without maximum power tracking
controllers will lose another 5% to 10% instantaneous power due to operation off
the maximum power point. All battery-based systems will lose energy keeping the
battery fully charged. This charging can reduce the annual energy production by
2% to 5%. All standby power systems have these battery charging losses.
Watt-hour meters measure electrical power and energy, and are commonly used
at electrical service entrances by utility companies for customer billing purposes.
Watt-hour meters essentially measure current, voltage and their phase angle to
determine ac power and energy. They can be electronic or electro-mechanical types.
Advanced electronic types use microprocessors to measure directional and time of
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 117
use power flows and other electrical properties such as reactive power, power factor and
peak power demand.See Fig 113.
Figure 113. A standard watt-hour meter can be used to measure average power over brief intervals.
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 115
Figure 112. A standard watt-hour meter can be used to measure average power over brief
intervals.
 The watt-hour constant (Kh)
indicates the watt-hours
accumulated per revolution of
the meter disk.
 Multiply Kh by the disk revolution
rate to calculate average power
through the meter. 3600
average power (W)
Wh
meter constant ( )
rev
rev
disk revolution rate ( )
sec
avg h rev
avg
h
rev
P K N
where
P
K
N
= × ×
=
=
=
Standard utility watt-hour meters are often used to record the energy produced by PV
systems over time, but can also be used to measure average power over brief intervals.
The watt-hour constant (Kh) indicates the watt-hours accumulated per revolution of the
meter disk. Most residential meters have Kh = 7.2 watt-hours/rev. The smaller the con-
stant, the faster the meter spins for a given amount of power passing through it. Multiply
Kh by the disk revolution rate to calculate average power through the meter. The disk has
markings on the top and sides with a scale of 0 to 100. Electronic meters use progressive
LCD hash marks to simulate disk revolutions and the rate of energy flow.
For example, the average power through a meter with Kh = 7.2 that makes 10 complete
revolutions in 40 seconds is calculated by:
Pavg = 7.2 Wh/rev × 10 rev/40 sec × 3600 sec/hr = 6480 W.
Performance verification for stand-alone systems with battery storage is more complex,
and involves measurements of:
	 •	 Battery voltage, amp-hours and state-of-charge
	 •	 PV array, battery and load currents
	 •	 Load availability and other factors
Battery health is the key to stand-alone PV systems performance, and battery failure is of-
ten the indicator of other system problems. Many battery charge controllers and inverters
monitor and record certain battery data, such as voltage, current and amp-hours. Closely
monitoring and evaluating this data can be an invaluable tool to those operating and
maintaining stand-alone systems.
Usually, stand-alone systems are designed to produce a specified amount of energy on
an average daily basis to meet system loads. Measurements of daily energy consumption
118 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
can be used by the system owner/operators to control their loads and manage the avail-
able energy, to maintain battery charge, or to minimize or eliminate the need for a backup
source, such as a generator. Measurements of daily minimum daily battery voltage can
be used an indicator of state-of-charge. The net amp-hours delivered to and withdrawn
from a battery can also be used to assess whether the battery is receiving enough charge.
Deficit charging will usually be indicated by declining minimum daily battery voltages.
The performance of electrical loads can be verified by measuring their current or power
consumption, and if they function as intended.
7.3	 Perform Maintenance Activities
Basic maintenance for PV arrays includes the following:
Debris Removal
Any leaves, trash or other debris that collects around PV arrays should be removed dur-
ing routine maintenance. These materials can present a fire hazard, as well as a problem
for proper drainage and can lead to mildew and insect problems that can ultimately lead
to degradations of wiring systems or other components.
Shading Control
Because a relatively small amount of shading can significantly reduce array output, any
conditions that contribute to increased shading of PV arrays should be evaluated during
routine maintenance. Trees and vegetation present ongoing shading concerns, and may
require trimming and maintenance. Ground-mounted PV arrays may also be susceptible
to shading from shrubs or long grass near the array. Where visual observations cannot
determine the extent of shading problems, a solar shading evaluation tool can be used.
Soiling
PV arrays become soiled over time, particularly in arid and dusty regions with infrequent
rainfall. Soiling may result from bird droppings, emissions, dust or dirt that settles and
accumulates on the array surface. Extensive soiling can reduce array output by 10% to
20% or more. Generally, cleaning PV array on buildings involves climbing ladders and
working at heights where personal fall arrest systems are required. Electrical shock haz-
ards may also exist for higher voltage arrays with existing faults. See Fig. 114.
Weathersealing and Structural
The weathersealing of all attachment points and building penetrations should be routine-
ly inspected for signs of deterioration or water leakage, and repairs made as required. All
structural attachments should be inspected for security and signs of degradation.
Battery Maintenance
Batteries can be one of the more maintenance-intensive components in a PV system.
Regular care and service is important to maximizing battery life, and to mitigate any
hazardous conditions. All battery maintenance should be conducted using proper proce-
dures and safety precautions. Battery maintenance includes checking and replenishing
electrolyte, cleaning, re-tightening terminals, measuring cell voltages, specific gravity and
any other periodic maintenance or testing recommended by the manufacturer.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 119
Battery maintenance involves various tasks depending on the type of battery and manu-
facturer requirements, including:
	 • 	 Inspecting and cleaning battery racks, cases trays and terminations
	 •	 Inspecting battery disconnects, overcurrent devices and wiring systems
	 •	 Checking termination torques
	 •	 Measuring voltage and specific gravity
	 •	 Adding water
	 •	 Inspecting auxiliary systems
	 •	 Load and capacity testing
Observe all safety precautions and wear appropriate PPE when conducting any battery
maintenance. Personal safety precautions for battery maintenance include:
	 •	 Wearing face shields, aprons and rubber gloves when dealing
		 with electrolytes
	 •	 Using insulated tools to prevent short circuits
	 •	 Providing eye wash facilities, water and baking soda for flushing and
		 neutralizing spilled electrolyte
	 •	 Providing disconnecting means to isolate battery system
	 •	 Fire protection equipment
Figure 114. Cleaning soiled PV arrays is a common maintenance need.
Jim Tetro
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 2
Sharp Solar
120 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Battery test equipment includes:
	 •	 DC voltmeters are used to measure battery and cell voltages
	 •	 DC ammeters (clamp-on type) are used to measure battery currents
	 •	 Hydrometers are used to measure electrolyte specific gravity
	 •	 Load testers discharge the battery at high rates for short periods
		 while the voltage drop is recorded
	 •	 Impedance and conductance testers may be used on some VRLA batteries
Battery terminals are made of soft lead alloys, and connections may become loose over
time. This can lead to increased resistance and voltage drop within the battery bank, re-
sulting in unequal charge and discharge currents among individual cells. In severe cases,
loose terminals can cause accelerated corrosion, and overheat to a point where the battery
post or cable connection deforms or even melts, creating a fire hazard and destroying the
battery. Regular battery maintenance should include checks of all terminals for corrosion
and proper torque. Terminals may be coated with petroleum jelly, grease, or special bat-
tery terminal corrosion inhibitors to retard corrosion. See Fig. 115.
Figure 115. Periodic battery maintenance should include checks of all terminals for corrosion and proper torque. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 118
Figure 114. Periodic battery maintenance should include checks of all terminals for corrosion and
proper torque.
 Periodic battery maintenance should include checks of all
terminals for corrosion and proper torque.
Specific gravity should be checked for open-
vent flooded lead-acid batteries as part of
annual maintenance, and may be used to
estimate battery state-of-charge. Abnormally
low readings may indicate failing or shorted
cells.
A fully charged lead-acid cell has a typical
specific gravity between 1.26 and 1.28 at
room temperature. Specific gravity decreases
with increasing electrolyte temperature,
and measurements must be corrected to a
reference temperature for comparison. Four
“points” of specific gravity (0.004) are added
for every 5.5°C (10°F) increment above a
reference temperature and four points are
subtracted for every 5.5°C (10°F) decrease in temperature. For example, at 90°F (32°C) a
hydrometer reading of 1.250 would be corrected to 1.254 at 80°F. See Fig 116.
Hydrometers measure electrolyte specific gravity (SG). Archimedes hydrometers use a
float and buoyancy principles to measure SG. Refractive index hydrometers use a prism
and optics to measure SG by the angle that light refracts through a droplet of electrolyte.
See Fig. 117.
Open-circuit voltage may also be measured and used independently or in conjunction
with specific gravity to estimate battery state-of-charge. The voltage readings must be
taken when the battery has not been charged or discharged for at least 5 to 10 minutes.
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 121
Flooded, open-vent batteries require frequent water additions to replenish water lost
through electrolyte gassing. Distilled water is recommended as any impurities may
poison a battery. Electrolyte levels must not be allowed to decrease below the tops of the
battery plates, which can oxidize and reduce capacity. Because electrolyte expands with
increasing concentration, batteries should only be completely filled or “topped off” when
they are fully charged. Otherwise, the battery may overflow electrolyte from the cell
vents.
The frequency and amount of watering required depends on charge rates, temperature,
regulation voltage and age of the battery among other factors. Watering intervals may be
extended where batteries have reserve electrolyte capacity. Advanced multi-stage charge
control methods and temperature compensation also reduce water loss. Higher water
loss should be expected in hot, arid climates. Excessive electrolyte loss may be due to
a faulty charge controller, failed temperature compensation or improper regulation set
point. Comparatively low water consumption in individual cells may indicate a weak or
failing cell, or need for equalization charge. Specific gravity is also likely to be lower in
cells with lower water loss.
Battery load testing applies very high discharge rates for a few seconds, while measuring
the decrease in battery voltage. Weak or failed cells are indicated by significantly greater
voltage drop during this test. Battery capacity testing involves discharging the battery at
nominal discharge rates to a prescribed depth-of-discharge. This test evaluates available
energy storage capacity for the system during normal operations.
Figure 116. Battery specific gravity and open-circuit voltage
are measured during maintenance to evaluate battery health
and estimate state-of-charge.
Figure 117. Hydrometers measure electrolyte specific gravity (SG).
Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 119
specific gravity and open-circuit voltage are measured during maintenance to
evaluate battery health and estimate state-of-charge.
State-of-
Charge
Specific
Gravity
Open-
Circuit
Voltage (V)
100% 1.265 12.6
75% 1.225 12.4
50% 1.190 12.2
25% 1.155 12.0
0 1.120 11.8
For typical lead-acid battery at 25°C
 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 120
Figure 116. Hydrometers measure electrolyte specific gravity (SG).
Archimedes Hydrometer
Refractive Index Hydrometer
References key: topic / name / detail / author
122 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
EFFICIENT. RELIABLE. RESPONSIVE.
What more do you want from your inverter supplier?
www.solectria.com | inverters@solectria.com | 978-683-9700
Built for the real world
MADE IN THE USA
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 123
References key: topic / name / detail / author
Introduction to Resources Section
The following pages list additional sources of information on the topics that are covered in the
NABCEP PV Installation Professional Job Task Analysis. The list of sources was assembled by a
committee of subject matter experts and represents their considerable efforts to offer additional
study materials. The list in not complete, nor could it ever be complete, as additional material in the
form of books, videos, articles and web sites are continually being produced.
The reader will note that some sub topic areas do not have recommended additional study refer-
ences. This is because the Committee did not find a reference for that particular topic area that met
their standards of usefulness and accuracy. NABCEP encourages dialogue and input at all times
and invites readers who identify potential references for any topic areas covered in this guide to
send them to NABCEP for review by the Committee for possible inclusion in future editions of
this Guide. Please send reference recommendations to info@nabcep.org with the subject line
“PV Resource Guide Reference Submission”.
References
Color Key:
Task Steps and Knowledge in each Category Level
Category / Level		 Description
l Critical			 Absolutely essential for a PV installer. Installers
				 do these tasks most frequently.
l Important			 Very important, but not of the highest level of
				 criticality. These tasks are done with less
				 frequency by installers yet have been identified
				 as important to the knowledge base of installers.
l Useful			 Might be useful; can inform education and
				 training to add richness and depth.
				 Installers do these tasks infrequently.
Appendixes
	 References..............................................................................123
	 Case Study Examples.......................................................149
	Sample NABCEP Exam Questions..........................156
References key: topic / name / detail / author
124 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
1. Verify Client Needs							
	
• Confirm desired location of equipment
• Address aesthetic concerns	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10/Page# 259-260; Mechanical Intergration -
	 Aesthetics; J.P. Dunlop; Home Power Magazine; Issue #142/Pgs# 44-51;
	 Architectural PV Design Considerations; M. Welch
• Address legal concerns
• Confirm loads assessment	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 9/Pgs# 233-240; System Sizing -
	 Load Analysis; J.P. Dunlop; PV Design & Installation man.; Chapter # 4/
	 Pgs# 38-40; Electric Load Analysis; S.E.I.
• Confirm critical loads	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 4/Pgs# 96-97; System Components & Config. -
	 Electric Loads; J.P. Dunlop; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.3; Stand alone System
	 Design - 5 rules for Load analysis
• Confirm system matches client expectation	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pgs# 84-85; Site Survey and Preplanning - Prep
	 Proposals/Install Planning
Additional useful references		
• Determine client’s energy expectations	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pg# 82; Site Survey and Preplanning -
	 Energy Audit; J.P. Dunlop; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue# 4.4; PV Performance
	 Guarantees (Part 1): Managing Risks & Expectations; Mat Taylor, David Williams	
• Determine client’s financial expectations	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 15/Pgs# 399-416; Economic Analysis; J.P. Dunlop	
• Obtain utility bills	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 4/Pgs# 105-107; System Components &
	 Config - Utility interactive Systems; J.P. Dunlop			
• Determine client budget	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 15/Pgs# 394-398; Economic Analysis -
	 Incentives/Rebates/Grants/Tax Incentive; J.P. Dunlop			
							
	
2. Review Site Survey						
• Evaluate roof conditions	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter #3/Pgs# 78-80; Site Survey and Preplanning -
	 Roofing Evaluation; J.P. Dunlop; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 2.3; Quality
	 Assurance: Aerial Site Surveys Save Time and Resources; Tim Harvey	
• Evaluate desired array and equipment locations	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pgs# 66,67,80; Site Survey and Preplanning -
	 Array Loc./Equipment Loc.; J.P. Dunlop; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 115/
	 Pgs# 98-100; Considerations for PV Site Surveys; J. Wiles; Home Power Magazine	
	 Issue # 130/Pgs# 52-56; Optimizing a PV array with Orientation and Tilt;
	 D. DelVecchio
• Locate solar equipment	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Page# 80; Site Survey and Preplanning -
	 Equipment Locations; J.P. Dunlop
• Locate conduit paths		
• Evaluate roof structure	 Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.2; Pitched Roof PV Mounting: Design and
	 Engineering considerations; Yun Lee
• Determine obstructions	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pages# 70 - 77; Site Survey and Preplanning -
	 Shading Priority/Alt. Angle method; J.P. Dunlop			
• Conduct a site hazard assessment (existing hazards)	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pages# 60 - 64; Site Survey and Preplanning - 		
	 Survey Safety; J.P. Dunlop			
• Identify staging/lifting/access locations	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10/Pgs# 256 - 257; Mechanical Integration -
	 Mech. considerations/Accessability
Verify System Design
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 125
References key: topic / name / detail / author
• Confirm accuracy of shading analysis	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pgs# 69-77; Site Survey and Preplanning;
	 Shading Analysis; J.P. Dunlop; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 121/Pgs# 88-90;
	 Solmetric Suneye Solar Site; Evaluation tool; J. Schwartz; Home Power Magazine,
	 Issue # 115/Pgs# 30-33; Choose the right Site to Maximize your Solar Investment;
	 Tehri Parker; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 1.1; Solar Site Evaluation: Tools &
	 Techniques to Quantify & Optimize Production; Mark Galli, Peter Hoberg	
• Evaluate existing electrical equipment	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Page# 80; Site Survey and Preplanning -
	 Electrical Assesment; J.P. Dunlop			
• Determine true South	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Page# 68; Site Survey and Preplanning -
	 Magnetic declination; J.P. Dunlop			
	 PV Design & Installation man.; Chapter # 3/Page# 32-33; The Solar Resource -
	 Orientation; S.E.I.; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 116/Page# 12-13; Ask the
	 Experts: Finding True South; R. Perez		
• Evaluate wall structure			
• Confirm existing roof tilt and orientation (pitch and azimuth)	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pages# 66 - 70; Site Survey and Preplanning -
	 Array Loc. / Equipment Loc.; J.P. Dunlop; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 137;
	 Pages #74-80; Modern PV Roof Mounting; Rebekah Hren			
• Confirm accuracy of site drawings	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pages# 81; Site Survey and Preplanning - Site
	 Layout Drawings;	J.P. Dunlop			
• Evaluate wind exposure	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10/Page# 271-272; J.P. Dunlop			
• Evaluate soil conditions	 Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.4; Ground Mounted PV - Soil Properties;
	 Charly Bray				
• Confirm solar resource	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 2/Pages# 33 - 53; Solar Radiation - Sun Path,
	 Tilt angle, Azimuth Angle, Data sets; J.P. Dunlop; Home Power Magazine; 	
	 Issue # 135/Page# 128; Irradiance & Insolation; E. Weliczko			
	
3. Confirm System Sizing
						
• Arrange modules in mounting area	 Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 1.1; Pitched Roof Racking: Layout, Flashing & Sealing
	 for the Life of the System; Steve Fain, David Brearley
• Determine topography of mounting area			
• Confirm utility/authority having jurisdiction (AHJ) restrictions	
Other references
• Maximize the incentives	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 15/Pages# 394-395; Economic Analysis -
	 Incentives; J.P. Dunlop			
	
4. Review Design of Energy Storage Systems
						
• Verify appropriate energy storage system location	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 480; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Verify ventilation requirements	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 480; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Verify circuit design for critical loads
• Verify access requirements	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt	
Verify System Design
References key: topic / name / detail / author
126 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
• Verify loads analysis	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 9/Pgs# 233-240; System Sizing - Sizing Calc./
	 Load analy./Critical Design analysis; J.P. Dunlop; Solar Pro Magazine;	Issue #3.3;	
	 Stand alone System Design - The art of load analysis; Phil Undercuffler		
• Inspect existing wiring 	 NFPA 70 NEC; NEC Chapters 1 - 4; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV
	 Systems; Mike Holt			
• Identify multi-wire branch circuits	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 210; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt				
• Confirm battery bank is appropriate to	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 9/Pgs# 243 - 245; System Sizing - Battery Bank
inverter requirements	 Sizing; J.P. Dunlop	; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 76/Pgs# 96-100; Measuring
	 Energy Usage for Inverter & Battery Bank Sizing; M. Patton; Solar Pro Magazine;
	 Issue # 3.1; Understanding and Optimizing Battery Temperature Compensation;
	 Jim Goodnight; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.3; Optimizing Array Voltage for
	 Battery-Based Systems; Jim Goodnight			
• Confirm battery bank is appropriate to	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 7/Pgs# 195 - 199; Charge Controllers -
other charging sources	 Battery & array Size / Mult. Battery banks; J.P. Dunlop			
• Confirm that battery technology is appropriate to usage	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 6 / Pgs# 161 - 165; Batteries - Battery types /
	 Battery Classifications / etc.; Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 9 / Pgs# 243 - 247;
	 System Sizing - Battery Bank Rated Capacity / Battery Selection; J.P. Dunlop
	
5. Confirm String Size Calculations
						
• Confirm highest and lowest design temperature	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt				
• Confirm module Voc at lowest design temperature	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems
	 Mike Holt				
• Confirm temperature corrected voltage	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems
	 Mike Holt				
• Confirm voltage limits of system	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems
	 Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.6; Array Voltage Considerations;
	 Bill Brooks				
• Configure appropriate string diagram	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 9 / Pgs# 249 -252; System Sizing - Array Rate
	 Output/Module Selection, J.P. Dunlop			
• Determine Vpmax at highest design temperature	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 705; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems
	 Mike Holt
Additional useful references
• Account for module degradation	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 5 / Pgs# 141 - 144; Cells,Modules, and Arrays -
	 Module Std.s / Performance ratings; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 140 /
	 Page# 41; Ask the Experts: Module Degradation; J. Davidson
• Determine inverter MPPT	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 705; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems
	 Mike Holt
	
Verify System Design
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 127
References key: topic / name / detail / author
	
6. Review System Component Selection
						
• Confirm component compatibility
• Confirm the selected module mounting system	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10 / Pgs# 260 - 267; Mechanical Integration -
is appropriate for the application	 Array Mounting Systems; J.P. Dunlop; Home Power Magazine, Issue # 124 /
	 Pgs# 58-64, Rack & Stack - PV Array Mounting Options; R. Mayfield;
	 Home Power Magazine; Issue # 130 / Pgs# 74-80; Pitched Roof Mounting;
	 R. Hren; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 142 / Pgs# 80-85; PV Rack Strategies;
	 G. McPheeters; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.2; Racking Equipment Guide;
	 Ryan Mayfield, David Brearley; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.1; Tile Roofing
	 Systems: Materials & Methods for Flashing Penetrations; Johan Alfsen	
• Confirm the selected grounding method	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
is appropriate for the application	 Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 1.1; Equipment Grounding Conductors:
	 Sizing and Methods; Ryan Mayfield; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 2.5; PV System
	 Ground Faults; Paul Mync, John Berdner
• Confirm the selected combiner boxes	 Home Power Magazine; Issue # 78 / Pgs# 52-56; Build your own PV Combiner
are appropriate for the application	 Box; D. Scanlin, Home Power Magazine, Issue # 132 / Pgs# 68-75, Combiner
	 Boxes; L. Wilensky	
• Confirm the number and type of inverters	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 310; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
are appropriate for the application	 Mike Holt	
• Confirm the number and type of charge controllers	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 7 / Pgs# 181-186; Charge Controllers - Charge
are appropriate for the application	 Controller Types; J.P. Dunlop		
• Confirm that all overcurrent protection devices are	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 240; Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.6; Surge
appropriate for the application	 Protection Devices for PV Installations; Robert Schlesinger
• Confirm DC disconnect (s) are appropriate	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
for the application	 Mike Holt
• Confirm the AC disconnect(s) are appropriate	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
for the application	 Mike Holt				
• Confirm maximum allowable number of 	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
unprotected parallel strings	 Mike Holt				
• Confirm GFP devices are appropriate for the 	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
application	 Mike Holt
Additional useful references
• Match modules to inverters	 Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 1.1 ; Grid-Direct PV String Inverter Guide;
	 David Brearley, Joe Schwartz; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 2.1; Array to Inverter
	 Matching: Mastering Manual Design Calculations; John Berdner			
• Determine number of strings	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt				
• Select string combiners	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 2.3; Strategies for Making Common
	 Connections in PV Power Circuits; Tommy Jacoby, David Brearley; Solar Pro
	 Magazine; Issue # 4.2; DC Combiners Revisited; Marvin Hamon		
	
Verify System Design
References key: topic / name / detail / author
128 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
	
7. Review Wiring and Conduit Size Calculations
						
• Confirm conductor ampacity calculations	 NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 240, 310, and 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for
	 PV Systems; Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.3; Code-Compliant
	 Conductor Sizing;	Jason Sharpe
• Confirm conduit fill calculations	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 310; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Confirm conductor run distance	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 11 / Pgs# 290 - 295; Electrical Integration -
	 Conductor Ampacity/Voltage Drop; J.P. Dunlop
• Confirm appropriate conduit type(s)	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt			
• Confirm appropriate conductor insulation type(s)	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 310; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Confirm continuous current calculations	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt				
• Confirm continuous load calculations	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt				
• Confirm conditions of use calculations	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 310; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Confirm temperature de-rate calculations	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Confirm conductor de-rate calculations	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 310; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.3; Code-Compliant Conductor Sizing;
	 Jason Sharpe				
• Confirm voltage drop calculations	 Basic Electrical Theory, Mike Holt; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV
	 Systems	; Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.2; Voltage Drop in PV Systems;
	 Blake Gleason
• Confirm power loss calculations	 Basic Electrical Theory; Mike Holt; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV
	 Systems; Mike Holt
• Confirm appropriate grounding conductor type(s)	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt				
• Confirm circuit current calculations	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt				
• Confirm conduit size calculations	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt				
• Confirm grounding conductor sizing calculations	 NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 250 and 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV
	 Systems; Mike Holt
• Confirm thermal expansion calculations	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt	
Additional useful references
• Determine environmental condition of conduit	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
Verify System Design
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 129
References key: topic / name / detail / author
	
8. Review Overcurrent Protection Selection
			 			
• Confirm voltage specifications	 NFPA 70 NEC, Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Confirm compatibility with conductor size and type	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 240; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Confirm circuit currents calculations	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt				
• Confirm characteristics of existing electrical	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 1 - 4; Under standing NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
distribution system	 Mike Holt
• Confirm selection of overcurrent protection	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
device enclosures	 Mike Holt
• Confirm equipment limits of overcurrent protection 	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 240; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 2.3; Load Side Point of Interconnection -
	 Bus or Conductor Rating; John Wiles
• Confirm available fault currents 	 NFPA 70 NEC, Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Confirm voltage compatibility	 NFPA 70 NEC, Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Confirm disconnecting means type	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt				
• Confirm disconnecting means amperage rating	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Confirm temperature rating of device	 NFPA 70 NEC, Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt				
• Confirm terminal temperature limits of device	 NFPA 70 NEC, Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Confirm enclosure rating of device
• Confirm wire size limitations of device	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 310; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
Additional useful references						
• Determine disconnecting means location	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt	 	 		
	
9. Review Fastener Selection
						
• Confirm fastener sizes	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10 / Pgs# 274 - 277; Mechanical Integration -
	 Attachement Methods - Lags/Bolts/J Bolt; J.P. Dunlop; Home Power Magazine;
	 Issue # 100 / Pgs# 100-103; The Nuts and Bolts of Fasteners; M. Brown
• Confirm environmental conditions assessment	 Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.4; Lag Screws in Residential PV Installations
	 Mark Shelly	
• Confirm compatibility of fasteners to system	
• Confirm fastener types	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10 / Pgs# 274 - 277; Mechanical Integration -
	 Lag Screw/Bolts/J-Bolts/Self Balasting; J.P. Dunlop; Solar Pro Magazine;
	 Issue # 3.4; Lag Screws in Residential PV Installations; Mark Shelly
Verify System Design
References key: topic / name / detail / author
130 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
• Confirm pilot hole specifications	 Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.4 Page# 74; Lag Screws in Residential PV
	 Installations; Mark Shelly; Home Power; Issue # 144 Page# 94-99; Prepping for PV;
	 Johan Alfsen
• Confirm fastener assembly	 Home Power Magazine; Issue # 144 Page# 94-99; Prepping for PV; Johan Alfsen	
• Confirm structural characteristics of substrate						
• Confirm fastener pull-out strengths
• Confirm fastener removal
• Confirm mounting method	 Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.4; Lag Screws in Residential PV Installations;
	 Mark Shelly; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.1; Tile Roofing Systems; Johan Alfsen;
	 Home Power Magazine; Issue # 144 Page# 94-99; Prepping for PV; Johan Alfsen
• Confirm torque values				
• Confirm usage of appropriate auxiliary materials						
• Confirm weatherproofing materials	 Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 1.1; Pitched Roof Racking; S. Fain, D. Brearley;
for building penetrations	 Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.3; Low-Slope Roofs As PV System Platforms;
	 James R. Kirby; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.1 Page# 62-68; Tile Roofing Systems;
	 Johan Alfsen			
• Confirm pull-out loads	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10 / Page# 274; Mechanical Integration -
	 Allowable Withdrawl Loads; J.P. Dunlop			
• Confirm wind loading	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10 / Page# 280 - 281; Mechanical Integration -
	 Structural Analysis; J.P. Dunlop	
• Confirm shear loads
• Confirm shear strengths
• Confirm types of loads
• Confirm accuracy of bill of materials						
10. Review Plan Sets
						
• Confirm AHJ requirements	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 12 / Pgs# 344 - 346; Utility Interconnection -
	 Interconnect agreements, J.P. Dunlop
• Confirm accuracy of electrical one- or three-line diagram
• Confirm accuracy of site plan	 Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 2.5; Project Plan Sets; Ryan Mayfield	
• Confirm accuracy of system design
• Generate a safety plan	 Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.6; Implementing a successful safety program;
	 Karl Riedlinger
• Assemble manufacturer’s data sheets
• Create labeling schedule	 Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 13 / Pgs# 363 - 366; Permitting and Inspection -
	 Lables and Marking; J.P. Dunlop; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.2; PV System
	 Labeling: NEC, OSHA and ANSI Codes and Standards; Gernon Harvey	
• Assemble manufacturer’s instructions
• Note and address structural concerns
• Complete commissioning forms	 Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 2.6; PV System Commissioning; Blake Gleason
• Generate string diagram
Additional useful references
• Clarify design and OEM manuals	 Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.3; Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems;
	 Tobin Booth; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.1; PV Systems and Firefighter Safety:
	 A Proactive Approach; Dan Fink		
						
Verify System Design
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 131
References key: topic / name / detail / author
	
1. Conduct Pre-Construction Meetings
						
• Plan weather contingencies	 Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual;
	 Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE
• Verify site conditions match design	 Project Management for Construction: Fundamental Concepts for Owners,
	 Engineers, Architects and Builders; Chris Hendrickson & Tung Au;
	 3.8 Construction Site Environment
• Assemble workforce, including other trades as appropriate	 Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual; Section 4.2;
	 Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE 	 	 	
• Determine daily construction goals	 Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual;
	 Section 4.9; Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE; 	 	 	
• Communicate construction strategy to customer	 Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual;
	 Section 6.3; Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE;	 	 	
• Provide customer orientation	 Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual;
	 Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE	 	 	
• Communicate target pull-off time for crew	 Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual;
	 Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE 	 	 	
• Document safety plan	 OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart C; SolarPro 4.6 Implementing a Successful
	 Safety Plan; Karl Riedlinger; “Elements of a Successful Safety Program” Section
• Resolve scheduling conflicts	 Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual;
	 Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE; Section 4.9
• Ensure pre-construction commitments by customer are complete		
• Determine community issues	 Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual;
	 Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE		 	
• Determine customer requirements	 Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual;
	 Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE	 	 	
	
2. Secure Permits and Approvals
	
• Coordinate inspections	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 3.3
	 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth			
• Schedule inspections	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 3.3
	 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth
• Confirm job permits	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 3.3;
	 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth			
• Resolve AHJ conflicts	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 3.3; 	
	 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth	
• Submit plans to utilities	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13 p. 357-359;
	 SolarPro 2.5 Project Plan Sets; Ryan Mayfield; “Purpose and Benefits” Section
• Resolve utility conflicts	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 12 p. 342-346;
	 SolarPro 3.3 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth
• Obtain sign-off final building permit	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 3.3
	 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth
• Determine additional agency permits 	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 3.3;
(e.g., zoning, solar access, HOA, historic district)	 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth;
	 “Common Permitting Problems” Section
Managing the Project
References key: topic / name / detail / author
132 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Additional useful references
	 Taking the Red Tape out of Green Power: How to Overcome Permitting;
	 Obstacles to Small-Scale Distributed Renewable Energy;
	 Network for New Energy Choices, September 2008.			
• Secure written record of approval to interconnect	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 12 p. 344-346	
• Submit plans to building department	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 2.5
	 Project Plan Sets; Ryan Mayfield; SolarPro 3.3 Avoiding and Resolving PV
	 Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth; “Effective Solutions” Section	
• Submit plans to fire department	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 3.3
	 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth; “Effective Solutions”
	 section; SolarPro 3.3 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth;
	 “Effective Solutions” Section		
	
3. Manage Project Labor
						
• Coordinate with subcontractors	 SolarPro 3.6; Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Darlene McCalmont;
	 “Improving the Bottom Line” Section
• Determine order of tasks	 Guidelines for a Successful Construction Project; The Associated General
	 Contractors of America, 2008; C.3 Sequenced Project Schedules	
• Allocate resources	 SolarPro 3.6; Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Darlene McCalmont
• Supervise project crews
• Communicate aspects of safety plan	 SolarPro 4.6 Implementing a Successful Safety Plan; Karl Riedlinger;
	 “Elements of a Successful Safety Program” Section		
• Coordinate with other trades	 Guidelines for a Successful Construction Project; The Associated General
	 Contractors of America, 2008; A.1 Guideline on General Contractor-Subcontractor
	 Relations 		
• Orient contractors to job site conditions
• Track man hours
• Conduct toolbox talks						
• Resolve disputes 	 					
Additional useful references	 				 	
• Confirm insurance compliance	 SolarPro 3.4 Large-Scale PV Operations and Maintenance; Dave Williams;
	 Section on “Insurance”			
	
4. Adapt System Design
						
• Identify potential conflicts in design						
• Document changes to proposed design
• Maintain as-built documentation	 SolarPro 3.6; Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Darlene McCalmont
	 “Improving the Bottom Line” Section; SolarPro 2.6; PV System Commissioning;	
	 Blake Gleason; “Commissioning Tasks” Section	 		
• Submit modification proposals	 Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual;
	 Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE; Section 4.4			
• Acquire approvals to change design		 				
• Submit any change orders		 				
	
Managing the Project
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 133
References key: topic / name / detail / author
	
5. Manage Project Equipment		 				
• Take delivery of components	 Project Management for Construction: Fundamental Concepts for Owners,
	 Engineers, Architects and Builders; Chris Hendrickson & Tung Au
• Schedule deliveries	 Project Management for Construction: Fundamental Concepts for Owners,
	 Engineers, Architects and Builders; Chris Hendrickson & Tung Au
• Identify lifting and handling areas	 Guidelines for a Successful Construction Project; The Associated General
	 Contractors of America, 2008; C.4 Guideline on Site Logistics
• Perform equipment inspection
• Perform equipment maintenance
• State site equipment
• Schedule machinery	 Project Management for Construction: Fundamental Concepts for Owners,
	 Engineers, Architects and Builders; Chris Hendrickson & Tung Au
• Ensure equipment operator certification
• Install pedestrian barriers
Additional useful references			 			
• Prepare site storage facilities	 Guidelines for a Successful Construction Project; The Associated General
	 Contractors of America, 2008; C.4 Guideline on Site Logistics			
• Obtain temporary facilities	 Guidelines for a Successful Construction Project; The Associated General
	 Contractors of America, 2008; C.4 Guideline on Site Logistics			
• Maintain temporary facilities	 Guidelines for a Successful Construction Project; The Associated General
	 Contractors of America, 2008; C.4 Guideline on Site Logistics			
	
6. Implement a Site Specific Safety Plan			 			
	
• Perform hazard analysis	 SolarPro 4.6 Implementing a Successful Safety Plan; Karl Riedlinger	
	 “Elements of a Successful Safety Progam” Section; Solar Construction Safety	
	 Oregon Solar Energy Energy Industries Association, 2006; “General Jobsite Safety”
	 Section	
• Identify job site hazards	 SolarPro 4.6 Implementing a Successful Safety Plan; Karl Riedlinger; “Elements of
	 a Successful Safety Progam” Section; Solar Construction Safety; Oregon Solar
	 Energy Energy Industries Association, 2006. “General Jobsite Safety” Section	
• Implement ladder safety	 OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart X; laddersafety.org; American Ladder Institute
	 Solar Construction Safety; Oregon Solar Energy Energy Industries Association,
	 2006. “Ladder Safety” Section			
• Implement fall protection plan	 OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart M (1926.500 to 1926.503). Dunlop, Jim: Photovoltaic
	 Systems, Second Edition, 2010, J.P. Dunlop, Ch. 3 p. 62-63; Solar Construction
	 Safety; Oregon Solar Energy Energy Industries Association, 2006; “Fall Protection
	 and Jobsite Trip Hazards” Section	
• Execute electrical safety	 OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart K; “NFPA 70E Electrical Safety in the Workplace”;	
	 NFPA; Solar Construction Safety; Oregon Solar Energy Energy Industries
	 Association, 2006;	 “Solar Electrical Safety” Section	
• Select personal protective equipment (PPE)	 OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart E
• Develop site specific safety plan	 OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart C; The Importance of Site Specific Safety and Health
	 Management Plans; Garcia, Gabe. 2010; SolarPro 4.6
	 Implementing a Successful Safety Plan; Karl Riedlinger
Managing the Project
References key: topic / name / detail / author
134 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
• Implement vehicle safety	 OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart O
• Install site safety barriers	 OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart M			
• Identify access points to site						
• Identify site evacuation points	 OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart P; Emergency Exit Routes Fact Sheet; OSHA, 2003	
• Post hospital map routes						
• Post emergency contact numbers						
• Ensure material safety data sheets (MSDS) are on-site	 OSHA CFR 29 1926; 1910.1200(g)
• Post contingency plan		
Managing the Project
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 135
References key: topic / name / detail / author
	
1. Mitigate Electrical Hazards
				
• Implement the site safety plan				
• Implement the lock-out, tag-out procedures				
• Determine voltage levels of interconnections	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Maintain clear work area	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Clarify the maximum working voltage	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Select required PPE based on system design
(arc flash, shock, burn, voltage, etc.)			 	
• Disconnect all unnecessary live circuits	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Determine working clearances	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Demonstrate situational awareness				
• Measure voltage on equipment before proceeding with work					
• Inspect safety equipment						
• Inspect test equipment				
• Maintain safety equipment				
• Inspect hand and power tools
• Measure current on equipment before proceeding with work				
• Maintain hand and power tools
	
2. Install Grounding Systems
				
• Install module grounding	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Install inverter grounding	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Install mounting system grounding	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Ground all noncurrent-carrying metal parts	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Bond metallic raceways	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Install grounding electrode conductor	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Bond all electrical equipment	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250 and 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV
	 Systems	; Mike Holt
• Apply antioxidant material	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Prepare surfaces for electrical connections	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Make grounding electrode connection	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
Installing Electrical Components
References key: topic / name / detail / author
136 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
• Install grounding electrode(s)	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Install supplementary ground electrode	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Install system grounds	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Determine grounding conductor size	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250 and 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV
	 Systems	; Mike Holt
• Install DC ground-fault protection	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Locate underground hazards	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
	
3. Install Conduit and Raceways
				
• Plan conduit routing	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Penetrate building envelope	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;		
	 Mike Holt
• Support and secure conduit	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Tighten all fittings	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Select fittings according to application	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Install above ground electrical raceways	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 225; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Install conduit bushings	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;		
	 Mike Holt
• Make knockouts in electrical raceways	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;		
	 Mike Holt
• Install underground electrical raceways	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Remove sharp edges (deburr)	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; 	
	 Mike Holt
• Install service entry mast	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 230; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Locate underground utilities	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; 	
	 Mike Holt
• Create underground trenches	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;		
	 Mike Holt
• Backfill underground trenches	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;		
	 Mike Holt
• Mark underground cables	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;		
	 Mike Holt
• Mark underground trenches	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;		
	 Mike Holt
Installing Electrical Components
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 137
References key: topic / name / detail / author
	
4. Install Electrical Components
				
• Select location of DC disconnect	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Mount electrical enclosures	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;		
	 Mike Holt
• Install DC combiner	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Label equipment	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690 and 705; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV
	 Systems	; Mike Holt
• Install PV system disconnects	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Install inverter disconnects	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Install utility required disconnects	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 404; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Install array wiring transition box	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Install inverter	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Install underground electrical components	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; 	
	 Mike Holt
• Install AC combiner	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Install meter bases	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 312; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Select label materials	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Install junction boxes in the attic	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
	
5. Install Circuit Conductors
				
• Pull conductors	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Label conductors	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690 and 705; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV
	 Systems; Mike Holt
• Terminate conductors	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Wire the inverter	 NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 110, 300, 310; Understanding NEC
	 Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt
• Wire modules	 NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 110, 300, 310; Understanding NEC
	 Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt
• Select the correct wire type, color, and gauge	 NFPA 70 NEC; Table 310.104, 200.6, Table 310.15(B); Understanding
	 NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt
• Secure conductors	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; 	
	 Mike Holt
Installing Electrical Components
References key: topic / name / detail / author
138 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
• Measure wires						
• Set up the wire installation (tugger, fish tape, rope)				
• Test conductor installation	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Test DC source circuits				
• Test DC currents
• Set up pull stations	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; 	
	 Mike Holt
• Clear the electrical raceway
• Splice electrical conductors	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
	
6. Install Utility Interconnection
				
• Install over current protection device (OCPD)	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 240; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Install disconnects	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 404; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Test utility voltage				
• Coordinate AHJ inspection
• Verify fill rates				
• Terminate conductors	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Implement lock-out, tag-out procedures				
• Evaluate existing service entrance equipment	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 230; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Install generation metering	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 312; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Test conductor insulation	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt
• Select connection location
• Coordinate utility shutdowns				
• Coordinate with customers and other regarding shutdowns				
• Move existing circuits	 NFPA 70 NEC; NFPA 70E; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
	
7. Install System Instrumentation
				
• Test system
• Install power and energy metering	 NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 312; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Install data communication cables	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 800; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Install communication systems	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 800; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Install environmental sensors				
• Install controllers				
Installing Electrical Components
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 139
References key: topic / name / detail / author
• Install electrical sensors				
• Install inverter interface				
• Install power supply						
• Install battery temperature sensors						
• Install outlet for monitoring system	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapters 1 - 4; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
	
8. Install Battery Components
				
• Test each unit before placement (voltage, specific gravity, polarity)				
• Terminate fine stranded cables	 NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 110 and 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV
	 Systems; Mike Holt
• Install maintenance disconnect	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 480; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Confirm battery bank location	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 480; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Install battery enclosure	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 480; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Install battery enclosure venting				
• Install battery spill containment						
• Install batteries				
• Prepare battery terminals (e.g., clean)				
• Install battery interconnection conductors				
• Install battery units				
• Apply antioxidant compounds				
• Calculate ampacity	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 480; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt
• Install charge controller				
• Seal conduit entry to battery box				
• Label battery units				
• Label battery enclosure				
• Label battery room				
• Establish maintenance schedule				
• Test final assembled battery polarity and voltage				
• Install safety station				
Installing Electrical Components
References key: topic / name / detail / author
140 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Installing Mechanical Components						
	
1. Install Equipment Foundation						
	
• Locate center points of holes	 Concrete Principles; Chapter 5 page 136; Thomas P. Fahl
• Place anchor hardware
• Install grounding equipment conductor (GEC)	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt		
• Excavate to design specifications	 Concrete Principles; Chapter 10 page 293; Thomas P. Fahl		
• Build concrete forms	 Concrete Principles; Chapter 4 page 98; Thomas P. Fahl		
• Coordinate foundation inspections	 See Local Jurisdiction (City or County) Development Services		
• Identify location of underground utilities	 www.callbeforeyoudig.com, www.bluestake.com		
• Add structural reinforcement	 Concrete Principles; Chapter 4 page 93; Thomas P. Fahl		
• Install wire raceways	 NECA 101-2006 Standard for Installing Steel Conduit (Rigid, IMC, EMT) (ANSI)	
	 Published 2006		
• Place concrete to design specifications	 Concrete Principles; Chapter 7 page 182; Thomas P. Fahl		
• Place anchor hardware	 Geotechnical Engineering Foundation Design; page 210; John N. Cernica	
• Install driven posts	 Concrete Principles; Chapter 5 page 119; ; Thomas P. Fahl; Installation
	 specification for Driven Piles PDCA Specification; 103-07; Pile Driving
	 Contractors Association
• Strip concrete forms	 Concrete Principles; Chapter 7 page 197; Thomas P. Fahl		
• Backfill excavation	 Geotechnical Engineering Foundation Design; page 150; John N. Cernica	
• Place mounting posts	 Concrete Principles; Chapter 5 page 136; Thomas P. Fahl; Ground Trac Installation
	 Manual; Professional Solar Products
	
2. Install Mounting System						
	
• Install roof attachments	 Installing Solar Power; Gary Gerber; Journal of Light construction, Article
• Weatherproof penetrations	 Sealing and flashing metal roofs; Rob Haddock; Journal of Light construction,
	 Article
• Locate structural roof members	 SolarWedge XD Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products; Page 3	
• Determine array attachment locations	 SolarWedge XD Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products; Page 3	
• Install structural attachments	 SolarWedge XD Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products; Page 4	
• Install module support frame	 RoofTrac Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products		
• Install rack components	 RoofTrac Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products
• Locate array footprint	 RoofTrac Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products
• Confirm compatibility with existing roofing system	 Roofing Instant Answers; ISBN: 0071387129; Terry Kennedy	
• Plumb array structure	 Ground Trac Installation Manual; Proffesional Solar Products		
• Level array structure	 Point to Point Lasers; David Frane; Journal of Light construction, Article Ground
	 Trac Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products
• Apply corrosion protection to cut surfaces	 NECA 101-2006 Standard for Installing Steel Conduit (Rigid, IMC, EMT)
	 (ANSI); Published 2006
• Install tracking apparatus	 wattsun.com, Installation Guide AZ-225; Array Technologies; Pg. 6
	 zomeworks.com, Zomeworks F-series Track Rack installation manual; zomeworks
• Install actuator motors	 wattsun.com, Installation Guide AZ-225; Array Technologies, Pg. 9		
• Install supplementary structural supports	 ewpa.com
• Confirm row spacing	 Renewable and Efficient Electric Power Systems; pg. 391 - 408;
	 Gilbert M. Masters
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 141
References key: topic / name / detail / author
• Confirm structural analysis has been performed	 Should I Call and Engineer; Harris Hyman; Journal of Light construction,
	 Article	
• Install structural members	 Framing Flaws; Donald Cohen; Journal of Light construction, Article	
• Locate ballast for mounting system	 See Racking Manufacturer. 	
• Install seismic and wind loading	 Special Design Provisions for Wind and Seismic (SDPWS), 2005 Edition,
	 with Commentary	American Wood Council			
	
3. Install PV Modules
						
• Unpack PV modules						
• Stage PV modules
• Secure module wiring	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt				
• Inspect module for physical damage						
• Fasten modules to structure						
• Torque module fasteners						
• Confirm module frame grounding						
• Align modules aesthetically						
• Determine project workflow
• Test PV modules						
• Prep PV modules						
Installing Mechanical Components
References key: topic / name / detail / author
142 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Complete System Installation
	
1. Test the System							
	
• Verify mechanical connection integrity	 Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems; Section 1-e, Section 2-a, and
	 Section 2-d; Inspector Guidelines for PV Systems, Version 2.1, March 2006
	 Brooks Engineering; Section: Inspection Guidelines for all PV systems;	
	 A Guide to Photovoltaic (PV) Design and Installation, June 2001; California
	 Energy Commission (CEC); Section 4: Solar Electric (PV) System Installation
	 Checklist
• Verify system grounding	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690.41; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;	
	 Mike Holt				
• Verify electrical connection torque	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Mike Holt; Article 110.3(B; SUNNY BOY 8000TL-US/9000TL-US/10000TL-US -
	 Installation Guide version 1.1; SMA; Section 6.5.2,Section 6.5.3, Section 6.6.2
• Verify polarity	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14; Commissioning,
	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting; J.P. Dunlop A Guide to Photovoltaic (PV)
	 Design and Installation, June 2001: California Energy Commission (CEC)	
	 Section 4: Solar Electric (PV) System Installation Checklist; “Grid connected
	 photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation,
	 commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Section: 5.4.3
• Measure DC voltages (string, output)	 “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system
	 documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”;	
	 IEC; Section 5.4.4; A Guide to Photovoltaic (PV) Design and Installation, June 2001;
	 California Energy Commission (CEC); Section 4: Solar Electric (PV) System
	 Installation Checklist
• Verify inverter operation	 Inverter Manufacturer’s Instructional Manual; “Grid connected photovoltaic
	 systems – Minimum requirements for system; documentation, commissioning
	 tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”, IEC, Section 5.4.6, A Guide to
	 Photovoltaic (PV) Design and Installation, June 2001; California Energy
	 Commission (CEC); Section 4: Solar Electric (PV) System Installation Checklist
• Measure DC currents	 “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system
	 documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”;
	 IEC; Section 5.4.5	
• Compare measured values with expected values	 SP2.6-34 PV System Commissioning; Section: Performance Verificaiton;
	 Blake Gleason; “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements
	 for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0,
	 2009-05”; IEC; Section 5
• Measure AC system values	 “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system
	 documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”
	 IEC; Section 5.4.1
• Perform physical inspection	 Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems; Inspector Guidelines for PV Systems,
	 Version 2.1, March 2006; Brooks Engineering; Section: Inspection Guidelines for all
	 PV systems; A Guide to Photovoltaic (PV) Design and Installation, June 2001
	 California Energy Commission (CEC); Section 4: Solar Electric (PV) System
	 Installation Checklist
• Verify conduit fitting tightness	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110.3(B), Article 110.12			
• Verify conduit and wiring supports	 Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems; Section 1-b, Section 1-e; NFPA 70
	 NEC; Chapter 3				
• Verify workmanship	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110.12
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 143
References key: topic / name / detail / author
• Measure environmental levels	 SP2.6-34 PV System Commissioning; Section: Expected Performance; Blake Gleason
• Measure irradiance levels	 SP2.6-34 PV System Commissioning; Section: Expected Performance; Blake Gleason	
• Calculate expected electrical parameters	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; SP3.6-68 Array Voltage Considerations; Bill Brooks
	 Expedited Permit Process (www.solarabcs.org OR www.brooksolar.com);
	 Brooks Engineering; Section 5,Section 6, Section 7			
• Verify anti-islanding system	 “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system
	 documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC;	
	 Annex C, Model PV array test report			
• Test for ground fault	 SP2.5-60 PV System Ground Faults; Mync & Berdner
• Measure insulation resistance	 SP2.5-66 PV System Ground Faults, Mync & Berdner, Insulation Resistance Testing
	 - Application Note	Fluke http://support.fluke.com/find-sales/Download/
	 Asset/1579160_6115_ENG_C_W.PDF; “Grid connected photovoltaic systems –
	 Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and
	 inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Section 5.4.7
• Measure environmental levels
• Confirm phase rotation	 Satcon Installation Manual - PowerGate Plus 100; Satcon			
	
2. Commission the System							
	
• Turn on system	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning,
	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting; J.P. Dunlop; A Guide to Photovoltaic (PV)
	 Design and Installation, June 2001, California Energy Commission (CEC)	;
	 Section 4: Solar Electric (PV) System Installation Checklist; SUNNY BOY 8000TL-
	 US / 9000TL-US / 10000TL-US - Installation Guide version 1.1; SMA Section 7
• Initiate startup procedures per manufacturer instructions	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14; Commissioning,
	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting; J.P. Dunlop; Satcon Installation Manual
	 - PowerGate Plus 100; Satcon; SUNNY BOY 8000TL-US / 9000TL-US / 10000TL-
	 US - Installation Guide version 1.1; SMA; Section 7
• Program variable set points	 Inverter Manufacturer’s Instructional Manual; Outback Power GTFX and
	 GVFX Inverter/Charger Programming Manual			
• Measure all electrical parameters	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010, Chapter 14, Commissioning,
	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Measured Parameters; J.P. Dunlop;
	 SP2.6-34 PV System Commissioning, Blake Gleason; Section: Expected
	 Performance; “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for
	 system; documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”;	
	 IEC; Section: 5.4	
• Compare measured values to expected values	 SP2.6-34 PV System Commissioning; Section: Performance Verificaiton	“Grid
	 connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system
	 documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”;
	 Blake Gleason; IEC; Section: 5.4.5.3
• Monitor startup process	 SUNNY BOY 8000TL-US / 9000TL-US / 10000TL-US - Installation Guide
	 version 1.1, SMA, Section 7			
• Record anomalous conditions	 SP2.6-34 PV System Commissioning; Section: Commissioning Tasks;
	 Blake Gleason
• Document design changes	 Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems; Section 1-a; SP2.6-34 PV System
	 Commissioning; Section: Commissioning Tasks; Blake Gleason			
• Verify as-built documentation	 Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems; Section 1-a; SP2.6-34 PV System
	 Commissioning; Section: Commissioning Tasks; Blake Gleason			
Complete System Installation
References key: topic / name / detail / author
144 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
• Verify labeling accuracy	 NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 690 and 705; Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems	
	 Section 3; Brooks Engineering
• Note data and time of system startup	 Maintenance and Operation of Stand-Alone Photovoltaic Systems, December 1991
	 Section: 3.0 Inspection; SolarPro_2009_PV_Commissioning_Form; SolarPro	
• Repair anomalous conditions						
• Record environmental conditions	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning,
	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Measured Parameters; J.P. Dunlop; SP2.6-34;
	 PV System Commissioning; Section: Expected Performance; Blake Gleason	
• Record prior values on inverter
• Measure voltage of energy storage system	 Maintenance and Operation of Stand-Alone Photovoltaic Systems,
	 December 1991; Section: 3.0 Inspection
• Verify calculation of Total Solar Resource Fraction	 http://energytrust.org/trade-ally/programs/solar/resources/; Energy Trust of
	 Oregon	Solar Resource Tools; Solar Site Assessment: http://www.oregon.gov/
	 ENERGY/RENEW/Solar/docs/SunChart.pdf?ga=t; State of Oregon	
• Verify polarity of energy storage system	 Maintenance and Operation of Stand-Alone Photovoltaic Systems, December 1991
	 Section: 3.0 Inspection; Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010
	 Chapter 14, Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting; J.P. Dunlop
• Verify anti-islanding performance	 “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system
	 documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”;
	 IEC; Annex C, Model PV array test report			
• Record voltage of energy storage system	 Maintenance and Operation of Stand-Alone Photovoltaic Systems, December 1991
	 Section: 3.0 Inspection
			
	
3. Complete System Documentation							
	
• File project photographs	 SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Section: Process
	 Management; Darlene McCalmont
• Record component serial numbers	 SolarPro_2009_PV_Commissioning_Form; SolarPro; SP3.6-82 Operations
	 Management for Solar Integrators; Section: Process Management;
	 Darlene McCalmont
• Deliver as-built documents	 “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system
	 documentation, commissioning tests and inspection; Edition 1.0, 2009-05”
	 IEC; Section 4, SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Darlene
	 McCalmont; Section: Process Management
• File permits	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 13, Permitting and
	 Inspection; J.P. Dunlop; SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators;	
	 Section: Process Management; Darlene McCalmont
• Record certificates of inspection						
• File inspection forms	 SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Section: Process
	 Management; Darlene McCalmont
• File commissioning forms	 SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Section: Process
	 Management; Darlene McCalmont
• File data sheets	 “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system
	 documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”;	
	 IEC; Section 4.4			
• File proof of system test results	 “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system;
	 documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”;
	 IEC; Section 4.7	
Complete System Installation
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 145
References key: topic / name / detail / author
• Complete equipment warranty registration	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning,
	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop			
• Complete installation warranty registration	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010, Chapter 14, Commissioning,
	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop	
Additional useful references
• Complete O&M documentation	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning,
	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Maintenance; J.P. Dunlop; “Grid connected
	 photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation,
	 commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Section 4.6;	
	 SP3.4-48 Large-Scale PV Operations & Maintenance		
• Compile customer operations manual	 “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system
	 documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”;	
	 IEC; Section 4.6; SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators;
	 Section: Process Management; Darlene McCalmont		
	
4. Orient Customer to System							
	
• Explain startup and shutdown procedures	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning,
	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop 			
• Answer customer questions						
• Explain safety procedures to customer	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning,
	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop			
• Explain maintenance procedures	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning,
	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop
• Address customer concerns			
• Train customer on maintenance and	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning,
operation procedures	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop			
• Explain equipment clearance requirements	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010;
	 Chapter 13, Permitting and Inspeciton - Inspection; J.P. Dunlop			
• Perform customer walk-through	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning,
	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop
• Provide contact information to customer						
• Explain normal operational performance	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning,
	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop	
Additional useful references
• Deliver O&M documentation to customer	 Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning,
	 Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop; “Grid
	 connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system
	 documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”;	
	 IEC; Section 4.6; SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators;	
	 Section: Process Management; Darlene McCalmont		
Complete System Installation
References key: topic / name / detail / author
146 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
	
1. Perform Visual Inspection							
	
• Verify equipment grounding	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690.43; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed., Chapter 11
	 pgs. 311-313; J.P. Dunlop; IAEI NEWS; “Connecting to Mother Earth, May/June
	 2010”; John Wiles
• Inspect module mounting system	 Mounting System Safety and Installation Instructions; Unique to each
	 manufacturer; Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems v1.1 June 2010;
	 Section 1e, 2a,2d IREC/ B. Brooks			
• Identify hazards	 NFPA 70E NEC; Chapter 1; OSHA			
• Inspect weatherproofing systems	 Weatherproofing/Flashing System Safety and Installation Instructions; Unique to
	 each manufacturer; Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems v1.1 June 2010; 	
	 Section 1e, 2d; IREC/ B. Brooks; The NRCA Waterproofing Manual;
	 http://www.nrca.net	
• Inspect for wiring damage	 NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250; Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems v1.1
	 June 2010; Section 1b; IREC/ B. Brooks			
• Inspect module integrity	 NFPA 70E NEC; Chapter 1; PV Module listed Safety and Installation Instructions
	 Unique to each manufacturer; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 374-6;	
	 J.P. Dunlop	
• Check inverter status	 Inverter Installation and Operation Manual; Unique to each manufacturer
	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 385; J.P. Dunlop			
• Inspect electrical equipment	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 1-4, Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV
	 Systems; Mike Holt; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 13; J.P. Dunlop; NFPA
	 70E NEC; Article 100-250			
• Identify damage due to corrosion	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed., Chapter 14 pg. 374; J.P. Dunlop			
• Identify array shading	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 3 pg. 69-77; J.P. Dunlop 			
	 Home Power Magazine; Issue# 121 / Pgs# 88-90: Solmetric Suneye Solar Site
	 Evaluation tool; J. Schwartz			
• Identify array soiling	 PV Module listed Safety and Installation Instructions; Unique to each
	 manufacturer; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 373; J.P. Dunlop	
• Inspect cells for discoloration	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 374-6; J.P. Dunlop
	 PV Module datasheet; Unique to each manufacturer	
• Verify grounding system integrity	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690.41; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems;
	 Chapter 6; Mike Holt; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 13 pg. 362-363;
	 J.P. Dunlop
• Look for unsupported wiring	 NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 110, 300, 310, 338, 690; Field Inspection Guidelines for
	 PV Systems v1.1 June 2010; Section 1b; IREC/ B. Brooks; Understanding NEC
	 Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt	
• Identify damage to module glazing	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed., Chapter 14 pg. 374-6, J.P. Dunlop
• Document findings	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 390; J.P. Dunlop			
• Identify mismatched equipment	 System Labels, Manuals, As-built documents; Equipment and Job specific
	 Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems v1.1 June 2010; Section 4; IREC/
	 B. Brooks; Solar Pro Magazine; “Array to Inverter Matching: Mastering Manual
	 Design Calculations, Dec/Jan 2009 (Issue 2.1)”; J. Berdner
• Inspect for working clearances	 NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110.26; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems
	 Chapter 1; Inverter Installation and Operation Manual; Unique to each
	 manufacturer; Mike Holt
Maintenance & Troubleshooting
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 147
References key: topic / name / detail / author
• Identify electrical connections damage due to overheating	 “Tests and measurements for electrical fire prevention”; Fluke “Application
	 Note http://www.fluke.com/fluke/usen/community/fluke-news-plus/
	 articlecategories/safety/electrical+fire+prevention.htm”			
• Confirm equipment serial numbers	 As-built Documents; Job specific			
• Inspect module back skin	 PV Module listed Safety and Installation Instructions; Unique to each
	 manufacturer				
• Check conduit fitting tightness	 NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3			
• Inspect for evidence of animals	 Solar Pro Magazine, J. Berdner, P. Mync, PV System Ground Faults,
	 Aug/Sep 2009 (Issue 2.5)			
• Identify vegetation growth						
• Identify water ponding						
• Identify ice damage
						
	
2. Verify System Operation							
	
• Measure system electrical parameters	 NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250; Solar Pro Magazine; “PV System
	 Commissioning” Oct/Nov 2009; B. Gleason
• Document found electrical parameters	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 390; J.P. Dunlop			
• Calculate expected electrical parameters	 Solar Pro Magazine; “PV System Commissioning” Oct/Nov 2009; B. Gleason
• Compare expected parameters with as-found parameters	 Solar Pro Magazine; “PV System Commissioning” Oct/Nov 2009; B. Gleason
• Note anomalous conditions						
• Test system electrical equipment operations	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 372; J.P. Dunlop		
• Recommend corrective actions						
• Verify source circuits are connected	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 372; J.P. Dunlop
• Interview customer	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 372; J.P. Dunlop			
• Document customer’s concerns						
• Compare historical kWh performance 	 Solar Pro Magazine; “PV System Commissioning” Oct/Nov 2009; B. Gleason
against expected kWh performance						
• Measure equipment temperatures	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 372; J.P. Dunlop	
• Note inter-annual weather variability	
• Measure terminal temperatures	 NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250; Standard for Infrared Inspection of Electrical
	 Systems & Rotating Equipment; Infraspection Institute, 425 Ellis Street,
	 Burlington, NJ 08016 http://www.infraspection.com/useful_guidelines.html
	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 372; J.P. Dunlop
• Verify operation of battery venting systems	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 372; J.P. Dunlop		
• Verify battery auxiliary systems	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14; J.P. Dunlop
	
3. Perform Corrective Actions							
	
• Replace defective modules						
• Check equipment variable set points	 Original System Labels, O&M Manual, As-built documents; Job Specific	
	 Equipment Installation and Operation Manuals; Unique to each manufacturer	
• Perform scheduled maintenance	 Owners and Operations Manual; Job Specific			
• Replace frayed wires	 NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250; American Electricians’ Handbook, Division 2, 8, 9	
• Replace blown fuses	 NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-130, 225; Equipment Installation and Operation
	 Manual; Unique to each manufacturer			
Maintenance & Troubleshooting
References key: topic / name / detail / author
148 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
• Replace faulty components	 NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250; Equipment Installation and Operation Manual
	 Unique to each manufacturer			
• Locate ground faults	 NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250; Solar Pro Magazine; PV System Ground Faults,
	 Aug/Sep 2009 (Issue 2.5); J. Berdner, P. Mync		
• Repair ground faults	 NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250; Solar Pro Magazine; The Bakersfield Fire:
	 A Lesson in Ground-Fault Protection, Feb/Mar 2011 (Issue 4.2); B. Brooks
• Locate line to line faults	 NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250			
• Repair line to line faults	 NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250
• Document corrective actions	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 390; J.P. Dunlop
• Clean arrays	 PV Module listed Safety and Installation Instructions; Unique to each manufacturer
• Service ventilation systems	 NFPA 70E NEC; Article 240, 300-320; Home Power Magazine; John Meyer, Joe
	 Schwartz; Battery Box Basics, John Meyer, Joe Schwartz, Jun/Jul 2007 (#119)
	 pp. 50-55; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.;
	 Chapter 14; J.P. Dunlop
• Clean batteries	 NFPA 70E NEC; Article 240, 300-320; Home Power Magazine; Flooded Lead-Acid
	 Battery Maintenance, Dec/Jan 2004 (#98) pp. 76-79; Richard Perez
• Recalibrate equipment variable set points	 Equipment Installation and Operation Manuals; Unique to each manufacturer
	 Original System Labels, O&M Manual, As-built documents; Job Specific	
• Wipe down power conditioning equipment						
• Clean heat sinks	 Inverter Installation and Operation Manual; Unique to each manufacturer	
• Schedule manufacturer onsite service call			
• Seal compromised weatherproofing systems	 The NRCA Waterproofing Manual; NRCA; http://www.nrca.net; Roof
	 manufacturer’s maintenance and warranty requirements; Manufacturer specific
• Perform battery maintenance	 NFPA 70E NEC; Article 240, 300-320; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14
	 pg. 376-380; J.P. Dunlop
• Perform controlled overcharge	 Home Power Magazine; Flooded Lead-Acid Battery Maintenance, Dec/Jan 2004
	 (#98) pp. 76-79; Richard Perez			
• Clean system labeling						
• Replace system labeling	 NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 690 and 705; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 13
	 pg. 363-366; J.P. Dunlop; Original System Labels, Manuals, As-built documents
	 Equipment and Job specific	
	
4. Verify Effectiveness of Corrective Actions							
	
• Retest system operations	 Solar Pro Magazine; “PV System Commissioning” Oct/Nov 2009; B. Gleason
• Retest electrical parameters	 Solar Pro Magazine; “PV System Commissioning” Oct/Nov 2009; B. Gleason	
• Retest environmental conditions	 Solar Pro Magazine; “PV System Commissioning” Oct/Nov 2009; B. Gleason	
• Compare pre-maintenance values to post-maintenance values
• Retest weatherproofing system	 The NRCA Waterproofing Manual; NRCA http://www.nrca.net; Roofing/
	 flashing system installation and maintenance manuals; Manufacturer specific	
• Reorient customer to system	 Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 372; J.P. Dunlop			
Maintenance & Troubleshooting
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 149
References key: topic / name / detail / author
NABCEP PV Installer Resource GuideP a g e | 171
9 CASE STUDY EXAMPLES
9.1 Example 1: Grid-Direct String Inverter PV System Connected
to Load Side of Service Panel.
Module Ratings:
Inverter Ratings:
Location: Newark, New Jersey
Design questions:
1. What does the NEC consider the maximum voltage of this PV module at this location?
Temperature Coefficient for VOC = αVOC = -0.37%/C = -0.0037/C
Temperature Correction Factor = 1 + α VOC(%) x (TempLOW– TempRATING)
= 1 + (-0.0037/C) x (-15C – 25C)
= 1 + 0.148 = 1.148
Answer: Voc x Temp. Corr. Factor = 37.3V x 1.148 = 42.8V
2. What is the maximum number of modules that may be installed in series where all dc
equipment is rated for 600Vdc?
MAX POWER-POINT CURRENT (IMP)
MAX POWER-POINT VOLTAGE (VMP)
OPEN-CIRCUIT VOLTAGE (VOC)
SHORT-CIRCUIT CURRENT (ISC)
MAX SERIES FUSE (OCPD)
MAXIMUM POWER (PMAX)
MAX VOLTAGE (TYP 600VDC)
VOC TEMP COEFF (mV/o
C or %/o
C )
IF COEFF SUPPLIED, CIRCLE UNITS
7.79 A
29.5 V
37.3 V
8.41 A
15 A
230 W
600 V
-0.37
MODULE MAKE
MODULE MODEL
AMERICAN SOLAR
AS 230
1.) LOWEST EXPECT AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE MINIMUM MEAN
EXTREME DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO
INSTALLATION LOCATION. LOWEST EXPECTED AMBIENT TEMP ___-15_o
C
2.) HIGHEST CONTINUOUS AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE HIGHEST
MONTH 2% DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO
INSTALLATION LOCATION. HIGHEST CONTINUOUS TEMPERATURE __34_o
C
Case Study Examples
Example 1: Grid-Direct String Inverter PV System
Connected to Load Side of Service Panel.
References key: topic / name / detail / author
150 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
= 1 + (-0.0037/C) x (-15C – 25C)
= 1 + 0.148 = 1.148
Answer: Voc x Temp. Corr. Factor = 37.3V x 1.148 = 42.8V
2. What is the maximum number of modules that may be installed in series where all dc
equipment is rated for 600Vdc?
NABCEP PV Installer Resource GuideP a g e | 172
Answer: Max. Number of Modules = 600V ÷ 42.8 = 14.0214 modules
3. What is the Maximum System Voltage as defined by NEC 690.7?
Answer: Vmax(module) x # of modules in Series = 42.8V x 14 = 599.2 Volts
4. If the module degradation is -0.5%/year, minimum voltage of the inverter is 300 Vdc, and
the module Vmp temperature coefficient is -0.5%/°C, what is the minimum number of
modules in series that will keep the Vmp above 300Vdc in 20 years at a module
temperature of 65°C?
Step 1: What is the adjustment factor for Vmp after 20 years of degradation?
20 years of voltage loss @ -0.5%/year = 1+ (20 x (-0.5%)) = (1-0.1) = 0.9
Step 2: What is the adjustment factorfor Vmp from STC to 65°C?
Vmp Loss due to temperature @ 65°C = 1 +[(65°C - TSTC) x (-0.5%/°C)] = 1 +
[(65°C-25°C) x (-0.5%/°C)] = 1+ [40°C x (-0.5%/°C)] = 1 – 0.2 = 0.8.
Step 3: Apply both adjustment factors to Vmp
Vmp @ 20 years and 65°C = Vmp x 0.9 x 0.8 = 29.5V x 0.9 x 0.8 = 21.24V
Step 4: Divide adjusted Vmp into 300V to determine minimum number of modules.
Min. # of Modules = 300V ÷ 21.24V = 14.1214 modules (min & max the same)
5. The inverter recommend maximum STC Watts of modules is 9600 WSTC, what is the
maximum number of modules that can be installed on this inverter?
Answer: 9600W ÷ 230W = 41.74 42 modules
Note: the recommended max is not a hard limit—for low altitude coastal climates
like New Jersey, the amount of power loss from the array is small. Also, as the
array degrades, the amount of power limiting will be small.
6. What array configuration provides for the best utilization of the array and inverter power?
Answer: 3 strings of 14, which is 42 modules9660 WattsSTC of modules
Note: This is right at the recommended limit of array size for the inverter. Since
the inverter should only be configured with strings of 14 modules, an array with
2 strings of 14 modules only has a 6440 Watt array that would be more suited to
between a 5kW and 6 kW inverter. A location at higher elevation would favor a
6kW inverter with 2 strings of 14 modules.
7. The PV array is on detached garage structure so it is decided that a combiner box and
disconnect be mounted outside the garage accessible at ground level before proceeding to
the house where the inverter is mounted next to the main panel. What is maximum
current of the photovoltaic power source and what size wire should be run underground
to the inverter?
Answer: Imax = Isc x 3 x 1.25 = 8.41 A x 3 x 1.25 = 31.54 AmpsMinimum conductor
ampacity according to NEC 690.8(B)(2)(a) is Imax x 1.25 = 31.54 A x 1.25 = 39.4 A
Since the circuit is run underground  8 AWG will work for all terminal types.
8. At what distance does the wire run voltage drop equal 2% for maximum operating current
so that a larger size conductor should be considered for the wire run?
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 151
References key: topic / name / detail / author
to the inverter?
Answer: Imax = Isc x 3 x 1.25 = 8.41 A x 3 x 1.25 = 31.54 AmpsMinimum conductor
ampacity according to NEC 690.8(B)(2)(a) is Imax x 1.25 = 31.54 A x 1.25 = 39.4 A
Since the circuit is run underground  8 AWG will work for all terminal types.
8. At what distance does the wire run voltage drop equal 2% for maximum operating current
so that a larger size conductor should be considered for the wire run?
NABCEP PV Installer Resource GuideP a g e | 173
The maximum operating current = Imp x 3 = 7.79 Amps x 3 = 23.37 Amps = I in
equation. Solve for “d” in the equation below.
 
feetd
ftA
V
ftAdV
kftkftft
Id
Vnom
V
kftkftft
Id
V
V
V
nomnom
d
drop
132
/778.037.232
24020
/778.037.23224020
/1000
2
02.0
%100
/1000
2
%100%2%














 









 



9. What is the minimum ac breaker allowed for this inverter?
Answer: Min. Breaker = Inverter Max AC Current x 1.25 = 32 A x 1.25 = 40 A
10. What is the minimum size conductor before considering ambient temperature or voltage
drop issues?
Answer: Table 310.15(B)(16) 8 AWG has 40 Amp ampacity at 60°C and 50 Amp
ampacity at 75°C depending on the temperature rating of the circuit breaker. 10 AWG
will not work in either case.
11. How much annual energy is the PV system expected to produce if the system factor is
0.77, the average daily irradiation is 4.21 kWh/m2
/day?
Answer: Annual PV system production = Peak Sun Hours x Total Module STC rating x
System Factor
Annual solar irradiation = average daily irradiation x 365 days = 4.21 kWh/m2
/day x 365
days/year = 1536.65 kWh/m2
/year  equivalent to 1536.65 Peak Sun Hours @
1000W/m2
Total Module STC rating (in kilowatts) = (230WSTC x 42)÷(1000W/kW) = 9.66 kWSTC
= 1536.65 hours x 9.66 kWSTC x 0.77 = 11,430 kWh (check answer using PVWatts)
References key: topic / name / detail / author
152 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
NABCEP PV Installer Resource GuideP a g e | 174
Contractor Name,
Address and Phone:
Bill and Jim’s Solar
456 Joslin Drive
Cocoa, CA
800-555-1212
Bill
Jim
One-Line Standard Electrical Diagram
for Small-Scale, Single-Phase PV Systems
Site Name: Antonio & Maria Andretti
Site Address: 123 Sunny St, Newark, NJ
System AC Size: 7.68 kW Solar Array
SIZE FSCM NO DWG NO REV
E1.1 0
SCALE NTS Date: SHEET
Drawn By:
Checked By:
DESCRIPTION OR CONDUCTOR TYPE
USE-2 or PV WIRE
BARE COPPER EQ. GRD. COND. (EGC)
THWN-2 or XHHW-2 or RHW-2
THWN-2 or XHHW-2 or RHW-2
INSULATED EGC
DC GROUNDING ELECTRODE COND.
THWN-2 or XHHW-2 or RHW-2
INSULATED EGC
TAG
1
2
3
4
5
CONDUIT AND CONDUCTOR SCHEDULE
COND.
GAUGE
10 AWG
10 AWG
10 AWG
N/A
N/A
6 AWG
8 AWG
10 AWG
NUMBER OF
CONDUCTORS
8 BLACK
1 BARE CU
4-R, 4-W, 1-G
N/A
N/A
1 BARE CU
1-R, 1-B, 1-W
1 GREEN
CONDUIT
TYPE
N/A
N/A
EMT
N/A
N/A
EMT
CONDUIT
SIZE
N/A
N/A
¾"
N/A
N/A
¾"
DESCRIPTION
SOLAR PV MODULE
PV ARRAY
J-BOX (IF USED)
COMBINER (IF USED)
DC DISCONNECT
DC/AC INVERTER
GEN METER (IF USED)
AC DISCONNECT (IF USED)
SERVICE PANEL
TAG
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
PART NUMBER
AS 230
N/A
MFR-supplied
MFR-supplied
AI-7000
FORM 2S
D222NRB
SD200SL
NOTES
AMERICAN SOLAR, QUANTITY - 42 (SEE NOTES SHEET FOR DETAILS)
ARRAY IS 3 STRINGS WITH 14 MODULES PER SERIES STRING
6"x6"x4" NEMA 4, PVC JUNCTION BOX
15-A MAX FUSE W/15-A FUSES, 600VDC, 4-STRING MAX
LISTED WITH INVERTER, 600VDC, 60-AMP (SEE GUIDE APPENDIX C)
7000 WATT, SINGLE PHASE (SEE NOTES SHEET FOR DETAILS)
4-JAW, 240V CYCLOMETER REGISTER KWH METER IN 100-A BASE
240VAC, 60-AMP FUSED W/ 40-A FUSES (SEE GUIDE APPENDIX C)
240VAC, 200-A MAIN, 200-A BUS, 40-A INVERTER OCPD
(SEE NOTE 5 FOR INVERTER OCPDs, ALSO SEE GUIDE SECTION 9)
FOR UNUSED SERIES STRINGS
PUT "N/A” in BLANK ABOVE
SEE GUIDE APPENDIX C FOR
INFORMATION ON MODULE AND
ARRAY GROUNDING
___14___ MODULES IN
SERIES SOURCE-CIRCUIT
___14___ MODULES IN
SERIES SOURCE-CIRCUIT
___14___ MODULES IN
SERIES SOURCE-CIRCUIT
___N/A___ MODULES IN
SERIES SOURCE-CIRCUIT
DC DISCO
INVERTER
AC DISCO
AC
DC M
BUILDING
GROUNDING
ELECTRODE
G
Disregard if
provided with
inverter
COMBINER
M
UTILITY
SERVICE
MAIN SERVICE PANEL
MAIN
OCPD
INVERTER
OCPD
J‐BOX
1
1 3 4 5 6 7 9
2 3
4
5
82
EQUIPMENT SCHEDULE
Contractor Name,
Address and Phone:
Bill and Jim’s Solar
456 Joslin Drive
Cocoa, CA
800-555-1212
Bill
Jim
Notes for One-Line Standard Electrical
Diagram for Single-Phase PV Systems
Site Name: Antonio & Maria Andretti
Site Address: 123 Sunny St, Newark, NJ
System AC Size: 7.68 kW Solar Array
SIZE FSCM NO DWG NO REV
E1.2 0
SCALE NTS Date: SHEET
Drawn By:
Checked By:
MAX POWER-POINT CURRENT (IMP)
MAX POWER-POINT VOLTAGE (VMP)
OPEN-CIRCUIT VOLTAGE (VOC)
SHORT-CIRCUIT CURRENT (ISC)
MAX SERIES FUSE (OCPD)
MAXIMUM POWER (PMAX)
MAX VOLTAGE (TYP 600VDC)
VOC TEMP COEFF (mV/o
C or %/o
C )
IF COEFF SUPPLIED, CIRCLE UNITS
7.79 A
29.5 V
37.3 V
8.41 A
15 A
230 W
600 V
-0.37
MODULE MAKE
MODULE MODEL
AMERICAN SOLAR
AS 230
PV MODULE RATINGS @ STC (Guide Section 5)
MAX DC VOLT RATING
MAX POWER @ 40o
C
NOMINAL AC VOLTAGE
MAX AC CURRENT
MAX OCPD RATING
600 V
7680 W
240 V
32 A
50 A
INVERTER MAKE
INVERTER MODEL
AMERICAN INVERTER
AI‐7000
INVERTER RATINGS (Guide Section 4)
1) IF UTILITY REQUIRES A VISIBLE-BREAK SWITCH, DOES THIS SWITCH MEET THE
REQUIREMENT? YES NO N/A
2) IF GENERATION METER REQUIRED, DOES THIS METER SOCKET MEET THE
REQUIREMENT? YES NO N/A
3) SIZE PHOTOVOLTAIC POWER SOURCE (DC) CONDUCTORS BASED ON MAX
CURRENT ON NEC 690.53 SIGN OR OCPD RATING AT DISCONNECT
4) SIZE INVERTER OUTPUT CIRCUIT (AC) CONDUCTORS ACCORDING TO INVERTER
OCPD AMPERE RATING. (See Guide Section 9)
5) TOTAL OF ___1___ INVERTER OCPD(s), ONE FOR EACH INVERTER. DOES TOTAL
SUPPLY BREAKERS COMPLY WITH 120% BUSBAR EXCEPTION IN 690.64(B)(2)(a)?
YES NO
NOTES FOR INVERTER CIRCUITS (Guide Section 8 and 9):
1.) LOWEST EXPECT AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE MINIMUM MEAN
EXTREME DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO
INSTALLATION LOCATION. LOWEST EXPECTED AMBIENT TEMP ___-15_o
C
2.) HIGHEST CONTINUOUS AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE HIGHEST
MONTH 2% DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO
INSTALLATION LOCATION. HIGHEST CONTINUOUS TEMPERATURE __34_o
C
2.) 2005 ASHRAE FUNDAMENTALS 2% DESIGN TEMPERATURES DO NOT EXCEED
47o
C IN THE UNITED STATES (PALM SPRINGS, CA IS 44.1o
C). FOR LESS THAN 9
CURRENT-CARRYING CONDUCTORS IN ROOF-MOUNTED SUNLIT CONDUIT AT
LEAST 0.5" ABOVE ROOF AND USING THE OUTDOOR DESIGN TEMPERATURE OF
47o
C OR LESS (ALL OF UNITED STATES),
a) 12 AWG, 90o
C CONDUCTORS ARE GENERALLY ACCEPTABLE FOR MODULES
WITH Isc OF 7.68 AMPS OR LESS WHEN PROTECTED BY A 12-AMP OR SMALLER
FUSE.
b) 10 AWG, 90o
C CONDUCTORS ARE GENERALLY ACCEPTABLE FOR MODULES
WITH Isc OF 9.6 AMPS OR LESS WHEN PROTECTED BY A 15-AMP OR SMALLER
FUSE.
NOTES FOR ARRAY CIRCUIT WIRING (Guide Section 6 and 8 and Appendix E):
OCPD = OVERCURRENT PROTECTION DEVICE
NATIONAL ELECTRICAL CODE®
REFERENCES
SHOWN AS (NEC XXX.XX)
NOTES FOR ALL DRAWINGS:
SIGNS–SEE GUIDE SECTION 7
SIGN FOR DC DISCONNECT
SIGN FOR INVERTER OCPD AND AC
DISCONNECT (IF USED)
RATED MPP CURRENT
RATED MPP VOLTAGE
MAX SYSTEM VOLTAGE
MAX CIRCUIT CURRENT
19.6 A
430 V
599 V
26.5 A
PHOTOVOLTAIC POWER SOURCE
WARNING: ELECTRICAL SHOCK
HAZARD–LINE AND LOAD MAY BE
ENERGIZED IN OPEN POSITION
AC OUTPUT CURRENT
NOMINAL AC VOLTAGE
29 A
240 V
SOLAR PV SYSTEM
AC POINT OF CONNECTION
THIS PANEL FED BY MULTIPLE
SOURCES (UTILITY AND SOLAR)
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 153
References key: topic / name / detail / author NABCEP PV Installer Resource GuideP a g e | 175
9.2 Example 2: Grid-Direct Micro-Inverter PV System Connected
to Load Side of Service Panel.
Module Ratings:
Inverter Ratings:
Location: Chattanooga, Tennessee
Design questions:
1. What does the NEC consider the maximum voltage of this PV module at this location?
Temperature Coefficient for VOC = αVOC = -0.37%/C = -0.0037/C
Temperature Correction Factor = 1 + α VOC(%) x (TempLOW– TempRATING)
= 1 + (-0.0037/C) x (-12C – 25C)
= 1 + 0.1369 = 1.1369
Answer: Voc x Temp. Corr. Factor = 37.3V x 1.1369 = 42.4V
2. What is the maximum number of modules that may be installed in series where all dc
equipment is rated for 60Vdc?
Answer: Max. Number of Modules = 60V ÷ 42.4 = 1.411 module (microinverter)
3. What is the Maximum System Voltage as defined by NEC 690.7? Answer to #1
Answer: Vmax(module) x # of modules in Series = 42.4V x 1 = 42.4 Volts
4. What is the maximum number of microinverters per 20-amp ac breaker allowed?
MAX POWER-POINT CURRENT (IMP)
MAX POWER-POINT VOLTAGE (VMP)
OPEN-CIRCUIT VOLTAGE (VOC)
SHORT-CIRCUIT CURRENT (ISC)
MAX SERIES FUSE (OCPD)
MAXIMUM POWER (PMAX)
MAX VOLTAGE (TYP 600VDC)
VOC TEMP COEFF (mV/o
C or %/o
C )
IF COEFF SUPPLIED, CIRCLE UNITS
7.79 A
29.5 V
37.3 V
8.41 A
15 A
230 W
600 V
-0.37
MODULE MAKE
MODULE MODEL
AMERICAN SOLAR
AS 230
1.) LOWEST EXPECT AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE MINIMUM MEAN
EXTREME DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO
INSTALLATION LOCATION. LOWEST EXPECTED AMBIENT TEMP ___-12_o
C
2.) HIGHEST CONTINUOUS AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE HIGHEST
MONTH 2% DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO
INSTALLATION LOCATION. HIGHEST CONTINUOUS TEMPERATURE __34_o
C
	 Example 2: Grid-Direct Micro-Inverter PV System Connected to
	 Load Side of Service Panel.
References key: topic / name / detail / author
154 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
NABCEP PV Installer Resource GuideP a g e | 176
Answer: 20 Amp circuit breaker Maximum continuous current = 20A x 0.8 = 16A
Number of inverters = 16A ÷ Imax = 16A ÷ 0.83 A = 19 inverters
5. What is the minimum size ac conductor for 19 inverters where an 11-foot length of
conduit from the array contains 4 current carrying conductors, is mounted 1½” above the
roof, and is in direct sunlight?
Answer:
Conduit fill adjustment factor: Table 310.15(B)(3)(a)  4-6 conductors  0.8
Sunlit conduit temperature adder: Table 310.15(B)(3)(c)  ½” to 3½”  22°C
Temperature adjustment basis: 34°C (2% ASHRAE value) + 22°C = 56°C ambient temp.
Temperature adjustment factor: Table 310.15(B)(2)(a)  0.71 (90°C Column)
Table 310.15(B)(16) 12 AWG has 30 Amp ampacity at 90°C: With correction factors,
the ampacity of 12 AWG is: 30A x 0.8(conduit fill) x 0.71(ambient temp) = 17.04 Amps
It is permissible to protect this conductor with a 20-amp circuit breaker according to NEC
240.4(B). A larger conductor should be considered unless the run is extremely short.
6. At what distance does the wire run voltage drop equal 1% for maximum operating current
so that a larger size conductor should be considered for the wire run?
The maximum operating current = Imp x 19 = 0.83 Amps x 19 = 15.83 Amps = I in
equation. Solve for “d” in the equation below.
 
feetd
ftA
V
ftAdV
kftkftft
Id
Vnom
V
kftkftft
Id
V
V
V
nomnom
d
drop
38
/98.183.152
24010
/98.183.15224010
/1000
2
01.0
%100
/1000
2
%100%1%














 









 



38 feet for 12 AWG; 61 feet for 10 AWG; and 97.4 feet for 8 AWG
7. If the house can handle 38 modules, two full branch circuits, how much annual energy is
the PV system expected to produce if the system factor is 0.8, the average daily
irradiation is 4.75 kWh/m2
/day?
Answer: Annual PV system production = Peak Sun Hours x Total Module STC rating x
System Factor
Annual solar irradiation = average daily irradiation x 365 days = 4.75 kWh/m2
/day x 365
days/year = 1733.75 kWh/m2
/year  equivalent to 1733.75 Peak Sun Hours @
1000W/m2
Total Module STC rating (in kilowatts) = (230WSTC x 38)÷(1000W/kW) = 8.74 kWSTC
= 1733.75 hours x 8.74 kWSTC x 0.8 = 12,122 kWh (check answer using PVWatts)
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 155
References key: topic / name / detail / author
NABCEP PV Installer Resource GuideP a g e | 177
Contractor Name,
Address and Phone:
Bill and Ted’s Solar
456 Excellent Drive
Knoxville, TN
800-555-1212
Bill
Ted
One-Line Standard Electrical Diagram
for Micro-Inverter or AC Module PV Systems
Site Name: John and Jane Homeowner
Site Address: 123 Solar Dr., Chattanooga, TN
System AC Size: 7.6 KW
SIZE FSCM NO DWG NO REV
E1.1a 0
SCALE NTS Date: SHEET
Drawn By:
Checked By:
DESCRIPTION OR CONDUCTOR TYPE
USE-2 or PV WIRE
GEC EGC X ALL THAT APPLY
EXTERIOR CABLE LISTED W/ INV.
THWN-2 or XHHW-2 or RHW-2
GEC EGC X ALL THAT APPLY
NO DC GEC IF 690.35 SYSTEM
THWN-2 or XHHW-2 or RHW-2
GEC EGC X ALL THAT APPLY
TAG
1
2
3
4
5
CONDUIT AND CONDUCTOR SCHEDULE
COND.
GAUGE
MFG
6 AWG
MFG
10 AWG
8 AWG
8 AWG
8 AWG
NUMBER OF
CONDUCTORS
MFG Cable
1 BARE CU
MFG Cable
2-B, 2-R, 2-W
1 GREEN
1-R, 1-B, 1-W
1 GREEN
CONDUIT
TYPE
N/A
N/A
N/A
EMT
SAME
EMT
SAME
CONDUIT
SIZE
N/A
N/A
N/A
¾"
SAME
¾"
SAME
DESCRIPTION
PV DC or AC MODULE
DC/AC INVERTER (MICRO)
J-BOX (IF USED)
PV ARRAY
AC COMB. PANEL (IF USED)
GEN METER (IF USED)
AC DISCONNECT (IF USED)
SERVICE PANEL
TAG
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
PART NUMBER
AS 230
AI-200
N/A
SD125SL
FORM 2S
D222NRB
SD200SL
NOTES
AMERICAN SOLAR, QUANTITY - 20 (SEE NOTES SHEET FOR DETAILS)
200 WATT, SINGLE PHASE (SEE NOTES SHEET FOR DETAILS)
6"x6"x4" NEMA 4, PVC JUNCTION BOX
2,20-A AC CIRCUITS WITH 19 MICRO-INVERTERS PER CIRCUIT
240VAC, 125-A MAIN LUG PANEL W/ 30-A BREAKER AS MAIN
4-JAW, 240V CYCLOMETER REGISTER KWH METER IN 100-A BASE
240VAC, 30-AMP UNFUSED (SEE GUIDE APPENDIX C)
240VAC, 200-A MAIN, 200-A BUS, 30-A INVERTER OCPD
(SEE NOTE 5 FOR INVERTER OCPDs, ALSO SEE GUIDE SECTION 9)
FOR UNUSED MODULES
PUT "N/A” in BLANK ABOVE
1
1
3
2
3
EQUIPMENT SCHEDULE
2
__10__
MICRO-iNVERTERS
IN BRANCH-
CIRCUIT
MOD
__1__
DC
AC
MOD
__1__
DC
AC
MOD
__1__
DC
AC
MOD
__1__
DC
AC
MOD
__1__
DC
AC
MOD
__1__
DC
AC
J‐BOX
4
AC DISCO
M
BUILDING
GROUNDING
ELECTRODE
G
M
UTILITY
SERVICE
MAIN SERVICE PANEL
MAIN
OCPD
INVERTER
OCPD
6
7
8
5
4
5
G
SEE GUIDE APPENDIX D FOR
INFORMATION ON MODULE AND
ARRAY GROUNDING
AC COMBINER
PANEL
G
__19__
MICRO-iNVERTERS
IN BRANCH-
CIRCUIT
__19__
MICRO-iNVERTERS
IN BRANCH-
CIRCUIT
Contractor Name,
Address and Phone:
Bill and Ted’s Solar
456 Excellent Drive
Knoxville, TN
800-555-1212
Bill
Ted
Notes for One-Line Standard Electrical
Diagram for Single-Phase PV Systems
Site Name: Joe and Jane Homeowner
Site Address: 123 Solar Dr., Chattanooga, TN
System AC Size: 7.6 kW Solar Array
SIZE FSCM NO DWG NO REV
E1.2a 0
SCALE NTS Date: SHEET
Drawn By:
Checked By:
MAX POWER-POINT CURRENT (IMP)
MAX POWER-POINT VOLTAGE (VMP)
OPEN-CIRCUIT VOLTAGE (VOC)
SHORT-CIRCUIT CURRENT (ISC)
MAX SERIES FUSE (OCPD)
MAXIMUM POWER (PMAX)
MAX VOLTAGE (TYP 600VDC)
VOC TEMP COEFF (mV/o
C or %/o
C )
IF COEFF SUPPLIED, CIRCLE UNITS
7.79 A
29.5 V
37.3 V
8.41 A
15 A
230 W
600 V
-0.37
MODULE MAKE
MODULE MODEL
AMERICAN SOLAR
AS 230
PV MODULE RATINGS @ STC (Guide Section 5)
MAX DC VOLT RATING
MAX POWER @ 40o
C
NOMINAL AC VOLTAGE
MAX AC CURRENT
MAX OCPD RATING
60 V
200 W
240 V
0.83 A
20 A
INVERTER MAKE
INVERTER MODEL
AMERICAN INVERTER
AI‐200
INVERTER RATINGS (Guide Section 4)
1) IF UTILITY REQUIRES A VISIBLE-BREAK SWITCH, DOES THIS SWITCH MEET THE
REQUIREMENT? YES NO N/A
2) IF GENERATION METER REQUIRED, DOES THIS METER SOCKET MEET THE
REQUIREMENT? YES NO N/A
3) SIZE PHOTOVOLTAIC POWER SOURCE (DC) CONDUCTORS BASED ON MAX
CURRENT ON NEC 690.53 SIGN OR OCPD RATING AT DISCONNECT
4) SIZE INVERTER OUTPUT CIRCUIT (AC) CONDUCTORS ACCORDING TO INVERTER
OCPD AMPERE RATING. (See Guide Section 9)
5) TOTAL OF ___2___ INVERTER OUTPUT CIRCUIT OCPD(s), ONE FOR EACH MICRO-
INVERTER CIRCUIT. DOES TOTAL SUPPLY BREAKERS COMPLY WITH 120% BUSBAR
EXCEPTION IN 690.64(B)(2)(a)? YES NO
NOTES FOR INVERTER CIRCUITS (Guide Section 8 and 9):
1.) LOWEST EXPECT AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE MINIMUM MEAN
EXTREME DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO
INSTALLATION LOCATION. LOWEST EXPECTED AMBIENT TEMP ___-12_o
C
2.) HIGHEST CONTINUOUS AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE HIGHEST
MONTH 2% DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO
INSTALLATION LOCATION. HIGHEST CONTINUOUS TEMPERATURE __34_o
C
NOTES FOR ARRAY CIRCUIT WIRING (Guide Section 6 and 8 and Appendix E):
OCPD = OVERCURRENT PROTECTION DEVICE
NATIONAL ELECTRICAL CODE®
REFERENCES
SHOWN AS (NEC XXX.XX)
NOTES FOR ALL DRAWINGS:
SIGNS–SEE GUIDE SECTION 7
SIGN FOR DC DISCONNECT
SIGN FOR INVERTER OCPD AND AC
DISCONNECT (IF USED)
No sign necessary since 690.51
marking on PV module covers
needed information
AC OUTPUT CURRENT
NOMINAL AC VOLTAGE
31.7 A
240 V
SOLAR PV SYSTEM
AC POINT OF CONNECTION
THIS PANEL FED BY MULTIPLE
SOURCES (UTILITY AND SOLAR)
References key: topic / name / detail / author
156 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Sample NABCEP Exam Questions
The following questions are representative of the difficulty and scope of the type of
questions that are on the NABCEP PV Installer Exam. These questions are provided to
give those preparing for the exam an understanding of the type of questions that are
on the exam. There is no guaranty that any problems on the NABCEP exam will match
these questions.
1. A family of four is purchasing a 5 kW net-metered utility interactive PV system for
their house which is located at 30°N latitude. The family members are out of the home
regularly during the following hours:
	 Father: 9 am - 5 pm
	 Mother: 8:30 am - 12:00 pm
	 Children: 8:00 am - 3:00 pm
While the home is unoccupied, the energy use goes to near zero. There are no shade
issues at the property; competing installation costs are equal, and the year round
utility rate remains constant. Which of the following orientations will produce the
most annual utility savings?
a.)	 true south
b.)	 true southeast
c.)	 true southwest
d.)	 magnetic south
2. A PV array for a utility-interactive system is to be ground mounted on a hill 1,000 feet
from the point of utility connection. The single string of PV modules operates between
300 and 550 volts dc. The inverter is a 240 V inverter. There is a small building halfway
between the array location and the utility point of connection. To minimize wire size,
increase performance, and ensure consistent operation, where should the inverter be
installed?
a.)	 At the PV array
b.)	 At the midpoint building
c.)	 At the utility point of connection
d.)	 Midway between the PV array and the building
3. Of the following site assessment tools, which are MOST OFTEN NEEDED to
determine optimal array placement?
a.)	 compass, level, and anemometer
b.)	 compass, inclinometer, and irradiance meter
c.)	 compass, digital camera, and multimeter
d.)	 compass, inclinometer, and sun path analyzer
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 157
References key: topic / name / detail / author
4. What is the MOST IMPORTANT consideration for mounting PV arrays on residential
rooftops with regard to energy production?
a.)	 Cooling
b.)	 Shading
c.)	 Tilt angle
d.)	 Stand-off height
5. A homeowner wants a roof mounted solar array that produces 90% of the annual
household energy consumption of 6900 kWh. The roof has a pitch of 26° and is facing
true south. The array is mounted parallel to the roof. Given an 80% system efficiency, and
the information contained in the table below, what is the array STC rating required to
achieve 90% of the annual energy needs?
a.)	 4.25 kW
b.)	 4.43 kW
c.)	 4.92 kW
d.)	 5.15 kW
6. Which characteristic of a 500 V dc PV array gives it an advantage over a 48 V dc array
of the same wattage?
a.)	 Only one device is required for GFDI protection.
b.)	 Under low light conditions, the single source circuit configuration produces
	 more power.
c.)	 Smaller conductors can be used between the array and inverter.
d.)	 The maximum power tracking capability of the inverter is increased.
a.) 6.0 feet
b.) 7.8 feet
c.) 9.6 feet
d.) 15.6 feet
5. What is the MOST IMPORTANT consideration for mounting PV arrays on
residential rooftops with regard toenergy production?
a.) Cooling
b.) Shading
c.) Tilt angle
d.) Stand-off height
6. A homeowner wants a roof mounted solar array that produces 90% of the annual
household energy consumption of 6900 kWh. The roof has a pitch of 26° and is
facing true south. The array is mounted parallel to the roof. Given an 80% system
efficiency, and the information contained in the table below, what is the array STC
rating required toachieve 90% of the annual energy needs?
a.) 4.25 kW
b.) 4.43 kW
c.) 4.92.kW
d.) 5.15 kW
7. Which characteristic of a 500Vdc PV array gives it an advantage over a 48Vdc array
of the same wattage?
a.) Only one device is required for GFDI protection.
b.) Under low light conditions, the single source circuit configuration produces more
power.
c.) Smaller conductors can be used between the array and inverter.
References key: topic / name / detail / author
158 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
7. The battery bank for a battery backup utility-interactive PV system is located in
a harsh environment with temperature and humidity extremes. The system charge
controller has a provision for temperature compensation, but it is not connected.
What is the MOST LIKELY result on the battery state of charge?
a.)	 Overcharged in both hot and cold weather.
b.)	 Undercharged in both hot and cold weather.
c.)	 Overcharged in cold weather and undercharged in hot weather.
d.)	 Undercharged in cold weather and overcharged in hot weather.
8. What is the required minimum working space width in front of a 48 V lead acid
battery bank?
a.)	 24” where all live exposed parts are less than 60 V dc.
b.)	 30” inches or the width of the battery bank, whichever is greater.
c.)	 36” from the right and left edges of the battery bank.
d.)	 36” from the top of the ungrounded battery terminal.
9. A single inverter system requires 9 or 10 modules in series and one or two series
strings in parallel. If the southeast roof is large enough for 8 modules and the southwest
roof is large enough for 15 modules, which of the following array configurations results
in the MOST EFFICIENT use of the PV modules installed?
a.)	 15 modules on southwest roof and 5 modules on southeast roof
b.)	 12 modules on southwest roof and 8 modules on southeast roof
c.)	 10 modules on southwest roof and 5 modules on southeast roof
d.)	 10 modules on southwest roof and 0 modules on southeast roof
NABCEP Sample Questions: (1) a, (2) c, (3) d, (4) b, (5) b, (6) c, (7) d, (8) b, (9) d
Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 159
References key: topic / name / detail / author
One size dOesn’t fit all.
UsUally One size fits terrible.
Ever wonder why the other guys keep
telling you their product is right for every
application? It’s because they only make one
product. Trust the only company who can
tailor the right solution for any size project.
SMA. A perfect fit every time.
References key: topic / name / detail / author
160 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
Looking for High-Quality Technical Solar Content?
SolarPro sets the standard in technical publishing for the North American solar industry.
Each issue delivers a comprehensive perspective on utility, commercial and residential
system design and installation best practices.
Join our community of over 30,000 industry professionals.
Subscribe for free at solarprofessional.com/subscribe

More Related Content

PPS
Pcts Proj Service
PDF
Doing Too Much PM Report
PDF
Performance Testing in Context; From Simple to Rocket Science
PDF
9 system-sizing
PDF
Dacum technicales sales
PPTX
NABCEP Exam Prep Review for PV Installation & Tech Sales 
PDF
PVdepot.com Solar Installation Guide
PDF
Nabcep techincal-sales-jta-guide-9-30-10 web
Pcts Proj Service
Doing Too Much PM Report
Performance Testing in Context; From Simple to Rocket Science
9 system-sizing
Dacum technicales sales
NABCEP Exam Prep Review for PV Installation & Tech Sales 
PVdepot.com Solar Installation Guide
Nabcep techincal-sales-jta-guide-9-30-10 web

Similar to PC installation resource guide (20)

PDF
Inspecting Photovoltaic (PV) Systems for Code Compliance
PDF
Inspecting pv systems_for_code_compliance
PPTX
New Mexico Statewide Standards for Solar PV and Solar Thermal
PDF
Experience ImagineSolar: Hands-on Training at our Solar Lab | Online Solar & ...
PDF
Solar PV in building
PPTX
SESSION_1_-_MODULE_1.pptx
PPTX
Victor Valley College Photovoltaic Solar Technician Program 2014
PPTX
SESSION 1 - MODULE 1 (5).pptxhjhjhjgjggj
PPTX
PV_Installation_Presentationsolardomain.pptx
PPT
Njatc Pv Powerpoint Acte Naae
PDF
Grid+connect+pv+install+and+supervise+guidelines+cec+issue+9Grid-Connected So...
PDF
Expedited Explanation 8 24 09 Permitting Workshop
PDF
solar poly cell for builders oct2009.pdf
PDF
Builders utilize Solar Energy 2009
PDF
Solar p vforbuildersoct2009
PPT
PVAmerica-2013-Presentation-FINAL
PPT
Volunteer orientation -ba
PPT
Volunteer orientation -grid alternatives
PDF
Ifc+solar+report web+ 08+05
PDF
Solar Energy - A Complete Guide
Inspecting Photovoltaic (PV) Systems for Code Compliance
Inspecting pv systems_for_code_compliance
New Mexico Statewide Standards for Solar PV and Solar Thermal
Experience ImagineSolar: Hands-on Training at our Solar Lab | Online Solar & ...
Solar PV in building
SESSION_1_-_MODULE_1.pptx
Victor Valley College Photovoltaic Solar Technician Program 2014
SESSION 1 - MODULE 1 (5).pptxhjhjhjgjggj
PV_Installation_Presentationsolardomain.pptx
Njatc Pv Powerpoint Acte Naae
Grid+connect+pv+install+and+supervise+guidelines+cec+issue+9Grid-Connected So...
Expedited Explanation 8 24 09 Permitting Workshop
solar poly cell for builders oct2009.pdf
Builders utilize Solar Energy 2009
Solar p vforbuildersoct2009
PVAmerica-2013-Presentation-FINAL
Volunteer orientation -ba
Volunteer orientation -grid alternatives
Ifc+solar+report web+ 08+05
Solar Energy - A Complete Guide
Ad

Recently uploaded (20)

PDF
How to Get Funding for Your Trucking Business
PDF
TyAnn Osborn: A Visionary Leader Shaping Corporate Workforce Dynamics
PPT
Lecture 3344;;,,(,(((((((((((((((((((((((
PPTX
sales presentation، Training Overview.pptx
PDF
Comments on Crystal Cloud and Energy Star.pdf
PDF
Cours de Système d'information about ERP.pdf
PPTX
Slide gioi thieu VietinBank Quy 2 - 2025
PDF
SIMNET Inc – 2023’s Most Trusted IT Services & Solution Provider
PDF
Charisse Litchman: A Maverick Making Neurological Care More Accessible
PPTX
Astra-Investor- business Presentation (1).pptx
PDF
Outsourced Audit & Assurance in USA Why Globus Finanza is Your Trusted Choice
PDF
Tata consultancy services case study shri Sharda college, basrur
PDF
kom-180-proposal-for-a-directive-amending-directive-2014-45-eu-and-directive-...
PDF
Deliverable file - Regulatory guideline analysis.pdf
PPTX
svnfcksanfskjcsnvvjknsnvsdscnsncxasxa saccacxsax
PPTX
Board-Reporting-Package-by-Umbrex-5-23-23.pptx
PDF
IFRS Notes in your pocket for study all the time
PDF
NewBase 12 August 2025 Energy News issue - 1812 by Khaled Al Awadi_compresse...
PPTX
Negotiation and Persuasion Skills: A Shrewd Person's Perspective
PDF
ANALYZING THE OPPORTUNITIES OF DIGITAL MARKETING IN BANGLADESH TO PROVIDE AN ...
How to Get Funding for Your Trucking Business
TyAnn Osborn: A Visionary Leader Shaping Corporate Workforce Dynamics
Lecture 3344;;,,(,(((((((((((((((((((((((
sales presentation، Training Overview.pptx
Comments on Crystal Cloud and Energy Star.pdf
Cours de Système d'information about ERP.pdf
Slide gioi thieu VietinBank Quy 2 - 2025
SIMNET Inc – 2023’s Most Trusted IT Services & Solution Provider
Charisse Litchman: A Maverick Making Neurological Care More Accessible
Astra-Investor- business Presentation (1).pptx
Outsourced Audit & Assurance in USA Why Globus Finanza is Your Trusted Choice
Tata consultancy services case study shri Sharda college, basrur
kom-180-proposal-for-a-directive-amending-directive-2014-45-eu-and-directive-...
Deliverable file - Regulatory guideline analysis.pdf
svnfcksanfskjcsnvvjknsnvsdscnsncxasxa saccacxsax
Board-Reporting-Package-by-Umbrex-5-23-23.pptx
IFRS Notes in your pocket for study all the time
NewBase 12 August 2025 Energy News issue - 1812 by Khaled Al Awadi_compresse...
Negotiation and Persuasion Skills: A Shrewd Person's Perspective
ANALYZING THE OPPORTUNITIES OF DIGITAL MARKETING IN BANGLADESH TO PROVIDE AN ...
Ad

PC installation resource guide

  • 1. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 1 www.nabcep.org V.5.0 / 10.11 Prepared by: William Brooks, PE James Dunlop, PE Brooks Engineering Jim Dunlop Solar N A B C E P PV Installation Professional Resource Guide v.6/2013 www.nabcep.org Raising Standards. Promoting Confidence
  • 2. 2 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
  • 3. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 3 Thank you to our Resource Guide Sponsors Acknowledgements: NABCEP wishes to thank the companies and individuals who have made this Resource Guide possible. This document is the result of the efforts of its principal authors: Bill Brooks (Brooks Engineering) and Jim Dunlop (Jim Dunlop Solar). It is also the result of the tireless and myriad contributions of the Study Guide Committee. We are grateful to the following individuals for their contributions: Johan Alfsen (Quick Mount PV) Jason Fisher (SunPower Corp) Brian Goldojarb (Itron Corp) Mike Holt (Mike Holt Enterprises) Tommy Jacoby (Jacoby Solar Consulting) Mark Mrohs (EchoFirst) Mark Skidmore (Solon) Richard Stovall (SolPowerPeople, Inc.) We could not have produced a document of such high qual- ity without the support of our sponsors. We wish to thank the following companies who made financial contributions for the production of this guide: SMA Affordable Solar Quick Mount PV Solar Pro North Carolina Solar Center at NCSU North Carolina State University OnGrid Solar Renewable Energy World Solar Energy International Solectria, LLC Spec Tech Materials and Enclosures Stahlin Enclosures Morningstar Corporation Outback Power Renova Solar Non Endorsement Statement: The North American Board of Certified Energy Practi- tioners (NABCEP) does not assume any legal liability or responsibility for the products and services listed or linked to in NABCEP publications and website. Reference to any specific commercial product, process, or service by trade name, trademark, manufacturer, or otherwise, does not constitute or imply NABCEP’s endorsement or recommendation. NABCEP 56 Clifton Country Road, Suite 202 Clifton Park, NY 12065 800-654-0021 / info@nabcep.org www.nabcep.org Design: Brownstone Graphics / ALBANY, NY Forward/Scope This document was developed to provide an overview of some of the basic requirements for solar photovol- taic (PV) system installations and those who install them. Readers should use this document along with the 2011 National Electrical Code® (NEC® ), the governing building codes and other applicable standards. These codes and standards are referenced often throughout this document, and are the principal rules that govern the installation of PV systems and any other electrical equipment. A thorough understanding of these require- ments is essential for PV system designers and installers. This document is a collaborative effort, and is consid- ered a work in progress. Future editions of this guide will incorporate comments, corrections and new content as appropriate to reflect new types of products, instal- lation methods or code requirements. Public comments are welcomed and can be directed to the following: www.pvstudyguide.org. Units of Measure Both the International System of Units (SI) and the U.S./ Imperial customary units of measure are used through- out this document. While SI units are generally used for solar radiation and electrical parameters, U.S./Impe- rial customary units are used most commonly in the U.S. construction industry for weights or measure. PV professionals are expected to be comfortable with using both systems of measurement and converting between the two given the appropriate unit conversion factors.
  • 4. 4 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 1 Introduction.........................................................................8 2 Verify System Design...............................................10 3 Managing the Project................................................82 4 Installing Electrical Components.................93 5 Installing Mechanical Components.........104 6 Completing System Installation.................108 7 Conducting Maintenance and Troubleshooting Activities...............................113 8 Appendixes.......................................................................123 References..............................................................................123 Case Study Examples.......................................................149 Sample NABCEP Exam Questions..........................156 Table of Contents Welcome to the 2013-14 edition of the NABCEP Certified PV Installation Professional Study and Resource Guide. This edition follows the most recent version of the NABCEP PV Installation Professional Job Task Analysis, which can be found at www.nabcep.org. Over the years we have received many suggestions for improving our Resource Guide. We often receive suggested corrections to perceived inaccuracies in the copy. With the publication of the 2012 resource guide, NABCEP launched an on-line forum (www.pvstudyguide.org/) where comments and suggestions can be post- ed. NABCEP Study Guide Committee members monitor this forum. As a result, the newest edition of the PV Installation Professional Study Guide includes the most relevant and appropriate suggestions we have received. We think that this open comment approach ultimately improved the Study Guide and we hope that you will find the guide to be relevant and useful. We also hope that you will contribute to our online forum if you have suggestions for improving the 2013 version. We always welcome your thoughts and constructive feedback. As ever, we wish to remind all readers of this Study and Resource Guide that it is in no way intended to be the definitive word on PV installation and design. The guide is not intended to be viewed as the sole study resource for the NABCEP PV Installation Professional Certification Examination preparation. The text and the resources in the appendix of this document are an excellent starting point for candidates preparing for the exam, however all candidates should recognize that there are many other sources of good information on the topics covered by the JTA, and they should use them. You may also find a list of references on the “resource” page at nabcep.org. The preferred method of preparation for the NABCEP exam is to review the Job Task Analysis (Exam Blueprint) to see what areas in the body of knowledge are required to pass the exam, and do an honest and thorough self-evaluation to determine what areas you may need to study the most.
  • 5. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 5 What makes our Classic Comp Mount the industry’s most trusted protection against roof leaks? The QBlock Elevated Water Seal Our patented QBlock technology encloses the EPDM rubber seal – the ultimate barrier between the rafter and the rain –  inside a cast-aluminum block and raises it 7/10 of an inch above the flashing where the rainwater flows. This completely protects the rubber seal from the elements for the life of the solar array. 925-478-8269 www.quickmountpv.com MADEIN THEUSA See how our patented QBlock technology prevents future roof leaks at quickmountpv.com/noleaks Don’t risk disastrous roof leaks with inadequate solar mounting products and methods. Insist on Quick Mount PV and install it right – and enjoy peace of mind for the full life of every PV system you install. Rubber seal raised .7" above the flashing and rainwater above the flashing and rainwater
  • 6. 6 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6
  • 7. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 7 Introduction This Photovoltaic (PV) Installation Professional Resource Guide is an informational resource intended for individu- als pursuing the PV Installation Professional Certification credential offered by North American Board of Certified Energy Practitioners (NABCEP). This guide covers some of the basic requirements for the design and installation of PV systems. Additionally, it includes numerous references to books, articles, websites, and other resources. Individuals should use this guide in conjunction with other resources in preparation for the NABCEP exam. In order to qualify for the exam, candidates should first carefully read the NABCEP Certification Handbook, which outlines certain prerequisites for education, training, and system installation experience in a responsible role, to qual- ify for the certification exam. For further information on the certification program, and how to apply, and to download the latest NABCEP Certification Information Handbook, go to: http://www.nabcep.org/certification/how-to-apply-2. This guide is organized and closely associated with the NABCEP PV Installation Professional Job Task Analysis (JTA). The JTA outlines the expected duties of a qualified PV installation professional, and defines the general knowl- edge, skills, and abilities required of those who specify, install and maintain PV systems. The JTA is the basis for the NABCEP PV Installation Professional Certification pro- gram and examination content, and should be referenced often when reviewing this document. The JTA is available for download from the NABCEP website, at: http://www. nabcep.org/certification/pv-installer-certification. The objectives of this guide are to provide general informa- tion, and additional resources concerning the key areas of the JTA. Following are the major content areas addressed in the JTA and in this guide, which serve as the specification for developing the professional examinations. The percent- ages indicate the relative numbers of exam items based on each content area. • Verify System Design (30%) • Managing the Project (17%) JTA Job Description for NABCEP Certified PV Installation Professional Given a potential site for a solar PV system installation, and given basic instructions, major components, schematics, and drawings, the PV installation professional will: specify, adapt, implement, configure, install, inspect, and maintain any type of photovoltaic system, including grid- connected and stand-alone systems with or without battery storage, that meet the performance and reliability needs of customers by incorporating quality craftsmanship and complying with all applicable codes, standards, and safety requirements. • Installing Electrical Components (22%) • Installing Mechanical Components (08%) • Completing System Installation (12%) • Conducting Maintenance and Troubleshooting Activities (11%) This guide is not an all-inclusive or definitive study guide for the exam, and exam questions are not nec- essarily based on the contents in this resource guide. Sample problems and scenarios are presented solely for example purposes, and are not to be considered representative of exam questions. A limited number of actual exam items that have been retired from the item bank are contained at the end of this document.
  • 8. 8 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 PV systems are electrical power generation systems that produce energy. They vary greatly in size and their applica- tions, and can be designed to meet very small loads from a few watts or less up to large utility-scale power plants producing tens of megawatts or more. PV systems can be designed to supply power to any type of electrical load at any service voltage. The major component in all PV systems is an array of PV modules that produces dc electricity when exposed to sunlight. Other major components may include power conditioning equipment, energy storage devices, other power sources and the electrical loads. Power conditioning equipment includes inverters, chargers, charge and load controllers, and maximum power point trackers. Energy storage devices used in PV systems are mainly batteries, but may also include advanced technologies like flywheels or other forms of storing electrical energy or the product, such as storing water delivered by a PV water pumping system. Other energy sources coupled with PV systems may include electrical generators, wind turbines, fuel cells and the electric utility grid. See Fig. 1. Balance-of-system (BOS) components include all mechanical or electrical equipment and hardware used to assemble and integrate the major components in a PV system together. Electrical BOS components are used to conduct, distribute and control the flow of power in the system. Examples of BOS components include: • Conductors and wiring methods • Raceways and conduits • Junction and combiner boxes • Disconnect switches • Fuses and circuit breakers • Terminals and connectors • Grounding equipment • Array mounting and other structural hardware  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 2 PV System Components 1. PV modules and array 2. Combiner box 3. DC disconnect 4. Inverter (charger & controller) 5. AC disconnect 6. Utility service panel 7. Battery (optional) 1 2 3 4 5 7 6 An Introduction to Photovoltaic Systems Figure 1. - PV system components
  • 9. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 9 Types of PV systems are classified based on the loads they are designed to operate, and their connections with other electrical systems and sources. The specific components needed depend on the type of system and its functional and operational requirements. Stand-alone PV systems operate independently of other electrical systems, and are commonly used for remote power or backup applications, including lighting, water pumping, transportation safety devices, communications, off-grid homes and many others. Stand-alone systems may be designed to power dc and/or ac electrical loads, and with a few exceptions, use batteries for energy storage. A stand-alone system may use a PV array as the only power source, or may additionally use wind turbines, an engine- generator, or another auxiliary source. Stand-alone PV systems are not intended to produce output that operates in parallel with the electric utility system or other sources. See Fig. 2. Interactive PV systems operate in parallel and are intercon- nected and synchronized with the electric utility grid. When connected to local distribution systems, interactive systems supplement utility-supplied energy to a building or facility. The ac power produced by interactive systems either supplies on-site electrical loads or is back-fed to the grid when the PV system output is greater than the site load demand. At night, during cloudy weather or any other periods when the electrical loads are greater than the PV system output, the additional power required is received from the electric utility. Interactive PV systems are required to disconnect from the grid during utility outages or disturbances for safety reasons. Only special battery-based interactive inverters can provide stand-alone power for critical loads independent from the grid during outages. See Fig. 3. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar System Components and Configurations: 4 - 2 Figure 2. Stand-alone PV systems operate autonomously and are designed to meet specific electrical loads. DC LoadPV Array Battery Charge Controller Inverter/ Charger AC Load AC Source (to Charger Only) Figure 2. Stand-alone PV systems operate autonomously and are designed to meet specific electrical loads.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar System Components and Configurations: 4 - 3 Figure 3. Utility-interactive PV systems operate in parallel with the electric utility grid and supplement site electrical loads. Load Center PV Array Inverter AC Loads Electric Utility Figure 3. Utility-interactive PV systems operate in parallel with the electric utility grid and supplement site electrical loads. PV systems can be designed to supply power to any type of electrical load at any service voltage.
  • 10. 10 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 2. Verify System Design While the PV installer may not actually design PV systems, they must know how to interpret and review system designs and effectively execute the installation based on the plans. They must also be able to evaluate site issues affecting the design, identify discrepancies in the design or with code compliance, and recommend and implement appropriate corrective actions or alternatives. Experienced PV installers have a thorough understanding of system designs, including their major components, functions and installation requirements. 2.1 Determine Client Needs An accurate assessment of the customer’s needs is the starting point for specifying, de- signing and installing PV systems. Developing and planning PV projects requires an un- derstanding of the customer’s expectations from both financial and energy perspectives. Companies and individuals offering PV installation services must interpret the customer’s desires, and based on the site conditions, clearly explain the options, their trade-offs and costs. They must also explain the functions and operating principles for different types of PV systems, and estimate their performance relative to the customer’s electrical loads. Customer development includes addressing all other issues affecting the proposed instal- lation, such as applicable incentives, legal matters, location of equipment and appearance. Fundamentally, knowledge of the client’s needs and desires become the basis for prepar- ing proposals, quotations, and construction contracts. There are several public domain and commercial software resources available in the PV industry that address different aspects of project development and systems design. The capabilities of these tools range from simple solar resource and energy production es- timates, to site survey and system design tools, to complex financial analysis software. Some tools also provide assistance with rebate programs applications and tax incentives, while other programs and worksheets focus on the technical aspects of system sizing and design. The following lists some of the popular software tools used in the PV industry: Public Domain (NREL/DOE) • PVWATTS: www.nrel.gov/rredc/pvwatts/ • In My Back Yard (IMBY): www.nrel.gov/eis/imby/ • System Advisor Model (SAM): www.nrel.gov/analysis/sam/ NABCEP PV Technical Sales Certification The NABCEP PV Techni- cal Sales Certification is a credential offered for those specifically engaged in marketing and the customer development process for PV installations. Further infor- mation on this certification program is available on the NABCEP website: http://www.nabcep.org/ certification/pv-technical- sales-certification
  • 11. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 11 Commercial • Clean Power Estimator: www.cleanpower.com • PVSYST: www.pvsyst.com • OnGrid: www.ongrid.net • PVSol: www.solardesign.co.uk/ • PV F-Chart: www.fchart.com • Maui Solar Software: www.mauisolarsoftware.com/ • HOMER: www.homerenergy.com/ Manufacturers and Integrators • Inverter string sizing and various system sizing and design tools Assessing Energy Use Knowledge of the customer’s electrical loads and energy use are important considerations for any type of PV installation. The energy produced by PV systems will offset energy derived from another source, and represents a return on the customer’s financial investment. Be prepared to evaluate and discuss the customer’s energy use relative to the PV system options and their expected performance. This can be as simple as reviewing electrical bills for the past year or longer if available. See Fig 5. For new construction or off-grid applications, the energy use can be estimated from equipment ratings and expected load use profiles, but estimates can be highly inaccurate. Actual measurements are always preferred, and there are a number of low-cost electronic watt-hour meters available that can be readily installed to mea- sure specific loads, branch circuits or entire electrical services. Load information is used to size and design PV systems, estimate their performance and to conduct financial evaluations. For stand-alone PV applications, load energy consumption dictates the size and cost of the PV system required, and is a critical design parameter. For these systems, accurate load as- DSIRE Many websites provide information concern- ing local and state regulations for PV installations, including incentive programs, utility interconnection rules, and require- ments for contractor licensing, permitting and inspection. The Database of State Incentives for Renew- able Energy (DSIRE) is an excellent source for this information, and includes up-to-date summary information and numerous links to federal, state and local websites. For addition- al details, see: www. dsireusa.org Figure 4. The Database of State Incentives for Renewable Energy (DSIRE) contains information on rules, regulations and policies for renewable energy and energy efficiency programs in all states. Figure 5. Electric bills are reviewed as part of a site survey to evaluate customer energy use. System Components and Configurations: 4 - 5 Figure 5. Electric bills are reviewed as part of a site survey to evaluate customer energy use. sessments are a must. In many cases, a customer could have a greater benefit in changing equipment or practices to minimize their energy use, rather than installing a larger PV system to offset inefficient loads or habits. Interactive (grid-connected) PV systems may be designed to satisfy a portion of existing site electrical loads, but gen- erally no more than the total energy requirements on a net basis. Systems us- ing energy storage (batteries) for off-grid and utility back-up applications require a detailed load analysis, to adequately size the array, battery and inverter for stand-alone operation. Many PV system
  • 12. 12 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Power and Energy Basics An understanding of power and energy fundamentals is essential for the PV professional. Electrical power is expressed in units of watts (W): 1 megawatt (MW) = 1,000 kilowatts (kW) = 1,000,000 watts (W) Electrical energy is expressed in units of watt-hours (Wh): 1 kilowatt-hour (kWh) = 1000 Wh Power and energy are related by time. Power is the rate of transferring work or energy, and analogous to an hourly wage ($/hr) or the speed of a vehicle (mi/hr). Energy is the total amount of work performed over time, and analogous to total income earned ($) or distance traveled (mi). Simply stated, energy is equal to the average power multiplied by time: Energy (Wh) = Avg. Power (W) × time (hr) sizing worksheets and software tools incorporate means to input a given electrical load and estimate the PV to load energy contribution in the results. Electrical loads are any type of device, equipment or appliance that consumes electri- cal power. Electrical loads are characterized by their voltage, power consumption and use profile. Many types of electrical loads and appliances are available in high- efficiency models. Alternating-current (ac) loads are powered by inverters, generators or the utility grid. Direct-current (dc) loads operate from a dc source, such as a bat- tery. Some small off-grid PV system applications use only dc loads, and avoid having to use an inverter to power ac loads. 2.2 Review Site Survey Site surveys are used to collect information about the local conditions and issues affect- ing a proposed PV installation. This information is documented through records, notes, photographs, measurements and other observations and is the starting point for a PV project. Ultimately, information from site surveys is used in combination with the cus- tomer desires as the basis for preparing final quotations, system designs, and planning the overall installation. There are many aspects to conducting a thorough site survey. The level of detail depends on the size and scope of the project, the type of PV system to be installed, and where and how it will be installed. Greater considerations are usually associated with commercial projects, due to the larger equipment and increased safety hazards involved. Obtaining the necessary information during a site survey helps plan and execute PV installations in a timely and cost-effective manner. It also begins the process of assembling the system manuals and project documentation.
  • 13. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 13 A number of tools, measuring devices, special equipment and safety gear may be re- quired for conducting site surveys. See Fig. 6. Some of the basic equipment includes: • Appropriate PPE including hardhats, safety glasses, safety shoes, gloves and fall protection equipment • Basic hand tools, ladders, flashlights, mirrors and magnifying glasses • Tape measures, compasses, levels, protractors and solar shading calculators • Voltmeters, ammeters, watt and watt-hour meters, and power quality analyzers • Graph paper, calculator, audio recorders, cameras and electronic notebooks A PV installer must evaluate whether a proposed site will be suitable for the installation and proper operation of the system. In general, a site assessment involves determining: • A suitable location for the array • Whether the array can operate without being shaded during critical times • The mounting method for the array • Where the balance-of-system (BOS) components will be located • How the PV system will be interfaced with existing electrical systems 2.2.1 Array Location PV arrays can be mounted on the ground, rooftops or any other suitable support struc- ture. The primary considerations for optimal PV array locations include the following: • Is there enough surface area available to install the given size PV array? • Can the array be oriented to maximize the solar energy received? • Is the area minimally shaded, especially during the middle of the day? • Is the structure strong enough to support the array and installers? • How will the array be mounted and secured? • How far will the array be from other system equipment? • How will the array be installed and maintained?  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar System Components and Configurations: 4 - 6 Figure 6. A variety of tools and equipment may be required for a site survey. Figure 6. A variety of tools and equipment may be required for a site survey.
  • 14. 14 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 • Will the array be subjected to damage or accessible to unqualified persons? • Are there local fire codes or wind load concerns that limit rooftop areas for PV installations? • Are there additional safety, installation or maintenance concerns? The answers to these and other questions will help determine the best possible locations for installing PV arrays. There are many trade-offs, and designers and installers need to evaluate potential locations based on the site conditions and other available information, and determine if a PV installation is feasible. Array Area Individual PV module characteristics and their layout dictate the overall surface area required for a PV array with a specified peak power output rating. The surface area required for a given array depends on many factors, including the individual module dimensions, their spacing in the array, and the power conversion efficiency of the mod- ules used. Fire safety codes, wind loads and accessibility to the array for installation and maintenance must also be considered when evaluating suitable array locations and lay- outs, and may limit possible locations to install PV arrays. PV arrays installed in multiple rows of tilted racks or on trackers require additional spacing between each array mount- ing structure to prevent row to row shading. Power densities for PV arrays can vary between 6 and 15 watts per square foot (W/sf) and higher, depending on module efficiency and array layout. For example, the power density of a 175 watt crystalline silicon PV module with a surface area of 14.4 sf is calcu- lated by: 175 W ÷ 14.4 sf = 12.2 W/sf For a 4 kW PV array, the total module surface area required would be: 4000 W ÷ 12.2 W/sf = 328 sf This is approximately the area of 10 sheets of plywood. Additional area is usually required for the overall PV array installation and other equipment. All things considered, it usually takes about 80 to 100 sf of surface area for a 1 kWdc rated PV array using standard crystalline silicon PV modules. For example, assum- ing an array power density of 10 W/sf, a 1 MW PV array would require 100,000 sf of array area, slightly larger than two acres and the approximate size of the rooftops on big box retail establishments. See Fig. 7. Figure 7. For a power density of 10 watts per square foot, a 500 kW PV array can be installed in a 50,000 square foot area.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar System Components and Configurations: 4 - 7 Figure 7. For a power density of 10 watts per square foot, a 500 kW PV array can be installed in a 50,000 square foot area. 270 ft 370 ft Total roof area: 100,000 sq. ft.
  • 15. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 15 Sun Position and the Solar Window The location of the sun relative to any point on earth is defined by two ever-changing angles. The solar azimuth angle defines the direction of the sun’s horizontal projection relative to a point on earth, usually symbolized by the Greek letter Psi (c). For example, with compass headings, north is 0° or 360°, east is 90°, south is 180° and west is 270°. However, some solar equipment and computer programs use due south as the zero de- gree reference because it simplifies the complex equations used to calculate sun position. In these cases, solar azimuth angles west of south are typically represented by negative angles (due west is -90°), and east of south is represented as a positive angle (due east is +90°). The solar altitude angle defines the sun’s elevation above the horizon, and commonly symbolized by the Greek letter alpha (a). At sunrise and sunset, when the sun is on the horizon, the sun’s altitude is 0°. If the sun is directly overhead, then its altitude is 90° (at the zenith). The sun will be directly overhead at noontime some point during the year only between the Tropic of Cancer and Tropic of Capricorn. This range of tropical latitudes (23.45° north and south of the equator, respectively) is defined by the limits of solar declination and sun position, which also define the beginnings of the seasons. See Fig. 8. A sun path or sun position diagram is a graphical representation of the sun’s altitude and azimuth angles over a given day of the year, for the specified latitude. These charts can be used to determine the sun’s position in the sky, for any latitude, at any time of the day or year. Sun path diagrams are the basis for evaluating the effects of shading on PV arrays and other types of solar collectors. Typically, these charts include the sun paths for the solstices and at the equinoxes, and sometimes the average monthly sun paths or for different seasons. At the equinoxes, Figure 8. Sun position is defined by the azimuth and altitude angles. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 8 Figure 8. Sun position is defined by the azimuth and altitude angles. North West South East Zenith Horizontal Plane Altitude Angle Azimuth Angle Zenith Angle Solar Noon Solar noon is the local time when the sun is at its highest point in the sky and crossing the local meridian (line of longi- tude). However, solar noon is not usually the same as 12 p.m. local time due to offsets from Daylight Savings Time, and the site longitude relative to the time zone standard meridi- an, and eccentricities in the earth-sun orbit. A simple method to determine solar noon is to find the local sunrise and sunset times and calculate the midpoint between the two.
  • 16. 16 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 the sun paths are identical, and define the average sun path for the year. The equinox- es define the first days of spring and fall, and everywhere on earth, the sun rises due east and sets due west, and the sun is above the horizon for exactly 12 hours. On the equinoxes, the sun is directly overhead (solar altitude is 90°), at solar noon everywhere along the equator. A sun path chart shows all possible sun positions over a day and the year. See Fig. 9. This chart indicates that on the first day of winter (December 21), the sun rises at about 7 a.m. solar time and sets at about 5 p.m. On December 21, the sun’s highest altitude is about 37° at noontime. On March 21 and September 21, the first days of spring and fall, the sun rises at 6 a.m. at an azimuth of 90° and the highest sun altitude is 60° at solar noon. On June 21, the first day of summer, the sun rises at about 5 a.m., reaches a maximum altitude of about 83° and sets at about 7 p.m. At 9 a.m. on June 21, the azimuth is approximately 95° (slightly north of east) and the altitude is approximately 49° (about half way between the horizon and zenith). The winter and summer solstices define the minimum and maximum solar altitude angles and the range of sun paths over a year. For any location on earth, the maximum solar altitude at solar noon is a function of the solar declination and the local latitude. Since we know solar altitude at solar noon on the equator is 90° at the equinoxes, the solar altitude angle will be lower at higher latitudes by an amount equal to that lati- tude plus the solar declination. For example, at 40° N latitude on the winter solstice, the solar altitude angle at solar noon would be 90° - 40° + (-23.45°) = 26.55°. Converse- ly, on the summer solstice at the same latitude, the maximum solar altitude would be approximately 47° higher or about 73.5°, since the solar declination varies between ±23.45°. At the winter solstice, the sun is directly overhead along the Tropic of Capri- corn (23.45° S) at solar noon, and at the summer solstice, the sun is directly overhead along the Tropic of Cancer (23.45° N). See Figs. 10 a-c.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 9 Figure 9. A sun path chart shows the annual range of sun position for a given latitude. Sun Position for 30o N Latitude 8 AM 8 AM 8 AM 10 AM 10 AM 10 AM Noon Noon Noon 11 AM 11 AM 11 AM 1 PM 1 PM 1 PM 2 PM 2 PM 2 PM 4 PM 4 PM 4 PM 0 15 30 45 60 75 90 (180)(150)(120)(90)(60)(30)0306090120150180 << East (positive) << Azimuth Angle >> West (negative) >> AltitudeAngle(positiveabovehorizon) Winter Solstice Summer Solstice Vernal and Autumnal Equinox Figure 9. A sun path chart shows the annual range of sun position for a given latitude.
  • 17. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 17 The solar window represents the range of sun paths for a specific latitude between the winter and summer solstices. Wherever possible, PV arrays should be ori- ented toward the solar window for maximum solar energy collection. As latitudes increase to the north from the equator, the solar window is inclined at a closer angle to the southern horizon. The sun paths and days are longer during summer and shorter dur- ing winter. For any location, the maximum altitude of the sun paths at solar noon varies 47° between the winter and summer solstices. Figures 10a -10c. The solar window is defined by the limits of sun paths between the winter and summer solstices. Figure 10c. Figure 10b. Solar Declination Solar declination (d) is the ever changing angle between the earth’s equatorial plane and the sun’s rays. This is the primary geo- metric factor affecting the sun position and the solar energy received at any point on earth. Solar declination varies continuously from –23.45° to +23.45° over the year in a sinusoidal fashion, due the earth’s constant tilt and elliptical orbit around the sun. The limits of solar declination define the tropi- cal and arctic latitudes, and the range of sun position in the sky relative to any point on earth. The winter and summer solstices are defined by the minimum and maximum limits of solar declination, respectively. Solar declination is 0° at the equinoxes, when the earth’s equatorial plane is aligned directly toward the sun’s rays.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 11 Figure 10b. Winter Solstice Equinoxes Summer Solstice N W S E Zenith 47 Tropic of Cancer  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 12 Figure 10c. Winter Solstice Equinoxes Summer Solstice N W S E Zenith 47 47° N Figure 10a.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 10 Figure 10. The solar window is defined by the limits of sun paths between the winter and summer solstices. Winter Solstice Equinoxes Summer Solstice N W S E Zenith 47 Equator 2.2.2 Array Orientation PV arrays should be oriented toward the solar window to receive the maximum amount of solar radiation available at a site, at any time. The closer an array surface faces the sun throughout every day and over a year without being shaded, the more energy that system will produce, and the more cost-effective the PV system becomes with respect to alternative power options. Similar to sun position, the orientation of PV arrays is defined by two angles. The array azimuth angle is the direction an array surface faces based on a compass heading or relative to due south. North is 0° or 360°, east is 90°, south is 180° and west is 270°. Unless site shading or local weather patterns dictate otherwise, the optimal azimuth angle for facing tilted PV arrays is due south (180° compass heading) in the Northern Hemisphere, and due north in the Southern Hemisphere. The array tilt angle is the angle between the array surface and the horizontal plane. Generally, the higher the site latitude, the higher the optimal tilt angle will be to maximize solar energy gain. A horizontal
  • 18. 18 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 array has a zero degree tilt angle, and a vertical array has a 90° tilt angle. The array azimuth angle has no significance for horizontal arrays, because they are always oriented horizontally no matter how they are rotated. See Fig. 13. nlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 13 Figure 11. Magnetic compass readings must be corrected for magnetic declination. West East Geographic North South - 180 Magnetic North 270 90 0 180 Magnetic Declination (Positive, Eastern)  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 14 Figure 12. The western U.S. has positive (easterly) declination, and will cause a compass needle to point east of geographic north. USGS East Declination (positive) West Declination (negative) Figure 11. Magnetic compass readings must be corrected for magnetic declination. Figure 12. The western U.S. has positive (easterly) declination, and will cause a compass needle to point east of geographic north. For unshaded locations, the maximum annual solar energy is received on a surface that faces due south, with a tilt angle slightly less than the local latitude. This is due to longer days and sun paths and generally sunnier skies during summer months, especially at temperate lati- tudes. Fall and winter performance can be enhanced by tilting arrays at angles greater than the local latitude, while spring and summer per- formance is enhanced by tilting arrays at angles lower than the local latitude. Adjustable-tilt or sun-tracking arrays can be used to increase the amount of solar energy received on a daily, seasonal or annual basis, but have higher costs and complexity than fixed-tilt arrays.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 1 Figure 13. The orientation of PV arrays is defined by the surface azimuth and tilt angles. West North East South Zenith South-facing array Southwest-facing array Tilt Angle Azimuth Angle Surface Normal Surface Direction Figure 13. The orientation of PV arrays is defined by the surface azimuth and tilt angles. Magnetic Declination Magnetic declination is the angle between mag- netic north and the true geographic North Pole, and varies with location and over time. Magnet- ic declination adjustments are made when using a magnetic compass and with some solar shad- ing devices to accurately determine due south. Magnetic compasses and devices incorporating them usually have a revolving bezel to adjust for magnetic declination. See Fig. 11. Magnetic declination is considered positive when magnetic north is east of true north and negative when magnetic north is west of true north. The western U.S. has positive (easterly) declination, and the eastern U.S. has negative (westerly) declination. Magnetic declination is near zero on a line running through Pensacola, FL, Springfield, IL and Duluth, MN, called an agonic line. The greatest magnetic declination occurs in the northeastern and northwestern most parts of the U.S. and North America. For example, a compass needle points 15° east of geographic north in Central California. Con- versely, a compass needle points about 13° west of geographic north in New Jersey. In most of the central and southern U.S., magnetic declina- tion is small and can usually be neglected, espe- cially considering the small effects of changing array azimuth angle by a few degrees. See Fig. 12.
  • 19. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 19 Varying the array tilt angle results in significant seasonal differences in the amount of solar energy received, but has a smaller impact on the total annual solar energy received. See Fig 14. For stand-alone PV systems installed at higher than tropical latitudes, the optimal tilt angle can significantly reduce the size and cost of the system required to meet a given load. For systems that have winter-dominant loads, arrays should be tilted at an angle of latitude +15°. If the array is being designed to meet a summer-dominant load, the array should to be tilted at an angle of latitude –15° to maximize solar energy collection during summer months.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 16 Figure 14. Array tilt angle affects seasonal performance. West North East South Winter Solstice Equinoxes Summer Solstice Zenith Latitude+15 tilt maximizes fall and winter performance Close to Latitude tilt maximizes annual performance Latitude-15 tilt maximizes spring and summer performance Figure 14. Array tilt angle affects seasonal performance. The effects of non- optimal array orienta- tion are of particular interest to PV installers and customers, be- cause many potential array locations, such as rooftops do not have optimal solar orienta- tions. When trade-offs are being made be- tween orientation and aesthetics, having this information available can help the prospec- tive owner and in- staller make decisions about the best possible array locations and their orientation. Multiplication factors can be used to adjust PV system annual energy production for various tilt angles relative to the orientation that achieves the maximum annual energy production, and are region specific. See Table 1. These tables help provide a better un- derstanding of the impacts of array orientation on the amount of solar energy received, and the total energy produced by a PV system. In fact, the amount of annual solar energy received varies little with small changes in the array azimuth and tilt angles. For south-facing arrays, array tilt angles close to 30º (a 7:12 pitch roof) produce nearly the maximum amount of energy on an annual basis for much of the continental U.S. How- ever, arrays oriented within 45º of due south (SE and SW) produce very close to the same energy (within 7%) as a south-facing array. Since shading losses are often much higher, these orientation losses tend to be smaller than one might expect. Even horizontally mounted (flat) arrays will produce more energy than systems using tilted arrays facing to the east or west. For some utility-interactive PV system installations, it may be desirable to face an array toward the southwest or even due west, provided that the array tilt is below 45º. West-
  • 20. 20 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 erly orientations tend to shift the peak array power output to the afternoon during utility peak hours, but do not necessarily maximize the energy production or financial benefit to the system owner if they are not the utility. Some net metering programs offer time- of-use rate structures to encourage the production of energy during utility peak hours. A careful analysis using an hourly computer simulation program is necessary to determine the cost benefit of these orientations. A minimum of six hours of unshaded operation is still important for best system performance. Note: The tables and charts showing the effects array orientation on the solar energy received and the energy produced by PV arrays were derived with data generated from PVWatts running simulations for various locations with different array tilt and azimuth angles. Table 1. Array orientation factors can be used to adjust the maximum available solar radiation for non-optimal orientations.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 18 Figure 16. PVWatts is an online tool used to estimate the performance of interactive PV systems. NREL PVWatts™ PVWatts™ is an online software model produced by the National Renewable Energy Laboratory to estimate the performance of grid-connected PV systems. See Fig 16. The user defines the site location, the maximum power for the PV array, the array mount- ing and orientation, and selects the appropriate derating factors. The software models the PV system output at each hour over a typical year, using archived solar resource and weather data. This tool can be used to evaluate the solar energy collected and energy produced by grid-tied PV systems for any location and for any array azimuth and tilt angles. To run PVWatts™ online, see: http://rredc.nrel.gov/solar/calculators/PVWATTS/version1/. Figure 16. PVWatts is an online tool used to estimate the performance of interactive PV systems.
  • 21. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 21 Contour charts may also be used to plot similar data comparing the effects of array orientation on the amount of solar energy received. See Fig. 15. These charts clearly show that for lower latitudes and array tilt angles closer to horizontal, array azimuth angles as much as 90º from due south have a minimal effect on the solar energy received. The reduction in solar energy received for off-azimuth orientations increases with increasing tilt angles and at higher latitudes. Generally, for most of the central and southern U.S., fixed-tilt arrays with azimuth angles ±45 degrees from due south and tilt angles ±15 of the local latitude will receive at least 90% of the annual solar energy as for optimally tilted south-facing surfaces. 2.2.3 Perform a Shading Analysis A shading analysis evaluates and quantifies the impacts of shading on PV arrays. Shad- ing may be caused by any obstructions in the vicinity of PV arrays that interfere with the solar window, especially obstructions to the east, south and west of an array. This includes trees, towers, power lines, buildings and other structures, as well as obstruc- tions close to and immediately around the array, such as antennas, chimneys, plumbing  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 17 270 240 210 180 150 120 90 0 15 30 45 60 Azimuth (deg) Tilt(deg) Available Irradiation (% of maximum) 95-100 90-95 85-90 80-85 75-80 70-75 270 240 210 180 150 120 90 0 15 30 45 60 Azimuth (deg) Tilt(deg) Available Irradiation (% of maximum) 95-100 90-95 85-90 80-85 75-80 70-75 Miami, FL Boston, MA Figure 15. The effects of varying array tilt and azimuth angles are location dependent. Figure 17. Shading of PV arrays can be caused by any obstructions interfering with the solar window.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 1 Figure 17. Shading of PV arrays can be caused by any obstructions interfering with the solar window. LADWP vents, dormer windows and even from other parts of the array itself. See Fig 17. Shading of PV arrays can also be caused by accumulated soiling on the array surface, which can be particularly severe in more arid regions like the western U.S., requiring regular cleaning to en- sure maximum system output. PV arrays should be unshaded at least 6 hours during the middle of the day to produce the maximum energy possible. Ideally, there should be no shading on arrays between the hours of 9 a.m. and 3 p.m. solar time over the year, since the majority of solar radiation and peak system output occur during this period. However, this is not always achievable and tradeoffs are made concern- ing the specific array location, or mitigating the shad- ing obstructions if possible (e.g., trimming or removing
  • 22. 22 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 trees, etc.). Even a small amount of shading on PV arrays during peak generation times can dramatically reduce the output of the system. Sun path charts are the basis for conducting shading evaluations. By measuring the worst-case altitude and azimuth angles of a shading object from an array location, a scale image of the obstruction can be plotted on a sun position chart for the given latitude. This shows the portion of the solar window that is obstructed by shading. Knowing the amount of receivable solar energy during different periods of a day, the shading analysis can be used to estimate the reduction in solar radiation received during the shaded times of the day and year, and ultimately estimate the reduced energy production for a PV system. These are the fundamental principles used for a shading analysis. Most system design and performance estimating tools also incorporate shading factors to derate the system output accordingly.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 20 Figure 18. Various devices are used to determine the extent of shading for potential PV array locations. Solar Pathfinder Solmetric SunEye Wiley ASSET Figure 18. Various devices are used to determine the extent of shading for potential PV array locations. To simplify shading evaluations, several devices and software tools have been com- mercially developed. See Fig. 18. These devices are all based on sun path charts and viewing the solar window at pro- posed array locations. The devices project or record obstructions in the solar window, and estimate the net solar energy received after shading. PV installers should be familiar with these tools, their principles of operation and how to obtain accurate results. More elaborate architectural software tools, such as Google Sketch-up and CAD programs can allow designers to simulate complex shading problems and provide detailed designs and renderings of proposed PV installations. Sources for shading evaluation tools and software include: • Solar Pathfinder™: www.solarpathfinder.com • Solmetric SunEye™: www.solmetric.com • Wiley ASSET™: www.we-llc.com • Google SketchUp™: sketchup.google.com For larger PV systems with multiple parallel rows one in front of another in the array, one row of modules can shade the one in back during winter months if the rows are too closely spaced. A six-inch shadow from an adjacent row of modules is capable of shutting down an entire string or row of modules depending on the direction of the shadows and the electrical configuration of the array. A simple rule for minimum spacing between rows is to allow a space equal to three times the height of the top of the row or obstruction in front of an array. This rule applies to the spacing for any obstructions in front of an array.
  • 23. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 23 For example, if the height of an array is three (3) feet, the minimum separation distance should be nine (9) feet since the height of the adjacent row if it is three feet above the front of the next row. See Fig. 19. In the southern half of the United States, a closer spac- ing may be possible, depending on the prescribed limits to avoid shading. However, even at the lowest latitudes the spacing should not be less than two times the height of the top of the adjacent module. Multiple rows of PV arrays can also be more closely spaced using lower tilt angles, and even with the orientation penalty of a lesser tilt angle, it is usually a better option than to suffer shading losses. The minimum required separation distances between PV array rows and other obstruc- tions depends on latitude, the height of the obstruction, and the time of day and year that shading is desired to be avoided. To avoid shading at the winter solstice between  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 21 Figure 19. Multiple rows of rack-mounted PV arrays must be separated far enough apart to prevent shading. D Sun PV Array H β Figure 19. Multiple rows of rack-mounted PV arrays must be separated far enough apart to prevent shading.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 22 Figure 20. The minimum required separation distances between PV array rows and other obstructions depends on latitude, the height of the obstruction, and the time of day and year. D Separation Factor vs. Latitude for South-Facing Array Rows To Avoid Shading on Winter Solstice at Specified Solar Time 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 Latitude (deg N) SeparationFactor,Distance/Height(D/H) 8 am - 4 pm 9 am - 3 pm 10 am - 2 pm 11 am - 1 pm Figure 20. The minimum required separation distances between PV array rows or other obstructions depends on latitude, the height of the obstruction, and the time of day and year to avoid shading. 9 a.m. and 3 p.m. solar time, the separation distance between PV arrays and ob- structions should be at least 2 times the height of the ob- struction at latitudes around 30°, 2-1/2 times the height at latitudes around 35°, 3 times the height at 40° latitude and 4 times the height at 45° latitude. See Fig. 20.
  • 24. 24 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 2.2.4 Array Mounting Methods PV arrays can be mounted on the ground, rooftops and other structures that provide adequate protection, support and solar access. The site conditions usually dictate the best mounting system location and approach to use. Rooftops are very popular locations for installing PV arrays. Because they are elevated, roof mounts offer some physical protection and limited access to the array for safety, and usually provide better sun exposure. Rooftop PV installations also do not occupy space on the ground that might be needed for other purposes. Rooftop and other building- mounted PV arrays must be structurally secured and any attachments and penetrations must be properly weathersealed. Available rooftop areas for mounting PV arrays may be limited by any number of factors, including required spaces about the array for instal- lation and service, pathways and ventilation access for fire codes, wind load setbacks, and spaces for other equipment. Sloped roofs also present a significant fall hazard, and require appropriate fall protection systems and/or personal fall arrest systems (PFAS) for installers and maintenance workers. The layout of a PV array can have a significant effect on its natural cooling and operating temperatures. A landscape (horizontal) layout may have a slight benefit over a portrait (vertical) layout when considering the passive cooling of the modules. Landscape is when the dimension parallel to the eaves is longer than the dimension perpendicular to the eaves. In a landscape layout, air spends less time under the module before escap- ing and provides more uniform cooling. Standoff mounts operate coolest when they are mounted at least 3 inches above a roof. Key items to evaluate during a site survey for roof-mounted PV arrays include: • Building type and roof design • Roof dimensions, slope and orientation • Roof surface type, condition and structural support • Fall protection methods required • Access for installation and maintenance   Ground-mounted PV arrays are commonly used for larger systems, or where rooftop in- stallations are not possible or practical. Ground-mounts can use a variety of racks, poles and other foundations to support the arrays. Ground-mounted arrays are generally more susceptible to damage than roof-mounted arrays, although their location and orientation is less constrained than for rooftop installations. If an array is mounted at ground level, NEC 690.31(A) requires that the wiring be protected from ready access. Several options may be possible to meet this requirement, including protecting the wiring with non- conductive screening like PVC, limiting access with security fencing, or by elevating the array. Elevating arrays also provides physical protection, and usually helps avoid shad- ing concerns that may exist at lower heights. Site surveys for ground-mounted PV arrays should consider: • Zoning and land use restrictions
  • 25. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 25 • Terrain, elevations and grading requirements • Soil type and array ground-cover • Water table, flood zones and drainage • Array foundation requirements • Security requirements and fencing • Access for vehicles, equipment and maintenance The following are common types of PV array mounting systems: Integral mounting systems are where modules are integrated into the roofing or building exterior. These systems are sometimes referred to as building-integrated PV or BIPV. Standoff mounting, referred to by some as flush mounting, uses standoffs attached to the roof to support rails on which PV modules are attached. This is the most common method for residential installations. See Fig. 21. Figure 21. Standoff mounts are the most common way PV arrays are attached to sloped rooftops.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 23 Figure 21. Standoff mounts are the most common way PV arrays are attached to sloped rooftops. Gary Lee Sharp Solar op Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 23 Figure 21. Standoff mounts are the most common way PV arrays are attached to sloped rooftops. y Lee Sharp Solar  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 23 Figure 21. Standoff mounts are the most common way PV arrays are attached to sloped rooftops. Gary Lee Sharp Solar Ballasted mounting systems are often used in large-scale flat roof commercial projects. These mounting systems require engineering for roof structural loading and ballast re- quirements. Often roof tethers augment the ballast for seismic concerns or excessive wind requirements. See Fig. 22.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 24 Figure 22. Self-ballasted PV arrays are a type of rack mount that relies on the weight of a the PV modules, support structure and additional ballast material to secure the array. Ascension Technology University of Wyoming  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 24 Figure 22. Self-ballasted PV arrays are a type of rack mount that relies on the weight of a the PV modules, support structure and additional ballast material to secure the array. Ascension Technology University of Wyoming  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 24 Figure 22. Self-ballasted PV arrays are a type of rack mount that relies on the weight of a the PV modules, support structure and additional ballast material to secure the array. Ascension Technology University of Wyoming Figure 22. Self-ballasted PV arrays are a type of rack mount that relies on the weight of a the PV modules, support structure and additional ballast material to secure the array. Rack mounting is typically used for non-tracking systems at ground level and on flat rooftops. This method is typical on large commercial or utility-scale arrays. Pole mounting, is typically used with manufactured racks mounted on top or attached to the side of a steel pole. Pole-top arrays are common for off-grid residential PV systems,
  • 26. 26 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 since the weight of the array is balanced over the pole, allow- ing easy seasonal adjustment. Side-of-pole mounts are most common in small one- or two- module applications where the entire system, such as remote telemetry application, is mount- ed on a single pole. See Fig. 23. Tracking mounting systems are systems that follow the sun on a daily or seasonal basis. Track- ing may increase summer gain by 30% or more, but winter gain may be 15% or less. Tracking may be two-axis for maximum performance or single-axis for simplicity and reliability. See Fig. 24.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 25 Figure 23. Pole-mounted arrays use either fixed, adjustable, or sun-tracking arrays installed on a rigid metal pipe.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 26 Figure 24. Sun-tracking arrays are typically mounted on poles and increase the amount of solar energy received. NREL, Warren Gretz Figure 24. Sun-tracking arrays are typically mounted on poles and increase the amount of solar energy received. Roof Structure and Condition An important consideration for roof-mounted PV arrays is to assess the condition of the roofing system and determine whether the roof and its underlying structure can support the additional load. Structural loads on buildings are due to the weight of building materials, equipment and workers, as well as contributions from outside forces like hydrostatic loads on founda- tions, wind loads and seismic loads. The requirements for determining structural loads on buildings and other structures are given in the standard ASCE 7 – Minimum Design Loads for Buildings and other Structures, which has been adopted into the building codes. A structural engineer should be consulted if the roof structure is in question, or if specific load calculations are required for local code compliance. Common stand-off roof-mounted PV arrays, including the support structures generally weigh between 3 and 5 pounds per square foot (psf), which should be fine for most roofs designed to recent standards. Generally, houses built since the early 1970’s have been through more rigorous inspection and tend to have more standard roof structures than those built prior to that period. If the attic is accessible, a quick inspection of the type of roof construction is worthwhile, and will help determine the appropriate attachment
  • 27. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 27 system to use for the array. Span tables are available in various references, which can help quantify the load-bearing capabilities of roof trusses or beams. For further information see: www.solarabcs.org/permitting Wind loads are a primary concern for PV arrays, especially in hurricane-prone regions. The design wind loads for PV arrays in some Atlantic and Gulf coastal re- gions can exceed 50 PSF and greater on certain portions of a roof or structure. While common stand-off PV arrays do not generally contribute to any additional wind loads on a structure, the array attachment points to the structure or foundation must be of sufficient strength to withstand the design loads. For example, a 15 square-foot PV module could impose an uplift load of 750 pounds under a design load of 50 psf. A panel of four of these modules can impose a load of 3,000 pounds on the entire mounting structure. If the panel is secured by six roof attachments, and if the forces are distributed equally, there would be a 500-pound force on each attachment, and it must be designed and installed to resist this maxi- mum uplift force. Several manufacturers of roof mounting systems provide engi- neering analysis for their mounting systems and attachment hardware. Without this documentation, local inspectors may require that a custom mounting system have a structural analysis from a professional engineer for approval. This engineering documentation easily justifies the additional costs of purchasing mounting hard- ware from a qualified mounting system manufacturer.   The age and condition of the roof covering must also be evaluated. If the roof cover- ing is due for replacement within the next 5 to 10 years, it typically makes sense to roof the building before installing the PV system, as the array would need to be removed and replaced before and after the roofing work.Different types of roof coverings have different lifetime expectations and degradation mechanisms, and wherever roofing issues are a concern for PV installation, it is highly advisable to engage a licensed roofing contractor in the project. Before recommending or deciding on any PV array mounting system, verify with the mounting system supplier that the hardware is appropriate for the given ap- plication.Also, it is generally not advisable to try to fabricate or copy a mounting system design for smaller projects. This usually costs much more than purchasing a pre-engineered system, and may not meet the structural or environmental require- ments of the application. PV array mounting structures also must be electrically connected to the equipment grounding system, and special bonding jumpers and connectors are available to maintain electrical continuity across separate structural components. Oftentimes, local jurisdictions require engineering documentation to certify the structural integrity of the mounting system and attachments. Commercial Roof Mounting Options PV arrays are mounted on large commercial buildings with flat composition roofs using a variety of racking systems. These mounting structures may be secured by fasteners and physical attachments to the building structure, or by using ballasted racking, or a combination of both to hold the array in place.
  • 28. 28 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Ballasted mounting systems are significantly heavier than mounting systems de- signed for direct structural attachments, depending on the weight of ballast used, and usually require special load calculations. The main advantages of ballasted mounts include easier installation, and by eliminating direct structural attachments and penetrations into the structure, the possibility of roof leaks is greatly dimin- ished. Ballasted mounting systems are engineered for specific wind loads and roof structures, and have very specific requirements on how to install the array. Even when wind loading is not a concern, additional restraints may be required on ballasted arrays for seismic loads.   2.2.5 BOS Locations Any site survey also includes identifying proposed locations for all BOS compo- nents, including inverters, disconnects, overcurrent devices, charge controllers, batteries, junction boxes, raceways, conductors and any other electrical apparatus or mechanical equipment associated with the system. The PV installer must ensure that all equipment locations are suitable for the intended equipment. Considerations for BOS locations include providing for accessibility to the equip- ment for installation and maintenance. Some BOS components may need to be installed in weather-resistant or rain-tight enclosures if they are not installed in- doors. Other components, including many utility-interactive inverters, may already be rated for wet and outdoor locations. Minimum clearances and working spaces are required for electrical equipment that may be serviced in an energized state. Dedi- cated clear spaces are also required above and in front of all electrical equipment. These and many other installation requirements are outlined in Article 110 of the NEC: Requirements for Electrical Installations. Avoid installing electrical equipment in locations exposed to high temperatures and direct sunlight wherever possible, and provide adequate ventilation and cooling for heat-generating equipment such as inverters, generators and chargers. Consid- erations should also be taken to protect equipment from insects, rodents, and other debris. All electrical equipment must be properly protected from the environment unless the equipment has applicable ratings. This includes protection from dust, rain and moisture, chemicals and other environmental factors. All electrical equipment contains instructions on the proper installation of the equipment, and for the environmental conditions for which it is rated. Some equipment has special considerations, covered under different sections of the electrical and building codes, and in manufacturer’s instructions. For example, bat- tery locations should be protected from extreme cold, which reduces their available capacity. Battery containers and installation must follow the requirements in NEC 480. Major components are generally located as close together as possible, and to the electrical loads or services that they supply, in order to minimize the length of conductors, voltage drop and the costs for the installation.
  • 29. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 29 2.3 Confirm System Sizing 2.3.1 Size the Module Mounting Area If a roof is selected for the array location, then it is necessary to determine whether the roof is large enough for the proposed number of PV modules. For roof areas with non- rectangular shapes, determining the amount of useable roof area can be a challenge. When laying out a plan for mounting modules on a roof, access to the modules must be provided for maintenance. For easiest access, a walkway should be provided between rows of modules. However, this consumes valuable roof area, so a balance needs to be made between the area for the array and access. New requirements in the 2012 Inter- national Fire Code [IFC 605.11] require clear space at the edges and peaks of roofs for firefighter access. This poses a challenge to roof-mounted PV systems. Often, only 50% to 80% of the roof area that has a suitable orientation can be used for mounting modules when room for maintenance, wiring paths, firefighter access and aesthetic considerations are taken into account. To determine the size of the PV array (ultimately the power rating of the system) that can be installed, the usable roof area must be first established. The dimensions and orien- tation of individual modules may allow various layouts for the array that ultimately need to fit within the usable areas of the roof. The location of structural attachments, the desired electrical configuration, and wire routing are also important considerations when determining the best layout. Computer-aided drawing tools can be helpful in determin- ing possible acceptable array layouts given module and roof dimensions. Smaller array surface areas are required to generate the same amount of power with higher efficiency modules. By definition, a 10% efficient PV module has a power density of 100 W/m2 (approximately 10 W/sf) peak power output when exposed to 1000 W/m2 solar irradiance. Crystalline silicon PV modules may have efficiencies 12% to 15% and higher for special higher-price models. Higher efficiency modules means less support structure, wiring methods and other installation hardware are required for an array. Most thin-film PV module technologies have efficiencies below 10%, and require correspond- ingly larger array areas to produce an equal amount of power. For example, consider a roof with overall dimensions of 14’ by 25’ (350 sf) with a usable area of 250 sf (71% of total). This roof area would be sufficient for a 2.5 kW crystalline silicon array (250 sf x 10 W/sf= 2500 W) or an 8% efficient thin film array of about 2 kW. 2.3.2 Arrange Modules in Mounting Area Siting the PV array in the available mounting area can have a large impact on the per- formance of a PV array. In addition to shading and orientation, the array layout must be consistent with the electrical string layout. A string is a series-connection of PV modules in an array. Each set of modules in a series string must be oriented in the same direction if the string is to produce its full output potential. For example, if a string has 12 modules in series, all 12 modules must be in the same or parallel planes of a roof and ideally be
  • 30. 30 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 shade-free at the same time. It is possible to split a string between two roof faces, pro- vided the modules face the same direction. The outputs of multiple strings having similar voltage but using different current output modules, or facing different directions may be connected in parallel. This characteristic of string inverters poses a design challenge on many residential proj- ects. For instance, a roof may be large enough to hold 24 modules on the south and west faces together. However, the south face may be large enough to mount 16 modules and the west face only large enough to mount 8 modules. If the inverter requires 12 modules in series, the west face is not usable and the south face will only permit 12 modules to be installed. This means that only half the potential array area can be utilized by that string inverter system. This example suggests that it might be reasonable to find an inverter with lower input voltage that only requires 8 modules in series, or consider using module level micro-inverters to avoid string sizing requirements altogether.   2.4 Review Design Energy Storage Systems A battery converts chemical energy to electrical energy when it is discharged, and con- verts electrical energy to chemical energy when it is charged. Because the power pro- duced by PV arrays does not always coincide with electrical loads, batteries are common- ly used in most stand-alone PV systems to store energy produced by the PV array, for use by system loads as required. Batteries also establish the dc operating voltage for the PV array, charge controllers and dc utilization equipment, including inverters and dc loads, as applicable. Batteries are sometimes used in interactive systems, but only with special types of battery-based inverters intended for interactive operation, also called multi-mode invert- ers. These inverters operate as diversionary charge controllers and dump excess PV array energy to the grid when it is energized [NEC 690.72]. When there is a loss of grid voltage,  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 27 Figure 25. Utility-interactive systems with battery storage are similar to uninterruptible power supplies, and have many similar components. Inverter/ Charger Critical Load Sub Panel Backup AC Loads Main Panel Primary AC Loads Electric Utility Bypass circuit BatteryPV Array AC Out AC In DC In/out Charge Control Figure 25. Utility-interactive systems with battery storage are similar to uninterruptible power supplies, and have many similar components. these inverters transfer loads from the grid to operate in stand-alone mode. Interactive systems with battery backup cost significantly more to install than simple inter- active systems without batteries, due to the additional equipment required (special inverters, batteries and charge controllers). The design and installation of these systems is also more complex, and usually involves conducting a load analysis and reconfiguring branch circuits in dedicated subpanels. See Fig. 25.  
  • 31. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 31 The lead-acid cell is the most common type of storage battery used in PV systems. Oc- casionally nickel-cadmium or other battery technologies are used. Newer battery types like lithium-ion are also becoming possible as the costs of these battery systems continue to decrease and performance improves. A motive power or traction battery is a type of lead-acid battery designed for use in deep discharge applications, such as electric vehicles. Motive power batteries are robust and are commonly used in stand-alone PV systems. A starting, lighting and ignition (SLI) bat- tery has a larger number of thinner plates to provide a greater surface and can deliver higher discharge currents, but are damaged by frequent and deep discharges, and are sel- dom used in PV systems. Deep discharge-type batteries differ from automobile starting batteries in several respects, mainly their designs use heavier, thicker plates and stronger inter-cell connections to better withstand the mechanical stresses on the battery under frequent deep discharges. Flooded batteries have a liquid electrolyte solution. Open-vent flooded types have removable vent caps and permit electrolyte maintenance and water additions. Valve-reg- ulated lead-acid (VRLA) batteries have an immobilized electrolyte in gel form or absorbed in fiberglass separator mats between the plates. VRLA batteries are spill proof and do not require electrolyte maintenance, however they are more expensive and less tolerant of overcharging and higher operating temperatures than flooded types. Charge controllers must use appropriate charge regulation settings for the type of battery used. See Fig 26. Vented lead-acid batteries release hydrogen and oxygen gases, under normal charging conditions. This is due to electrolysis of the electrolyte solution during final charging stages, and results in water loss. Consequently, adequate ventilation must be provided for both vented and sealed battery systems [NEC 480.9 and 480.10]. While it is difficult to determine adequate ventilation requirements, it is generally advisable to provide greater 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Batteries: 6 - 28 Figure 26. Both flooded and sealed lead-acid batteries are commonly used in PV systems. BATTERY TYPE ADVANTAGES DISADVANTAGES FLOODED LEAD-ACID Lead-Antimony low cost, wide availability, good deep cycle and high temperature performance, can replenish electrolyte high water loss and maintenance Lead-Calcium Open-Vent low cost, wide availability, low water loss, can replenish electrolyte poor deep cycle performance, intolerant to high temperatures and overcharge Lead-Calcium Sealed-Vent low cost, wide availability, low water loss poor deep cycle performance, intolerant to high temperatures and overcharge, can not replenish electrolyte Lead-Antimony/Calcium Hybrid medium cost, low water loss limited availability, potential for stratification VALVE-REGULATED LEAD-ACID Gelled medium cost, little or no maintenance, less susceptible to freezing, install in any orientation fair deep cycle performance, intolerant to overcharge and high temperatures, limited availability Absorbed Glass Mat medium cost, little or no maintenance, less susceptible to freezing, install in any orientation fair deep cycle performance, intolerant to overcharge and high temperatures, limited availability NICKEL-CADMIUM Sealed Sintered-Plate wide availability, excellent low and high temperature performance, maintenance free only available in low capacities, high cost, suffer from ‘memory’ effect Flooded Pocket-Plate excellent deep cycle and low and high temperature performance, tolerance to overcharge limited availability, high cost, water additions required Figure 26. Both flooded and sealed lead-acid batteries are commonly used in PV systems.
  • 32. 32 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 ventilation than necessary. A good rule is to provide similar ventilation to a battery room as is required for a combustion water heater. VRLA batteries do not release gasses under normal charging, and have lower ventilation requirements than flooded open vent types. Capacity is a measure of battery energy storage, commonly rated in ampere-hours (Ah) or kilowatt-hours (kWh). For example, a nominal 6-volt battery rated at 220 Ah stores 1.32 kWh of energy. Battery design features that affect battery capacity include the quan- tity of active material, the number, design and physical size of the plates, and electrolyte specific gravity. Usable capacity is always less than the rated battery capacity. Opera- tional factors that affect the usable battery capacity include discharge rate, cut-off voltage, temperature and age of the battery. See Fig. 27. The rate of charge or discharge is expressed as a ratio of the nominal battery capacity (C) to the charge or discharge time period in hours. For example, a nominal 100 ampere-hour battery discharged at 5 amps for 20 hours is considered a C/20, or 20-hour discharge rate. The higher the discharge rate and lower the temperature, the less capacity that can be withdrawn from a battery to a specified cutoff voltage. See Fig. 28. State-of-charge is the percentage of available battery capacity compared to a fully charged state. Depth-of-discharge is the percentage of capacity that has been removed from a bat- tery compared to a fully charged state. The state-of-charge and depth-of-discharge for a battery add to 100 percent. The allowable depth-of-discharge is the maximum limit of battery discharge in operation. The allowable depth-of-discharge is usually limited to no more than 75 to 80% for deep cycle batteries, and must also be limited to protect lead-acid bat- teries from freezing in extremely cold conditions.   Specific gravity is the ratio of the density of a solution to the density of water. Sulfuric- acid electrolyte concentration is measured by its specific gravity, and related to battery state of charge. A fully charged lead-acid cell has a typical specific gravity between 1.26 and 1.28 at room temperature. The specific gravity may be increased for lead-acid batteries Batteries: 6 - 29 Voltage(V) Capacity (Ah) Cut off voltage High discharge rate Low discharge rate Figure 27. Battery capacity is a measure of the stored energy that a battery can deliver under specified conditions.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 -30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50 C/500 C/120 C/50 C/5 C/0.5 Battery Operating Temperature ( o C ) Percentof25o CCapacity Figure 28. The higher the discharge rate and the lower the temperature, the less capacity that can be withdrawn from a battery to a specified cutoff voltage.
  • 33. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 33 used in cold weather applications. Conversely, the specific gravity may be decreased for applications in warm climates to prolong battery life. In very cold climates, batteries must be protected from freezing by installing in a suit- able enclosure, or by limiting the depth of discharge. Because the density of electrolyte decreases with increasing temperature, specific gravity readings must be adjusted for temperature. Inconsistent specific gravity readings between cells in a flooded lead-acid battery indicate the need for an equalizing charge. Many factors and trade-offs are considered in battery selection and systems design, and are often dictated by the application or site requirements. Among the factors to consider in the specification and design of battery systems include: • Electrical properties: voltage, capacity, charge/discharge rates • Performance: cycle life vs. DOD, system autonomy • Physical properties: Size and weight, termination types • Maintenance requirements: Flooded or VRLA • Installation: Location, structural requirements, environmental conditions • Safety and auxiliary systems: Racks, trays, fire protection, electrical BOS • Costs, warranty and availability Most PV systems using batteries require a charge controller to protect the batteries from overcharge by the array. Only certain exceptions apply for special self-regulated systems, which are designed using very low charge rates, special lower voltage PV modules, larger batteries and well-defined, automated loads. If the maximum charge rates from the PV array multiplied by one hour is equal to 3% of the battery nominal amp-hour capacity or greater, a charge controller is required [NEC 690.72]. If a battery is overcharged, it can create a hazardous condition and its life is generally reduced, especially for sealed, valve- regulated lead-acid (VLRA) batteries. Many charge controllers also include overdischarge protection for batteries, by disconnecting loads at a predetermined low-voltage, low state-of-charge condition. Battery installations in dwellings must operate less than 50 volts nominal, unless live parts are not accessible during routine battery maintenance. This requirement generally limits the voltage of lead-acid batteries to no more than 48 volts, nominal. This equates to either 24 series-connected nominal 2-volt lead-acid cells, or 40 series-connected nominal 1.2-volt alkali type nickel cadmium cells. All battery installations in dwellings must have live parts guarded. Live parts must also be guarded for any battery installations 50 volts or greater by elevation, barriers or location in rooms accessible to only qualified persons. Sufficient working spaces and clearances must be provided for any battery installations [NEC 110.26]. If the nominal voltage of a battery bank exceeds 48 V, then the batteries shall not be installed in conductive cases, unless they are VRLA batteries designed for installation with metal cases [NEC 690.71(D)]. Note that 48 V nominal battery banks typically operate above 50 V and exceed the 50 V limit for ungrounded PV systems [NEC 690.41]. Battery systems either must have a system grounded conductor or meet the requirements for ungrounded systems [NEC 690.35].
  • 34. 34 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Racks and trays are used to support battery systems and provide electrolyte contain- ment. Racks can be made from metal, fiberglass or other structural nonconductive materials. Metal racks must be painted or otherwise treated to resist degradation from electrolyte and provide insulation between conducting members and the bat- tery cells [NEC 480.9]. Due to the potential for ground faults, metal or other conduc- tive battery racks, trays and cases are not allowed for open-vent flooded lead-acid batteries more than 48 volts nominal. In addition, conductive racks are not permitted to be located within 150 mm (6 in.) of the tops of the nonconductive battery cases [NEC 690.71(D)]. These requirements do not apply to sealed batteries that are manu- factured with conductive cases. Any conductive battery racks, cases or trays must also have proper equipment grounding [NEC 250.110]. If batteries are connected in series to produce more than 48 V (nominal), then the bat- teries must be connected in a manner that allows the series strings of batteries to be separated into strings of 48 V or less for maintenance purposes [NEC 690.71(D-G)]. The means of disconnect may be non-load-break, bolted, or plug-in disconnects. For strings greater than 48 V, there must also be a means of disconnecting the grounded circuit conductors of all battery strings under maintenance without disconnecting the grounded conductors of operating strings. Whenever the available fault current of a battery exceeds the interrupt ratings of nor- mal overcurrent devices, disconnect means or other equipment in a circuit, special current-limiting overcurrent devices must be installed [NEC 690.9, 690.71]. While many dc-rated circuit breakers do not have sufficient interrupt ratings, current limit- ing fuses are available with interrupt rating 20,000 A and higher. Whenever these fuses may be energized from both sides, a disconnect means is required to isolate the fuse from all sources for servicing [NEC 690.16]. A disconnecting means must also be provided for all ungrounded battery circuit conductors, and must be readily acces- sible and located within sight of the battery system [NEC 690.17]. To prevent battery installations from being classified as hazardous locations, venti- lation of explosive battery gasses is required. However, the NEC does not provide specific ventilation requirements. Vented battery cells must incorporate a flame arres- tor to help prevent cell explosions from external ignition sources, and cells for sealed batteries must have pressure relief vents [NEC 480.9, 480.10]. Special safety precautions, equipment and personal protective equipment (PPE) are required when installing and maintaining battery systems. Hazards associated with batteries include caustic electrolyte, high short-circuit currents, and explosive poten- tial due to hydrogen and oxygen gasses produced during battery charging. Insulated tools should be used when working on batteries to prevent short-circuiting. High- voltage battery systems may present arc flash hazards, and special PPE, disconnect- ing means and equipment labeling may apply [See NFPA 70E]. Batteries are also very heavy and should only be lifted or supported by methods approved by the manu- facturer. Battery installations over 400 lbs may also have to meet certain engineering requirements in seismic regions for the design of non-structural electrical compo- nents [See ASCE 7-10].
  • 35. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 35 2.4.1 Determine Loads The sizing of batteries or any other energy storage system is based on the magnitude and duration of the applied electrical loads. The average power consumption of the elec- trical loads defines the maximum discharge rates as well as the total energy withdrawn from the battery on an average daily basis. The size of the battery (total capacity) is selected based on these system parameters and the desired maximum and average daily depth-of-discharge. The maximum battery depth-of-discharge in actual system opera- tion is determined by the low-voltage load disconnect, the discharge rate, temperature and other factors.. Identify all existing and planned electrical loads that will be connected to the system, including their ac or dc operating voltage, their power or current consumption, and their expected average daily use. List all loads and multiply the power use by the aver- age daily time of operation to determine daily energy consumption and peak power demand. See Fig. 29. In practice, the inverter should be large enough to power the total connected load, but is only required to be as large as the single largest load [NEC 690.10(A)]. 2.4.2 Identify Circuits for Required Loads Load circuits supplied by stand-alone PV systems must be clearly identified and limited to the design loads. Additional loads beyond what the system has been designed to supply will ultimately result in decreasing battery state-of-charge and reduced battery lifetime. Ensure that only critical loads are connected and that the most efficient loads and practices are used wherever possible. In all cases, do not exceed the load estimates for which the system was designed unless additional generation resources are used. Multiwire Branch Circuits Many stand-alone PV systems use inverters with 120 Vac output, with the hot leg con- nected to both sides (phases) of a common 120/240 V split-phase load center. Normally with 240 V service, the current on one phase is 180 degrees opposed to the current on the other phase, and results in neutral conductor currents equal to the difference be- tween the two phase currents.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Batteries: 6 - 31 Electrical Load Power (W) Avg. Daily Time of Use (hr) Avg. Daily Energy (watt- hours) Lighting 200 6 1200 Refrigerator 300 9.6 (40% duty cycle) 2880 Microwave 1200 0.5 600 Pumps 1000 1 1000 TV and entertainment equipment 400 4 1600 Fans 300 6 1800 Washer 400 0.86 (3 hours 2 times per week) 344 Miscellaneous plug loads 200 12 2400 Total all loads 4000 W (4 kW) 11,824 Wh (11.8 kWh) Figure 29. A load assessment evaluates the magnitude and duration of electrical loads. OSHA requirements for battery installations include the following: • Unsealed batteries must be installed in ventilated enclo- sures to prevent fumes, gases, or electrolyte spray entering other areas, and to prevent the accumulation of an explosive mixture. • Battery racks, trays and floors must be of sufficient strength and resistant to electrolyte. • Face shields, aprons, and rubber gloves must be provided for workers handling acids or batteries, and facilities for quick drenching of the eyes and body must be provided within 25 feet of battery handling areas. • Facilities must be provided for flushing and neutralizing spilled electrolyte and for fire protection. • Battery charging installations are to be located in designated areas and protected from dam- age by trucks. • Vent caps must be in place during battery charging and maintained in a functioning condition.
  • 36. 36 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 When the two phases (buses) in the panel are connected together to distribute the 120 V source, the currents on both sides of the panel are now in phase with each other and are additive. If multiwire branch circuits that share a neutral conductor for two branch circuits are connected to this modified distribution panel, the neutral conductor can potentially become overloaded and create a fire hazard. For these installations, a special warning sign is required on the panel to prohibit the connection of multiwire branch circuits [NEC 690.10(C)].   2.4.3 Batteries and Battery Conductors The goal of battery wiring is to create a circuit that charges and discharges all batteries equally. If batteries are connected in series, this is automatic, but if batteries are connected in parallel, the currents may be unequal due to subtle differences in cable resistance and connections. All batteries used in a battery bank must be the same type, same manufac- turer, the same age, and must be maintained at equal temperatures. Batteries should have the same charge and discharge properties under these circumstances. Series batteries connections build voltage while capacity stays the same as for one battery. See Fig. 30. Parallel battery connections build capacity while voltage stays the same. See Fig. 31. Parallel connections are made from opposite corners of the battery bank to help equalize the voltage drop and current flow through each string. In general, no more than four batteries or series strings of batteries should be connected in parallel. It is better to use larger batteries with higher ampere-hour ratings than to connect batteries in parallel. Large conductors, such as 2/0 AWG, 4/0 AWG or larger, are typically used to minimize voltage drop in battery connections. Figure 30. Series battery connections increase voltage.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Batteries: 6 - 32 Figure 30. Series battery connections increase voltage. Battery 2 12 volts 100 amp-hours 24 volts 100 amp-hours Total: + - + - Battery 1 12 volts 100 amp-hours + -  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 33 Figure 31. Parallel battery connections increase capacity. Battery 2 12 volts 100 amp-hours 12 volts 200 amp-hours Total: + - Battery 1 12 volts 100 amp-hours + - + - Figure 31. Parallel battery connections increase capacity. Listed flexible cables rated for hard service usage are permitted to be used for battery conductors, and can help reduce excessive terminal stress that can occur with standard stranded conductors [NEC 690.74, Art. 400]. Welding cable (listed or not listed), automo- tive battery cables, diesel locomotive cables (marked DLO only) and the like may not meet NEC requirements for battery connections. Properly rated cable will have a conduit rating such as THW or RHW to meet building wiring requirements. Size Batteries for Loads Battery sizing in most PV systems is based on the average daily electrical load and a de- sired number of days of battery storage. The number of days of storage is selected based
  • 37. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 37 on the importance of the application, and the desired average daily depth- of-discharge for the battery. Autonomy is defined as the number of days that a fully charged battery can meet system loads without any recharging. Autonomy is calculated by the nominal battery capacity, the average daily load and the maximum allowable depth-of-discharge. Larger autonomy means a larger battery with higher costs, and shallower aver- age daily depth-of-discharge, lower charge and discharge rates, and usu- ally longer battery life. Figure 32. A charge controller is required in most PV systems that use battery storage to regulate battery state-of-charge.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 34 Charge controller protects battery from overcharge by PV array Charge Controller BatteryPV Array  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 35 Figure 33. Charge controllers used in PV systems vary widely in their size, functions and features. Morningstar TriStar controller Morningstar ProStar controller Morningstar lighting controller Outback MPPT controller Xantrex C-series controller Figure 33. Charge controllers used in PV systems vary widely in their size, functions and features. For example, consider a system load that is 100 Ah per day. A 400 Ah battery is selected, with a desired allowable depth-of-discharge of 75% (300 Ah usable). This battery design would deliver 3 days of autonomy in this system (3 days × 100 Ah/day = 300 Ah). Critical applications, such as vaccine refrigeration systems, telecommunications or defense and public safety applications may be designed for greater than 3 days of autonomy to help improve system reliability. PV hybrid systems using generators or other backup sources may require less autonomy to achieve the same level of system availability. Charge Controller Operation A battery charge controller limits the voltage and or current delivered to a battery from a charging source to regulate state-of-charge [NEC 690.2]. See Fig 32. A charge controller is required in most PV systems that use battery storage, to prevent damage to the batteries or hazardous conditions resulting from overcharging [NEC 690.72(A)]. Many charge con- trollers also provide overdischarge protection for the battery by disconnecting dc loads at low state-of-charge. Additional functions performed by charge controllers include controlling loads or backup energy source and providing monitoring and indicators of battery voltage and other system parameters. Special controllers are also available that regulate battery charge by diverting excess power to auxiliary loads. See Fig 33. Many charge controllers protect the battery from overdischarge by disconnecting dc loads at low battery voltage and state-of-charge, at the allowable maximum depth of discharge limit. See Fig. 34. Some smaller charge controllers incorporate overcharge and overdis-  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 35 Figure 33. Charge controllers used in PV systems vary widely in their size, functions and features. Morningstar TriStar controller Morningstar ProStar controller Morningstar lighting controller Outback MPPT controller Xantrex C-series controller
  • 38. 38 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 charge functions within a single controller. Generally, for larger dc load currents, separate charge controllers or relays are used. If two charge controllers are used, it is possible that they may be the same model but simply installed with different settings for different pur- poses; one on the array side for charge regulation and one on the load side of the battery for load control. Battery-based inverters usually have programmable set-points for the low voltage load disconnect and load reconnect voltages. An alarm or indicator usually notifies the opera- tor when the batteries are getting close to or have reached the LVD. It is also possible to employ multiple LVD controllers on the load side of the batteries, to have different LVD settings based on load priorities. Factory defaults for LVDs are often set at a low level so it may be desirable to raise the settings to provide greater protection of the batteries, however this reduces available capacity. Charge controllers have maximum input voltage and current ratings specified by the manufacturer and the listing agency. The PV array must not be capable of generating voltage or current that will exceed the charge controller input voltage and current limits. The charge controller rated continuous current (sometimes specified as input current, sometimes as output current) must be at least 125% of the PV array short-circuit output current, and the charge controller maximum input voltage must be higher than the maxi- mum system voltage [NEC 690.7]. Set points are the battery voltage levels at which a charge controller performs regula- tion or control functions. The proper regulation set points are critical for optimal battery charging and system performance.   The regulation voltage (VR) is the maximum voltage set point the controller allows the battery to reach before the array current is disconnected or limited. For interrupting type controllers, the array reconnect voltage (ARV) is the voltage set point at which the array is again reconnected to charge the battery. PWM and constant-voltage type controllers do not have a definable ARV. The low-voltage disconnect (LVD) is the battery voltage set point at which the charge controller disconnects the system loads to prevent overdischarge. The LVD defines the Figure 34. Charge controllers are also used to protect a battery from excessively deep discharges.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 36 This controller protects battery from overcharge This controller protects battery from overdischarge PV Array Battery DC Load Load Controller Charge Controller
  • 39. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 39 maximum battery depth-of-discharge at the given discharge rate. The load reconnect volt- age (LRV) set point is the voltage that load are reconnected to the battery. A higher LRV allows a battery to receive more charge before loads are reconnected to the battery. Low-voltage disconnect set points are selected based on the desired battery depth-of-dis- charge and discharge rates. High discharge rates will lower battery voltage by a greater amount than lower discharge rates at the same battery state-of-charge. For a typical lead- acid cell, a LVD set point of 1.85 VPC to 1.91 VPC corresponds to a depth-of-discharge of 70% to 80% at discharge rates C/20 and lower. Some PV charge controllers and battery chargers use three-stage charging algorithms to more effectively deliver power to the battery. Bulk charging occurs when the battery is below around 90% state-of-charge, and all available PV current is delivered to the batter- ies. During the bulk charge stage, battery voltage increases as the battery charges. Once the regulation voltage is reached, the charging current is limited to maintain the regula- tion voltage. Absorption charging is a finishing charge that occurs for a specified period after the regulation voltage is reached, usually for a few hours. This charging time at higher regulation voltages helps fully charge the battery, but if sustained for too long can overcharge the battery. Charging current continues to decrease throughout the absorption charge. Float charging is a maintenance charge that maintains the battery at a lower float voltage level and minimal current, essentially offsetting battery self-discharge Figure 35. Advanced battery chargers and controllers use multi-stage charging algorithms. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Batteries: 6 - Figure 35. Advanced battery chargers and controllers use multi-stage charging algorithms. Reducing Absorption Current Float Current Float Voltage Maximum Charge Current Increasing Voltage Bulk Charge - Constant Voltage Bulk Stage Battery Voltage Absorption Stage Float Stage Battery Current Time  Figure 36. Optimal charge regulation set points depend on the type of battery and control method used.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Batteries: 6 - 38 Figure 36. Optimal charge regulation set points depend on the type of battery and control method used. Battery Type Regulator Design Type Charge Regulation Voltage at 25 o C Flooded Lead- Antimony Flooded Lead- Calcium Sealed, Valve Regulated Lead-Acid Flooded Pocket Plate Nickel- Cadmium On-Off, Interrupting Per nominal 12 volt battery 14.6 - 14.8 14.2 - 14.4 14.2 - 14.4 14.5 - 15.0 Per Cell 2.44 - 2.47 2.37 - 2.40 2.37 - 2.40 1.45 - 1.50 Constant-Voltage, PWM, Linear Per nominal 12 volt battery 14.4 - 14.6 14.0 - 14.2 14.0 - 14.2 14.5 - 15.0 Per Cell 2.40 - 2.44 2.33 - 2.37 2.33 - 2.37 1.45 - 1.50 losses. See Fig. 35. The optimal charge regulation set points depend on the type of battery and control method used. Higher charge regulation voltages are required for all types of bat- teries using interrupting type controllers, compared to more effective constant-volt- age, PWM or linear designs. See Fig. 36. Equalization charging is a periodic over- charge to help restore consistency among battery cells. Equalization charging is per- formed on flooded, open-vent batteries to help minimize differences and restore
  • 40. 40 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 consistency in capacity between individual cells, and can help reduce sulfation and strati- fication. Some charge controllers provide the capability for manual or automatic or equal- ization charging. Flooded lead-acid batteries are normally equalized at approximately 2.6 volts per cell (VPC) at 25°C for 1-3 hour periods once or twice a month. Equalization is generally not recommended for VRLA batteries; see manufacturer’s instructions. Temperature compensation is a feature of charge controllers that automatically adjusts the charge regulation voltage for battery temperature changes. Charge controllers may have internal temperature compensation, or use external sensors attached to the batteries. Where battery temperatures vary seasonally more than 10°C, compensation of the charge regulation set point is normally used. Temperature compensation is recommended for all types of sealed batteries, which are much more sensitive to overcharging than flooded types. Temperature compensation helps to fully charge a battery during colder condi- tions, and helps protect it from overcharge and excessive electrolyte loss during warmer conditions. The standard temperature compensation coefficient for lead-acid cells is -5 mV/°C. When the battery is cold, the charge regulation voltage is increased, and conversely when the battery is warm, the charge regulation voltage is reduced. For example, consider a nomi- nal 24 V charge controller with a regulation voltage of 28.2 V at 25°C. When the battery temperature is 10°C, the temperature compensated regulation voltage is 29.7 V. Con- versely, if the battery temperature is 40°C, the charge regulation voltage will be reduced to 27.3 volts. Figure 37. Multiple charge controllers may be used on individual subarrays for larger systems. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Batteries: 6 - 39 Figure 37. Multiple charge controllers may be used on individual subarrays for larger systems. PV Subarray #1 Charge Controller #1 One subarray may be directly connected to battery without charge control if charge current x 1 hr is less than 3% of battery capacity. PV Subarray #2 Charge Controller #2 PV Subarray #3 Charge Controller #3 PV Subarray #4 Battery DC Load Note: No overdischarge protection shown. Figure 38. A diversionary charge controller diverts excess PV array power to auxiliary loads.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Solar Radiation: 2 - 40 Figure 38. A diversionary charge controller diverts excess PV array power to auxiliary loads. PV Array Charge Controller Battery Diversion Controller Diversion Load This controller protects the battery when the diversion load is unavailable Diversionary controller protects the battery from overcharge by diverting power to a diversionary load For larger systems, the output of multi- ple charge controllers may be connected in parallel and used to charge a single battery bank. See Fig. 37. Depending on the specific controller, the multiple controllers may regulate independently or through a master-slave arrangement. One subarray may be left unregulated if the maximum charge current multiplied by one hour is less than 3% of the bat- tery capacity. This can help improve the finishing charge. A diversionary charge controller diverts excess PV array power to auxiliary loads when the primary battery system is fully charged, allowing a greater utili- zation of PV array energy. Whenever a diversionary charge controller is used, a second independent charge controller is required to prevent battery overcharge in the event the diversion loads are unavail- able or the diversion charge controller
  • 41. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 41 fails [NEC 690.72]. The additional charge controller uses a higher regulation voltage, and permits the diversionary charge controller to operate as the primary control. See Fig 38. Several requirements apply to PV systems using dc diversionary loads and dc diversion charge controllers. Typical dc diversionary loads include resistive water heating ele- ments, dc water pumps or other loads that can utilize or store the energy in some other form.These requirements are intended to help prevent hazardous conditions and protect the battery if the diversion controller fails or the dc loads are unavailable. • The dc diversion load current must be no greater than the controller maximum current rating. • The dc diversion load must have a voltage rating greater than the maximum battery voltage. • The dc diversion load power rating must be rated at least 150 percent of the maximum PV array power output. • The conductors and overcurrent protection for dc diversion load circuits must be sized for at least 150 percent of controller maximum current rating. Some interactive PV systems use battery-based inverters as a backup power source when the utility is de-energized. Normally, these systems regulate the battery charge by divert- ing excess PV array dc power through the inverter to produce ac power to feed site loads or the grid. When the grid de-energizes, an automatic transfer switch disconnects loads from the utility network and the system operates in stand-alone mode. If all loads have been met and the grid is not available, the battery can be overcharged. These systems must also have a second independent charge controller to prevent battery overcharge when the grid or loads are not available to divert excess power [NEC 690.72(C)(3)]. See Fig. 39.   Figure 39. Battery-based interactive inverters operate as diversionary charge controllers to regulate battery state-of-charge.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 41 Figure 39. Battery-based interactive inverters operate as diversionary charge controllers to regulate battery state-of-charge. PV Array Charge Controller Battery Interactive Inverter Utility Grid This controller protects the battery when the grid is unavailable The inverter normally protects the battery from overcharge by diverting power to the grid Power may flow in reverse directions if inverter also includes a battery charger Maximum Power Point Tracking MPPT Charge Controllers Maximum power point tracking (MPPT) charge controllers operate PV arrays at maximum power under all operating conditions independent of battery volt- age. Typically, the PV array is configured at higher voltages than the battery, and dc to dc power conversion circuits in the controller automatically provides a lower voltage and higher current output to the battery. MPPT controllers can improve array energy utilization and allow non-standard and higher array operating voltages, requiring smaller conductors and fewer source circuits to charge lower voltage battery banks. MPPT charge controllers are advantageous on cold sunny days in the winter when stand-alone systems have lower battery voltage and the array voltage is high due to the cold operating temperature. Normally, the output current of a charge controller will be less than or equal to the input current. The exception to this rule is a MPPT charge controller, in which the output cur-
  • 42. 42 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 rent may exceed the input current but at lower voltage. If a MPPT charge controller is used, it is important to consult the manufacturer’s specifications to determine the maximum output current. The maximum rated output current of the charge controller must be posted on a sign at the dc disconnect [NEC 690.53].   2.4.4 Generators Electrical generators are often interfaced with PV systems to supplement the PV array when it cannot produce enough energy alone to meet the system loads or charge the batteries. These are often referred to as hybrid systems, because they use more than one energy source. Generators may be directly interfaced with stand-alone systems or with battery-based utility-interactive systems. In regions where the summer solar resource is significantly more than the winter resource, an auxiliary electric genera- tor may be useful to reduce the size of the PV array and battery required to meet the wintertime loads alone. Many battery-based PV inverters have built-in battery chargers that permit the con- nection of an auxiliary ac source, such as a generator, to provide supplemental battery charging, or to directly power ac loads.Some of these inverters are programmable and have relay circuits that can automatically start the generator whenever the batteries reach a prescribed low voltage. When the batteries have been recharged to an ad- equate state of charge, defined by the inverter programming, the inverter will auto- matically shut down the generator. Most of these advanced inverters can also exercise the generator on a regular basis to ensure that it will start when needed. Utility-interactive PV systems without batteries require a separate generator trans- fer switch to isolate the electrical loads from the grid and the PV system when the generator is operated, because most generators alone cannot interface directly to the grid without additional synchronizing and protective equipment. In this design, the generators are either started automatically or manually in the event of a utility outage. Charging Batteries with a Generator Typically, PV-generator hybrid systems may be designed to fully charge the batter- ies in 5 to 10 hours, or at a C/5 to C/10 rate. This means that if the batteries are 80% discharged and the generator is programmed to charge the batteries until they are only 30% discharged, that it would take 5 hours to do so at the C/10 rate. Generally, it is not advantageous to fully charge batteries with the generator, which can be inef- ficient, and can result in wasting valuable PV energy that may have been available to contribute to the charge. The basic idea to optimize generator run time is to load the generator as high a power level and minimum operation time as possible, to minimize fuel consumption and maintenance.  
  • 43. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 43 2.5 Confirm String Size Calculations PV array source circuits are usually designed to meet the voltage requirement of connect- ed dc utilization equipment, such as batteries, charge controllers, or interactive inverters. All dc equipment must also have appropriate current ratings for the given PV array and source circuit currents. The PV array must also operate within acceptable voltage limits for the dc equipment, over all temperatures. Battery charging applications require the PV array maximum power voltage to be greater than the battery regulation voltage at the highest array operating temperatures. This helps ensure that the maximum PV array current is delivered to the battery. Maximum power point tracking charge controllers permit the use of much higher array voltages than the battery voltage. See Fig. 40. The experienced PV installer should be able to identify the advantages and disadvantag- es of systems that operate at different dc voltages, ranging from 12 V systems to systems operating up to 600 V and greater where permitted. The major disadvantage of lower voltage systems are much higher currents for the same power levels, requiring much larger and more expensive conductors, overcurrent devices and switchgear. For example, the currents in a 12 V system are twice as high as currents in a 24 V system, and four times as high as for 48 V systems. These higher currents require significantly larger wire sizes. In fact, to maintain a voltage drop within certain limits, say 3%, for the same load at 24 V as opposed to at 12 V, the allowable wire resistance is 4 times as high as for the 12 V loads because the 24 V system reduces the current by half and the percentage volt- age drop is based on twice the voltage as 12 V.   Interactive inverters can usually handle PV array dc power input levels 110% to 130% or more of the continuous ac output power rating, especially in warmer climates. Inverters thermally limit array dc input and array power tracking at high temperatures and power levels. PV array must also not exceed the maximum dc input current limits for the inverter. Figure 40. Generally, 36 series-connected silicon solar cells are needed to provide adequate maximum power voltage to fully charge a lead acid-battery.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 42 Figure 40. Generally, 36 series-connected silicon solar cells are needed to provide adequate maximum power voltage to fully charge a lead acid-battery. PV module maximum power voltage must be higher than battery voltage at highest operating temperature Voltage (V) Current(A) Module with 36 series-connected cells operating at temperature of 50 C (optimal) 10 20 Operating voltage range for 12-volt lead-acid battery: 11.5 to 14.5 volts. Maximum power points Module with 30 series-connected cells at 50 C (voltage too low to deliver maximum current to battery) Module with 42 series-connected cells at 50 C (voltage is more than adequate for charging, but power is wasted)
  • 44. 44 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Array voltage requirements the most critical part of sizing arrays for interactive in- verters. Array voltage is affected by the site ambient temperature range and the array mounting system design. The array voltage must be above the minimum inverter oper- ating and MPPT voltage during hottest operating conditions, factoring in annual array voltage degradation of 0.5% to 1% per year. Array voltage must also not exceed 600 dc or the maximum inverter operating voltage during the coldest operating conditions. Exceeding maximum voltage limits violates electrical codes and voids manufacturer warranties. Use record lows or preferably ASHRAE 2% minimum design temperatures to determine maximum array voltage. See Fig. 41. 2.6 Review System Components Selection The PV installer is often required to make judgments and recommendations concern- ing the system design based on a variety of factors including site considerations and customer needs. The installer is often required to review or modify designs based on the application requirements, and they must ensure that the overall installation meets code requirements. It is not unusual for something to be left out of a design, and the installer may be responsible for identifying these discrepancies in the design review process. The installer should also know when and where to consult an experienced system designer when design issues extend beyond the installer’s capabilities. 2.6.1 Differentiating Among Available Modules and Inverters Both PV modules and inverters used in PV systems are subject to UL standards and must be listed and approved for the application to meet code compliance. Inverters in- tended for use in interactive PV systems, or with ungrounded PV arrays must be special- ly labeled. Likewise ac modules, special modules manufactured with built-in inverters much be clearly labeled as ac modules with the appropriate specifications. Product approval usually only provides a measure of safety and is not indicative of field performance or reliability. There are relatively few resources to find comprehensive and unbiased analyses on the field performance of these products, but certain periodicals Figure 41. Properly configuring PV arrays for interactive inverters involves an understanding the array I-V characteristics and temperature effects.   2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 43 Figure 41. Properly configuring PV arrays for interactive inverters involves an understanding the array I-V characteristics and temperature effects. Voltage Array voltage decreases with increasing temperature 25 C 50 C 0 C -25 C STC DC Input Operating Range Inverter MPPT Range PV Array IV Curves at Different Temperatures
  • 45. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 45 provide annual reviews, results from independent testing, and comments from installers. Online forums are another good place to find out more about products. Manufacturer’s specifications are based on laboratory tests, and it is important to recognize that field performance is far more dynamic. A given product may perform quite well under one set of conditions but under-perform in other conditions (e.g. at given temperatures, voltages, etc.). Reference: CEC eligible equipment website: www.consume- renergycenter.org  In addition to electrical safety listing, the selection of PV modules for a given project may be based on any number of factors, including: • Physical characteristics (dimensions and weight) • Electrical specifications (power tolerance and guaranteed power output) • Warranties, reliability and reputation of the manufacturer • Manufacturer certification to quality standards (ISO 9000) • Module warranty and design qualification (IEC 61215/61216) • Customer satisfaction and field results • Costs and availability In addition to electrical safety listing, specifying inverters for PV installations includes the following considerations: • Interactive or stand-alone • Power rating and maximum current • Power conversion efficiency • Location environment rating • Size and weight • Nominal dc input and ac output voltages and limits of operation • Protective and safety features (array ground and arc faults, reverse polarity, etc.) • Warranties and reliability • Costs and availability • Additional features (monitoring, chargers, controls, MPPT etc.) PV Modules Photovoltaic or solar cells convert sunlight to dc electricity. They are often referred to as direct energy conversion devices because they convert one basic form of energy to another Figure 42. PV modules produce a specified electrical output.   2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 44 Figure 42. PV modules produce a specified electrical output. Single (mono) crystallinePolycrystalline 36 cell modules 60 cell polycrystalline module in a single step. PV modules have no mov- ing parts, and produce no noise or emis- sions during normal operation. Generally speaking, commercial PV modules are very reliable products with expected lifetimes exceeding 20-25 years in normal service. See Fig 42. PV cells are made from a variety of semi- conductor technologies. Most PV cells are made from multi (poly) or single crystalline silicon (mono) that is doped with certain
  • 46. 46 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 elements to produce desirable properties. Thin-film technologies, including amorphous silicon, cadmium-telluride (CdTe), copper-indium-diselenide (CIS), and others continue to be developed, and presently make up about 10% to 15% of the current market. Thin film PV modules are generally less expense than conventional crystalline silicon modules, but also less efficient and less proven that crystalline silicon. PV modules are commonly flat-plate types that respond to both direct and diffuse solar radiation. Concentrating PV (CPV) modules are special designs that use optics (lenses or reflectors) to concentrate the solar power received through a larger aperature area onto a small-area PV device. Individual silicon solar cells are manufactured in sizes up to and over 200 in2 in area. The electrical current output of a solar cell is directly related to cell area, the cell efficiency, and the amount of solar radiation incident on the cell surface. Modern silicon solar cells may be up to 8 inches in diameter and greater, and produce currents in excess of 8 A.   A common crystalline silicon solar cell produces about 0.5 V to 0.6 V independent of cell area, but decreases with increasing temperature. The temperature effects on voltage have important ramifications for designing PV arrays to meet the voltage requirements of inverters and other dc utilization equipment in different climates. See Fig 43. Usually, 36, 60, 72 or greater number of individual cells are connected in series to produce higher voltage PV modules. PV modules using 36 series-connected cells are optimally suited for charging a 12 V battery. Higher voltage modules are used for higher-voltage grid connected systems, to minimize the numbers of module connections required for an installation. However, PV modules are now becoming so large that they are reaching the Figure 43. Silicon solar cells produce about 0.5 V to 0.6 volt independent of cell area, depending on temperature.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 45 Figure 43. Silicon solar cells produce about 0.5 to 0.6 volt independent of cell area, depending on temperature. Monocrystalline cell Polycrystalline cell Figure 44. Standard Test Conditions (STC) is the universal rating condition for PV modules and arrays.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 46 Figure 44. Standard Test Conditions (STC) is the universal rating condition for PV modules and arrays.  The electrical performance of PV modules is rated at Standard Test Conditions (STC):  Irradiance: 1,000 W/m2 , AM 1.5  Cell temperature: 25 C Source: SolarWorld USA m Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 45 Figure 43. Silicon solar cells produce about 0.5 to 0.6 volt independent of cell area, depending on temperature. Monocrystalline cell Polycrystalline cell limits of safe handling by one person. A 230-watt PV module made of crystalline silicon PV cells typically has an area of about 17 sf, and weighs 35 pounds or more. See Fig 44. Solar Energy Fundamentals The principles of solar radiation, the solar resource and its units of measureare very important for the PV designer and installer to understand, especially as it concerns the perfor- mance of PV modules and arrays. This includes quantifying the amount of solar power incident on a PV array at any given point in time, as well as estimating the total solar energy received on monthly and annual basis. Solar radiation is the basic source of energy that drives a PV system. It must be ac- curately measured and quantified to make reasonable perfor- mance estimates in the design, in order to verify the proper operation of modules, arrays and complete systems.   Solar radiation is electromagnetic radiation ranging from about 0.25 mm to 4.5 mm in wavelength, including the near ultravio- let (UV), visible light, and near infrared (IR) portions of the spectrum. The sun produces immense quantities of electro- magnetic radiation as a product of fusion reactions at its core.
  • 47. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 47 The tiny fraction reaching the earth’s surface amounts to approximately 170 million gigawatts (GW), many thousands of times greater than all of the electrical power used on earth. Reference: U.S. Energy Information Administration, Annual Energy Outlook 2011: http://www.eia.gov/forecasts/aeo/pdf/0383(2011).pdf Solar irradiance (solar power) is the sun’s radiant power incident on a surface of unit area, commonly expressed in units of kW/m2 or W/m2 . Due to atmospheric effects, typical peak values of terrestrial solar irradiance are on the order of 1000 W/m2 on surfaces at sea level facing the sun’s rays under a clear sky around solar noon. Consequently, 1000 W/m2 is used as a reference condition for rating the peak output for PV modules and arrays. This value of solar irradiance is often referred to as peak sun. However, higher val- ues of irradiance are common at higher altitudes and on exceptionally clear days during winter months when the sun is closest to earth. In these cases, solar irradiance can reach 1250 W/m2 or higher for several hours during the middle of a day. For south-facing fixed (non-tracking) tilted surfaces on a clear day, the incident solar ir- radiance varies along a bell-shaped curve, peaking at solar noon when the surface faces most directly toward the sun. Local weather patterns and cloud cover affect the receiv- able radiation accordingly. See Fig 45. Solar Energy Powers the World The U.S. currently has just over 1100 GW of peak electrical power generation capacity, supplying a total annual electrical consump- tion of about 3,700 billion kWh. To produce this much energy would require about 2,500 GW of peak PV generation distributed throughout the U.S. Using a reference PV module efficiency of 15% (power density 150 W/m2 ), the total array surface area required would be about 4 million acres (about 6400 square miles), or about 0.2% of the continental U.S. land area. Considering over 50% of U.S. land area is already dedicated to the extraction of natural resources and fos- sil fuels, including agricul- ture, forestry, mining and public lands, a significant contribution from PV in meeting our national energy needs is not an unrealistic expectation. Figure 45. For fixed south-facing surfaces on a clear day, the incident solar irradiance varies in a bell-shaped curve, peaking at solar noon. Figure 46. The amount of solar energy received on a surface over a given period of time is equal to the average solar power multiplied by the time.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 47 Figure 45. For fixed south-facing surfaces on a clear day, the incident solar irradiance varies over the day in a bell-shaped curve, peaking at solar noon. Time of Day SolarIrradiance(W/m2) Sunrise Noon Sunset  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 48 Figure 46. The amount of solar energy received on a surface over a given period of time is equal to the average solar power over the period multiplied by the time. Time of Day SolarIrradiance(W/m2) Sunrise Noon Sunset Solar irradiation (energy) is the area under the solar irradiance (power) curve Solar irradiance (power) Solar irradiation (solar energy) is the sun’s radiant energy incident on a surface of unit area, commonly expressed in units of kWh/m2 . Solar irradiation is sometimes called solar insolation. Similar to electrical power and energy, solar power and solar energy are related by time. The amount of solar energy received on a surface over a given period of time is equal to the average solar irradi- ance multiplied by the time. Graphi- cally, solar irradiation (energy) is the area under the solar irradiance (power) curve. See Fig 46. For example, if the solar irradiance (power) averages 400 W/m2 over a 12 hour period, the total solar irradiation (energy) received is 400 W/m2 × 12 hr = 4800 Wh/m2 = 4.8 kWh/m2 . Conversely, if the total solar energy received over an 8 hour period is 4 kWh, the average solar power would be 4 kWh ÷ 8 hr = 0.5 kW/m2 = 500 W/m2 .
  • 48. 48 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Solar irradiation (energy) can be represented as a total for the year (kwh/m2 -yr), or com- monly on an average daily basis for a given monthor annually (kWh/m2 -day). When solar energy is represented on an average daily basis, the total daily energy can be equivocated to the same amount of energy received at a peak irradiance level of 1 kW/m2 , for a specific number of hours. Peak Sun Hours (PSH) represents the average daily amount of solar energy received on a given surface, and is equivalent to the number of hours that the solar irradiance would need to be at a peak level of 1 kW/m2 to accumulate the total amount of daily energy received. See Fig 47. Since the power output PV modules and arrays are rated at 1 kW/m2 solar irradiance, Peak Sun Hours simply represents the equivalent number of hours that a PV module or array will operate at its peak rated output. For example, consider a PV array that produces a peak power output of 6 kW when exposed to 1 kW/m2 irradiance, at average operating temperatures. If the array surface receives 5 PSH per day on average, the expected daily energy production for this array would be 6 kW × 5 hrs/day = 30 kWh/day. Coinciden- tally, the average daily residential energy use in the U.S is about 30 kWh/day, and a 6 kW PV system is about the typical size that can be installed on an average residential rooftop. Solar radiation measurements made over past years throughout the U.S. and around the world have been processed and archived in databases, and this data is used by designers to estimate the expected performance of PV systems. See Fig 48. The Renewable Resource Data Center (RReDC) at the National Renewable Energy Laboratory (NREL) maintains an extensive collection of renewable energy data, maps, and tools for solar radiation, as well as biomass, geothermal, and wind resources. Reference: The National Solar Radiation Database includes data for over 1,400 sites in the U.S. and its territories, and many other sites around the world, see: www.nrel.gov/rredc/ Figure 47. Peak sun hours (PSH) represents the average daily amount of solar energy received on a surface, and equivalent to the number of hours that the solar irradiance would be at a peak level of 1 kW/m2 .  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 49 Figure 47. Peak sun hours (PSH) represents the average daily amount of solar energy received on a surface, and equivalent to the number of hours that the solar irradiance would be at a peak level of 1 kW/m2. Time of Day (hrs) SolarIrradiance(W/m2) 1000 W/m2 Sunrise Noon Sunset Peak Sun Hours Solar Insolation Solar IrradianceArea of box equals area under curve Solar Constant The Solar Constant is the average value of solar ir- radiance outside the earth’s atmosphere on a surface facing the sun’s rays, at the average earth-sun distance of 1 Astronomical Unit (AU), equal to about 93 million miles. The Solar Constant represents the average value of extraterrestrial solar ir- radiance, which is approxi- mately 1366 W/m2 . Due to the earth’s slightly elliptical orbit around the sun, the actual values for extrater- restrial irradiance vary from the average value by about 7% between the aphelion and perihelion (points in the earth’s orbit furthest and closest to the sun, respec- tively). Approximately 30% of the extraterrestrial irradi- ance is reflected or absorbed by the atmosphere before it reaches the earth’s surface. hrs Peak Sun Hours ( ) = Avg. Daily Irradiation (kWh/m2 ∙ day) day Peak Sun (1 kW/m2 )
  • 49. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 49 Solar radiation data can be represented in tables, databases or in graphical form. See Fig. 49. Standard solar radiation data tables give several key sets of data for different fixed and tracking surfaces. The major limitation of the data tables is that they only provide data for south-facing fixed surfaces. Other tools, such as PVWatts™ can be used to pre- dict the solar energy received on fixed-tilt surfaces facing directions other than due south. The standard format spreadsheets provide minimum and maximum data for each month and annual averages for the following solar resource data and surface orientations: • Total global solar radiation for fixed south-facing flat-plate collectors tilted at angles of 0°, Lat-15°, Lat, Lat+15°, and 90°. • Total global solar radiation for single-axis, north-south tracking flat-plate collectors at tilt angles of 0°, Lat-15°, Lat, Lat+15°. • Total global solar radiation for dual-axis tracking flat-plate collectors. • Direct beam radiation for concentrating collectors. • Average meteorological conditions. Figure 48. The National Solar Radiation Database includes data for over 1,400 sites in the U.S.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 50  NSRDB 1961-1990  30 years of solar radiation and meteorological data from 239 NWS sites in the U.S.  TMY2 hourly data files  NSRDB 1991-2005 Update  Contains solar and meteorological data for 1,454 sites.  TMY3 hourly data files NREL  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 51 Figure 49. Solar radiation data tables gives the total global solar radiation for fixed south-facing flat-plate collectors tilted at angles of 0, Lat-15°, Lat, Lat+15° and 90°. City: DAYTONA BEACH State: FL WBAN No: 12834 Lat(N): 29.18 Long(W): 81.05 Elev(m): 12 Pres(mb): 1017 Stn Type: Primary SOLAR RADIATION FOR FLAT-PLATE COLLECTORS FACING SOUTH AT A FIXED-TILT (kWh/m2/day), Percentage Uncertainty = 9 Tilt(deg) Jan Feb Mar Apr May Jun Jul Aug Sep Oct Nov Dec Year 0 Average 3.1 3.9 5.0 6.2 6.4 6.1 6.0 5.7 4.9 4.2 3.4 2.9 4.8 Minimum 2.7 3.2 4.2 5.6 5.3 5.4 5.5 4.8 4.3 3.5 2.9 2.4 4.6 Maximum 3.7 4.4 5.5 6.8 7.0 7.0 6.6 6.3 5.5 4.8 3.7 3.3 5.1 Lat - 15 Average 3.8 4.5 5.5 6.4 6.4 6.0 5.9 5.8 5.2 4.7 4.1 3.6 5.2 Minimum 3.2 3.7 4.5 5.8 5.3 5.3 5.4 4.8 4.5 3.8 3.4 2.8 4.8 Maximum 4.6 5.2 6.1 7.1 7.0 6.8 6.4 6.5 6.0 5.5 4.6 4.1 5.5 Lat Average 4.3 4.9 5.7 6.3 6.0 5.5 5.5 5.6 5.3 5.0 4.6 4.1 5.2 Minimum 3.6 4.0 4.6 5.7 5.0 4.9 5.1 4.6 4.5 4.0 3.8 3.1 4.9 Maximum 5.4 5.8 6.3 7.0 6.6 6.3 6.0 6.3 6.1 5.9 5.2 4.9 5.7 Lat + 15 Average 4.6 5.1 5.6 5.9 5.4 4.8 4.9 5.1 5.1 5.1 4.8 4.4 5.1 Minimum 3.8 4.1 4.5 5.3 4.5 4.3 4.5 4.2 4.3 4.0 3.9 3.3 4.7 Maximum 5.8 6.0 6.3 6.5 5.8 5.5 5.3 5.7 5.9 6.0 5.6 5.3 5.5 90 Average 3.9 3.8 3.6 2.9 2.1 1.8 1.9 2.4 3.0 3.6 4.0 3.9 3.1 Minimum 3.1 3.1 2.9 2.7 2.0 1.6 1.8 2.0 2.5 2.7 3.1 2.8 2.8 Maximum 5.1 4.7 4.0 3.1 2.2 1.9 2.0 2.6 3.4 4.3 4.7 4.7 3.3 NREL Figure 49. Solar radiation data tables gives the total global solar radiation for fixed south-facing flat-plate collectors tilted at angles of 0°, Lat-15°, Lat, Lat+15° and 90°.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 50 Figure 48. The National Solar Radiation Database includes data for over 1400 sites in the U.S.  NSRDB 1961-1990  30 years of solar radiation and meteorological data from 239 NWS sites in the U.S.  TMY2 hourly data files  NSRDB 1991-2005 Update  Contains solar and meteorological data for 1,454 sites.  TMY3 hourly data files NREL
  • 50. 50 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 PV Module Performance Photovoltaic module electrical performance is characterized by its current-voltage (I-V) characteristic. I-V curves represent an infinite number of current and voltage operating point pairs for a PV device, at a given solar irradiance and temperature operating condi- tion. Certain electrical parameters representing key points along the I-V curve are rated by the manufacturer at the specified conditions, affixed on product labels, and are the basis for the designing the photovoltaic source and output circuits. See Fig. 50. Figure 50. An I-V curve represents the electrical performance for PV modules and arrays.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 52 Figure 50. An I-V curve represents the electrical performance for PV modules and arrays.  PV device performance is specified by the following I-V parameters at a given temperature and solar irradiance condition:  Open-circuit voltage (Voc)  Short-circuit current (Isc)  Maximum power point (Pmp)  Maximum power voltage (Vmp)  Maximum power current (Imp) Voltage (V) Isc Voc Imp Vmp Pmp Area = Pmp Figure 51. Current-voltage curves can also be expressed as power-voltage curves where the maximum power point (Pmp) is clearly shown. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 53 Figure 51. Current-voltage curves can also expressed as power-voltage curves where the maximum power point (Pmp) is clearly shown. Voltage (V) Isc Imp Vmp Voc Pmp = Imp x Vmp Pmp Current vs. voltage Power vs. voltage PV module performance is sometimes represented by power versus voltage curves, which contain the same infor- mation as I-V curves. Power versus voltage curves provide a clearer illustration of how the power output is affected by the operating voltage, and where peak power output oc- curs. See Fig. 51. Key Module Parameters Open-circuit voltage (Voc) is the maximum dc voltage on an I-V curve, and is the operating point for a PV device with no connected load. Voc corresponds to an infinite resistance or open-circuit condition, and zero current and zero power output. Open-circuit voltage is independent of cell area and increases with decreasing cell temperature, and is used to determine maximum circuit voltages for PV modules and arrays. For crystalline silicon solar cells, the open-circuit voltage is typically on the order of 0.5 V to 0.6 V at 25°C. Thin- film technologies have slightly higher cell voltages and different temperature coefficients, but lower current density than crystalline silicon cells.
  • 51. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 51   Short-circuit current (Isc) is the maximum current on an I-V curve. Isc corresponds to a zero resistance and short-circuit condition, at zero voltage and zero power output. Short- circuit current is directly proportional to solar irradiance, and rated values are used in calculations to size PV circuit conductors and overcurrent devices. Because PV modules are inherently current-limited, PV modules can be short-circuited without harming the modules using an appropriately rated shorting device. In fact, measuring the short-circuit current of a module or string when it is disconnected from the rest of the system is one way to test modules and strings. Some PV charge controllers regulate battery charging by short-circuiting the module or array. Note that short circuits for extended periods of time (greater than several minutes under high irradiance) may damage some thin-film mod- ules. Manufacturers’ data sheets provide applicable cautions. The maximum power point (Pmp) of a PV device is the operating point on its I-V curve where the product of current and voltage is at its maximum. The maximum power voltage (Vmp) is the corresponding operating voltage at Pmp, and is typically 70% to 80% of the open-circuit voltage. The maximum power current (Imp) is the operating current at Pmp, and typically 90% of the short-circuit current. The maximum power point is located on the “knee” of the I-V curve, and represents the highest efficiency operating point for a PV device under the given conditions of solar irradiance and cell temperature. Operating Point The specific operating point on an I-V curve is determined by the electrical load accord- ing to Ohm’s Law. Consequently, the load resistance to operate a PV module or array at its maximum power point is equal to the maximum power voltage divided by the maxi- mum power current (Vmp/Imp). For example, consider a PV module with maximum power voltage (Vmp) = 35.8 V, and maximum power current (Imp) = 4.89 A. The load resistance required to operate this module at maximum power is equal to Vmp ÷ Imp = 35.8 V ÷ 4.89 A = 7.32 Ω. The maximum dc power produced is simply the product of the maximum power current and voltage. See Fig. 52. In application, the operating point on the I-V curve is determined by the specific equip- ment connected to the output of the PV array. If the load is a battery, the battery voltage Figure 52. The specific operating point on an I-V curve is determined by the electrical load resistance according to Ohm’s Law. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 54 Figure 52. The specific operating point on an I-V curve is determined by the electrical load resistance according to Ohm’s Law. Voltage Decreasing resistance Constant Temperature Increasing resistance R = 0 R = ∞ Load lines of constant resistance sets the operating point on the I-V curve, and sets the operating current. If the PV array is connected to an interactive in- verter, the inverter circuits seek to operate the PV at its maximum power point as long as the array voltage operates within the inverter specifications. Maximum power point tracking (MPPT) refers to the process or electronic equipment used to operate PV modules or arrays at their maximum power point under varying conditions. MPPT circuits are integral to interactive inverters, some charge controllers and also available as separate equipment or part of PV array source circuit combiner boxes.
  • 52. 52 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Response to Irradiance Changes in solar radiation have a direct linear and proportional effect on the current and maximum power output of a PV module or array. See Fig. 53. Therefore, doubling the so- lar irradiance on the surface of the array doubles the current and maximum power output (assuming constant temperature). Changing irradiance has a smaller effect on voltage, mainly at lower irradiance levels. Because voltage varies little with changing irradiance at higher levels, PV devices are well-suited for battery charging applications. See Fig. 54. The short-circuit current (Isc), maximum power current (Imp), and maximum power (Pmp) at one condition of solar irradiance may be translated to estimate the value of these parameters at another irradiance level: Isc2 = Isc1 × (E2 /E1 ) Pmp2 = Pmp1 × (E2 /E1 ) Imp2 = Imp1 × (E2 /E1 ) where Isc1 = rated short-circuit current at irradiance E1 (A) Isc2 = short-circuit current at new irradiance E2 (A) E1 = rated solar irradiance (W/m2 ) E2 = new solar irradiance (W/m2 ) Pmp1 = rated maximum power at irradiance E1 (W) Pmp2 = new maximum power at new irradiance E2 (W) Imp1 = rated maximum power current at irradiance E1 (A) Imp2 = new maximum power current at new irradiance E2 (A) PV installers verify performance of PV systems in the field by measuring the solar irradi- ance incident on arrays with simple handheld meters, and correlating with the actual system power output. For example, if it has been established that the peak output of a PV array is 10 kW under incident radiation levels of 1000 W/m2 at normal operating tem- peratures, then the output of the array should be expected to be around 7 kW if the solar irradiance is 700 W/m2 , assuming constant temperature. Figure 53. Changes in solar radiation have a direct linear and proportional effect on the current and maximum power output of a PV module or array. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 55 Figure 53. Changes in solar radiation have a direct linear and proportional effect on the current and maximum power output of a PV module or array. Voltage 1000 W/m2 750 W/m2 500 W/m2 250 W/m2 Current increases with increasing irradiance Voc changes little with irradiance Maximum power increases with increasing irradiance Maximum power voltage changes little with irradiance Constant Temperature Figure 54. PV module current and voltage are affected differently by solar irradiance. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: Figure 54. PV module current and voltage are affected differently by solar irradianc Irradiance (W/m2) 1000 Isc increases with increasing irradiance Voc changes little with irradiance above 200 W/m2 Constant Temperature 8006004002000
  • 53. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 53 Response to Temperature The current and voltage output of a PV module are temperature dependent. For crystal- line silicon PV devices, increasing cell temperature results in a measureable decrease in voltage and power, and a slight increase in current. Higher cell operating temperatures also reduce cell efficiency and lifetime. The temperature effects on current are an order of magnitude less than on voltage, and neglected as far as any installation or safety issues are concerned. Temperature coefficients relate the effects of changing PV cell temperature on its voltage, current and power output. For crystalline silicon PV devices, the temperature coefficient for voltage is approximately -0.4%/°C, the temperature coefficient for short-circuit cur- rent is approximately +0.04 %/°C, and the temperature coefficient for maximum power is approximately -0.45 %/°C. Note that the power and voltage temperature coefficients are negative, as these parameters decrease with increasing temperature. Thin-film PV mod- ules have different temperature coefficients than crystalline silicon modules. See Fig. 55. Since PV modules achieve their highest voltages at the lowest temperatures, this voltage determines the minimum voltage ratings required for the modules and associated dc cir- cuit components [NEC 690.7]. For crystalline silicon PV modules, the maximum voltage for PV systems is determined by multiplying the module rated open-circuit voltage (Voc) by the number of modules in series, and by a voltage correction factor [NEC Table 690.7]. See Fig. 56. Where other than crystalline silicon (thin-film) PV modules are used, or if temperature coefficients are provided with manufacturer’s instructions, manufacturer’s instructions must be used to calculate maximum system voltage. The following three methods are used to calculate maximum system voltage. The example uses a PV module with rated open-circuit voltage (Voc) = 37.3 V, installed in a location with a -12°C lowest expected ambient temperature. The array design uses 14 series-connected PV modules. Figure 55. For crystalline silicon PV devices, increasing cell temperature results in a decrease in voltage and power, and a small increase in current.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 57 Figure 55. For crystalline silicon PV devices, increasing cell temperature results in a decrease in voltage and power, and a small increase in current. Voltage T = 25°C T = 50°C T = 0 C Increasing temperature reduces voltage Increasing temperature reduces power output Increasing temperature increases current Figure 56. Voltage-temperature correction factors for crystalline silicon PV modules increase with decreasing temperatures.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 58 Figure 56. Voltage-temperature correction factors for crystalline silicon PV modules increase with decreasing temperatures.  Voltage-temperature correction factors for crystalline silicon PV modules increase with decreasing temperatures.  Manufacturer’s listed instructions must be used if:  The minimum temperatures are below -40 C,  Other than crystalline silicon PV modules are used, or  Coefficients are provided with listed instructions. Minimum Ambient Temperature (oC) Correction Factor 24 to 20 1.02 19 to 15 1.04 14 to 10 1.06 9 to 5 1.08 4 to 0 1.10 -1 to -5 1.12 -6 to -10 1.14 -11 to -15 1.16 -16 to -20 1.18 -21 to -25 1.20 -26 to -30 1.21 -31 to -35 1.23 -36 to -40 1.25 Adapted from NEC Table 690.7
  • 54. 54 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Rating Conditions Standard Test Conditions (STC) is a universal rating condition for PV modules and arrays, and specifies the electrical output at a solar irradiance level of 1000 W/m2 at AM 1.5 spectral distribution, and 25°C cell tempera- ture. The conditions are conducive to testing indoors in a manufacturing environment but tend to overestimate actual field performance, as PV arrays rarely at a temperature of 25°C and an irradiance of 1000 W/m2 at the same time. An operating temperature of 50°C at Peak Sun is much more common when the module is at mild ambient temperatures. See Fig. 57. Method 1 — Module Manufacturer’s Temperature Correction Factor—Percentage Method Temperature Coefficient for VOC = aVOC = -0.37% / °C = -0.0037 / °C Temperature Correction Factor = 1 + aVOC (%) x (TempLOW – TempRATED ) = 1 + (-0.0037/°C) x (-12°C – 25°C) = 1 + 0.137 = 1.137 VMAX = 37.3V x 14 x 1.137 = 593.7 V < 600 V (compliant for a 600VMAX inverter) Method 2 — Module Manufacturer’s Temperature Correction Factor—Voltage Method Temperature Coefficient for VOC = aVOC = x -137mV/°C = -0.137 V/°C Temperature Correction Factor = 1 + [aVOC (V/°C) x (TempLOW – TempRATED ) ÷VOC ] = 1+ [-0.137 V/°C x (-12°C – 25°C) ÷ 37.3V] = 1+ [5.069V ÷ 37.3V] = 1.136 VMAX = 37.3 V x 14 x 1.136 = 593 V < 600 V (compliant for a 600VMAX inverter) Method 3 — Table 690.7 Temperature Correction Factor From row for ambient temperature = -11°C to -15°C 1.16 VMAX = 37.3V x 14 x 1.16 = 605.8 V > 600 V (this is less accurate and yields a value that exceeds the allowable 600 VMAX for the inverter, only 13 modules in series would be permitted.) Maximum System Voltage The maximum system volt- age is the PV array open- circuit voltage at the lowest expected ambient tem- perature at a site. The NEC defines lowest expected ambient temperature in an informational note in Art. 690.7 as the Extreme Annu- al Mean Minimum Design Dry Bulb Temperature from the ASHRAE Handbook— Fundamentals. A table of these values for the United States is available in the appendix of the Expedited Permit Process: www.solar- abcs.org/permitting. The ASHRAE temperatures represent statistically valid expected low temperatures, and fall midway between the record low and the average low for a location. The record low tempera- ture for a location is overly conservative to use for PV module voltage-tempera- ture corrections, and mod- ule voltage really doesn’t reach its maximum until irradiance levels exceed 200 W/m2 , well after the record low temperature has occurred. Most PV module manufacturers now publish the temperature coefficient for Voc in their specifica- tions. Figure 57. The differences between rating conditions can be clearly shown by the I-V curves.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Array Figure 57. The differences between rating conditions can be clearly shown by the I-V cur Voltage STC SOC PTC NOC
  • 55. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 55 PV module performance is sometimes represented at other test conditions, including: • Standard Operating Conditions (SOC) Irradiance: 1,000 W/m2 Cell temperature: NOCT • Nominal Operating Conditions (NOC) Irradiance: 800 W/m2 Cell temperature: NOCT • Nominal Operating Cell Temperature (NOCT) Irradiance: 800 W/m2 Ambient Temp: 20°C PV Array: open-circuit Wind Speed: 1.0 m/s • PVUSA Test Conditions (PTC) 1000 W/m², 45°C, 1 m/s A number of standards have been developed to address the safety, reliability and perfor- mance of PV modules. PV modules are classified as electrical equipment, and hence must conform to accepted product safety standards, and according to the NEC, they must be listed or approved by a recognized laboratory. In the U.S., PV modules are listed for electrical safety to UL1703 “Safety Standard for Flat- Plate Photovoltaic Modules and Panels”. These requirements cover flat-plate photovoltaic modules intended for installation in accordance with the NEC and for use in systems with a maximum system voltage of 1000 volts or less. The standard also covers compo- nents intended to provide electrical connections and for the structural mounting of PV modules. The corresponding international standard is IEC61730, which has been harmo- nized with UL 1703. PV Module Labels Certain key I-V parameters at Standard Test Conditions are required to be labeled on ev- ery listed PV module [NEC 690.51]. These nameplate electrical ratings govern the circuit design and application limits for the module, and must include the following information and ratings: • polarity of terminals • maximum overcurrent device rating for module protection • open-circuit voltage (Voc) • short-circuit current (Isc) • maximum permissible systems voltage • operating or maximum power voltage (Vmp) • operating or maximum power current (Imp) • maximum power (Pmp)
  • 56. 56 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Other items found on PV modules labels include fire classification ratings, minimum conductor sizes and ratings, and additional design qualification and type testing certifica- tion [IEC 61215 or IEC 61646]. Additional information related to PV module installation is found in the installation instructions included with listed PV modules. All installers should thoroughly read this information before working with or installing any PV mod- ules or arrays [NEC 110.2]. See Fig. 59. PV modules may be evaluated for external fire exposure for building roof covering materials. The fire class is identified in the individual Recognitions as class A, B or C in accordance with UL’s Roofing Materials and Systems Directory. Modules not evaluated for fire exposure are identified as NR (Not Rated), and cannot be installed on buildings.  Air Mass Air mass (AM) is the relative path length of direct solar radiation through the atmosphere. Air mass affects the amount and spectral content of the solar radiation reaching the earth’s surface, and varies with sun position and altitude (barometric pressure). AM 1.5 defines the spectral irradiance characteristic for testing and rating the electrical performance of PV cells and modules, and is representative of a solar altitude angle of about 42°. Air mass is equal to 1/cosUz , where Uz is the zenith angle (90°-altitude angle). AM 0 is taken outside the earth’s atmo- sphere, and represents extraterrestrial radiation. When the sun is directly overhead in the tropics, air mass is equal to one (AM 1). Air mass is also corrected for higher altitudes by average pressure ratios. See Fig 58. Figure 58. Air mass (AM) 1.5 defines the spectral irradiance characteristic for testing and rating the electrical performance of PV cells and modules.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar C 1 cos z o where AM air mass zenith angle (degz P local pressure (Pa P sea level pressureo Air mass is calac P AM P θ θ = = = =  =  Earth Sun directly overhead (zenith) Sun at mid-morning or mid-afternoon Earth’s Surface Limits of Atmosphere Air Mass = 0 (AM0) Air Mass = 1 (AM1.0) Zenith Angle θz = 48.2 deg Air Mass = 1.5 (AM1.5) Horizon  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 60 Figure 58. Air mass (AM) 1.5 defines the spectral irradiance characteristic for testing and rating the electrical performance of PV cells and modules. 1 cos z o where AM air mass zenith angle (deg)z P local pressure (Pa) P sea level pressure (Pa)o Air mass is calaculated by the following: P AM P θ θ = = = =   =    Earth Sun directly overhead (zenith) Sun at mid-morning or mid-afternoon Earth’s Surface Limits of Atmosphere Air Mass = 0 (AM0) Air Mass = 1 (AM1.0) Zenith Angle θz = 48.2 deg Air Mass = 1.5 (AM1.5) Horizon Figure 59. PV module nameplate electrical ratings govern the circuit design and application limits for the product.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 61 Figure 59. PV module nameplate electrical ratings govern the circuit design and application limits for the product.  All PV modules must be marked with the following information [690.51]:  Open-circuit voltage  Short-circuit current  Operating voltage  Operating current  Maximum power  Polarity of terminals  Maximum overcurrent device rating  Maximum permissible system voltage
  • 57. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 57 Series/Parallel Connections PV arrays consist of building blocks of individual PV modules connected electrically in series and parallel to achieve the desired operating voltage and current. PV modules are usually connected in series first to build voltage suitable for connection to dc utilization equipment, such as interactive inverters, batteries, charge controllers or dc loads. PV source circuits are then connected in parallel at combiner boxes to build current and power output for the array. A string is a series connection of PV devices. PV cells or modules are configured electrically in series by connecting the negative terminal of one device to the positive terminal of the next device, and so on. For the series connection of similar PV modules, the voltages add and the resulting string voltage is the sum of the individual module voltages. The resulting string current output remains the same as the current output of an individual module. See Figs. 60 & 61. Connecting PV modules in series with dissimilar cur- rent ratings results in loss of power, similar in effect to partially shading an array, or having parts of a series source circuit located on surfaces facing differ- ent directions and receiving different solar irradiance. The resultant current output for a string of dissimilar current output devices is ultimately limited to the lowest current output device in the entire string, and should be avoided. However, it is perfectly acceptable to connect PV modules with different voltage output in series, as long as each module has the same rated current output. See Fig. 62. Series strings of PV modules are configured electri- cally in parallel by connecting the negative termi- nals of each string together and the positive strings together. Usually, an overcurrent device is required in each string. For the parallel connection of strings, the string currents add and the resulting string voltage is the average of the individual string voltages. Parallel connections of strings with different current output, or from strings in different planes are acceptable, but may require different circuit sizing. See Figs. 63, 64 & 65. Monopole PV arrays consist of two output circuit conductors, a positive and negative. Bipolar PV ar- rays combine two monopole arrays with a center tap. Figure 60. PV cells or modules are configured electrically in series by connecting the negative terminal of one device to the positive terminal of the next device, and so on. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 62 Figure 60. PV cells or modules are configured electrically in series by connecting the negative terminal of one device to the positive terminal of the next device, and so on. (-) Pos (+) Neg (-) 1 2(+) (-)(+) n (-)(+) Vseries string = V1 + V2 ….. + Vn Vseries string = V1 x n Iseries string = I1 = I2 ….. = In (for similar devices) Figure 61. Connecting similar PV devices in series increases voltage while current stays the same.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 63 Figure 61. Connecting similar PV devices in series increases voltage while current stays the same. For similar PV devices in series: Vseries = V1 + V2 ….. + Vn Vseries = V1 x n Iseries = I1 = I2 ….. = In Voltage (V) Current(A) 1 device 2 devices in series “n” devices in series Figure 63. PV cells or modules are connected in parallel by connecting the negative terminals together and the positive terminals together at a common point.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 65 Figure 63. PV cells or modules are connected in parallel by connecting the negative terminals together and the positive terminals together at a common point. For PV devices in parallel: Vparallel = V1 = V2 ….. = Vn (for similar devices) Vparallel = (V1 + V2 … + Vn) / n Iparallel = I1 + I2 ….. + In Pos (+) Neg (-) n (-) (+) 1 (-) (+) 2 (-) (+) Figure 62. Connecting dissimilar PV devices in series must be avoided. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 64 Figure 62. Connecting dissimilar PV devices in series must be avoided.  When dissimilar PV devices are connected in series, the voltages still add, but the current is limited by the lowest current output device in series.  Not acceptable. Vseries = VA + VB Iseries = IA < IB Pos (+) (-) (+) Neg (-) Pos (+) Neg (-) A B
  • 58. 58 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Certain inverters require the use of bi-polar arrays. See Fig. 66. Bypass diodes are connected in parallel with series strings of cells to prevent cell overheating when cells or parts of an array are shaded. See Fig. 67. Bypass diodes are essentially electrical check valves that permit the flow of current in only one direction. When modules in series strings are partially shaded, it may cause reverse voltage across the shaded cells or modules. The bypass diode shunts current around the shaded area and prevents cell overheat- ing. Most listed PV modules are equipped with factory installed bypass diodes. Bypass diodes may or may not be serviceable via module junction boxes in the field. See Fig. 68. PV Inverters Inverters are used in PV systems to produce ac power from a dc source, such as a PV array or batteries. Inverter sizes range from module-level inverters rated a few hundred watts to utility-scale inverters 1 MW and larger. Similar to the way PV systems are classified, types of PV inverters are also defined based on their application in stand-alone, utility-interactive, or a combination of both types of systems. Stand-alone inverters operate from batteries and supply power independent of the electrical utility system. These inverters may also include a battery charger to operate from an independent ac source, such as the electric utility or a generator. See Fig 69. Utility-interactive or grid-connected inverters operate from PV arrays and supply power in parallel with an electrical production and distribution network. They do not supply PV array power to loads during loss of grid voltage (energy storage is required). See Fig. 70. Multi-mode inverters are a type of battery-based interactive inverter that act as diversionary charge controllers by producing ac power output to regu- late PV array battery charging, and sends excess power to the grid when it is energized. During grid outages, these inverters transfer backup loads off- grid, and operate in stand-alone mode. They can Figure 64. Connecting similar PV devices in parallel increases current while voltage stays the same.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 66 Figure 64. Connecting similar PV devices in parallel increases current while voltage stays the same. Voltage (V) Current(A) Device 1+2 independently Devices 1+2 in parallel For PV devices in parallel: Vparallel = V1 = V2 ….. = Vn (for similar devices) Vparallel = (V1 + V2 … + Vn) / n Iparallel = I1 + I2 ….. + In Figure 65. Dissimilar current PV modules and strings having similar voltage may be connected in parallel.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 67 Connecting Dissimilar PV Devices in Parallel  When dissimilar devices are connected in parallel, the individual currents add, and the voltage is the average of devices. Vparallel = (VA + VB) / 2 Iparallel = IA + IB B A Pos (+)Neg (-) Figure 66. Monopole PV arrays consist of two output circuit conductors; bipolar PV arrays combine two monopole arrays with a center tap.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 68 Figure 65. Monopole PV arrays consist of two output circuit conductors; while bipolar PV arrays combine two monopole arrays with a center tap. Bipolar ArrayMonopole Array PV Array Positive (+) Negative (-) Center Tap PV Array Positive (+) Negative (-) PV Array Figure 67. Bypass diodes are connected in parallel with series strings of cells to prevent cell overheating when cells or parts of an array are shaded. 2012 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 2 Bypass Diodes When cells are not shaded, the bypass diode is reverse biased and does not conduct current Shaded cell When a cells is shaded, the bypass diode is forward biased and conducts current Pos (+)Neg (-)
  • 59. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 59 operate either in interactive or stand-alone mode, but not simultaneously. Although stand-alone and interactive PV inverters both produce ac power from dc power input, they have differ- ent applications and functions. See Fig. 71. The following list different types of utility-interactive inverters and their applications: Module-level inverters include ac modules and micro in- verters installed integral to or adjacent to individual PV modules. These small inverters are rated 200 W to 300 W maximum ac power output, which is consistent with standard PV module sizes. The ac outputs of multiple inverters are connected in parallel to a dedicated branch circuit breaker. Advantages of module-level inverters include individual module MPPT and better energy har- vest from partially shaded and multi-directional arrays. They also minimizes field-installed dc wiring and dc source circuit design issues, and they are inherently safer as the maximum dc voltages on the array are for a single module (35-60 V) as opposed to a series connection of several hundred volts for string inverters. See Fig. 72. String inverters are small inverters in the 1 kW to 12 kW size range, intended for residential and small commercial applications. They are generally single-phase and usually limited to 1 to 6 parallel-connected source circuits. Some integrate source circuit combiners, fuses and disconnects into a single unit. Larger systems using multiple string inverters offer a number of advantages in systems design and installation. Multiple inverters can be distributed at Figure 68. Bypass diodes are often located in module junction boxes.  Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 70 Figure 67. Bypass diodes are often located in module junction boxes. Figure 69. Stand-alone inverters supply power to ac loads isolated from the grid, and the inverter power rating dictates the maximum load.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 71 Figure 68. Stand-alone inverters supply power to ac loads isolated from the grid, and the inverter power rating dictates the maximum load. DC LoadPV Array Battery Charge Controller Stand-Alone Inverter/Charger AC Load AC Source (to Charger Only) Figure 70. Interactive inverters use PV arrays for dc power input, and supply synchro- nized ac output power in parallel with the utility grid, supplementing power to the local ac distribution system.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 72 Figure 69. Interactive inverters use PV arrays for dc power input, and supply synchronized ac output power in parallel with the utility grid, supplementing power to the local ac distribution system. Load Center PV Array Interactive Inverter AC Loads Electric Utility Figure 71. Stand-alone inverters use a battery for the dc power source, while interactive inverters use a PV array as the dc source.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 73 Figure 70. Stand-alone inverters use a battery for the dc power source, while interactive inverters use a PV array as the dc source. Battery Stand-Alone Inverter AC Load PV Array Interactive Inverter Utility Grid Interactive Operation with PV Array as DC Power Source AC load is limited by inverter power rating PV array size is limited by inverter power rating Stand-Alone Operation with Battery as DC Power Source Vs.
  • 60. 60 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 57 mperature results in a decrease in r, and a small increase in current. temperature ower output subarray locations, avoiding long dc circuits, and can be interconnect- ed at distributed points in an electrical system. Multiple inverters also provide redundancy in the event of an individual inverter or subarray failure, and provide MPPT and monitoring at the subarray level, facili- tating fault finding and optimizing the output of individual subarrays of different size, type, orientation or partially shaded. The ac output of multiple string inverters can be distributed equally across the three phases networks to avoid phase imbalance. See Fig. 73A and 73B. Central inverters start at 30 kW to 50 kW up to 500 kW, and interconnect to 3-phase grids. They are best suited for homogeneous PV arrays hav- ing all the same modules and source circuit configurations, and aligned and oriented in the same direction with no shading. Utility-scale inverters are very large equipment with power ratings 500 kW to 1 MW and higher, designed for solar farms. These types may also include medium-voltage (MV) transformers and switchgear, and are interconnected to the grid at distribution voltages up to 38 kV. For utility-controlled sites, certain variances with the NEC and product listing requirements may apply. Both utility-scale and central inverter installations require heavy equipment handling, larger conduit and switchgear, and should be installed by competent individuals having experience with the installation of large electrical equipment. See Fig. 74. Special controls may be used for utility-scale inverters that differ from smaller inverters due to their impact on grid operations. Smaller inverters are designed for near unity power factor output with tighter anti-islanding and power quality controls. Utility-scale inverters may be designed to deliver reactive power or low voltage ride through (LVRT), or provide other dynamic controls for grid support. Multi-mode inverters are battery-based interactive inverters that provide grid backup to critical loads, typical with rated ac power output 2 kW to 10 kW. They can operate in either interactive or stand-alone mode, but not simultaneously, and many can interface and control auxiliary Figure 72. AC modules and micro inverters are small inverters installed integral to or adjacent to individual PV modules. Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 74 micro inverters are small inverters installed integral to or adjacent to individual PV modules. Enphase Micro Inverter Figure 73B. String inverters are small inverters in the 1 to 12 kW size range, intended for residential and small commercial applications.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 75 Figure 73A. Stand-alone inverters convert DC power from batteries into AC power. Morningstar SureSine SMA Sunny Island
  • 61. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 61 source, such as generators for hybrid system applications. These types of inverters and systems are used where a backup power supply is required for critical loads. Under nor- mal circumstances when the grid is energized, the inverter acts as a diversionary charge controller, limiting battery voltage and state-of charge by supplying output power to ac loads or the grid. When the primary power source is lost, a transfer switch internal to the inverter opens the connection with the utility, and the inverter operates dedicated loads that have been disconnected from the grid. An external bypass switch is usually provided to allow the system to be taken off-line for service or maintenance, while not interrupting the operation of electrical loads. These inverters may also be used in hybrid system ap- plications to control loads, battery charging, and generator starting. Inverter circuits use high-speed switching transistors to convert dc to ac power. Large thyristors are used in high power applications up to several MW for HVDC power trans- mission at grid-interties. Most PV inverters use metal-oxide semiconductor field-effect transistors (MOSFETs) or insulated gate bi-polar transistors (IGBTs). Power MOSFETs operate at lower voltages with high efficiency and low resistance compared to IGBTs. They switch at very high speeds (up to 800 kW) and are generally used in medium to low-power applications from 1 kW to 10 kW. IGBTs handle high current and voltage, but switch at lower speeds (up to 20 kHz), and are more common for high-voltage, large power applications up to an over 100 kW. Switching elements are connected in parallel to increase the current and power capability of an inverter. Sine waves, square waves and modified square waves are examples of common inverter ac waveforms. Listed utility-interactive inverters produce utility-grade sine wave output. Some small, lower cost stand-alone inverters produce modified square wave or square wave output. See Fig. 75. Figure 74. Utility-scale inverters use higher DC input and AC output voltages to reduce losses, and the size and costs of the conductors and switchgear required. Figure 73. Utility-scale inverters use higher DC input and AC output voltages to reduce loss and the size and costs of the conductors and switchgear requir
  • 62. 62 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Selecting and specifying the best inverter for a given application involves considering the system design and installation requirements. Inverter specification sheets are critical. Inverter selection is often the first consideration in system design, and based on the type of loads or electrical service and voltage, and the size and location of the PV array. AC Waveforms For a pure sine wave, the peak voltage is related to the RMS voltage by a factor of the square root of 2: Vpeak = Vrms × √2 = Vrms × 1.414 Vrms = Vpeak × 0.707 For example, a typical AC voltage sine wave with peak voltage of 170 V has an RMS voltage of 170 × 0.707 = 120 V. For pure sine waves, the average voltage is also related to RMS and peak voltage by: Vrms = 1.11 × Vavg, or Vavg = 0.9 × Vrms. Vavg = 0.637 × Vpeak, or Vpeak = 1.57 × Vavg. For a square wave, Vavg, Vrms, and Vpeak are all equal. See Fig. 76. Figure 75. For a pure sine wave, the peak voltage is related to the RMS voltage by a factor of the square root of 2. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 77 Figure 74. Sine waves, square waves and modified square waves are examples of common inverter ac waveforms. Time > Sine Wave 0 Modified Square Wave Square Wave
  • 63. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 63 Specifications for inverters typically include: DC Input • Maximum array or dc voltage (open-circuit, cold) • Recommended maximum array power • Start voltage and operating range (interactive inverters only) • MPPT voltage range (interactive inverters only) • Maximum usable input current (interactive inverters) • Maximum array and source circuit current • Array ground fault detection AC Output • Nominal voltage • Maximum continuous output power • Maximum continuous output current • Maximum output overcurrent device rating • Power conversion efficiency • Power quality • Anti-islanding protection Performance • Nominal and weighted efficiencies • Stand-by losses (nighttime) • Monitoring and communications interface Physical • Operating temperature range • Size and weight • Mounting locations, enclosure type • Conductor termination sizes and torque specifications • Conduit knockout sizes and configurations Other Features • Integral dc or ac disconnects • Number of source circuit combiner and fuse/circuit ratings • Standard and extended warranties Figure 76. Sine waves, square waves and modified square waves are examples of common inverter ac waveforms.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 78 Figure 75. For a pure sine wave, the peak voltage is related to the RMS voltage by a factor of the square root of 2: One cycle: 360 Time >> 0 Sine wave has Vpeak = VRMS x √2 120 Voltage 170 Square wave has Vpeak = VRMS -170 -120 Inverter efficiency is calculated by the ac power output divided by the dc power input. Inverter efficiency varies with power level, input volt- age and temperature, among other factors. For example, an inverter having an input power of 6000 Wdc and producing and output of 5700 Wac has an efficiency of 5700 ÷ 6000 = 0.95 = 95%. See Fig 77.
  • 64. 64 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 In addition to product safety testing and listing to the UL1741 standard, the California Energy Commission (CEC) has established requirements for independent inverter ef- ficiency testing by an NRTL to be approved as eligible equipment. Incentive programs in other states also require the use of PV modules and inverters on the CEC list. A complete list of eligible inverters and test results are available online.   Inverter efficiency testing is conducted over the entire power range of the inverter, and at minimum, maximum and nominal dc operating voltages. Inverter efficiency rises quickly with a low power levels, and most inverters reach at least 90% efficiency at only 10% of their maximum continuous output power rating. See Fig 78. Reference: List of Eligible Inverters per SB1 Guidelines, California Energy Commission: http://www.gosolarcalifornia.org/equipment/inverters.php Figure 77. Inverter efficiency is calculated by the ac power output divided by the dc power input.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 79 Figure 76. Inverter efficiency is calculated by the AC power output divided by the DC power input. 5700 0.95 95% 6000 where = inverter efficiency = AC power ouput (W) = DC power input (W) AC inv DC inv AC DC P P P P η η = = = = AC Output: 5700 W DC Input: 6000 W Losses: 300 W Inverter Inverter Standards The following standards apply to inverters used in PV systems, including requirements for product listing, installation and interconnection to the grid. UL 1741 Inverters, Converters, Controllers and Interconnection System Equipment for Use with Distributed Energy Resources addresses requirements for all types of distributed generation equipment, including inverters and charge controllers used in PV systems, as well as the interconnection of wind turbines, fuel cells, microturbines and engine-generators. IEEE 1547 Standard for Interconnecting Distributed Resources with Electric Power Sys- tems, and IEEE 1547.1 Standard for Conformance Test Procedures for Equipment Inter- connecting Distributed Resources with Electric Power Systems are the basis for UL 1741 certification for interactive inverters. Inverter installation requirements are governed by the NEC Articles 690 and 705. These articles cover inverter installation requirement including sizing conductors and overcur- rent protection devices, disconnect means, grounding, and for connecting interactive inverters to the electric utility grid.
  • 65. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 65   2.7 Review Wiring and Conduit Size Calculations There are several circuits in PV systems depending on the type of system installed. Some circuits are dc and others are ac, operating at different voltages and currents, and of varying length and environmental exposure. Some of these circuits have special requirements for sizing the circuit conductors and overcurrent protection. The PV installer should be able to clearly identify the different circuits in a PV system and their installation requirements [NEC 690.2]. See Figs. 79, 80 & 81. Figure 78. Inverter efficiency testing is conducted over a range of operating voltages and power levels.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 80 California Energy Commission  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 81 Figure 78. The PV power source consists of the complete PV array dc power generating unit, including PV source circuits, PV output circuits, and overcurrent protection devices as required. PV Module PV Output Circuit Photovoltaic Power Source PV Array PV Source Circuits To disconnect means and DC equipment  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 82 Figure 79. For simple interactive PV systems, the PV array is connected to the dc input of inverters, and there is no energy storage. Interactive System PV Array Source Circuit Combiner Box DC Fused Disconnect Ground Fault Protection AC Fused Disconnect Electric Utility Utility Disconnect Integral components in many small string inverters < 12 kW PV Source Circuits PV Output Circuit Inverter Input Circuit Inverter Output Circuit Inverter Main Service Panel Figure 81. For stand-alone PV systems the PV array charges the battery, and the battery provides dc power to the inverter which can produce ac power output at any time.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 83 Figure 80. For stand-alone PV systems the PV array charges the battery, and the battery provides dc power to the inverter which can produce ac power output at any time. Stand-Alone System PV Array Source Circuit Combiner Box PV Fused Disconnect Ground Fault Protection Inverter Fused Disconnect Auxiliary AC Source PV Source Circuits PV Output Circuit Inverter DC input Circuit Inverter/ Charger Battery Charge Controller Battery Fused Disconnect Inverter Output Circuit AC Loads DC Loads Figure 79. The PV power source consists of the complete PV array dc power generating unit, including PV source circuits, PV output circuits, and overcurrent protection devices as required. Figure 80. For simple interactive PV systems, the PV array is connected to the dc input of inverters, and there is no energy storage.
  • 66. 66 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 2.7.1 Determine Circuit Currents PV Source Circuit Maximum Current The required ampacity of the source circuit wiring, or conductors from modules to source circuit combiner box, depends upon the rated PV module short-circuit current (Isc). The maximum current for PV source circuits is determined by 125% of the sum of the module rated short-circuit currents in parallel [NEC 690.8(A)]. Since most crystalline silicon ar- rays only have one series string per source circuit, there is normally no need to account for parallel circuits in the source circuit calculation. The reason for the 125% factor is that in certain locations and times of the year, it is possible for the modules to operate at 125% of the STC short-circuit current rating for 3 hours or more around solar noon. For example, consider a module with short circuit rating of 8.41 A. The maximum continuous current rating of that module is 125% of the STC short-circuit current rating, or 1.25 × 8.41 A = 10.5 A. PV Output Circuit Maximum Current The maximum current for the PV output circuit and the entire PV power source is the sum of all parallel source circuits supplying dc power. The maximum circuit current for a typical PV array with three series strings is the sum of the three source circuit maximum currents. For the example with a maximum source circuit current of 10.5 A, the maximum current for the PV output circuit having three of these source circuits in parallel would be 3 × 10.5 A = 31.5 A. Inverter Output Circuit Maximum Current The inverter output circuit is defined as the ac circuit from the inverter output to the utilization load. In the case of utility-interactive installations, the inverter output circuit is the ac output that connects to the interactive point of utility connection. This point of connection in residential PV systems is often a simple circuit breaker in a utility-fed service panel. The maximum current of the inverter output circuit is the continuous cur- rent capability of the inverter (continuous = 3-hour rating). The maximum continuous current of an inverter may be listed on the product specification sheet. If it is not available on the specification sheet, then the current can be calculated by taking the continuous power rating at 40°C and dividing that value by the nominal ac voltage. For example, the maximum current for an inverter with maximum continuous power output of 7,000 W at 240 Vac would be 29 A.   Battery Circuit Current Battery circuits are unique in that they carry not only the dc current required to run the inverter at full load continuously (for 3 hours), but they must also carry ac current. This may surprise some installers, but all inverters require an ac input in order to create and ac output. Since dc sources such as a PV array do not naturally provide these ac currents, a short-term storage device is necessary. In utility-interactive inverters, these storage devices are capacitors. Each time the ac power goes to zero, when the ac voltage goes to zero, the power from the PV array is stored in the capacitor. That energy is rereleased at the peak of the next waveform. Therefore current is stored and removed from the capaci- tor two times every cycle. When the required frequency is 60 Hertz, the frequency on the capacitors is 120 Hertz. This storage is sometimes called half-wave storage.
  • 67. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 67 In battery-based inverters, rather than installing capacitors, the battery is used for half- wave storage. Current that is needed to create the sine wave is stored and removed from the battery. This means that additional current is travelling on the battery input conduc- tors that must be accounted for. 2.72 Calculate Required Ampacity of Conductors Temperature and Conduit Fill Corrections for Ampacity of Conductors The required ampacity of conductors is based on the maximum circuit current, the size of the overcurrent protection device, the ambient temperature of the conductor, the type of conductor and insulation, the conduit fill of the conductor, and any limitations that the terminals may place on the conductor. PV systems are some of the most complex wiring systems to determine wire sizing due to the large number of factors that must be considered when choosing an adequate wire size. Fortunately, the 2011 NEC has clearer direction on this subject that should help installers and system designers more accurately specify wire sizes. To illustrate the proper code-approved method, it is beneficial to do an example using NEC 690.8 from the 2011 NEC.   EXAMPLE: A residential rooftop PV system has 3 pairs of conductors in a sunlit raceway mounted 1½” above the roof surface in Palm Springs, California. The short-circuit current of each source circuit is 8.41 amps. What is the minimum size conductor for this scenario? Answer: Step 1: Calculate Maximum Circuit Current [690.8(A)(1)]: Imax = Isc x 1.25 = 8.41 A x 1.25 = 10.5 A Step 2: Calculate the minimum overcurrent protective device (OCPD) [690.8(B)(1)(a)]: OCPD = Imax x 1.25 = 10.5 A x 1.25 = 13.1 A 14 A [690.9(C)] Step 3: Calculate minimum conductor size without conditions of use [690.8(B)(2)(a)] Minimum conductor ampacity = Imax x 1.25 = 13.1A 14 AWG (minimum bldg wire, Table 310.15(B)16) Step 4: Calculate minimum conductor size based on Imax with conditions of use [690.8(B)(2)(b)]: Conditions of use include conduit fill, sunlit conduit temperature adder, and ambient temperature adjustment factors. Conduit fill adjustment factor 0.8 according to Table 310.15(B)(3)(a) Sunlit conduit temperature adder 22°C according to Table 310.15(B)(3)(c) Ambient temperature adjustment factor 22°C + 44°C = 66°C 0.58 [Table 310.15(B)(2)(a)] Minimum conductor ampacity = Imax ÷ conduit fill adj factor ÷ temp adj factor = 10.5 ÷ 0.8 ÷ 0.58 = 22.6 A 12 AWG Step 5: Determine if 15 Amp overcurrent protection can protect the conductor under conditions of use [690.8(B)(2)(c)] 12 AWG ampacity = 30 A x 0.8 x 0.58 = 13.92 A (fails because 14 A fuse will not protect this conductor under conditions of use) 10 AWG ampacity = 40 A x 0.8 x 0.58 = 18.56 A (okay)  
  • 68. 68 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 PV Source Circuits Outside Conduit Exposed outdoor cables are common in PV systems and in industrial conventional electri- cal systems, but they are less common in commercial and residential electrical systems. Conductors as single conductor cables, or bundles of three conductors or less, are com- monly run in PV arrays from a few kilowatts up to megawatts. Since these conductors are often run for some distance in free air, it would be possible to claim free air ampacities for those exposed lengths of cables [NEC Table 310.15(B)(17)]. However, these exposed conductors are often run into raceways for physical protection and support. As long as the sections of raceway protection are not more than 10 ft or 10% of the circuit length, then free air ampacities can be used [NEC 310.15(A)(2)]. Bundled or Inside Conduit In almost all cases, wiring behind modules will be exposed to elevated temperatures, sometimes as high as 75°C. The NEC also recognizes the fact that conductors installed in conduit exposed to direct sunlight, as is common in PV systems, can operate at tempera- tures that are 17ºC or more above the ambient temperature [Table 310.15(B)(3)(c)]. This means that a conduit in an outdoor temperature of 40ºC should actually be sized based on a 57ºC operating temperature due to sunlight exposure. Suppose the conductors are exposed to 57°C and that 14 AWG THWN, with insulation rated at 75°C, is being consid- ered. According to NEC Table 310.15(B)(16), when THWN wire is operated at 30°C or less, its ampacity is 20 A. But the correction factor associated with Table 310.15(B)(2)(a) requires that the ampacity of the wire be derated to 58% of its 30°C value if it is operated at 57°C. This reduces the ampacity of the 14 AWG THWN wire to 20 A x 0.58 = 11.6 A. Wherever 4-6 current carrying conductors are bundled or enclosed in the same conduit or raceway, according to NEC Table 310.15(B)(3)(a), a further adjustment of 80% is needed for conduit fill. This reduces the ampacity of the 14 AWG THWN conductors to 11.6 A x 0.8 = 9.28 A. The ampacity of the conductor, after the application of these “conditions of use” factors must be equal to or greater than the maximum circuit current, or a larger size conductor is required. The fuse protecting the conductors must also be rated at 1.25 times the maximum current (1.56 Isc), which is 13.1 A, and that fuse must provide overcurrent protection for the con- ductor under its conditions of use. The fuse rating can be rounded up to the next higher standard value (14 A), but this will not protect the cable, which has a corrected ampacity of only 9.28 A. The 14 AWG THWN conductor therefore is not acceptable due to the mini- mum size of the overcurrent protection required. However, if a 14 AWG THWN-2 copper wire is used, the 30°C ampacity is 25 A. Further- more, the temperature correction factor for 57°C operation is 0.71. The resulting ampacity of the 14 AWG THWN-2 conductor, when corrected for temperature and for conduit fill becomes 25 x 0.71 x 0.8 = 14.2 A, which is adequate to handle the maximum source circuit current. It can also be protected with a 14 A fuse. When using conductors with insulation temperature ratings higher than the terminal temperature rating of the connected devices, a check must be made to ensure that the conductor temperature during normal operation does not exceed the maximum tempera-
  • 69. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 69 Prepare for the new grid. With the“Masters of the Off-Grid.” www.outbackpower.com OutBack Power’s Certificate Training Program: NABCEP- approved comprehensive course covers all aspects of energy storage-based systems. Puts you well on your way to PV Installation Professional Certification or Solar PV Re-Certification. Two west-coast training locations in Washington and Arizona. Contact training@outbackpower.com or call 360-435-4030 and ask for Certificate Training Program. Delivering our Customers with the Best Overall Value. For Off-Grid Applications When Every WATT Counts! www.morningstarcorp.com/products Products Built From the Inside Out NABCEP PV Installation Professional Certification looks a little different these days, but our promise has not changed. As the industry’s mark of excellence, NABCEP certification continues to provide unparalleled opportunity for job advancement, salary growth and consumer trust. Experience. Quality. Professionalism. Our promise has never changed. And our new look only makes certification more attractive. PV Installation Professional NABCEP PV Installation Professional Certification Visit nabcep.org The new look of expertise.
  • 70. 70 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP CAREER PATHWAYS:  PV INSTALLATION PROFESSIONAL  PV TECHNICAL SALES  PV CONTINUING EDUCATION We’ll get you there. go.ncsu.edu/pvtraining Solar Congratulations to NABCEP for making strides in our industry. We are proud to support your dedicated mission to responsible energy. r e n o v a s o l a r . c o m America’s first professionally accredited company. PV Installation Company Renova Energy Corp. California – 2012
  • 71. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 71 The World’s #1 News Source for Solar Installers! Keeping you informed. Featuring award-winning online content and the world’s largest Solar Energy e-Newsletter. Register Today! www.RenewableEnergyWorld.com
  • 72. 72 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 SCHOLARSHIPS AVAILABLE SO NO COST TO YOU! CONTACT TODAY: www.spectechedu.com PHONE: 616-794-7536 E-MAIL: info@spectechedu.com STAHLIN – The World’s Most Specified Non-Metallic Enclosure “ B E C AU S E P E R F O R M A N C E M AT T E R S ” SpecTECH is the only nationally-recognized educational program developed specifically to provide a comprehensive understanding of material sciences as relates to the proper selection of enclosures for diverse applications. This two-day hands on educational opportunity is accredited for 12 NABCEP CEU’s & 16 PDH hours! SpecTECH Enclosures & Material Education ALONG WITH Stahlin Non-Metallic Enclosures TWO RESOURCES DEDICATED TO YOUR SUCCESS IN THE SOLAR ENERGY INDUSTRY! NEED NABCEP CONTINUING EDUCATION CREDITS? STAHLIN NON-METALLIC ENCLOSURES www.stahlin.com 500 Maple St. • Belding, MI 48809 • Phone: 616-794-0700 • Fax: 616-794-3378 • COST EFFECTIVE • UV RESISTANT • CORROSION RESISTANT • UL1741 APPROVED • TYPE 4X AND 6P TYPICAL APPLICATIONS: • COMBINER BOXES • JUNCTION • INSTRUMENTATION • CONTROLS
  • 73. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 73 ture rating of the terminals of these devices. In this case the module terminals are rated at 90°C and the fuse terminals are rated at 60°C or 75°C. The ampacity of the 14 AWG conductor taken from the 75°C or 60°C insulation column in NEC Table 310.15(B)(16) is 20 A. The continuous current in this circuit is only 10.5 A so it is assured that the 14 AWG conductor will operate at temperatures well below 60°C at the fuse terminals if the ter- minals are in an ambient temperature of 30ºC. If the fuse terminals are in a 40ºC environ- ment, similar to conduit not exposed to sunlight, the maximum allowable current must be corrected by the 40ºC correction factor of 0.82 (0.82 x 20 A = 16.4 A). Fortunately, the maximum continuous current is only 10.5 A which is well below the maximum of 16.4 A. If the terminals are in a box on the roof exposed to direct sunlight, they would have to be rated for 75ºC minimum in order to not overheat on a hot sunny day since the tempera- tures could reach 57ºC similar to inside the conduit. PV Output Circuit Bundled or Inside Conduit PV power source circuits, similar to feeder circuits in conventional ac distribution in buildings are typically run inside conduit. Occasionally these circuits are bundled to- gether and run in cable trays. In either case, adjustment factors must be applied to the allowable ampacity of the conductors to prevent the insulation from being damaged by overheating. Table 310.15(B)(3)(a) covers the adjustment factors required for conductors in raceways or multi-conductor cables. Bundles of single conductor cables would also be required to use these adjustment factors. Inverter Output Circuit The inverter output circuit is sized according to 690.8(A)(3), which states that the conduc- tor shall be sized according to the maximum continuous current output of the inverter. The overcurrent device protecting the wire must be sized at least 1.25 times the continu- ous current. The chosen overcurrent device should be the sized according to the conduc- tor ampacity after conditions of use or the next standard size above that ampacity. If the overcurrent device is sized larger than the next available size, when the max OCPD rating for the inverter allows a larger size, then the conductor size must be increased to match the OCPD rating. Battery Circuit To properly calculate the required ampacity of the inverter input circuit in a battery- based inverter system, the maximum input current needs of the inverter must be calcu- lated and then the RMS ac current of the inverter operation must be numerically added. EXAMPLE: A 6000 Watt (Volt-Amp) inverter is connected to a large battery bank at 48 Volts. Inverter is operating at full capacity and lowest dc operating voltage of 44 Volts. What is the total current flowing through the inverter input circuit conductors for a 90% efficient inverter with 45 amps of ac ripple current on the battery? Step 1: Calculate dc current: Idc = inverter power ÷ inverter efficiency ÷ dc voltage at minimum operating voltage = 6000 VA ÷ 0.9 ÷ 44 V = 152 A [690.8(A)(4)] Step 2: Total current = Idc + Iac ripple = 152 A + 45 A = 197 A
  • 74. 74 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Size Equipment Grounding Conductor for Each Circuit The equipment grounding conductor (EGC) for the dc side of the PV system is sized according to NEC 690.45. Since most PV systems related to residential and commercial buildings must have ground-fault protection systems [NEC 690.5]. NEC 690.45(A) re- quires the minimum size EGC to be based on Table 250.122. For systems without ground- fault protection, the EGC is sized according to 690.45(B) and must be a minimum of twice the rated short circuit current of the largest circuit it is protecting. 2.7.3 Calculate Voltage Drop Voltage Drop for Circuits It is wasteful to dissipate energy to heat wires when the cost of larger wires is usually minimal compared with the cost of PV modules. Voltage drop is often the determining factor in wire sizing particularly for systems operating below 100 Volts. Voltage drop is not a safety issue, therefore it is not covered in great detail in the NEC. However PV sys- tems with excessive voltage drop are inefficient and can perform poorly. Once the NEC requirements for ampacity have been met, the voltage drop must be veri- fied that it is within acceptable limits for efficiency and quality performance. For any given wire size, voltage drop increases with increasing currents and/or increasing wire lengths. Therefore circuits with high current and/or long lengths deserve close scrutiny with respect to voltage drop. This is particularly true of systems operating at 12 V, 24 V, or 48 V, but even higher voltage systems can have significant voltage drop issues as a result of long circuits.   There is no specified code compliance limit for voltage drop in any given circuit. Gener- ally accepted practices within the industry limit overall system voltage drop within a range of 2% to 5% of the circuit operating voltage. The PV system designer must use their best judgment considering performance and economics. Five percent is generally considered a maximum overall acceptable voltage drop from source to load. In order to achieve this 5% limit you will have to limit intermediate runs within a circuit to a lesser percentage voltage drop. For instance, intermediate circuit runs such as “PV array to PV combiner box” and “PV Combiner box to PV charge controller” must be limited to less than 2 % each in order to stay within 5% overall.
  • 75. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 75 Determining Voltage Drop If the one-way distance between two points is expressed as length (d) in feet, recognize that the total wire length of a circuit between these two points will be 2 x d. Ohm’s Law (Vd = I x R) provides the basic equation to find voltage drop in conductors, where Vd is the amount of voltage drop in the conductor at the highest expected current level. The Ω/ kft term is the resistance of the conductor in ohms/1000 feet and is presented in the NEC Chapter 9, Table 8.   Where I is the circuit current in Amperes, which for source circuits is usually taken as the maximum power current, Imp , Vnom is the nominal system voltage, which, in this case, is 24V, and Ω/kft is found from NEC Chapter 9, Table 8, “Conductor Properties.” The resistance for 14 AWG stranded copper uncoated wire is 3.14, Ω/kft. Assuming the distance from junction box to source circuit combiner box to be 40 ft, the %Vdrop is found, after substituting all the numbers into the formula, to be Clearly a value of 7.3% is high and is well above the recommended target of 1-3%. Even though 14 AWG THWN wire may meet the ampacity requirements of the NEC, it falls quite short of meeting the voltage drop requirements for system performance. If the tar- get % Vdrop is less than 2% from junction box to combiner box, what would be the correct conductor size? To find the correct conductor size, substitute in the Ω/kft values for other wire sizes until a size is found that will meet the voltage drop requirements. Substituting the value for Ω/kft for 12 AWG stranded copper gives % Vdrop = 4.62%, which is still too high. For 10 AWG stranded copper, the result is % Vdrop = 2.89%, and for 8 AWG stranded copper, the result is % Vdrop = 1.82%, which meets the performance requirement. The distance from source-circuit combiner box to charge controller also must be calcu- lated. Assuming a distance of 10 feet, the %Vdrop can be calculated using the equation below to be: %100 /1000 2 %100% /1000 2 1000 2 ×       Ω × ×× =×=       Ω × ×× =       Ω ××= ×= nomnom d drop d d V kftkftft Id V V V kftkftft dI V kftft kft dR RIV %3.7%100 24 14.3 /1000 7402 % =×       Ω × ×× = V kftkftft Aft Vdrop %45.1%100 24 24.1 /1000 14102 % =×       Ω × ×× = V kftkftft Aft Vdrop %3.7%100 24 14.3 /1000 7402 % =×       Ω × ×× = V kftkftft Aft Vdrop %45.1%100 24 24.1 /1000 14102 % =×       Ω × ×× = V kftkftft Aft Vdrop
  • 76. 76 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 This voltage drop is high for such a short wire run, and as 8 AWG is being used for the wire runs from the junction box to the source-circuit combiner box, it is recommend that 6 AWG be used between the combiner box and the charge controller. The voltage drop over this circuit will then be reduced to 0.9%. This exercise shows how large the conduc- tors must be in 24 V systems to carry small amounts of current. To achieve overall system voltage drops that are within 3% to 5%, individual circuits must have much lower voltage drops. To illustrate the need to keep these voltage drops at reasonable levels, the following table (Table 2) shows one way of tracking voltage drop to maintain it within appropriate levels. Not all systems will have all these differ- ent circuits, but it becomes easy to see how voltage drops can add up if care is not taken throughout the wire sizing process. The following table shows how a typical wire sizing exercise would proceed. Table 3. Conductor voltage drop example using diagram from Figure 9. Circuit Name Total Distance(kft) Current (amps Wire Size Ω/kft Vdrop %Vdrop Dc circuits (@ 24 V) Module wiring 0.012 7 12AWG 1.98 0.166 V 0.69 % Array to J-box 0.02 7 10AWG 1.24 0.174 V 0.72% J-box to Combiner 0.08 7 8AWG 0.778 0.436 V 1.82% Combiner to CC 0.01 21 6AWG 0.491 0.103 V 0.43% CC to Disco 0.006 21 6AWG 0.491 0.062 V 0.26% Disconnect to inverter 0.006 21 6AWG 0.491 0.062 V 0.26% Dc Vdrop total 1.003 V 4.18% Ac Circuits (120 V) Inverter to disconnect 0.01 6 amps 10AWG 1.2 0.072 V 0.06% Disconnect to Service Panel 0.05 6 amps 10AWG 1.2 0.36 V 0.3% Ac Vdrop total 0.36% Overall Vdrop total 4.54% Table 2. Conductor voltage drop example.
  • 77. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 77 The example in this table is very typical of a well-designed, 24 V PV system. It also il- lustrates where increasing wire size will initially have the most impact—in the J-box to combiner circuit. By increasing this circuit size from 8 AWG to 6 AWG, the voltage drop will reduce by about 0.7% overall. However, the larger size wire will require the next size larger conduit to accommodate these circuits. An overall voltage drop of less than 5% for a 24 V system is a good target and getting voltage drop below 3% is extremely difficult for these very low voltage systems. A 48 V system will drop the dc voltage drop impact to 25% of that seen with 24 V systems for the same wire sizes shown in the table, yielding an overall system voltage drop near 1%. This is one of the main reasons why 48 V battery- based systems are generally recommended over 24 V systems. Other unavoidable voltage drops not calculated in this table include voltage drops in fuses, circuit breakers, and switches which can add up to 0.5% for a 24 V system. Additionally, charge controllers can cause another 1% to 4% voltage drop depending on the product. If the wiring from the modules to the junction box is exposed, the NEC requires the wire must be listed as or marked “sunlight-resistant.” A suitable insulation type for this ap- plication is USE-2. Even if exposed wiring is used, the ampacities of NEC Table 310.15(B) (16) must still be used if the conductors terminate at equipment (PV modules). As a final note on voltage drop, it is common practice to use smaller wiring between modules and junction boxes, and then increase the wire size between the junction box and the string combiner box. As the wire size is increased to meet voltage drop requirements, then it is important to be sure that lugs or terminals in each of the boxes can accommodate the larger wire size. It is required that the box itself be large enough for the wire. If wire sizes in junction boxes are 6 AWG and smaller, the minimum box size is found from either NEC Table 314.16(A) or Table 314.16(B). If conductors larger than 6 AWG are in the box, then the installation must comply with NEC 300.4(F), and the box size should be deter- mined in accordance with NEC 314.28(A). Listed PV combiner boxes will have terminals and wire bending space consistent with the current ratings of the device. Some will ac- commodate the larger wires necessary to address voltage-drop requirements. 2.7.4 Select Size and Type of Conductor Based on Location, Required Ampacity, and Voltage Drop The previous sections have described how to determined the required size of a conductor based on the ampacity and voltage drop requirements. The NEC states that all conduc- tors in conduit installed in exposed locations (outdoors, on rooftops), or underground must be rated for wet locations (NEC 300.9 and 300.5(B) respectively). A common miscon- ception is that conductors in watertight conduit do not have to be wet rated. All outdoor and underground conduit systems have moisture in them that will condense under the right conditions.   When selecting conductors for outdoor conduit systems, the conductor should have a “W” in the wire designation for wet rating. Since rooftops are high temperature environ- ments, it is often necessary to select 90°C rated conductors. The most commonly selected conductors for rooftop conduit in PV systems are THWN-2, XHHW-2, and RHW-2. The THHN designation, while rated for 90°C, is not rated for wet locations. The THWN and XHHW designations, while rated for wet locations are not rated for 90°C in wet locations.
  • 78. 78 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 USE-2 often run from the PV modules to the inverter in conduit. This is acceptable as long as the conduit run is exterior to the building, or if run interior, the conductor car- ries an indoor conductor designation such as XHHW-2 or RHW-2. Most conductors carry multiple designations, which causes some confusion for installers. All that matters when reviewing conductor designations is that the one designation needed for the location is listed on the conductor insulation. Just because one designation, like USE-2, is prohibited indoors does not exclude the conductor from being installed indoors as long as the con- ductor has one of the allowed indoor designations. 2.7.5 Select Conduit for Conductors Select Conduit Type Based on Application When using conduit as the wiring method, the type of conduit selected is based on a va- riety of factors including physical protection, sunlight resistance, temperature extremes, and corrosion resistance. In tropical climates where the temperature differences are small and corrosion is severe, PVC conduit systems are common. PVC is also commonly used underground because of its corrosion resistance and the fact that ground temperature does not fluctuate as much as air temperature. However, in climates with large tempera- ture swings and less corrosion concerns like desert areas, steel conduit systems are much more common such as EMT and IMC. Occasionally, the physical protection needs of the installation are high in places like parking garages and hospitals. These locations often re- quire rigid steel RMC conduit. Locations with large expansion and contraction concerns due to long conduit runs may favor IMC over EMT since the pipe is threaded and less susceptible to compression fittings vibrating loose over time.   Ultimately, whatever wiring method is selected will require some maintenance over time. The type and amount of maintenance will depend on the local conditions and the response of the selected conduit to those conditions. Life-cycle costs for conduit and wir- ing systems must be considered when selecting the most appropriate conduit for a PV project. Select Conduit Size Based on Type and Conductor Fill The NEC states that the maximum fill for a conduit based on the ratio of the sum of the cross-sectional area of the wires to the inner cross-sectional area of the conduit can be no more than 40% (NEC Chapter 9, Table 1). There is no differentiation made based on conduit type or conductor type. However, conductors with thicker rubberized insula- tion generally need more room than slicker thermoplastic insulations. Regardless of the conductor type, it is best for a goal of 25% conduit fill for easier pulling of conductors through conduit. Select Expansion Joints Based on Type, Temperature, and Fixed Distance Expansion fittings are required on straight runs between fixed points depending on the straight distance, the temperature fluctuations, and the type of conduit. PVC has the larg- est expansion rate of commonly used wiring methods having 5 times the expansion of steel conduit. Given the temperature changes in much of the United States, PVC rooftop conduit systems will require expansion fittings for all constrained straight runs over 20 feet (not a misprint) and require one 4 in expansion fitting every 75 ft in the run [Table 352.44]. Steel conduit, such as IMC, requires expansion fittings for all constrained runs over 100 ft and requires one 4 in fitting every 375 ft in the straight run.
  • 79. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 79   2.8 Review Overcurrent Protection Selection Once the wire size from the junction box to the source-circuit combiner box has been determined, the source-circuit fuse sizes need to be determined. These fuses or circuit breakers (both known as overcurrent protective devices (OCPD)) are installed to pro- tect the PV modules and wiring from excessive reverse current flow that can damage cell interconnects and wiring between the individual PV modules. The maximum size fuse is specified by the PV module manufacturer and approved as part of the module listing. The fuse size marked on the back of the module must be at least 156% (1.25 x Imax) of the STC-rated module short-circuit current to meet NEC requirements for overcurrent protection. It can be larger if the module manufacturer has tested and list- ed the module with a larger value. The fuse will generally be a dc-rated cartridge-type fuse that is installed in a finger-safe pullout-type fuse holder. The finger-safe holder is necessary, as each end of the fuse holder will typically be energized at a voltage close to the maximum system voltage. These fuses are available in 1-amp increments from 1 A to 15 A, with other larger sizes as provided for in NEC 240.6(A). However, even though the code may state the standard fuse sizes, fuse manufactures may not make all standard sizes.   2.9 Review Fasteners Selection If the chosen design calls for installation on a sloped roof, most mounting systems are fastened solidly to the roof trusses or rafters rather than the roof decking. Depending upon the type of roof, the mounts need to be attached in a manner that will ensure that the roof will not leak at the penetrations. The residential building code now requires that all roof penetrations be flashed to prevent roof leakage. Products exist for flashing any roof type so compliance with this requirement is possible regardless of the roof type. Methods that do not attach directly to structural members require engineering and preferably product certification by the appropriate organization. For mounting systems, the ICC Evaluation Service is a typical choice for these types of certifications. Commercial rooftop PV systems often use ballasted mounting systems to secure the PV array on the roof. These ballasted systems require detailed engineering reports and evaluations to ensure that the wind loading and dead loading issues of the system have been properly addressed. Several companies that manufacture these systems provide professional engineering services to certify the drawings for submittal to the local ju- risdiction. Some locations cannot use ballasted systems because of excess design wind speeds. Some designs allow for a combination of ballast and roof attachments to allow installation in high wind zones and high seismic zones. Materials used for mounting structures and fasteners must be suitable for the environ- ment and compatible with other materials they contact. In dry areas such as South- western United States, a plated steel fastener may not degrade much with time. In high corrosion environments, such as Florida, it is essential that fasteners be corrosion- resistant stainless steel. Manufacturers of commercial array mounts and racks generally supply the mounts with stainless steel hardware to be sure it will be adequate for most installation locations and site conditions.
  • 80. 80 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Materials for array mounts can also vary widely depending upon environmental require- ments. In some areas, painted wooden mounts may be acceptable, while other locations require mounts made of galvanized steel or aluminum. A common structural material used for commercial array mounts is corrosion resistant aluminum of various alloys such as 6061 or 6063 aluminum. Aluminum develops a thin oxide coating very quickly, and this coating prevents further oxidation. Anodizing is common with aluminum extru- sions and can improve the corrosion resistance and aesthetics. Stainless steel is generally too expensive for structural materials, even though it is highly corrosion resistant. The combination of aluminum structural members and stainless steel fasteners is a practical solution to minimizing the cost while maximizing long-term structural reliability. 2.92 Lag Screw Fasteners The withdrawal load is the force required to remove a screw by pulling in line with the screw. The pull strength increases as the diameter of the screw increases and is directly proportional to the length of the screw thread imbedded in the wood. When a lag screw must pass through a metal L-bracket, then roof shingles and roof membrane, nearly one inch of the length of the screw does not enter rafter or truss. Also note that many lag screws in lengths over one inch are not threaded the entire length of the screw. Pilot or lead holes must be drilled for lag screws, typically in the range of 67%-80% of the lag screw shank diameter. Larger pilot holes are required for hard woods than for soft woods. Note that actual pull strengths will vary depending upon the wood that is used, and this is why using safety factors of four or more is not unusual. A safety factor of four simply means that if withdrawal strength of X pounds is needed, then the design requires withdrawal strength of 4X pounds. The allowable withdrawal loads for various lag screw sizes driven into the side grain of four common types of kiln-dried wood can be easily calculated. See Fig. 82. The minimal wind loading of a PV array occurs when the array is mounted parallel to the roof surface at height of 6 inches or less and at least three feet away from the edges of the roof. In regions with high design wind speeds, it is best to keep the modules away from the edges of the roof. Some roof structures above cathedral ceilings have structural insulated panels (SIPS) and may require the mounting screws to penetrate a sandwich of foam insulation between two layers of decking before the screw will enter a support beam. Other cathedral roof structures are built over scissors trusses with the insulation above the ceiling rather than under the roof decking. If there is any uncertainty over the roof composition, roof loads, uplift loads, or roof materials, the installer should consult with a structural engineer, professional roofer, or building contractor.
  • 81. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 81 2.10 Review Plan Sets A complete plan set is a necessary component of an effective permit application. More complex projects require more detailed plan sets. Specific details need to be outlined to the extent that portions of the installation are not standard industry practice or require specific direction. The Expedited Permit Process, published by the Solar America Board for Codes and Standards has provided simple interactive pdf drawings (www.solarabcs.org/permitting) that allow installers to fill in blanks in the form and print good quality plans for residential-sized PV systems. These SolarABCs plans include several standard templates for string inverter systems, micro-inverter systems, and ac module systems. More complex systems may require structural drawings and more detailed electrical drawings. Figure 82. Allowable with- drawal loads for lag screws in lumber depend on the density and species of the wood, the diameter of the screw, and the thread penetration depth.   2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 84 Lumber Type > Douglas Fir Southern Yellow Pine White Spruce Screw Nominal Shank Diameter (in) Specific Gravity 0.51 0.58 0.45 1/4 232 281 192 5/16 274 332 227 3/8 314 381 260 Allowable Withdrawal Loads for Lag Screws (lb/in) Includes a factor of safety of 4 X
  • 82. 82 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 3 Managing the Project Project management is a key aspect of any construction project. Once a contract has been signed with the customer, the project schedule can commence for the construction of the PV system. Longer lead time system components such as modules, inverters, and com- biner boxes can be ordered while drawings are being finalized and the permit package is being assembled for submittal. The construction foreman must be informed of the project plans and be given the opportunity to provide their input to the process to implement any necessary improvements to the construction process. A healthy feedback mechanism should be in place to make continual process improvements and learn from the mistakes of past projects. Failure to make process improvements when managing projects will lead to a loss of morale with the construction crew and ultimately result in high labor turn- over rates. In summary, planning a PV installation utilizes information gathered during a site sur- vey, and includes the following considerations: • Reviewing, completing and adapting the system design • Submitting applications for permits, utility interconnection and incentives • Defining the project schedule, manpower and equipment needs • Identifying and resolving construction activity conflicts such as power outages or alterations to the site • Coordinating other logistics with the customer such as site access, worker facilities, waste collection and storage areas 3.1 Secure Permits and Approvals A complete permit package is critical to an expeditious permitting and approval process. When working with jurisdictions for the first time, it is always valuable to schedule a meeting with the building department and develop an understanding of the expectations of the jurisdiction on the contents of a permit package. Jurisdictions that are new to PV systems will require more time and effort in processing the paperwork for construction approval. While it is rarely a problem to provide too much information, the information must be relevant and well organized so the plan reviewer can perform their review as efficiently as possible. The benefit of having a positive and helpful attitude when working with jurisdictional personnel is hard to understate. Most jurisdictional employees are overworked, under- paid, and underappreciated. Showing an appreciation for their role in the construction process can make big difference in how a permit package is received. Too often contrac- tors get a bad attitude about having to work through the bureaucracy of local govern- ment. That attitude often comes across loud and clear to the jurisdictional employees causing them to lose any possible motivation they might have had to process the paper- work in a timely manner. For a plan checker with little or no PV experience, offering to be available for questions and clarifications can help move the process more quickly. A high quality permit package is one of the most effective methods of establishing a good rapport with the local jurisdiction. The contents of a high quality permit package include:
  • 83. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 83 • A title page with the project address, brief project description, list of project specifica- tions, and a table of contents. • Completed forms that the local jurisdiction requires to process a permit. • A site plan that shows the location of major components on the property including array layout, location of access pathways for rooftop system for fire department review, setbacks to property lines for ground mounted systems, and location of the utility disconnect if required. • Detailed electrical diagram showing and specifying all major components used in the electrical portion of the PV system. This diagram must show the configuration of the PV array, the location and ratings of overcurrent protection and disconnecting means, callout conduit and wire size, type, and ratings. The electrical diagrams should also include specifications and content for the required signs and labels. • Mounting structure information including manufacturer, model, installation docu- mentation and details. • Specification sheets for all major electrical equipment including PV modules, inverters, combiner boxes, and any other unique components that are not common in conventional electrical installations.   Some jurisdictions may handle the entire approval process by submitting a single pack- age of materials with multiple copies for distribution to several internal departments. Other jurisdictions may require separate submittals to be filed with the building depart- ment, planning and zoning department, fire department, and any other relevant depart- ment. Knowing and understanding how to navigate the approval process takes time and focus so that projects can work their way through the process as quickly as possible. 3.2 Preconstruction The proper preparation for construction is as important as the actual construction process itself. Making sure all required material is on hand or procured to be available by the time it is needed on the site requires significant planning and project experience. All PV projects require a safety plan, and safety equipment must be on hand prior to construc- tion. The safety equipment must be inspected to insure that it is in good repair and has no missing pieces. Any necessary equipment rentals need to be planned, budgeted, and deliveries scheduled. Often large amounts of materials may need to be staged and moved into position in preparation for construction, requiring special equipment. A number of software tools are available to assist construction managers in planning and allocating project resources. 3.3 Project Labor Determining the amount and proper allocation of project labor is critical to a smooth and efficient construction project. In the pressure and busyness of project preparations, a commonly overlooked aspect of the construction process is good communication with the construction crew as to their roles and reasonable expectations. A key component of that process is training the crew for the specific job needs of the project. Even experienced project labor needs continuing education on aspects of the project that may slightly dif- ferent than previous projects. Since materials, mounting systems, modules, and inverters are constantly changing in the dynamic PV world, some level of personnel training will be involved in each project, including site-specific safety hazards, at a minimum.  
  • 84. 84 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Assuming that a crew has all the knowledge and materials to carry out the project is an all too common mistake in a construction project. This requires checking with project labor to make sure they are comfortable with their responsibilities and making sure that they are comfortable expressing recommendations for process improvement. Managing the morale of project labor requires a good understanding of the personalities in the crew and good motivational skills so that laborers are recognized and appreciated for a job well done. 3.4 Adapting System Design In the early stages of a construction project it is often necessary to make adjustments to the project plan to address discrepancies between the site and system design, and un- foreseen project obstacles. This may require adaptations to the system design. It is rare for a project to go completely as planned. Even with the best preplanning, issues beyond the control of the project manager invariably arise that require flexibility, such as making material substitutions due to product availability.   3.5 Implement a Site Safety Plan A safe PV system is installed according to applicable building codes and standards. PV installer safety includes considerations for a safe work area, safe use of tools and equip- ment, safe practices for personnel protection, and awareness of safety hazards and how to avoid them. The installation of PV systems involves a number of safety hazards, prin- cipally electrical and fall hazards. Working safely with PV systems requires a fundamental understanding of electrical sys- tems and the safety hazards involved, in addition to normal work site and construction hazards. The common sense aspects for jobsite safety can be summarized as follows: • If the workplace is cluttered, the possibility of tripping over something is significantly increased. • If the workplace is a sloped roof with clutter, the possibility of falling off the roof is significantly increased. • If tools are left lying out on a roof, the chance of the tools falling off the roof and injuring someone below is increased. • If the workplace is a rooftop in bright sunshine, the chance of sunburn and heat exhaustion is increased, so workers should take appropriate precautions like using sunscreen, keeping well-hydrated and wearing light-colored clothing. There are the usual subtle hazards, as well. These include nicks, cuts, and burns from sharp or hot components. Gloves should be used when handling anything that might be sharp, hot, rough, or that might splinter. Special insulating gloves are required for work- ing with live voltages. There is always the possibility of dropping tools or materials on either oneself, someone else, or on sensitive equipment or materials. Dropping conduc- tive tools across battery terminals is an especially dangerous hazard. When a PV system is being assembled, it presents the possibility of shock to personnel. Proper procedure during installation can reduce, and often eliminate hazards including electrical shock. Improperly installed systems may result in shock or fire hazards developing over time due to wiring or arcing faults.
  • 85. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 85   3.5.1 OSHA Regulations All individuals working on or contracting installation services for PV systems should be familiar with standards established by the Occupational Safety and Health Administra- tion (OSHA), contained in Volume 29 of the U.S. Code of Federal Regulations (29 CFR). OSHA regulations are applicable in all U.S. states and territories and enforced by federal or local authorities. States with OSHA-approved programs must set standards at least as effective as federal standards. These standards apply to private employers and general industry, for construction, maritime, agricultural and other occupations. The broad scope of OSHA regulations includes health standards, electrical safety, fall protection systems, stairways and ladders, hand and power tools, cranes and lifts, excavations, scaffolding, and other potential hazards likely to be encountered in constructing PV systems. OSHA regulations require that employers provide a safe and healthful workplace free of hazards, and follow the applicable OSHA standards. Employers must provide safety training addressing all probable hazards on a construction site, and employers of 11 or more employees must maintain records of occupational injuries and illnesses. All em-  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules Figure 82. The OSHA 10-Hour Construction Industry Training Program is strongly fo OSHA ployers must display the OSHA poster, and report to OSHA within 8 hours any accident that results in a fatality or hospitalization of three or more em- ployees. Workers are responsible for following the employer’s safety and health rules and wear or use all required safety gear and equipment, reporting hazardous conditions to OSHA if employers do not fix them, and cooperating with OSHA inspectors. Large construction projects often require workers to complete 10 hour training on OSHA regulations and have a valid course completion card for insurance purposes.   Safety and Health Regulations for Construction (29 CFR Part 1926) applies to general construction, including several subparts applicable to the installa- tion of PV systems: OSHA 10 The OSHA 10-Hour Construction Industry Training Program is intended to provide entry-level con- struction workers with a general awareness on rec- ognizing and preventing hazards on a construction site. Many projects require all construction workers on a jobsite to have a current OSHA 10 training. Workers must also receive additional training on hazards specific to their job. See Fig. 83. Figure 83. The OSHA 10-Hour Construction Industry Training Program is strongly recommended and may be required for PV installers. Subpart C - General Safety and Health Provisions Subpart D - Occupational Health and Environmental Controls Subpart E - Personal Protective and Life Saving Equipment Subpart I - Tools, Hand and Power Subpart K - Electrical Subpart M - Fall Protection Subpart X - Stairways and Ladders
  • 86. 86 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 3.5.2 Fall Protection Falls are the leading cause of deaths in the construction industry. Because most PV systems involve climbing ladders, or working on rooftops, it is essential that PV installers are familiar with OSHA fall protection regulations. Most fatalities occur when employees fall from open-sided floors and through floor openings. Conse- quently, OSHA requires that fall protection be used for walkways and ramps, holes and excavations, roofs, wall openings or skylights where an employee or worker can fall 6 feet or more. Employers must provide training to employees on how to recognize and minimize fall hazards, and the use of fall protec- tion systems and devices. See Figs. 84, 85 & 86. Fall protection options include Per- sonal Fall Arrest Systems (PFAS), guardrails and safety nets, and must be in place before work com- mences. See Figs. 87 & 88. Train- Figure 85. Skylights must be protected from fall hazards by barriers or covers.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 86 Figure 83. Fall protection is a primary safety concern for PV installers. Alameda County JATC/Mel Switzer NREL/Rob Williamson  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 87 Figure 84. Skylights must be protected from fall hazards by barriers or covers. California Dept. of Public Health A PV installer fell to his death through this skylight. National Electric Figure 86. Warning lines designate safe areas in which work may take place without the use of PFAS. Figure 87. A personal fall arrest system (PFAS) consists of an anchorage and connectors, a body harness, and a lanyard/deceleration device. op Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 88 Figure 85. Warning lines designate safe areas in which work may take place without the use of PFAS. Warning Line National Electric  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 89 Figure 86. A personal fall arrest system (PFAS) consists of an anchorage and connectors, a body harness, and a lanyard/deceleration device. Lanyard, Lifeline and Roof Anchors Body Harnesses Jim Dunlop Jim Dunlop Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 86 Figure 83. Fall protection is a primary safety concern for PV installers. Alameda County JATC/Mel Switzer NREL/Rob Williamson Figure 84. Fall protection is a primary safety concern for PV installers.
  • 87. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 87 ing is required on how to properly use and maintain PFAS, including the anchorages, lifelines and body harnesses. Guardrails used to protect open-sided floors and platforms must have top rails between 39 and 45 in tall, a mid-rail, and toe boards at least 3-1/2 in high. Safety nets must be deployed no further than 30 ft below where work is performed, preferably closer. In certain applications, the use of designated safety monitors and warning lines may meet the requirements, but is the least desirable of all fall protection systems. In any case, it is best practice to perform work at ground level if possible, such as pre-assembly of PV panels and arrays. Figure 88. Safety line anchorages must be independent of any platform anchorage and capable of supporting at least 5,000 pounds per worker. Figure 89. A stairway or ladder is required at points of access to a construction site where there is a break in elevation of 19 inches or more.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 90 Figure 87. Safety line anchorages must be independent of any platform anchorage and capable of supporting at least 5,000 pounds per worker. Removable/Reusable Roof Anchors Permanent Roof Anchor with Cap Concrete Dee-ring Anchor Guardian Fall Protection Figure 90. Stairrails and handrails must be able to withstand 200 pound force.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 91 Figure 88. A stairway or ladder is required at points of access to a construction site where there is a break in elevation of 19 inches or more. OSHA 3.5.3 Stairways and Ladders OSHA requires that a stairway or ladder be used at points of access where there is an elevation break of 19 in or more on a jobsite. See Fig. 89. Stairways with four or more risers, or higher than 30 in, must be equipped with at least one handrail, capa- ble of withstanding a force of 200 pounds. See Fig. 90. Stairways with four or more risers or more than 30 in high must have a stair rail along each unprotected side or edge. Stairs must be installed between 30 and 50 degrees, must have uniform riser height and tread depth, with less than a 1/4-in variation. Stairways landings must be at least 30 in deep and 22 in wide at ev- ery 12 ft or less of vertical rise. Unprotected sides of landings must have standard 42 inch guardrail systems. Where doors or gates open directly on a stairway, a plat- form must be used that extends at least 20 in beyond the swing of the door.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 92 Figure 89. Stairrails and handrails must be able to withstand 200 pound force. OSHA
  • 88. 88 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Ladders must be kept in a safe working condition. Keep the area around the top and bot- tom of a ladder clear, and ensure rungs, cleats, and steps are level and uniformly spaced 10 in to 14 in apart. Use ladders only for their designed purpose. Never tie ladders together to make longer sections, or load ladders beyond the maximum load for which they are rated. A competent person must inspect ladders for visible defects, like broken or missing rungs, and if a defective ladder is found, immediately mark it defective or tag it “Do Not Use”, and withdraw defective ladders from service until repaired. Ladders should be used on stable and level surfaces, and secured to prevent accidental movement due to workplace activity. Do not use ladders on slippery surfaces unless secured or provided with slip-resistant feet. Ladders, particularly wooden ones, should never be painted which can conceal defects. A double-cleated ladder (with center rail), or two or more ladders are required when ladders are the only way to enter or exit a working area with 25 or more employees, or when a ladder will serve simultaneous two-way traffic. Non-self-supporting ladders (those that lean against a wall or other support) must be positioned at an angle where the horizontal distance from the top support to the foot of the ladder is 1/4 the working length of the ladder (the distance along the ladder between the foot and the top support). See Fig. 91. When using a portable ladder for access to an upper landing surface, the side rails must extend at least 3 ft above the upper landing surface. For step ladders, the top and top step should never be used as a step, and never use crossbracing on the rear of a stepladder for climbing — unless the ladder is designed for that purpose. Tall fixed ladders 24 ft or longer must be equipped with either: a ladder safety device; self-retracting lifelines with rest platforms every 150 ft or less; or cage or well, and multiple ladder sections, each section not exceeding 50 ft. Figure 91. Ladders must be used with the proper angle and secured at the appropriate height. If using ladders where the employee or the ladder could contact exposed energized electrical equip- ment, such as transformers or overhead services, ladders must have nonconductive side rails such as wood or fiberglass. Face the ladder when going up or down, and use at least one hand to grab the ladder when going up or down. Do not carry any object or load that could cause you to lose balance while climbing ladders. Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 4 Ladder Angle Min 3 ft 4 ft 16 ft OSHA Tie-off points
  • 89. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 89 3.5.4 Hand and Power Tools Power tools are extremely hazardous when used or maintained improperly. Workers using hand and power tools may be exposed to a number of hazards, including objects that fall, fly, are abrasive, or splash; harmful dusts, fumes, mists, vapors, and gases; and frayed or damaged electrical cords, hazardous connections and improper grounding. Eye protection is usually always required. All hand and power tools and similar equipment, whether furnished by the employer or the employee, shall be maintained in a safe condition. All power tools must be fitted with factory guards and safety switches, and hand-held power tools must be equipped with a constant pressure switch or on-off switch. Hazards are usually caused by misuse and improper maintenance. Additional guidelines and precautions for using power tools include the following: • Follow manufacturers’ instructions • Use the proper personal protective equipment (PPE) • Disconnect tools when not in use, for cleaning, and when changing accessories • Secure work with clamps or a vise, freeing both hands to operate the tool • Inspect tools regularly before use and maintain in sharp, clean condition • Do not wear loose clothing and jewelry that can get caught in moving parts • Do not use electric cords to carry, hoist or lower tools • Keep cords and hoses away from heat, oil, and sharp edges • Remove damaged electric tools & tag them: “Do Not Use.” 3.5.5 Personal Protective Equipment (PPE) Personal protective equipment (PPE) includes protective clothing, gloves, footwear, helmets, goggles, respirators, aprons or other garments designed to protect workers from injury to the body by impacts, electrical hazards, heat and chemicals, and other job-relat- ed safety hazards. PPE is the last measure of control when worker exposure to the safety hazards cannot be totally eliminated by feasible work practices or engineering controls. Responsibilities of the employer include assessing the workplace for hazards, providing PPE, determining when to use it, and providing training for affected employees. Employee responsibilities include using PPE in accordance with training received and other instructions, and inspecting daily and maintaining the PPE in a clean and reliable condition. The employer shall ensure that each affected employee wears a protective helmet when working in areas where there is a potential for injury to the head from falling objects, or exposure to electrical hazards. See Fig. 92. Type I hard hats provide protection from blows only to the top of the head. Type II hard hats have a full brim and provide protec- tion from blows to the top or sides of the head. Class G (General) hardhats are intended to reduce the danger of contact exposure to low voltage conductors and are proof tested to 2,200 volts. Class E (Electrical) hardhats are intended to reduce the danger of exposure to high voltage conductors and are proof tested to 20,000 volts. Class C (Conductive)
  • 90. 90 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 hardhats provide no electrical insulation and not intended to provide protection against contact with electrical conductors. Eye protection must be provided to protect against hazards such as dust and other flying particles, corrosive gases, vapors, and liquids, and welding operations. See Fig. 93. The selection of eye protection is based on protection from a specific hazard, its comfort, and must not restrict vision or movement, or interfere with other PPE. Types of eye and face protection include: • Safety glasses: Single or double lens; close and comfortable fit important. Prescription lenses available. • Goggles: Offer the most complete protection from impacts, chemicals and vapors by sealing around the eye area. Vented types allow air flow and reduce the chance for fogging, but protect from impacts only. Non-vented and indirect-vent types protect from impacts as well as splash, vapors or particles; use lens coatings for better anti-fog performance. Many types fit over prescription eyeglasses. • Face shields: A supplementary, secondary protective device to protect a worker’s face from certain chemical and welding radiation hazards. Must use with safety glasses for impact protection. Special lenses and shade number required for specific welding operations. Hearing protection must be used whenever an employee’s noise exposure exceeds an 8-hour time-weighted average (TWA) sound level of 90 dBA. Noise levels above 115 dBA require control measures for any duration. OSHA also recognizes an 85 dBA TWA as an action level to monitor noise levels. Noise levels likely exceed 85dBA if one has to raise their voice to converse with another person 3 feet away. Hearing pro- tection options include earmuffs that fit over the ear and seal against the side of the head, disposable and reusable earplugs inserted directly into the ear canal, or hearing bands. See Fig 94. All approved hearing protectors have an assigned Noise Reduction Rating (NRR) in decibels.   Figure 92. Hard hats protect the head from blows and energized electrical conductors. Figure 93. Types of eye and face protection include safety glasses, goggles and face shields. nlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 94 Type II, Class E Hard Hat Lab Safety Supply  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 95 Figure 92. Types of eye and face protection include safety glasses, goggles and face shields. Vented and Indirect-Vent Goggles Impact Splash-Resistant Goggles Safety Glasses Face Shield Lab Safety Supply
  • 91. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 91 When employees are exposed to harmful atmospheres, dust or vapors, the employer shall provide respirators which are applicable and suitable for the purpose intended. Although not generally required, certain construction tasks related to a PV installation may require respiratory protection, such as working in insulated attics. Foot protection must be used when any of the following conditions are present: heavy objects such as barrels or tools that might roll onto or fall on employees’ feet; sharp objects such as nails or spikes that might pierce ordinary shoes; molten metal that might splash on feet; or working on hot, wet or slippery surfaces. Safety shoes have impact-re- sistant toes and heat-resistant soles, and may be electrically conductive for use in explo- sive atmospheres, or nonconductive to protect from electrical hazards. All types of protective footwear must include an identification label listing the applicable standard, manufacturer, and specifications. All protective footwear must provide impact and compression resistance. Impact resistance (I) is rated for 75, 50 or 30 foot-pounds. Compression resistance (C) is rated for 75, 50 or 30 which correlates to 2500, 1750 or 1000 pounds of compression resistance. Protective footwear may also meet the following specifications as labeled: • Metatarsal resistance (Mt) is rated for 75, 50 or 30 foot-pounds. • Conductive (Cd) footwear is used to dissipate static electricity in explosive environments. • Electrical hazard (EH) footwear has non-conductive soles and provides secondary protection from live electrical equipment. • Puncture resistant (PR) footwear provides integral protection from sharp objects penetrating the sole. • Static dissipative (SD) footwear reduces the accumulation of excess static electricity for electronics environments. • Chain saw cut resistant (CS) footwear. • Dielectric insulation (DI) footwear is designed to provide additional insulation for contact with energized electrical conductors. Figure 94. Hearing protection should be used whenever using machinery or power tools with noise levels exceeding 85 dB.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 96 Figure 93. Hearing protection should be used whenever using machinery or power tools with noise levels exceeding 85 dB.  Earmuffs  Fit over the ear and seal against the side of the head.  Earplugs  Inserted directly into the ear canal.  All approved hearing protectors have an assigned Noise Reduction Rating (NRR) in decibels.  Reduces decibel exposure. Reusable Earplugs Ear Muffs Hearing Bands Disposable Foam Plugs Lab Safety Supply
  • 92. 92 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Employers shall select and require employees to use appropriate hand protection when employees’ hands are exposed to hazards such as harmful substances; severe cuts or lacerations; severe abrasions; punctures; chemical burns; thermal burns; and temperature extremes. See Fig. 95. Employers shall base the selection of the appropriate hand protec- tion on an evaluation of the performance characteristics of the hand protection relative to the tasks to be performed, conditions present, duration of use, and the hazards and potential hazards identified. Types of gloves vary widely in materials and application, including: • Durable gloves made of mesh, leather or high-performance materials like Kevlar® to protect from cuts, burns and heat. • Chemical-resistant rubber gloves to protect from burns and irritation • Electrical insulating gloves for exposure to live voltages Correct glove size and fit is important for comfort and dexterity. Glove size is determined by diameter of the hand at its widest point. Common men’s sizes are: Small: 7½-8”, Medium: 8½-9”, Large: 9½-10”, and Extra Large: 10 ½-11”. Figure 95. Gloves are rated for six levels of abrasion, cut and puncture resistance tested to ANSI/ASTM standards.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 97 Figure 94. Gloves are rated for six levels of abrasion, cut and puncture resistance tested to ANSI/ASTM standards. Level 2 Cut-Resistant Kevlar® Gloves Level 5 Cut-Resistant Leather Gloves Chemical-Resistant Gloves Class 0, Low Voltage Gloves Lab Safety Supply
  • 93. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 93 4 Installing Electrical Components 4.1 Mitigate Electrical Hazards About 5 workers are electrocuted every week in the U.S., causing 12% of all young worker workplace deaths. It takes very little electrical energy to cause personal injury; and electrical hazards also pose a significant fire danger — further compounding the risk to life and property. Electrical accidents are caused by a combination of three factors: 1) unsafe equipment and/or installation, 2) workplaces made unsafe by the environment, and 3) unsafe work practices. Preventing electrical hazards on the job involves the following practices: • Wearing nonconductive Class E hardhat • Wearing electrical hazard (EH) rated foot protection • Using properly grounded or double-insulated power tools maintained in good condition • Avoiding overhead power lines and buried electrical conductors • Working on electrical equipment and circuits in a de-energized state • Maintaining an orderly job site and cautious work flow Lockout and tagging is used to prevent unknowing individuals from energizing electrical circuits or other hazardous machinery while they are being serviced or maintained. See Fig 96. Lockout refers to the physical locking of the power source disconnect with a pad- lock in the “off” or open position. Tagging refers to the labeling of deactivated controls, de-energized equipment and circuits at all points where they can be energized, and must identify equipment or circuits being worked on. When working on energized equipment is unavoidable, use the appropriate PPE, including helmets, face shields, gloves and flame-resistant clothing.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 98 Figure 95. Employer must provide policies, procedures, documentation, equipment, training, inspection and maintenance for lock out and tag out programs to authorized employees. Figure 96. The employer must provide policies, procedures, documentation, equipment, training, inspection and maintenance for lock out and tag out programs to authorized employees. To protect workers from electrical hazards use barriers and guards to prevent passage through areas of exposed energized equipment; pre-plan work, post hazard warn- ings and use protective measures; and keep working spaces and walkways clear of cords. Test GF- CIs regularly, and check switches and insulation. Flexible extension cords for temporary use on con- struction projects must be 3-wire type (with ground) and designed for hard or extra-hard use.
  • 94. 94 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 4.2 Install Electrical Equipment The installer should pay careful attention to the location of module junction boxes so the lengths of electrical wiring can be minimized and organized into source circuits as needed, once modules are mounted. Modules are normally installed in groups that produce the desired source-circuit volt- age. Junction boxes do not have to be readily accessible, but must permit ready access by temporarily removing modules connected by flexible wiring methods [NEC 690.34]. The layout of BOS components should be done in a neat and professional manner that provides for convenient access, testing, and disconnecting of system components. If the array is on a residential roof, it is generally preferable to install combiner boxes containing source-circuit fuses or circuit breakers in a more accessible location. Because most PV modules carry warranties of 20 years or more, any other components installed on the roof should be also be capable of operating for 20 years without significant maintenance. The BOS layout should minimize distances for dc wiring if the system operates at 48 V or less. However, residential PV arrays operating at more than 300 V dc may use longer dc runs without significant voltage drop. Keeping the ac voltage drop as low as reasonably possible will im- prove system performance by reducing the likelihood of inverters tripping offline due to high utility voltage. 4.2.1 Working Space for Electrical Systems Working spaces must be allowed for installers and maintenance personnel to safely work on electrical equipment [NEC 110.26]. Proper working spaces are the first priority when locating balance of system hardware for a PV system. Generally, clearances in front of equipment that may be serviced in an energized state must be at least 3 ft, but several qualifiers determine the appropriate clearance to use. Voltages from 150 V to 600 V require greater clearances if live parts are on one side and grounded parts on the other or if live parts are on both sides of the working space. The width of working spaces must be the width of the equipment or 30 in, whichever is wider. For equipment operating at dc voltages less than 60 V, smaller working spaces may be permitted by special permission of the AHJ. Although this is allowed in the code, permission must be secured prior to mounting equip- ment should smaller clearances be sought. Some PV installations may involve working in attic spaces, which usually requires wearing a breathing mask, eye protection, and clothing that will protect skin from irritating insulation. Ensure that the attic floor will support the weight of a worker, and take care to step only on structural members to prevent falling through the ceiling. Attics can be extremely hot and workers should limit their exposures and maintain hydration. Additional lighting is also usually required when working in attics or other confined spaces. Electrical Injuries There are four main types of electrical injuries. Direct types of injuries include electrocution (death due to electrical shock), electrical shock, and burns. Indirect electri- cal injuries include falls due to electrical shock. Other common electrical injuries include burns and concussions resulting from arcing explosions, as well as eye damage due to arc flash. Working on or near exposed energized conductors or electrical equipment requires spe- cial personal protective equipment (PPE). Means to assess the electri- cal hazards that exist, and the PPE and other precautions required are addressed in NFPA 70E, Electrical Safety in the Workplace. The severity of the shock depends on the path of current flow through the body, the amount of current, and the duration of the exposure. Low voltage does not mean low hazard. Currents above 10 mA can paralyze or “freeze” muscles. Cur- rents of more than 75 mA ac can cause a rapid, ineffective heartbeat, and can result in death in minutes unless a defibrillator is used. 75 mA is not much current — a small power drill uses 30 times as much. Electrical burns are the most com- mon shock-related injury, which can occur by touching electrical wiring or equipment that is improperly used or maintained, and typically occurs on the hands. Electrical burns are often very serious injuries and require immediate attention.
  • 95. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 95 4.3 Install Wiring Methods Wiring methods include all conductors, cables, conduits, raceways, fittings, connectors, terminals, junction boxes and other equipment used for electrical connections between system components. The installation requirements for wiring methods are covered in Chapter 3 of the NEC: Wiring Methods and Materials. Manufacturers provide additional product-specific instructions, and installation of many wiring methods requires special- ized training and experience. Much of the installation work in all electrical systems is mechanical in nature. Conduit systems are the most common wiring methods for circuits leaving the vicinity of PV arrays. Conduit is used to support and protect string conductors and to install the PV output circuits from combiner boxes to inverters. Each type of conduit or raceway system has specific application and installation requirements [NEC Chap 3]. Conduit runs must be supported properly at the intervals required by the specific con- duit type. While the NEC does not require conduit to be held at any specific distance above the roof surface, the building code does not permit items on a rooftop that could cause damming of leaves and other debris. Although the building code does not specifi- cally address electrical conduit systems, it is wise to keep a minimum of 0.75 in of air- space beneath conduit runs, to help prevent smaller debris from being trapped under the conduit. The 0.75 in airspace also has the advantage of reducing the conduit temperature [NEC Table 310.15(B)(3)(c)]. Since in conventional ac systems it is uncommon to have long rooftop feeders, like those in large PV systems, there exists little field experience from electrical workers on install- ing these wiring methods on rooftops. Setting up a conduit run with multiple expansion fittings is not trivial and requires painstaking adherence to manufacturer’s directions that account for the conduit temperature and where in the expansion process that tempera- ture falls. Expansion joints must be held in place so that the conduit moves relative to the joint. In addition to the concerns over the conduit system, the conductors inside the con- duit also move relative to the conduit system and the end terminations. Several systems in recent history have not properly accounted for this relative motion which has caused significant conductor insulation damage resulting in fires in some cases. Since this type of damage is likely in large conduit systems, operation and maintenance programs must periodically check for this damage. 4.4 Install Grounding Systems Proper grounding of PV systems reduces the risk of electrical shock to personnel and the effects of lightning and surges on equipment. There are two basic types of grounding. System grounding connects a current-carrying conductor in an electrical system to ground, or earth potential. Equipment grounding connects non-current carrying metal parts to ground, such as PV module frames, racks, enclosures, junction boxes, conduit and other metallic components. Bonding is electrically connecting metal parts together so that they stay at the same voltage. All PV systems require equipment grounding, and most also require system grounding. The grounding and bonding requirements for PV systems are covered in NEC Article 690 Part V and Article 250.
  • 96. 96 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 System grounding is the intentional connection of a current-carrying conductor in an electrical system to ground (earth). Commonly, this connection is made at the supply source, such as a transformer or at the main service disconnecting means. For PV arrays, one conductor of a 2-wire system, or the center tap conductor of a bipolar system must be grounded if the maximum PV system voltage is over 50 V [NEC 690.41]. An exception is allowed for ungrounded ar- rays meeting all of the requirements in NEC 690.35. The dc system grounding connection must be made at a single point on the PV output circuit [NEC 690.42]. Locating this connection point as close as practicable to the photovoltaic source better protects the system from voltage surges due to lightning. Typically, for PV systems requiring ground-fault protection, the single point of grounding for a dc current-carrying conductor is usually made internal to a ground-fault protection device within utility-interactive inverters, and additional external bonding connections are not permitted. Figure 97. Devices listed and identified for bonding the exposed metallic frames of PV modules to grounded mounting structures are permitted, but are not approved for all modules and mounting structures. 11 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 99 Figure 96. Devices listed and identified for bonding the exposed metallic frames of PV modules to grounded mounting structures are permitted, but are not approved for all modules and mounting structures. Unirac “WARNING - ELECTRIC SHOCK HAZARD. THE DIRECT CURRENT CIRCUIT CONDUCTORS OF THIS PHOTOVOLTAIC POWER SYSTEM ARE UNGROUNDED BUT MAY BE ENERGIZED WITH RESPECT TO GROUND DUE TO LEAKAGE PATHS AND/OR GROUND FAULTS.” PV arrays are permitted to have ungrounded source and output circuits only when the following conditions are met [NEC 690.35]: • Both ungrounded conductors (positive and negative) must have a disconnecting means and overcurrent protection. • Array ground fault-protection for all conductors must be provided. • All PV source and output circuit conductors must be either installed in raceways, use jacketed multi-conductor cables, or use listed and labeled PV wire where used for single-conductor exposed PV module connections. Inverters or charge controllers used with ungrounded PV arrays must be listed and identified for use with ungrounded arrays. The PV power source must be marked at each disconnect, junction box or other device that may be serviced with the following label: Equipment grounding is the connection of normally non-current carrying metal parts to ground. Equipment grounding requires electrical bonding of PV module frames, racks, enclosures, junction boxes, conduit and other metallic components. This ensures that
  • 97. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 97 metal components in the system will be at equipotential, thus reducing the risk of electri- cal shock. The installation of an equipment grounding conductor (EGC) is required for all metal framed PV module systems and any PV array that has exposed conductors in con- tact with metal support structures, regardless of system voltage [NEC 250, 690.43]. The EGC can be a conductor, busbar, metallic raceway, or structural component. EGCs must be installed in the same raceway as the PV circuit conductors upon leaving the vicinity of an array. System grounding and equipment grounding conductors are separate and only connected together (bonded) at the source of supply. Several methods are permitted to provide equipment grounding for PV modules. Tradi- tional methods use self-tapping screws and cup washers, or lay-in lugs attached to the module frames to connect the EGC. Other methods include using bonding washers or clips between module frames and supports, and the EGC is connected to the support structure. EGCs smaller than 6 AWG must be protected from physical damage, and cop- per grounding conductors should never be allowed to directly touch aluminum module frames or supports. Special washers or lugs are used to make the connection between copper and aluminum. Refer to PV module and mounting system manufacturer’s installation instructions for specific grounding requirements. See Fig. 97. For most utility-interactive systems, the grounded dc conductor, the dc equipment grounding conductor, and the ac equipment grounding conductor are terminated in the inverter. The EGC is connected to the dc grounded circuit conductor through the GFID circuit. The premises grounding system serves as the ac grounding system, and the dc GEC is combined with the ac EGC. The proper and safe grounding of PV systems has been the subject of much discussion in recent years, especially the grounding of PV module frames to support structures.Con- sequently, PV module manufacturers are now required to provide details for equipment grounding in their listed installation instructions per the UL 1703 standard. While indoor grounding means are plentiful in the electrical industry, products designed for outdoor use are not nearly as available. Couple this issue with the fact that much of the electrical industry uses steel for wiring methods and support structures, as opposed to aluminum in the PV industry and now the usable products are much less. Grounding and bonding of steel is relatively straightforward since bolted connections and welding accomplishes the bonding requirements. Readily available copper lugs can be mounted to steel structures for connecting to equipment grounding conductors. Aluminum, on the other hand, is a different story. Simple bolting of aluminum structures will not necessary create effective bonding. This is due to the fact that aluminum either has an anodized coating to reduce corrosion or a thick layer of oxidation as in the case of non-anodized aluminum. In either case, simple bolting of modules to structures, or lugs to modules or structures, will not necessarily provide the necessary bonding and grounding. The NEC generally requires that the installer remove non-conductive coatings prior to making electrical connections. This means that in order to call two aluminum surfaces electrically connected, one must remove the non-conductive coating on both surfaces. Using a grinder on an array of 500,000 modules, or even a few dozen modules is not very practical. Alternative means exist, but these means must be compatible with the
  • 98. 98 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 products being installed. One common method of electrically connecting two aluminum structural pieces is to have stainless fasteners with serrations. Stainless star washers can also be used to break through the non-conductive coatings and establish effective bond- ing. The typical PV module has an aluminum frame that must be bonded and grounded. Module manufacturers may provide hardware and fasteners for making electrical con- nections to the frame metal. Some modules will simply have directions on how to make such connections. Some modules have multiple methods available for grounding while others may only specifically mention a single method (more common). According the UL safety standard for modules (UL1703), the manufacturer is required to provide informa- tion on all approved grounding methods. Since it can be expensive to specifically test each grounding method, many module manufacturers limit the number of options to reduce testing costs. Generic grounding methods that bond adjacent modules together and bond modules to their support structures is specifically mentioned in NEC Article 690 as of the 2005 edi- tion. See Fig. 98. Products exist that can perform these functions and many module manu- facturers list these options in their installation manuals. While these methods work well with most PV modules manufactured today, problems arise when module instructions do not specifically mention these options. Many jurisdictions take a strict interpretation of the requirement that all products must be installed according to the supplied manufac- turer’s instructions [NEC 110.3(B)]. For those jurisdictions, only the specifically mentioned methods will likely be allowed. Many module installation manuals will allow any code- approved grounding method. The UL1703 module standard and a new standard UL2703 for module racking systems are being revised to allow better accommodation of generic grounding systems. A grounding electrode system consists of a rod, pipe, plate, metal water pipe, building steel or concrete-encased electrode, and includes all grounding electrodes at a building or structure that must be bonded together. The grounding electrode conductor (GEC) connects the grounded system conductor or the equipment grounding conductor (EGC) to a grounding electrode system. The GEC must be a continuous length without splices except for irreversible connections. A 6 AWG GEC may be secured to and run along build- ing surfaces where protected from damage. GECs smaller than 6 AWG must be in metal raceways or use armored cables [NEC 250]. Specific requirements are given for the grounding electrode system used for PV installa- tions [NEC 690.47]. The requirements are given ac systems, dc systems, and system with both ac and dc grounding requirements. The existing grounding electrode system should Figure 98. Special bonding jumpers, stainless-steel bonding washers and lay-in lugs may be used to electrically connect separate components or attach equipment grounding conductors.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 100 Figure 97. Special bonding jumpers, stainless-steel bonding washers and lay-in lugs may be used to electrically connect separate components or attach equipment grounding conductors.
  • 99. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 99 be checked as part of any PV installation, particularly for older facilities that may have degraded grounding systems. Verify that all available grounding electrodes at the facility are bonded together, and that the grounding electrode conductors are properly installed and sized. Battery systems are considered to be grounded when the PV power source is grounded [NEC 690.71, 690.41]. Battery systems over 48 volts are permitted without grounding a current-carrying conductor but have several requirements [NEC 690.71(G)]. First, the PV source and output circuits must have a grounded current-carrying conductor or meet the requirements for ungrounded arrays and have overcurrent protection for each ungrounded conductor [NEC 690.35]. The dc and ac load circuits for the system must also be solidly grounded. Both the positive and negative ungrounded battery circuit conductors must have a switched disconnect means and overcurrent protection, or dc-rated circuit breaker. A ground-fault detector-indicator is also required for ungrounded battery systems over 48 V. Utility Interconnection Interconnection refers to the technical and procedural matters associated with operating interactive PV systems and other distributed generation sources in parallel with the electric utility system. Technical interconnection issues include safety, power quality, and impacts on the utility system, and are addressed in national codes and standards. Interconnection procedures are based on state and utility policies, and include the application process and schedule, customer agreements, and permitting and inspection. Contractual aspects of in- terconnection policies include fees, metering requirements, billing arrangements, and size restrictions on the distributed generator. IEEE 1547 Standard for Interconnection of Distributed Resources with Electrical Power Systems establishes the technical requirements for interconnecting all types of distributed genera- tion equipment, including photovoltaics, fuel cells, wind generators, reciprocating engines, microturbines, and larger combustion turbines with the electrical power system. It also es- tablishes requirements for testing, performance, maintenance and safety of the interconnec- tion, as well as response to abnormal events, anti-islanding protection and power quality. The focus of IEEE 1547 is on distributed resources with capacity less than 10 MVA, and interconnected to the electrical utility system at primary or secondary distribution voltages. The standard provides universal requirements to help ensure a safe and technically sound interconnection. It does not address limitations or impacts on the utility system in terms of energy supply, nor does it deal with procedural or contractual issues associated with the interconnection. UL 1741 Inverters, Converters, Controllers and Interconnection System Equipment for Use with Distributed Energy Resources addresses requirements for all types of distributed generation equipment, including inverters, charge controllers and combiner boxes used in PV systems, as well as equipment used for the interconnection of wind turbines, fuel cells, microtur- bines and engine-generators. This standard covers requirements for the utility interface, and is intended to supplement and be used in conjunction with IEEE 1547. The products covered by the UL 1741 listing are intended to be installed in accordance with the National Electrical Code, NFPA 70.
  • 100. 100 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 All inverters and ac modules that are specifically intended to be used in utility-interactive PV systems must be listed and identified for interactive operations, and this information must be marked on the product label. Battery-based inverters intended only for stand- alone off-grid applications do not have these special identification markings, and may not be used for grid- connected applications. However, all inverters used in PV systems must be listed to the UL 1741 standard, whether they are used for stand-alone or interactive systems. See Fig 99. NEC Article 690 Part VII addresses the connection of PV systems to other power sources, and applies to all interactive PV systems connected to the utility grid. For the 2011 NEC, many of the common interconnec- tion requirements applicable to all distributed genera- tors, including PV systems, fuel cells and wind tur- bines were moved to Article 705. The point of connection, or point of common coupling, is the point where a distributed generator interfaces with the electric utility system. The point of connection may be located on the load side or the supply side of a facil- ity service disconnecting means. See Fig. 100. The output of interactive PV inverters may be connect- ed to either the supply side or load side of the service disconnecting means [NEC 690.64, 705.12]. For many smaller systems, the point of connection is usually made on the load side of the service disconnect at any distribution equipment on the premises, usually at a panelboard. See Fig 101. For load side connections, where the distribution equipment is supplied by both the utility and one or more utility-interactive inverters, and where the dis- tribution equipment is capable of supplying multiple branch circuits or feeders, or both, load side connec- tions must comply with the following seven require- ments [705.12(D)]: See Fig 102. 1. Each source (inverter) must have a dedicated discon- nect and overcurrent protection device. This can be a fusible disconnect or circuit breaker and need not be service rated. PV systems using more than one inverter Figure 99. Inverters and ac modules used in utility-interactive PV systems must be listed and identified for interactive operations.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 101 Figure 98. Inverters and AC modules used in utility-interactive PV systems must be listed and identified for interactive operations. Figure 100. Interactive inverters may be connected to either the load side or the supply side of the service disconnecting means. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 102 Figure 99. Interactive inverters may be connected to either the load side or the supply side of the service disconnecting means. Distribution Equipment To Utility To Branch Circuits Service Disconnect Supply Side Load Side Figure 102. Load side connections require that the sum of the ampere ratings of overcurrent devices supplying power to a busbar or conductor does not exceed 120% of busbar or conductor rating.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 104 Figure 101. Load side connections require that the sum of the ampere ratings of overcurrent devices supplying power to a busbar or conductor does not exceed 120% of busbar or conductor rating. Distribution Equipment To Utility To Branch Circuits Service Disconnect Interactive Inverter Backfed Circuit Breaker 200 A 40 A Figure 101. Many small residential and commercial PV systems can be interconnected by adding backfed circuit breakers to distribution panels as long as certain conditions are met.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 103 Figure 100. Many small residential and commercial PV systems can be interconnected by adding backfed circuit breakers to distribution panels as long as certain conditions are met. Distribution Equipment To Utility To Branch Circuits Service Disconnect Interactive Inverter Backfed Circuit Breaker
  • 101. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 101 are considered multiple sources, and require a dedicated disconnect and overcurrent de- vice for each inverter. A single disconnecting means can be additionally provided for the combination of multiple parallel inverters connected to subpanels. This requirement does not apply ac modules or micro inverters where the output of multiple inverters is permit- ted for one disconnect and overcurrent device. 2. Load side connections require that the sum of the ampere ratings of overcurrent devices supplying power to a busbar or conductor does not exceed 120% of busbar or conductor rating. For a typical 200 A residential service with a 200 A panel busbar, up to 40 A of backfed PV breakers would be allowed, allowing a maximum inverter continuous output current rating of 32 A. For interactive PV systems with energy storage intended to supply a backup load during grid outages, the bus or conductor loading is evaluated at 125% of the inverter maximum continuous current output rather than the overcurrent device rating. EXAMPLE: What is the highest rated inverter continuous AC output current that can be interconnected to a 125 A panel supplied from the grid by a 100 A overcurrent device? The OCP devices supplying power to the panel (PV and grid) cannot exceed 120% of the panel bus rat- ing. The allowable OCP devices is 1.2 × 125 A = 150 A. The allowable PV breaker would then be 150 A – 100 A = 50 A. Since the PV OCP device needs to be 125% of the inverter maximum continuous output current ratings, the maximum inverter continuous output current would be 50 A / 1.25 = 40 A. 3. Interactive inverters must be interconnected on the line side of all ground-fault protec- tion equipment. Most ground-fault protection breakers are not listed for backfeeding, and may damage them and prevent proper operation. Supply side interconnections are usually required for larger facilities incorporating ground-fault protection devices at the service if they are not listed and approved for backfeeding. 4. Distribution equipment used for interconnecting inverters must have markings to identify the connection for all sources. This requires labels for backfed PV breakers and main supply breakers. 5. Circuit breakers used for inverter connections must be suitable for backfeeding. Break- ers without “Line” and “Load” side marking have been evaluated in both directions, and considered to be identified as suitable for backfeeding. 6. Fastening normally required for supply breakers is not required for breakers supplied by interactive inverters. Bolt-in connections, or panel covers normally render breakers not readily accessible for removal. The requirement for listed interactive inverters to de- energize output upon loss of utility voltage also makes these breakers safer for removal and service.
  • 102. 102 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 7. If the sum of the overcurrent device ratings supplying a panelboard is greater than 100% of the bus rating, the inverter output breakers must be installed at the opposite end of the bus from the utility supply breaker, and have a permanent label stating: WARNING: INVERTER OUTPUT CONNECTION – DO NOT RELOCATE THIS OVERCURRENT DEVICE. EXAMPLE: Consider a 7 kW PV inverter with 240 V output. Can this inverter be connected to a 150 A panel bus supplied by a 150 A main service breaker? The inverter maximum continuous output current is: 7,000 W ÷ 240 V = 29.2 A The required overcurrent device rating is: 29.2 A × 125% = 36.5 A rounded up to next standard breaker size, 40 A The 150 A panelboard permits 120% × 150 A = 180 of supply breakers: 180 A – 150 A main leaves 30 A maximum allowable PV supply breakers. A 7 kW inverter requires a 40 A breaker and may not be connected to this panel. Ultimately, the ratings of distribution equipment and overcurrent protection devices limit the size of load side interconnections. To allow the load side connection of a 7 kW inverter for the previous example, possible solutions include: • Upgrading the panel rating to 200 A with a 200 A main breaker would allow a 40 A back- fed breaker from the PV systems. • Keeping the main breaker at 150 A would allow even more PV capacity to be intercon- nected, and not require a utility service upgrade.
  • 103. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 103 When the requirements for load side connection become impractical, interactive PV systems and other interconnected power sources may be connected to the supply side of the service disconnecting means [NEC 705.12(A), 230.82(6)]. These requirements are similar to installing another service, which involves tapping the service conductors or bus, or installing new service equipment. Supply side interconnections are often re- quired for larger installations. The sum of the ratings for overcurrent devices supplying a service must not exceed the service ratings. See Fig 103. Supply side connections must have a service-rated disconnect and overcurrent device, with a minimum rating of at least 60 A, and have an interrupt rating sufficient for the maximum available fault current.The connection can be made by tapping the service conductors at the main distribution panel prior to the existing service disconnect, or it may be made on the load side of the meter socket if the terminals permit. Additional pull boxes may be installed to provide sufficient room for the tap. Service equipment for larger commercial facilities often have busbars with provisions for connecting tap conductors. In cases of very large PV installations, existing service conductor ampacity or distribu- tion transformers may not be sufficient and separate services may be installed. Power flow can occur in both directions at the point of connection, and the interface equip- ment and any metering must be sized and rated for the operating conditions. Systems larger than 100 kW may be interconnected at other points in a facility provided qualified persons operate and maintain the systems, and that appropriate safeguards, procedures and documentation are in place [NEC 705.12(C)]. Figure 103. Supply side connections are made on the utility side of the service disconnecting means.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 105 Figure 102. Supply side connections are made on the utility side of the service disconnecting means. Distribution Equipment To Utility To Branch Circuits Service Disconnect Interactive Inverter Service Rated Fused Disconnect
  • 104. 104 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 5 Installing Mechanical Components PV modules and array mounting systems are installed in accordance with manufacturer’s instructions. Not following these instructions may void product warranties or listings. Specialized training and experience may be required to install certain products and sys- tems, such as large area modules, building-integrated products or large tracking arrays. 5.1 Install Mounting System PV arrays are constructed from building blocks of individual PV modules, panels and sub arrays that form a mechanically and electrically integrated dc power generation unit. The mechanical and electrical layout and installation of PV arrays involves many interre- lated considerations and tradeoffs. Some of the many factors to consider include: • Module physical and electrical characteristics • Array electrical design and output requirements • Mounting location, orientation and shading • Type of mounting surface (roof or ground mount) • Access and pathways for installation, maintenance and fire codes • Structural loads on modules, mounting structures and attachments • Thermal characteristics of modules and effects of mounting system • Weathersealing of building penetrations and attachments • Materials and hardware compatibilities with the application environment • Aesthetics Mounting system designs have a strong effect on average and peak array operating temperatures. Higher operating temperatures reduce array voltage, power output and energy production, and accelerate degradation of modules and their performance over many years. Rack mounted arrays have the greatest passive cooling and lowest operating tempera- tures, with temperature rise from 15°C to 25°C above ambient temperatures under solar irradiance levels of 1000 W/m2 . Direct mounts have the highest operating temperatures, with temperature rise coefficients of 35 to 40°C/kW/m2 . Standoff mounts have moderate operating temperatures, depending on the standoff height. Maximum passive cooling gains are generally achieved with the tops of PV modules 3 to 6 inches above the roof surface. Common standoff PV arrays are mounted slightly above and parallel to rooftops. PV modules are typically bolted or clamped with their long dimension across two structural rails or beams for support. The rails are then fastened and weathersealed to the building structure at defined points along the rails with special brackets designed for a specific type of roof. PV arrays installed in higher wind regions require stronger rails, or smaller spans between rail attachments (more attachment points) to avoid excessive rail and module deflections. These brackets support the entire structural loads on the PV array at
  • 105. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 105 the attachment points, which are either screwed of bolted to the roof trusses or structure. Lag screws are commonly used for screwed attachments to residential roof types. The point attachments must be installed properly to structural members. See Figs. 104 & 105. Where lag screws are used, they must be centered into a truss generally only 1-1/2 inches in width. To find the exact center of trusses, special deep-penetrating stud find- ers can be used. With practice, the trusses on a shingled residential roof can usually be located by hitting the roof with a hammer. The center of the truss can be located by driv- ing a small nail through the roof covering, deck and into the truss, then moving over 1/8 inch or so at a time until the nail does not penetrate into the truss, locating the truss edge. Backing up ¾ in then defines the center of the truss. A drill alignment tool can help center the appropriate size pilot holes prior to screw installation. Weather sealant and flashings are then used to seal the entire area around the attachment point, including any small nail holes used to find the trusses. When structural members are not present or cannot be located for array attachment points, the installer may be required to add additional blocking in the attic between the roof trusses. This is commonly required toward the edges of hip roofs. Typically a solid anchor between trusses can use pairs of 2x6 boards that are attached between rafters or trusses. The 2x6 pairs provide three inches of wood into which a lag screw can penetrate, as well as a relatively large area for mounting the bracket on top of the roof. In order to Figure 105. Point attachments connect the array assembly to a building or structure at distributed locations, and are usually the critical design point of the entire mounting system.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 107 Figure 104. Structural considerations for PV arrays include attachments of modules and supports to structures.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 106 to structures. Trusses or beams Point attachments to structure Roof surface PV Modules Module support rails Module attachments Figure 106. Additional blocking may be required for some installations to adequately secure point attachments to the structure.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 108 Figure 105. Additional blocking may be required for some installations to adequately secure point attachments to the structure.
  • 106. 106 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 provide proper support for the array, the boards must be nailed or screwed securely onto the rafters or trusses with at least two fasteners on each side of each board. See Fig. 106. PV array mounting system designs and all components must be able to withstand the maximum forces expected in any given application. Oftentimes, independent engineer- ing or test results may be required to certify PV array structural designs for local building code compliance. The critical design area is usually the point attachments of the array mounting system to a structure. A number of pre-engineered standoff mounts are available commercially. When installed according the manufacturer’s directions, engineers or test laboratories certify these mounts to be capable of withstanding specified wind loads. If engineered mounting sys- tems are used, it is necessary follow the instructions to ensure that the system is installed properly to address the design wind load requirements. During inspection, it should be pointed out that the directions were followed to meet the loading requirements. Figure 108. PV module specifications give the maximum mechanical loads that the module can support using specified supports and attachments.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 110 Figure 107. PV module specifications give the maximum mechanical loads that the module can support using specified supports and attachments. SolarWorld Figure 107. PV modules are commonly attached to underlying rails or beams using bolted attachments or clamps to the module frame.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 109 Figure 106. PV modules are commonly attached to underlying rails or beams using bolted attachments or clamps to the module frame. Bolted Attachments Bottom Clamps Top Clamps 5.2 Install PV Modules Most standard flat-plate PV modules are glass laminates enclosed in an aluminum frame. The frame provides mechanical support for the laminate, and a means to structurally attach the module to a mounting system and for electrical grounding. PV modules are either bolted with fasteners or clamped to the top or bottom of supporting rails or beams. See Fig. 107. In common sloped rooftop applications, the rails are usually laid out with the length in an east-west direction across the roof, which permits variable width attachments to the underlying roof structural members, such as rafters or trusses. As the spacing between rafters or trusses is usually fixed, this may constrain the installation of rails up and down the roof slope (in a north-south direction).
  • 107. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 107 This is because PV modules require the support rails to be located at certain points on the module frame to support the specified mechanical loads. Refer to the mounting hardware manufacturer’s data on maximum allowable loads and deflection on module support beams. See Fig. 108. Manufacturer’s instructions should be carefully followed whenever handling or install- ing PV modules. Although PV modules are designed to withstand environmental ex- tremes for many years, they can be damaged if improperly stored, handled or installed. Some modules are more durable than others, but care should be taken to ensure that the module edges are not chipped or impacted. Unframed laminates are particularly suscep- tible to edge damage and require significantly more care in handling. Small chips or nicks in the glass result in high stress points that become cracks that destroy the module. Since clamps are commonly used to fasten PV modules, it is important to install the proper clamps for the modules used, and torque to the proper values so that the clamps stay firmly in place but do not crush the module frame. Follow the PV module manufacturer’s installation instructions for the allowable mounting points to structurally secure modules and meet the maximum design loads. Working safely with PV modules involves taking precautions to avoid electrical shock from potentially high dc voltages, especially when several modules are connected in series. Wiring faults may also lead to hazardous conditions and high voltages on metal components. Care in handling, transporting, storing and installing PV modules includes the following: • Leave modules in packaging until they are to be installed. • Carry modules with both hands, do not use connectors as a handle • Do not stand modules on hard ground or on their corners • Do not place modules on top of each other or stand on them • Do not mark or work on them with sharp objects • Keep all electrical contacts clean and dry • Do not install modules in high winds General safety precautions for installing PV modules include the following: • Use the appropriate safety equipment (insulated tools/gloves, fall protection, etc.) • Never insert electrically conducting parts into the plugs or sockets • Never connect non-load break connectors under load, or if dirty or wet • Never use damaged modules • Do not dismantle modules. • Do not remove any part or label fitted by the manufacturer • Never treat the rear of the laminate with paint, adhesives or mark it using sharp objects • Do not artificially concentrate sunlight on modules
  • 108. 108 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 6 Completing System Installation Once PV systems are installed, they are inspected and commissioned to verify the instal- lation matches the plans and code requirements, and to verify that performance expecta- tions are met. 6.1 Commission the System Commissioning of PV systems follows similar requirements to any electrical installation, involving visual observations, testing and measurements to verify the safety and quality of the installation in accordance with the plans and applicable codes and standards, and to verify the proper operation and performance of the system. Key steps of a commissioning procedure include: • Completing final installation details • Completing a system checkout and visual inspections • Verifying wiring insulation integrity and proper termination torques • Completing system documentation and labeling requirements • Perform initial start-up and operations • Demonstrate and verify shutdown and emergency procedures • Verifying expected output and performance • Conducting user training and orientation A final checkout confirms that the installation is complete before beginning operations. A punch list can help check off items as they are completed, and should include the follow- ing items: • Verifying disconnects are open and lockout/tagout procedures are in place • Visually inspecting all components and connections (structural and electrical) • Verifying terminal torque specifications and insulation integrity • Verifying consistency of overall installation with system design and code compliance • Identifying and completing any unresolved items Numerous markings, labels and signs are required to identify PV systems and their com- ponents, and to warn operators, service personnel or emergency responders of hazardous conditions. Manufacturer markings and labels identify the size, type, specifications and ratings for PV modules, inverters, controllers, combiner boxes, conductors, raceways, overcurrent devices, switchgear and all other electrical components. These markings are placed on the product at the time of manufacture, and include listing marks from the testing laboratory, such as UL. Code officials may verify these markings during final inspections, and use them for the basis of their approval. Additional markings and labels are required for the overall system and certain compo- nents, and are to be provided and placed by the installer. These include additional labels on conductors, connectors, conduits, disconnecting means, and at the point of utility connection. Special labeling is also required for bipolar arrays, ungrounded PV arrays,
  • 109. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 109 battery storage systems, and stand-alone inverters providing a single 120-volt supply. The initial startup for a PV system is conducted after all inspections and checks have been completed with all outstanding items resolved. Typical startup procedures include: • Installing overcurrent devices • Closing all DC and AC disconnects and turning on inverter • Verifying system output 6.2 Visual Inspection Visual inspections should be performed as part of commissioning and routinely over the system lifetime to verify and ensure that the system remains in a satisfactory condition for use. Prior to operation, PV systems should be inspected for full compliance with the many NEC requirements, including verifying appropriate: • Circuit voltages and currents • Conductor and overcurrent device sizes and ratings • Disconnecting means • Wiring methods and connectors • Equipment and system grounding • Markings and labels • Connections to other sources • Battery and charge controller installation An inspection checklist is an indispensible tool for contractors and regulators, and provides an organized process to review and help ensure code compliance for PV installations. The basic purposes for an inspection checklist include: • Verification of appropriate equipment listings and labeling, intended for the conditions of use, and installed in accordance with instructions. • Verification of appropriate sizes and ratings for major components and balance-of-systems equipment. • Verification of proper grounding and bonding. • Verification that all equipment and the overall installation is completed in a workmanlike manner in compliance with all applicable codes. Some sources for PV system inspection checklists include: www.nmsu.edu/~tdi/Photovoltaics/Codes-Stds/Codes-Stds.html http://irecusa.org/wp-content/uploads/2010/07/PV-Field-Inspection-Guide-June-2010-F-1.pdf www.jimdunlopsolar.com/vendorimages/jdsolar/PVInspectionChecklist.pdf 6.3 Test the System Testing PV systems requires qualified persons with knowledge of electrical systems measure- ments, the test equipment used, and the specifications and characteristics of the equipment or systems under test. PV systems should be thoroughly tested at the time of commissioning and periodically over the system life to ensure proper and safe operations.
  • 110. 110 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Electrical testing on interactive PV systems includes the following measurements and verifications: • Test ac circuits for continuity, phasing, voltage • Test dc circuits for continuity of grounding conductors • Verify correct dc polarity • Test string open-circuit voltage • Test string short circuit current • Verify system functionality • Test insulation resistance for PV arrays source and output circuits Insulation Resistance Testing Insulation resistance testing measures the resistance from ungrounded circuits to ground, and is used to verify and demonstrate integrity of wiring systems [NEC 110.7]. These tests can be used to identify damage or insulation faults for PV modules and interconnect wiring, to locate ground faults, or to assess the degradation of array wiring, PV modules and other system circuits. The insulation tester can be a variable dc power supply or megohmmeter that provides a test voltage of 500 V. Damage to wiring insulation can be due to improper installation, or from vermin chew- ing the wires. Older PV arrays may have significantly higher leakage current than when they were new. Proper insulating gloves and other applicable PPE should be used when- ever touching a PV array or associated conductive surfaces to protect against electrical shock, especially when ground-fault conditions are indicated. Insulation resistance testing measures the resistance between the system circuits and ground. Insulation resistance for large PV arrays is generally measured at source circuit combiner boxes, where the individual source circuits can be accessed for disconnection and testing. The tests can be conducted dry, or a wetting agent can be sprayed on por- tions of an array to better pinpoint fault locations. All circuits must be isolated from others for testing and grounding or bonding connec- tions are left connected. Any surge suppression equipment must be removed from the circuits. Connect the positive and negative output leads of the array together, and to the positive terminal of the insulation tester. A short-circuiting device is required suitable for the source circuit or array maximum current. Connect the negative terminal of the insula- tion tester to the grounding point for the array or source circuit. Apply a dc test voltage of 500 V and wait for capacitive effects to subside and readings to stabilize. Measure and record the insulation resistance in megohms. Observe and listen to the array during the tests for evidence of arcing or flashover. Generally, when a fault exists, resistance mea- surements will decrease significantly. Tests conducted during system commissioning may be used as a baseline for which later measurements can be compared. 6.3.1 Complete System Documentation Adequate documentation for PV systems is an essential part of the approval process, and helps ensure safe and reliable operation over decades of operation. Complete documen-
  • 111. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 111 tation is particularly important for safety concerns, routine maintenance, later modifica- tions, and for systems having a change in ownership or those responsible for operating and maintaining the system. In most jurisdictions, system documentation is required by the building officials for the plan review and permitting process, and also for intercon- nection approval from the local utility. In some cases, incentive programs may require additional documentation, such as a shading analysis and system performance estimates. Final system documents should always be provided to the owners and caretakers and should be accessible at the system site for future reference. The installation contactor should also keep a copy of the system documentation materials for their records and follow-on service as required. A complete system documentation package is a well-organized collection of all relevant documents depicting the as-built system design, major components and relevant infor- mation on safety, operations, and maintenance. While the details may vary with the size and scope of specific projects, key components of a final PV system documentation pack- age should include the following: • General information should include the system dc and ac power ratings; the manu- facturer, model and quantity of PV modules, inverters, batteries, controllers and all other major components, as applicable. The dates of the system installation, commis- sioning and inspection should also be noted. • Contact information should include the names, postal addresses, phone numbers and email addresses for the customer/owner, system designer, installation contractor and any other responsible parties or subcontractors. • A site layout drawing is often required by local jurisdictions for permitting purposes, to identify equipment locations on buildings or relative to property lines or ease- ments. In some cases, a shading analysis and performance estimates may be provided with project proposals, and should also be including with the final system docu- ments. • A single line diagram should be provided depicting the overall system design, includ- ing the types of modules, total number of modules, modules per string and total number of strings; the types and number of inverters; and any other major compo- nents. For larger projects, complete as-built electrical and mechanical drawings are usually required. • The types, sizes and ratings for all balance-of-system components should also be an- notated on the single line diagram, or noted and provided in a separate table, includ- ing specifications for all conductors, raceways, junction boxes, source circuit combiner boxes, disconnects, overcurrent protection devices, and grounding equipment, as applicable. • Data sheets and specifications should be provided for PV modules, inverters and other major components, including module mounting systems. For most products, installation and user/operator manuals are available and provide important information regarding the safe operation and maintenance of the equipment. • Operation and maintenance information should include procedures for verify- ing proper system operation and performance, and how to determine if there is a problem and what to do. Procedures for isolating/disconnecting equipment and emergency shutdown procedures should also be provided. A maintenance plan and intervals should be provided for all routine (scheduled) system maintenance, such as
  • 112. 112 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 array cleaning as required. Operating and maintenance guidelines should differenti- ate what tasks can be performed by the owner or caretakers, from those that require professional service due to the complexity of the tasks, special equipment needs, or safety concerns. Maintenance agreements, plans and recordkeeping forms or sheets should also be provided to document maintenance activities over time. • Warranty details on major components should be clearly identified, indicating the terms and conditions, and how the warranty process is handled and by whom. System warranties should also be addressed, including quality of workmanship, roof weathersealing or performance warranties as applicable. • Copies of all commissioning test reports and verification data shall be provided as applicable. • Contracting and financial details are also an important part of system documentation, and may be included with the technical items discussed above or under a separate file. These documents should include construction contracts, invoices and payments for materials and labor, building permits, inspection certificates, interconnection agreements, and applications and approvals from incentive programs, such as rebates and tax forms.
  • 113. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 113 7 Conducting Maintenance and Troubleshooting Activities PV systems require periodic maintenance to ensure safe and reliable operations over the long-term, and to maximize performance. Although most PV systems usually require little maintenance, a maintenance plan ensures that essential service is performed on a regular schedule. Maintenance helps identify and avoid potential problems that affect system functions, performance, or safety. When problems do occur, a systematic troubleshooting process is used to diagnose and identify the problems, and take corrective actions. All PV systems require some maintenance. A maintenance plan includes a list and schedule for all required system maintenance and service, such as: • Inspections of components and wiring systems • Evaluation of structural attachments and weathersealing • Cleaning and removing debris around arrays • Performing battery maintenance • Conducting electrical tests and verifying performance • Replacement of damaged or failed system components 7.1 Perform Visual Inspection Visual inspections of the complete system should be performed with regular mainte- nance, similar to the initial inspection prior to commissioning. The main difference is that during maintenance inspections, the code compliance aspects of the system do not neces- sarily need to be evaluated, as the equipment would not normally have been changed. However, the integrity of the electrical installation must be carefully evaluated for deteri- orating effects over time, due to the site conditions, or even for poor quality components or damage for outside influences. Visual inspections and observations are supplemented with electrical tests and measurements to fully verify system integrity and performance. PV modules should be visually inspected for signs of any physical damage, including bent frames or broken glass. See Fig. 109. Modules with fractured or damaged laminates Figure 109. Inspect PV arrays for any signs of physical damage, such as impacts or fractures.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 111 Figure 108. Inspect PV arrays for any signs of physical damage, such as impacts or fractures. Obvious impact damage Less obvious fractured glass will eventually admit moisture and de- velop high leakage currents, and should be removed from the array and replaced. Most PV modules use tempered glass, which shatters into small pieces when stressed or impacted. Physical damage may be quite obvious in the case of im- pacts, but fractured glass in a PV module may not be clearly evident from a distance.
  • 114. 114 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 More subtle signs of module degradation include delamination, moisture or corrosion within modules, particularly near cell busbar connections and edges of laminates. Discol- orations inside module laminates may be an indicator of a failing edge seal, or damage to the back of the module laminate. Degradation of solder bonds at internal cell connec- tions can lead to hot spots and ultimately burn through the back of the module, resulting in module failure, reduced system performance and creating a fire hazard. See Fig.110. Burned bus bars, delaminated modules and damaged wiring systems are likely to show faults during insulation resistance testing. Thermal imaging can be a useful diagnostics tool for identifying faults in wiring systems or poor connections, especially for PV arrays. Figure 111. Operating parameters in PV systems are measured to verify expected performance. lar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 113 Figure 110. Operating parameters in PV systems are measured to verify expected performance. Figure 110. PV modules should be carefully inspected for any signs of discoloration, corrosion or delamination.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 112 Figure 109. PV modules should be carefully inspected for any signs of discoloration, corrosion or delamination. Back Surface Front Surface Burned Busbars Delamination and Corrosion 7.2 Verify System Operation Performance data can be used to verify output expectations and identify problems that require service or maintenance. See Fig. 111. Most invert- ers and charge controllers provide some indication of performance and operating status, such as power output or energy production, and fault or error indications. This information is extremely helpful in verifying proper system operation. Also ensure that the system can be disconnected and shut down safely and that it starts properly. Knowledge of the specific equipment used and the product installation and operation instructions are crucial to verifying their safe and proper operation. For simple interactive PV systems without energy storage, the key indi- cators for system performance are ac power output (kW) and ac energy production (kWh). The ac power output for an interactive system is determined by the rated dc power output of the array, the inverter ef- ficiency and systems losses, and is proportional to solar irradiance on the array. Measurement of ac power output is usually given on inverter output displays, or can be recorded over time and accessed remotely. Power mea- surements may be an instantaneous (snap-shot) measurement, or averaged over a certain interval.
  • 115. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 115 The ac power output of an interactive PV system at any moment can be com- pared with expectations, using the basic translation formulas for solar irradiance and temperature. The ac power output can be read from inverter displays or by additional power meters, and the array temperatures and solar radiation in the plane of the array can be measured with simple handheld meters without working on energized equipment. Power verification can be done any time when the system is operating under steady sunlight conditions, preferably at higher irradiance levels. Generally, the maximum ac power output for interactive systems can be related to the rated maximum dc power output rating for the array and adjusted by a number of derating factors. The factors include several types of dc and ac system losses and power conversion efficiencies, which in combination result in ac power output varying between 70% to 85% of the PV array dc rating at Standard Test Conditions (STC), depending on temperature. The ac energy production (kWh) for grid-connected PV systems is measured over periods of months and years to compare with sizing and long-term perfor- mance expectations. The ac energy production for grid-connected PV systems with no energy storage can be estimated using popular tools such as PVWATTS. PVWATTS performs an hour-by-hour simulation for a typical year to estimate average power output for each hour and totals energy production for the entire year. PVWATTS uses an overall dc to ac derate factor to determine the rated ac power at STC. Power corrections for PV array operating temperature are per- formed for each hour of the year as PVWATTS reads the meteorological data for the location and computes the performance. A power correction of -0.5%/°C for crystalline silicon PV modules is used. Actual solar irradiation (insolation) and array temperatures can be used to more precisely compare with the ac energy produced. The average daily ac energy production divided by the product of the PV array dc peak power rating at STC and peak sun hours is a key indicator of system performance: ac kWh / (dc kWp x PSH) = 0.7 to 0.85 (depending on temperature and system losses) The installer must be capable of making a good estimate of the PV array power output based on the system design and environmental conditions. System adjustment factors for module mismatch and dc and ac wire losses vary based upon the actual installation. Another factor that can limit irradiance is soiling on the array. This is particularly a concern in climates in the western U.S. that can go for several months without rain. Solar Radiation Measurements A pyranometer measures total global solar irradiance (solar power). Irradiance measurements are used in the field to translate the actual output of PV array and systems to a reference condition to verify perfor- mance. Small inexpensive meters using calibrated PV cells as sensors are avail- able from $150 and up. See Fig 112. A small PV mod- ule with calibrated short- circuit current can also be used to approximate solar radiation levels. Figure 112. Handheld solar meters use a small PV cell to measure solar irradiance.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Figure 111. Handheld solar meters use a small PV Daystar
  • 116. 116 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Example: How much power should a 4,800 Watt (STC) crystalline silicon array produce when the array temperature is 45°C and the irradiance is 840 W/m2 ? The inverter efficiency is 95%; module mismatch and the dc and ac wiring losses are 2% and 3% respectively, and soil- ing is minimal. System Adjustment Factors: 1. Temperature: [1 - (45°C–25°C) x (–0.005/°C)] = 0.90 2. Irradiance: (IRR ÷ 1000W/m2 ) = 840 ÷ 1000 = 0.84 3. Inverter Efficiency: 0.95 4. Mismatch and dc and ac wire losses: 5% total = 0.95 5. Soiling: 0% = 1.0 Inverter Output Power = 4800 x (0.9) x (0.84) x (0.95) x (0.95) x (1.0) = 3275 W STC array rating Temperature Irradiance Inverter Efficiency Mismatch and wiring Soiling For a utility-interactive system with battery backup, the calculation of expected voltages, currents, and powers is more complicated. The difference between a bat- tery backup system and a system without batteries is that the PV array does not operate at its maximum power voltage unless a MPT charger is used. The battery also requires constant charging to remain fully charged. The output power of the system can be estimated when the system is operating in utility-interactive mode, and if the batteries are fully charged. Typical maximum power tracking controlled battery-based systems will lose 2% (0.98) for maximum power tracking losses and about 5% (0.95) for additional inverter losses. These systems will operate at about 93% of the same size PV sys- tems without batteries. Battery-based systems without maximum power tracking controllers will lose another 5% to 10% instantaneous power due to operation off the maximum power point. All battery-based systems will lose energy keeping the battery fully charged. This charging can reduce the annual energy production by 2% to 5%. All standby power systems have these battery charging losses. Watt-hour meters measure electrical power and energy, and are commonly used at electrical service entrances by utility companies for customer billing purposes. Watt-hour meters essentially measure current, voltage and their phase angle to determine ac power and energy. They can be electronic or electro-mechanical types. Advanced electronic types use microprocessors to measure directional and time of
  • 117. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 117 use power flows and other electrical properties such as reactive power, power factor and peak power demand.See Fig 113. Figure 113. A standard watt-hour meter can be used to measure average power over brief intervals.  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 115 Figure 112. A standard watt-hour meter can be used to measure average power over brief intervals.  The watt-hour constant (Kh) indicates the watt-hours accumulated per revolution of the meter disk.  Multiply Kh by the disk revolution rate to calculate average power through the meter. 3600 average power (W) Wh meter constant ( ) rev rev disk revolution rate ( ) sec avg h rev avg h rev P K N where P K N = × × = = = Standard utility watt-hour meters are often used to record the energy produced by PV systems over time, but can also be used to measure average power over brief intervals. The watt-hour constant (Kh) indicates the watt-hours accumulated per revolution of the meter disk. Most residential meters have Kh = 7.2 watt-hours/rev. The smaller the con- stant, the faster the meter spins for a given amount of power passing through it. Multiply Kh by the disk revolution rate to calculate average power through the meter. The disk has markings on the top and sides with a scale of 0 to 100. Electronic meters use progressive LCD hash marks to simulate disk revolutions and the rate of energy flow. For example, the average power through a meter with Kh = 7.2 that makes 10 complete revolutions in 40 seconds is calculated by: Pavg = 7.2 Wh/rev × 10 rev/40 sec × 3600 sec/hr = 6480 W. Performance verification for stand-alone systems with battery storage is more complex, and involves measurements of: • Battery voltage, amp-hours and state-of-charge • PV array, battery and load currents • Load availability and other factors Battery health is the key to stand-alone PV systems performance, and battery failure is of- ten the indicator of other system problems. Many battery charge controllers and inverters monitor and record certain battery data, such as voltage, current and amp-hours. Closely monitoring and evaluating this data can be an invaluable tool to those operating and maintaining stand-alone systems. Usually, stand-alone systems are designed to produce a specified amount of energy on an average daily basis to meet system loads. Measurements of daily energy consumption
  • 118. 118 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 can be used by the system owner/operators to control their loads and manage the avail- able energy, to maintain battery charge, or to minimize or eliminate the need for a backup source, such as a generator. Measurements of daily minimum daily battery voltage can be used an indicator of state-of-charge. The net amp-hours delivered to and withdrawn from a battery can also be used to assess whether the battery is receiving enough charge. Deficit charging will usually be indicated by declining minimum daily battery voltages. The performance of electrical loads can be verified by measuring their current or power consumption, and if they function as intended. 7.3 Perform Maintenance Activities Basic maintenance for PV arrays includes the following: Debris Removal Any leaves, trash or other debris that collects around PV arrays should be removed dur- ing routine maintenance. These materials can present a fire hazard, as well as a problem for proper drainage and can lead to mildew and insect problems that can ultimately lead to degradations of wiring systems or other components. Shading Control Because a relatively small amount of shading can significantly reduce array output, any conditions that contribute to increased shading of PV arrays should be evaluated during routine maintenance. Trees and vegetation present ongoing shading concerns, and may require trimming and maintenance. Ground-mounted PV arrays may also be susceptible to shading from shrubs or long grass near the array. Where visual observations cannot determine the extent of shading problems, a solar shading evaluation tool can be used. Soiling PV arrays become soiled over time, particularly in arid and dusty regions with infrequent rainfall. Soiling may result from bird droppings, emissions, dust or dirt that settles and accumulates on the array surface. Extensive soiling can reduce array output by 10% to 20% or more. Generally, cleaning PV array on buildings involves climbing ladders and working at heights where personal fall arrest systems are required. Electrical shock haz- ards may also exist for higher voltage arrays with existing faults. See Fig. 114. Weathersealing and Structural The weathersealing of all attachment points and building penetrations should be routine- ly inspected for signs of deterioration or water leakage, and repairs made as required. All structural attachments should be inspected for security and signs of degradation. Battery Maintenance Batteries can be one of the more maintenance-intensive components in a PV system. Regular care and service is important to maximizing battery life, and to mitigate any hazardous conditions. All battery maintenance should be conducted using proper proce- dures and safety precautions. Battery maintenance includes checking and replenishing electrolyte, cleaning, re-tightening terminals, measuring cell voltages, specific gravity and any other periodic maintenance or testing recommended by the manufacturer.
  • 119. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 119 Battery maintenance involves various tasks depending on the type of battery and manu- facturer requirements, including: • Inspecting and cleaning battery racks, cases trays and terminations • Inspecting battery disconnects, overcurrent devices and wiring systems • Checking termination torques • Measuring voltage and specific gravity • Adding water • Inspecting auxiliary systems • Load and capacity testing Observe all safety precautions and wear appropriate PPE when conducting any battery maintenance. Personal safety precautions for battery maintenance include: • Wearing face shields, aprons and rubber gloves when dealing with electrolytes • Using insulated tools to prevent short circuits • Providing eye wash facilities, water and baking soda for flushing and neutralizing spilled electrolyte • Providing disconnecting means to isolate battery system • Fire protection equipment Figure 114. Cleaning soiled PV arrays is a common maintenance need. Jim Tetro  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 2 Sharp Solar
  • 120. 120 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Battery test equipment includes: • DC voltmeters are used to measure battery and cell voltages • DC ammeters (clamp-on type) are used to measure battery currents • Hydrometers are used to measure electrolyte specific gravity • Load testers discharge the battery at high rates for short periods while the voltage drop is recorded • Impedance and conductance testers may be used on some VRLA batteries Battery terminals are made of soft lead alloys, and connections may become loose over time. This can lead to increased resistance and voltage drop within the battery bank, re- sulting in unequal charge and discharge currents among individual cells. In severe cases, loose terminals can cause accelerated corrosion, and overheat to a point where the battery post or cable connection deforms or even melts, creating a fire hazard and destroying the battery. Regular battery maintenance should include checks of all terminals for corrosion and proper torque. Terminals may be coated with petroleum jelly, grease, or special bat- tery terminal corrosion inhibitors to retard corrosion. See Fig. 115. Figure 115. Periodic battery maintenance should include checks of all terminals for corrosion and proper torque. 2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 118 Figure 114. Periodic battery maintenance should include checks of all terminals for corrosion and proper torque.  Periodic battery maintenance should include checks of all terminals for corrosion and proper torque. Specific gravity should be checked for open- vent flooded lead-acid batteries as part of annual maintenance, and may be used to estimate battery state-of-charge. Abnormally low readings may indicate failing or shorted cells. A fully charged lead-acid cell has a typical specific gravity between 1.26 and 1.28 at room temperature. Specific gravity decreases with increasing electrolyte temperature, and measurements must be corrected to a reference temperature for comparison. Four “points” of specific gravity (0.004) are added for every 5.5°C (10°F) increment above a reference temperature and four points are subtracted for every 5.5°C (10°F) decrease in temperature. For example, at 90°F (32°C) a hydrometer reading of 1.250 would be corrected to 1.254 at 80°F. See Fig 116. Hydrometers measure electrolyte specific gravity (SG). Archimedes hydrometers use a float and buoyancy principles to measure SG. Refractive index hydrometers use a prism and optics to measure SG by the angle that light refracts through a droplet of electrolyte. See Fig. 117. Open-circuit voltage may also be measured and used independently or in conjunction with specific gravity to estimate battery state-of-charge. The voltage readings must be taken when the battery has not been charged or discharged for at least 5 to 10 minutes.
  • 121. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 121 Flooded, open-vent batteries require frequent water additions to replenish water lost through electrolyte gassing. Distilled water is recommended as any impurities may poison a battery. Electrolyte levels must not be allowed to decrease below the tops of the battery plates, which can oxidize and reduce capacity. Because electrolyte expands with increasing concentration, batteries should only be completely filled or “topped off” when they are fully charged. Otherwise, the battery may overflow electrolyte from the cell vents. The frequency and amount of watering required depends on charge rates, temperature, regulation voltage and age of the battery among other factors. Watering intervals may be extended where batteries have reserve electrolyte capacity. Advanced multi-stage charge control methods and temperature compensation also reduce water loss. Higher water loss should be expected in hot, arid climates. Excessive electrolyte loss may be due to a faulty charge controller, failed temperature compensation or improper regulation set point. Comparatively low water consumption in individual cells may indicate a weak or failing cell, or need for equalization charge. Specific gravity is also likely to be lower in cells with lower water loss. Battery load testing applies very high discharge rates for a few seconds, while measuring the decrease in battery voltage. Weak or failed cells are indicated by significantly greater voltage drop during this test. Battery capacity testing involves discharging the battery at nominal discharge rates to a prescribed depth-of-discharge. This test evaluates available energy storage capacity for the system during normal operations. Figure 116. Battery specific gravity and open-circuit voltage are measured during maintenance to evaluate battery health and estimate state-of-charge. Figure 117. Hydrometers measure electrolyte specific gravity (SG). Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 119 specific gravity and open-circuit voltage are measured during maintenance to evaluate battery health and estimate state-of-charge. State-of- Charge Specific Gravity Open- Circuit Voltage (V) 100% 1.265 12.6 75% 1.225 12.4 50% 1.190 12.2 25% 1.155 12.0 0 1.120 11.8 For typical lead-acid battery at 25°C  2011 Jim Dunlop Solar Cells, Modules and Arrays: 5 - 120 Figure 116. Hydrometers measure electrolyte specific gravity (SG). Archimedes Hydrometer Refractive Index Hydrometer
  • 122. References key: topic / name / detail / author 122 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 EFFICIENT. RELIABLE. RESPONSIVE. What more do you want from your inverter supplier? www.solectria.com | inverters@solectria.com | 978-683-9700 Built for the real world MADE IN THE USA
  • 123. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 123 References key: topic / name / detail / author Introduction to Resources Section The following pages list additional sources of information on the topics that are covered in the NABCEP PV Installation Professional Job Task Analysis. The list of sources was assembled by a committee of subject matter experts and represents their considerable efforts to offer additional study materials. The list in not complete, nor could it ever be complete, as additional material in the form of books, videos, articles and web sites are continually being produced. The reader will note that some sub topic areas do not have recommended additional study refer- ences. This is because the Committee did not find a reference for that particular topic area that met their standards of usefulness and accuracy. NABCEP encourages dialogue and input at all times and invites readers who identify potential references for any topic areas covered in this guide to send them to NABCEP for review by the Committee for possible inclusion in future editions of this Guide. Please send reference recommendations to info@nabcep.org with the subject line “PV Resource Guide Reference Submission”. References Color Key: Task Steps and Knowledge in each Category Level Category / Level Description l Critical Absolutely essential for a PV installer. Installers do these tasks most frequently. l Important Very important, but not of the highest level of criticality. These tasks are done with less frequency by installers yet have been identified as important to the knowledge base of installers. l Useful Might be useful; can inform education and training to add richness and depth. Installers do these tasks infrequently. Appendixes References..............................................................................123 Case Study Examples.......................................................149 Sample NABCEP Exam Questions..........................156
  • 124. References key: topic / name / detail / author 124 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 1. Verify Client Needs • Confirm desired location of equipment • Address aesthetic concerns Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10/Page# 259-260; Mechanical Intergration - Aesthetics; J.P. Dunlop; Home Power Magazine; Issue #142/Pgs# 44-51; Architectural PV Design Considerations; M. Welch • Address legal concerns • Confirm loads assessment Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 9/Pgs# 233-240; System Sizing - Load Analysis; J.P. Dunlop; PV Design & Installation man.; Chapter # 4/ Pgs# 38-40; Electric Load Analysis; S.E.I. • Confirm critical loads Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 4/Pgs# 96-97; System Components & Config. - Electric Loads; J.P. Dunlop; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.3; Stand alone System Design - 5 rules for Load analysis • Confirm system matches client expectation Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pgs# 84-85; Site Survey and Preplanning - Prep Proposals/Install Planning Additional useful references • Determine client’s energy expectations Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pg# 82; Site Survey and Preplanning - Energy Audit; J.P. Dunlop; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue# 4.4; PV Performance Guarantees (Part 1): Managing Risks & Expectations; Mat Taylor, David Williams • Determine client’s financial expectations Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 15/Pgs# 399-416; Economic Analysis; J.P. Dunlop • Obtain utility bills Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 4/Pgs# 105-107; System Components & Config - Utility interactive Systems; J.P. Dunlop • Determine client budget Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 15/Pgs# 394-398; Economic Analysis - Incentives/Rebates/Grants/Tax Incentive; J.P. Dunlop 2. Review Site Survey • Evaluate roof conditions Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter #3/Pgs# 78-80; Site Survey and Preplanning - Roofing Evaluation; J.P. Dunlop; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 2.3; Quality Assurance: Aerial Site Surveys Save Time and Resources; Tim Harvey • Evaluate desired array and equipment locations Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pgs# 66,67,80; Site Survey and Preplanning - Array Loc./Equipment Loc.; J.P. Dunlop; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 115/ Pgs# 98-100; Considerations for PV Site Surveys; J. Wiles; Home Power Magazine Issue # 130/Pgs# 52-56; Optimizing a PV array with Orientation and Tilt; D. DelVecchio • Locate solar equipment Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Page# 80; Site Survey and Preplanning - Equipment Locations; J.P. Dunlop • Locate conduit paths • Evaluate roof structure Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.2; Pitched Roof PV Mounting: Design and Engineering considerations; Yun Lee • Determine obstructions Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pages# 70 - 77; Site Survey and Preplanning - Shading Priority/Alt. Angle method; J.P. Dunlop • Conduct a site hazard assessment (existing hazards) Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pages# 60 - 64; Site Survey and Preplanning - Survey Safety; J.P. Dunlop • Identify staging/lifting/access locations Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10/Pgs# 256 - 257; Mechanical Integration - Mech. considerations/Accessability Verify System Design
  • 125. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 125 References key: topic / name / detail / author • Confirm accuracy of shading analysis Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pgs# 69-77; Site Survey and Preplanning; Shading Analysis; J.P. Dunlop; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 121/Pgs# 88-90; Solmetric Suneye Solar Site; Evaluation tool; J. Schwartz; Home Power Magazine, Issue # 115/Pgs# 30-33; Choose the right Site to Maximize your Solar Investment; Tehri Parker; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 1.1; Solar Site Evaluation: Tools & Techniques to Quantify & Optimize Production; Mark Galli, Peter Hoberg • Evaluate existing electrical equipment Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Page# 80; Site Survey and Preplanning - Electrical Assesment; J.P. Dunlop • Determine true South Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Page# 68; Site Survey and Preplanning - Magnetic declination; J.P. Dunlop PV Design & Installation man.; Chapter # 3/Page# 32-33; The Solar Resource - Orientation; S.E.I.; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 116/Page# 12-13; Ask the Experts: Finding True South; R. Perez • Evaluate wall structure • Confirm existing roof tilt and orientation (pitch and azimuth) Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pages# 66 - 70; Site Survey and Preplanning - Array Loc. / Equipment Loc.; J.P. Dunlop; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 137; Pages #74-80; Modern PV Roof Mounting; Rebekah Hren • Confirm accuracy of site drawings Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 3/Pages# 81; Site Survey and Preplanning - Site Layout Drawings; J.P. Dunlop • Evaluate wind exposure Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10/Page# 271-272; J.P. Dunlop • Evaluate soil conditions Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.4; Ground Mounted PV - Soil Properties; Charly Bray • Confirm solar resource Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 2/Pages# 33 - 53; Solar Radiation - Sun Path, Tilt angle, Azimuth Angle, Data sets; J.P. Dunlop; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 135/Page# 128; Irradiance & Insolation; E. Weliczko 3. Confirm System Sizing • Arrange modules in mounting area Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 1.1; Pitched Roof Racking: Layout, Flashing & Sealing for the Life of the System; Steve Fain, David Brearley • Determine topography of mounting area • Confirm utility/authority having jurisdiction (AHJ) restrictions Other references • Maximize the incentives Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 15/Pages# 394-395; Economic Analysis - Incentives; J.P. Dunlop 4. Review Design of Energy Storage Systems • Verify appropriate energy storage system location NFPA 70 NEC; Article 480; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Verify ventilation requirements NFPA 70 NEC; Article 480; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Verify circuit design for critical loads • Verify access requirements NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt Verify System Design
  • 126. References key: topic / name / detail / author 126 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 • Verify loads analysis Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 9/Pgs# 233-240; System Sizing - Sizing Calc./ Load analy./Critical Design analysis; J.P. Dunlop; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue #3.3; Stand alone System Design - The art of load analysis; Phil Undercuffler • Inspect existing wiring NFPA 70 NEC; NEC Chapters 1 - 4; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Identify multi-wire branch circuits NFPA 70 NEC; Article 210; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm battery bank is appropriate to Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 9/Pgs# 243 - 245; System Sizing - Battery Bank inverter requirements Sizing; J.P. Dunlop ; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 76/Pgs# 96-100; Measuring Energy Usage for Inverter & Battery Bank Sizing; M. Patton; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.1; Understanding and Optimizing Battery Temperature Compensation; Jim Goodnight; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.3; Optimizing Array Voltage for Battery-Based Systems; Jim Goodnight • Confirm battery bank is appropriate to Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 7/Pgs# 195 - 199; Charge Controllers - other charging sources Battery & array Size / Mult. Battery banks; J.P. Dunlop • Confirm that battery technology is appropriate to usage Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 6 / Pgs# 161 - 165; Batteries - Battery types / Battery Classifications / etc.; Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 9 / Pgs# 243 - 247; System Sizing - Battery Bank Rated Capacity / Battery Selection; J.P. Dunlop 5. Confirm String Size Calculations • Confirm highest and lowest design temperature NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm module Voc at lowest design temperature NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems Mike Holt • Confirm temperature corrected voltage NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems Mike Holt • Confirm voltage limits of system NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.6; Array Voltage Considerations; Bill Brooks • Configure appropriate string diagram Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 9 / Pgs# 249 -252; System Sizing - Array Rate Output/Module Selection, J.P. Dunlop • Determine Vpmax at highest design temperature NFPA 70 NEC; Article 705; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems Mike Holt Additional useful references • Account for module degradation Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 5 / Pgs# 141 - 144; Cells,Modules, and Arrays - Module Std.s / Performance ratings; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 140 / Page# 41; Ask the Experts: Module Degradation; J. Davidson • Determine inverter MPPT NFPA 70 NEC; Article 705; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems Mike Holt Verify System Design
  • 127. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 127 References key: topic / name / detail / author 6. Review System Component Selection • Confirm component compatibility • Confirm the selected module mounting system Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10 / Pgs# 260 - 267; Mechanical Integration - is appropriate for the application Array Mounting Systems; J.P. Dunlop; Home Power Magazine, Issue # 124 / Pgs# 58-64, Rack & Stack - PV Array Mounting Options; R. Mayfield; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 130 / Pgs# 74-80; Pitched Roof Mounting; R. Hren; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 142 / Pgs# 80-85; PV Rack Strategies; G. McPheeters; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.2; Racking Equipment Guide; Ryan Mayfield, David Brearley; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.1; Tile Roofing Systems: Materials & Methods for Flashing Penetrations; Johan Alfsen • Confirm the selected grounding method NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; is appropriate for the application Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 1.1; Equipment Grounding Conductors: Sizing and Methods; Ryan Mayfield; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 2.5; PV System Ground Faults; Paul Mync, John Berdner • Confirm the selected combiner boxes Home Power Magazine; Issue # 78 / Pgs# 52-56; Build your own PV Combiner are appropriate for the application Box; D. Scanlin, Home Power Magazine, Issue # 132 / Pgs# 68-75, Combiner Boxes; L. Wilensky • Confirm the number and type of inverters NFPA 70 NEC; Article 310; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; are appropriate for the application Mike Holt • Confirm the number and type of charge controllers Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 7 / Pgs# 181-186; Charge Controllers - Charge are appropriate for the application Controller Types; J.P. Dunlop • Confirm that all overcurrent protection devices are NFPA 70 NEC; Article 240; Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.6; Surge appropriate for the application Protection Devices for PV Installations; Robert Schlesinger • Confirm DC disconnect (s) are appropriate NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; for the application Mike Holt • Confirm the AC disconnect(s) are appropriate NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; for the application Mike Holt • Confirm maximum allowable number of NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; unprotected parallel strings Mike Holt • Confirm GFP devices are appropriate for the NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; application Mike Holt Additional useful references • Match modules to inverters Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 1.1 ; Grid-Direct PV String Inverter Guide; David Brearley, Joe Schwartz; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 2.1; Array to Inverter Matching: Mastering Manual Design Calculations; John Berdner • Determine number of strings NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Select string combiners NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 2.3; Strategies for Making Common Connections in PV Power Circuits; Tommy Jacoby, David Brearley; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.2; DC Combiners Revisited; Marvin Hamon Verify System Design
  • 128. References key: topic / name / detail / author 128 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 7. Review Wiring and Conduit Size Calculations • Confirm conductor ampacity calculations NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 240, 310, and 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.3; Code-Compliant Conductor Sizing; Jason Sharpe • Confirm conduit fill calculations NFPA 70 NEC; Article 310; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm conductor run distance Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 11 / Pgs# 290 - 295; Electrical Integration - Conductor Ampacity/Voltage Drop; J.P. Dunlop • Confirm appropriate conduit type(s) NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm appropriate conductor insulation type(s) NFPA 70 NEC; Article 310; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm continuous current calculations NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm continuous load calculations NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm conditions of use calculations NFPA 70 NEC; Article 310; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm temperature de-rate calculations NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm conductor de-rate calculations NFPA 70 NEC; Article 310; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.3; Code-Compliant Conductor Sizing; Jason Sharpe • Confirm voltage drop calculations Basic Electrical Theory, Mike Holt; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems ; Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.2; Voltage Drop in PV Systems; Blake Gleason • Confirm power loss calculations Basic Electrical Theory; Mike Holt; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm appropriate grounding conductor type(s) NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm circuit current calculations NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm conduit size calculations NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm grounding conductor sizing calculations NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 250 and 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm thermal expansion calculations NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt Additional useful references • Determine environmental condition of conduit NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt Verify System Design
  • 129. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 129 References key: topic / name / detail / author 8. Review Overcurrent Protection Selection • Confirm voltage specifications NFPA 70 NEC, Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm compatibility with conductor size and type NFPA 70 NEC; Article 240; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm circuit currents calculations NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm characteristics of existing electrical NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 1 - 4; Under standing NEC Requirements for PV Systems; distribution system Mike Holt • Confirm selection of overcurrent protection NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; device enclosures Mike Holt • Confirm equipment limits of overcurrent protection NFPA 70 NEC; Article 240; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 2.3; Load Side Point of Interconnection - Bus or Conductor Rating; John Wiles • Confirm available fault currents NFPA 70 NEC, Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm voltage compatibility NFPA 70 NEC, Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm disconnecting means type NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm disconnecting means amperage rating NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm temperature rating of device NFPA 70 NEC, Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm terminal temperature limits of device NFPA 70 NEC, Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm enclosure rating of device • Confirm wire size limitations of device NFPA 70 NEC; Article 310; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt Additional useful references • Determine disconnecting means location NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt 9. Review Fastener Selection • Confirm fastener sizes Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10 / Pgs# 274 - 277; Mechanical Integration - Attachement Methods - Lags/Bolts/J Bolt; J.P. Dunlop; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 100 / Pgs# 100-103; The Nuts and Bolts of Fasteners; M. Brown • Confirm environmental conditions assessment Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.4; Lag Screws in Residential PV Installations Mark Shelly • Confirm compatibility of fasteners to system • Confirm fastener types Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10 / Pgs# 274 - 277; Mechanical Integration - Lag Screw/Bolts/J-Bolts/Self Balasting; J.P. Dunlop; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.4; Lag Screws in Residential PV Installations; Mark Shelly Verify System Design
  • 130. References key: topic / name / detail / author 130 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 • Confirm pilot hole specifications Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.4 Page# 74; Lag Screws in Residential PV Installations; Mark Shelly; Home Power; Issue # 144 Page# 94-99; Prepping for PV; Johan Alfsen • Confirm fastener assembly Home Power Magazine; Issue # 144 Page# 94-99; Prepping for PV; Johan Alfsen • Confirm structural characteristics of substrate • Confirm fastener pull-out strengths • Confirm fastener removal • Confirm mounting method Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.4; Lag Screws in Residential PV Installations; Mark Shelly; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.1; Tile Roofing Systems; Johan Alfsen; Home Power Magazine; Issue # 144 Page# 94-99; Prepping for PV; Johan Alfsen • Confirm torque values • Confirm usage of appropriate auxiliary materials • Confirm weatherproofing materials Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 1.1; Pitched Roof Racking; S. Fain, D. Brearley; for building penetrations Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.3; Low-Slope Roofs As PV System Platforms; James R. Kirby; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.1 Page# 62-68; Tile Roofing Systems; Johan Alfsen • Confirm pull-out loads Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10 / Page# 274; Mechanical Integration - Allowable Withdrawl Loads; J.P. Dunlop • Confirm wind loading Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 10 / Page# 280 - 281; Mechanical Integration - Structural Analysis; J.P. Dunlop • Confirm shear loads • Confirm shear strengths • Confirm types of loads • Confirm accuracy of bill of materials 10. Review Plan Sets • Confirm AHJ requirements Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 12 / Pgs# 344 - 346; Utility Interconnection - Interconnect agreements, J.P. Dunlop • Confirm accuracy of electrical one- or three-line diagram • Confirm accuracy of site plan Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 2.5; Project Plan Sets; Ryan Mayfield • Confirm accuracy of system design • Generate a safety plan Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.6; Implementing a successful safety program; Karl Riedlinger • Assemble manufacturer’s data sheets • Create labeling schedule Photovoltaic Systems; Chapter # 13 / Pgs# 363 - 366; Permitting and Inspection - Lables and Marking; J.P. Dunlop; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.2; PV System Labeling: NEC, OSHA and ANSI Codes and Standards; Gernon Harvey • Assemble manufacturer’s instructions • Note and address structural concerns • Complete commissioning forms Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 2.6; PV System Commissioning; Blake Gleason • Generate string diagram Additional useful references • Clarify design and OEM manuals Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 3.3; Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth; Solar Pro Magazine; Issue # 4.1; PV Systems and Firefighter Safety: A Proactive Approach; Dan Fink Verify System Design
  • 131. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 131 References key: topic / name / detail / author 1. Conduct Pre-Construction Meetings • Plan weather contingencies Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual; Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE • Verify site conditions match design Project Management for Construction: Fundamental Concepts for Owners, Engineers, Architects and Builders; Chris Hendrickson & Tung Au; 3.8 Construction Site Environment • Assemble workforce, including other trades as appropriate Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual; Section 4.2; Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE • Determine daily construction goals Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual; Section 4.9; Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE; • Communicate construction strategy to customer Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual; Section 6.3; Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE; • Provide customer orientation Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual; Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE • Communicate target pull-off time for crew Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual; Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE • Document safety plan OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart C; SolarPro 4.6 Implementing a Successful Safety Plan; Karl Riedlinger; “Elements of a Successful Safety Program” Section • Resolve scheduling conflicts Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual; Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE; Section 4.9 • Ensure pre-construction commitments by customer are complete • Determine community issues Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual; Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE • Determine customer requirements Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual; Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE 2. Secure Permits and Approvals • Coordinate inspections Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 3.3 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth • Schedule inspections Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 3.3 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth • Confirm job permits Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 3.3; Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth • Resolve AHJ conflicts Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 3.3; Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth • Submit plans to utilities Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13 p. 357-359; SolarPro 2.5 Project Plan Sets; Ryan Mayfield; “Purpose and Benefits” Section • Resolve utility conflicts Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 12 p. 342-346; SolarPro 3.3 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth • Obtain sign-off final building permit Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 3.3 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth • Determine additional agency permits Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 3.3; (e.g., zoning, solar access, HOA, historic district) Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth; “Common Permitting Problems” Section Managing the Project
  • 132. References key: topic / name / detail / author 132 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Additional useful references Taking the Red Tape out of Green Power: How to Overcome Permitting; Obstacles to Small-Scale Distributed Renewable Energy; Network for New Energy Choices, September 2008. • Secure written record of approval to interconnect Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 12 p. 344-346 • Submit plans to building department Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 2.5 Project Plan Sets; Ryan Mayfield; SolarPro 3.3 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth; “Effective Solutions” Section • Submit plans to fire department Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; J.P. Dunlop; ch. 13; SolarPro 3.3 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth; “Effective Solutions” section; SolarPro 3.3 Avoiding and Resolving PV Permitting Problems; Tobin Booth; “Effective Solutions” Section 3. Manage Project Labor • Coordinate with subcontractors SolarPro 3.6; Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Darlene McCalmont; “Improving the Bottom Line” Section • Determine order of tasks Guidelines for a Successful Construction Project; The Associated General Contractors of America, 2008; C.3 Sequenced Project Schedules • Allocate resources SolarPro 3.6; Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Darlene McCalmont • Supervise project crews • Communicate aspects of safety plan SolarPro 4.6 Implementing a Successful Safety Plan; Karl Riedlinger; “Elements of a Successful Safety Program” Section • Coordinate with other trades Guidelines for a Successful Construction Project; The Associated General Contractors of America, 2008; A.1 Guideline on General Contractor-Subcontractor Relations • Orient contractors to job site conditions • Track man hours • Conduct toolbox talks • Resolve disputes Additional useful references • Confirm insurance compliance SolarPro 3.4 Large-Scale PV Operations and Maintenance; Dave Williams; Section on “Insurance” 4. Adapt System Design • Identify potential conflicts in design • Document changes to proposed design • Maintain as-built documentation SolarPro 3.6; Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Darlene McCalmont “Improving the Bottom Line” Section; SolarPro 2.6; PV System Commissioning; Blake Gleason; “Commissioning Tasks” Section • Submit modification proposals Electrical Pre-Construction Planning Process Implementation Manual; Awad S. Hanna, Ph.D., PE; Section 4.4 • Acquire approvals to change design • Submit any change orders Managing the Project
  • 133. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 133 References key: topic / name / detail / author 5. Manage Project Equipment • Take delivery of components Project Management for Construction: Fundamental Concepts for Owners, Engineers, Architects and Builders; Chris Hendrickson & Tung Au • Schedule deliveries Project Management for Construction: Fundamental Concepts for Owners, Engineers, Architects and Builders; Chris Hendrickson & Tung Au • Identify lifting and handling areas Guidelines for a Successful Construction Project; The Associated General Contractors of America, 2008; C.4 Guideline on Site Logistics • Perform equipment inspection • Perform equipment maintenance • State site equipment • Schedule machinery Project Management for Construction: Fundamental Concepts for Owners, Engineers, Architects and Builders; Chris Hendrickson & Tung Au • Ensure equipment operator certification • Install pedestrian barriers Additional useful references • Prepare site storage facilities Guidelines for a Successful Construction Project; The Associated General Contractors of America, 2008; C.4 Guideline on Site Logistics • Obtain temporary facilities Guidelines for a Successful Construction Project; The Associated General Contractors of America, 2008; C.4 Guideline on Site Logistics • Maintain temporary facilities Guidelines for a Successful Construction Project; The Associated General Contractors of America, 2008; C.4 Guideline on Site Logistics 6. Implement a Site Specific Safety Plan • Perform hazard analysis SolarPro 4.6 Implementing a Successful Safety Plan; Karl Riedlinger “Elements of a Successful Safety Progam” Section; Solar Construction Safety Oregon Solar Energy Energy Industries Association, 2006; “General Jobsite Safety” Section • Identify job site hazards SolarPro 4.6 Implementing a Successful Safety Plan; Karl Riedlinger; “Elements of a Successful Safety Progam” Section; Solar Construction Safety; Oregon Solar Energy Energy Industries Association, 2006. “General Jobsite Safety” Section • Implement ladder safety OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart X; laddersafety.org; American Ladder Institute Solar Construction Safety; Oregon Solar Energy Energy Industries Association, 2006. “Ladder Safety” Section • Implement fall protection plan OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart M (1926.500 to 1926.503). Dunlop, Jim: Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010, J.P. Dunlop, Ch. 3 p. 62-63; Solar Construction Safety; Oregon Solar Energy Energy Industries Association, 2006; “Fall Protection and Jobsite Trip Hazards” Section • Execute electrical safety OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart K; “NFPA 70E Electrical Safety in the Workplace”; NFPA; Solar Construction Safety; Oregon Solar Energy Energy Industries Association, 2006; “Solar Electrical Safety” Section • Select personal protective equipment (PPE) OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart E • Develop site specific safety plan OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart C; The Importance of Site Specific Safety and Health Management Plans; Garcia, Gabe. 2010; SolarPro 4.6 Implementing a Successful Safety Plan; Karl Riedlinger Managing the Project
  • 134. References key: topic / name / detail / author 134 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 • Implement vehicle safety OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart O • Install site safety barriers OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart M • Identify access points to site • Identify site evacuation points OSHA CFR 29 1926; Subpart P; Emergency Exit Routes Fact Sheet; OSHA, 2003 • Post hospital map routes • Post emergency contact numbers • Ensure material safety data sheets (MSDS) are on-site OSHA CFR 29 1926; 1910.1200(g) • Post contingency plan Managing the Project
  • 135. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 135 References key: topic / name / detail / author 1. Mitigate Electrical Hazards • Implement the site safety plan • Implement the lock-out, tag-out procedures • Determine voltage levels of interconnections NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Maintain clear work area NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Clarify the maximum working voltage NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Select required PPE based on system design (arc flash, shock, burn, voltage, etc.) • Disconnect all unnecessary live circuits NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Determine working clearances NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Demonstrate situational awareness • Measure voltage on equipment before proceeding with work • Inspect safety equipment • Inspect test equipment • Maintain safety equipment • Inspect hand and power tools • Measure current on equipment before proceeding with work • Maintain hand and power tools 2. Install Grounding Systems • Install module grounding NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install inverter grounding NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install mounting system grounding NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Ground all noncurrent-carrying metal parts NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Bond metallic raceways NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install grounding electrode conductor NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Bond all electrical equipment NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250 and 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems ; Mike Holt • Apply antioxidant material NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Prepare surfaces for electrical connections NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Make grounding electrode connection NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt Installing Electrical Components
  • 136. References key: topic / name / detail / author 136 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 • Install grounding electrode(s) NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install supplementary ground electrode NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install system grounds NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Determine grounding conductor size NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250 and 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems ; Mike Holt • Install DC ground-fault protection NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Locate underground hazards NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt 3. Install Conduit and Raceways • Plan conduit routing NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Penetrate building envelope NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Support and secure conduit NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Tighten all fittings NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Select fittings according to application NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install above ground electrical raceways NFPA 70 NEC; Article 225; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install conduit bushings NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Make knockouts in electrical raceways NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install underground electrical raceways NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Remove sharp edges (deburr) NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install service entry mast NFPA 70 NEC; Article 230; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Locate underground utilities NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Create underground trenches NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Backfill underground trenches NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Mark underground cables NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Mark underground trenches NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt Installing Electrical Components
  • 137. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 137 References key: topic / name / detail / author 4. Install Electrical Components • Select location of DC disconnect NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Mount electrical enclosures NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install DC combiner NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Label equipment NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690 and 705; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems ; Mike Holt • Install PV system disconnects NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install inverter disconnects NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install utility required disconnects NFPA 70 NEC; Article 404; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install array wiring transition box NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install inverter NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install underground electrical components NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install AC combiner NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install meter bases NFPA 70 NEC; Article 312; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Select label materials NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install junction boxes in the attic NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt 5. Install Circuit Conductors • Pull conductors NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Label conductors NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690 and 705; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Terminate conductors NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Wire the inverter NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 110, 300, 310; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Wire modules NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 110, 300, 310; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Select the correct wire type, color, and gauge NFPA 70 NEC; Table 310.104, 200.6, Table 310.15(B); Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Secure conductors NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt Installing Electrical Components
  • 138. References key: topic / name / detail / author 138 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 • Measure wires • Set up the wire installation (tugger, fish tape, rope) • Test conductor installation NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Test DC source circuits • Test DC currents • Set up pull stations NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Clear the electrical raceway • Splice electrical conductors NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt 6. Install Utility Interconnection • Install over current protection device (OCPD) NFPA 70 NEC; Article 240; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install disconnects NFPA 70 NEC; Article 404; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Test utility voltage • Coordinate AHJ inspection • Verify fill rates • Terminate conductors NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Implement lock-out, tag-out procedures • Evaluate existing service entrance equipment NFPA 70 NEC; Article 230; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install generation metering NFPA 70 NEC; Article 312; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Test conductor insulation NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Select connection location • Coordinate utility shutdowns • Coordinate with customers and other regarding shutdowns • Move existing circuits NFPA 70 NEC; NFPA 70E; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt 7. Install System Instrumentation • Test system • Install power and energy metering NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 312; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install data communication cables NFPA 70 NEC; Article 800; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install communication systems NFPA 70 NEC; Article 800; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install environmental sensors • Install controllers Installing Electrical Components
  • 139. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 139 References key: topic / name / detail / author • Install electrical sensors • Install inverter interface • Install power supply • Install battery temperature sensors • Install outlet for monitoring system NFPA 70 NEC; Chapters 1 - 4; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt 8. Install Battery Components • Test each unit before placement (voltage, specific gravity, polarity) • Terminate fine stranded cables NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 110 and 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install maintenance disconnect NFPA 70 NEC; Article 480; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Confirm battery bank location NFPA 70 NEC; Article 480; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install battery enclosure NFPA 70 NEC; Article 480; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install battery enclosure venting • Install battery spill containment • Install batteries • Prepare battery terminals (e.g., clean) • Install battery interconnection conductors • Install battery units • Apply antioxidant compounds • Calculate ampacity NFPA 70 NEC; Article 480; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Install charge controller • Seal conduit entry to battery box • Label battery units • Label battery enclosure • Label battery room • Establish maintenance schedule • Test final assembled battery polarity and voltage • Install safety station Installing Electrical Components
  • 140. References key: topic / name / detail / author 140 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Installing Mechanical Components 1. Install Equipment Foundation • Locate center points of holes Concrete Principles; Chapter 5 page 136; Thomas P. Fahl • Place anchor hardware • Install grounding equipment conductor (GEC) NFPA 70 NEC; Article 250; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Excavate to design specifications Concrete Principles; Chapter 10 page 293; Thomas P. Fahl • Build concrete forms Concrete Principles; Chapter 4 page 98; Thomas P. Fahl • Coordinate foundation inspections See Local Jurisdiction (City or County) Development Services • Identify location of underground utilities www.callbeforeyoudig.com, www.bluestake.com • Add structural reinforcement Concrete Principles; Chapter 4 page 93; Thomas P. Fahl • Install wire raceways NECA 101-2006 Standard for Installing Steel Conduit (Rigid, IMC, EMT) (ANSI) Published 2006 • Place concrete to design specifications Concrete Principles; Chapter 7 page 182; Thomas P. Fahl • Place anchor hardware Geotechnical Engineering Foundation Design; page 210; John N. Cernica • Install driven posts Concrete Principles; Chapter 5 page 119; ; Thomas P. Fahl; Installation specification for Driven Piles PDCA Specification; 103-07; Pile Driving Contractors Association • Strip concrete forms Concrete Principles; Chapter 7 page 197; Thomas P. Fahl • Backfill excavation Geotechnical Engineering Foundation Design; page 150; John N. Cernica • Place mounting posts Concrete Principles; Chapter 5 page 136; Thomas P. Fahl; Ground Trac Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products 2. Install Mounting System • Install roof attachments Installing Solar Power; Gary Gerber; Journal of Light construction, Article • Weatherproof penetrations Sealing and flashing metal roofs; Rob Haddock; Journal of Light construction, Article • Locate structural roof members SolarWedge XD Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products; Page 3 • Determine array attachment locations SolarWedge XD Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products; Page 3 • Install structural attachments SolarWedge XD Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products; Page 4 • Install module support frame RoofTrac Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products • Install rack components RoofTrac Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products • Locate array footprint RoofTrac Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products • Confirm compatibility with existing roofing system Roofing Instant Answers; ISBN: 0071387129; Terry Kennedy • Plumb array structure Ground Trac Installation Manual; Proffesional Solar Products • Level array structure Point to Point Lasers; David Frane; Journal of Light construction, Article Ground Trac Installation Manual; Professional Solar Products • Apply corrosion protection to cut surfaces NECA 101-2006 Standard for Installing Steel Conduit (Rigid, IMC, EMT) (ANSI); Published 2006 • Install tracking apparatus wattsun.com, Installation Guide AZ-225; Array Technologies; Pg. 6 zomeworks.com, Zomeworks F-series Track Rack installation manual; zomeworks • Install actuator motors wattsun.com, Installation Guide AZ-225; Array Technologies, Pg. 9 • Install supplementary structural supports ewpa.com • Confirm row spacing Renewable and Efficient Electric Power Systems; pg. 391 - 408; Gilbert M. Masters
  • 141. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 141 References key: topic / name / detail / author • Confirm structural analysis has been performed Should I Call and Engineer; Harris Hyman; Journal of Light construction, Article • Install structural members Framing Flaws; Donald Cohen; Journal of Light construction, Article • Locate ballast for mounting system See Racking Manufacturer. • Install seismic and wind loading Special Design Provisions for Wind and Seismic (SDPWS), 2005 Edition, with Commentary American Wood Council 3. Install PV Modules • Unpack PV modules • Stage PV modules • Secure module wiring NFPA 70 NEC; Article 300; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Inspect module for physical damage • Fasten modules to structure • Torque module fasteners • Confirm module frame grounding • Align modules aesthetically • Determine project workflow • Test PV modules • Prep PV modules Installing Mechanical Components
  • 142. References key: topic / name / detail / author 142 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Complete System Installation 1. Test the System • Verify mechanical connection integrity Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems; Section 1-e, Section 2-a, and Section 2-d; Inspector Guidelines for PV Systems, Version 2.1, March 2006 Brooks Engineering; Section: Inspection Guidelines for all PV systems; A Guide to Photovoltaic (PV) Design and Installation, June 2001; California Energy Commission (CEC); Section 4: Solar Electric (PV) System Installation Checklist • Verify system grounding NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690.41; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Verify electrical connection torque NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt; Article 110.3(B; SUNNY BOY 8000TL-US/9000TL-US/10000TL-US - Installation Guide version 1.1; SMA; Section 6.5.2,Section 6.5.3, Section 6.6.2 • Verify polarity Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14; Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting; J.P. Dunlop A Guide to Photovoltaic (PV) Design and Installation, June 2001: California Energy Commission (CEC) Section 4: Solar Electric (PV) System Installation Checklist; “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Section: 5.4.3 • Measure DC voltages (string, output) “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Section 5.4.4; A Guide to Photovoltaic (PV) Design and Installation, June 2001; California Energy Commission (CEC); Section 4: Solar Electric (PV) System Installation Checklist • Verify inverter operation Inverter Manufacturer’s Instructional Manual; “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system; documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”, IEC, Section 5.4.6, A Guide to Photovoltaic (PV) Design and Installation, June 2001; California Energy Commission (CEC); Section 4: Solar Electric (PV) System Installation Checklist • Measure DC currents “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Section 5.4.5 • Compare measured values with expected values SP2.6-34 PV System Commissioning; Section: Performance Verificaiton; Blake Gleason; “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Section 5 • Measure AC system values “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05” IEC; Section 5.4.1 • Perform physical inspection Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems; Inspector Guidelines for PV Systems, Version 2.1, March 2006; Brooks Engineering; Section: Inspection Guidelines for all PV systems; A Guide to Photovoltaic (PV) Design and Installation, June 2001 California Energy Commission (CEC); Section 4: Solar Electric (PV) System Installation Checklist • Verify conduit fitting tightness NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110.3(B), Article 110.12 • Verify conduit and wiring supports Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems; Section 1-b, Section 1-e; NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3 • Verify workmanship NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110.12
  • 143. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 143 References key: topic / name / detail / author • Measure environmental levels SP2.6-34 PV System Commissioning; Section: Expected Performance; Blake Gleason • Measure irradiance levels SP2.6-34 PV System Commissioning; Section: Expected Performance; Blake Gleason • Calculate expected electrical parameters NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690; SP3.6-68 Array Voltage Considerations; Bill Brooks Expedited Permit Process (www.solarabcs.org OR www.brooksolar.com); Brooks Engineering; Section 5,Section 6, Section 7 • Verify anti-islanding system “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Annex C, Model PV array test report • Test for ground fault SP2.5-60 PV System Ground Faults; Mync & Berdner • Measure insulation resistance SP2.5-66 PV System Ground Faults, Mync & Berdner, Insulation Resistance Testing - Application Note Fluke http://support.fluke.com/find-sales/Download/ Asset/1579160_6115_ENG_C_W.PDF; “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Section 5.4.7 • Measure environmental levels • Confirm phase rotation Satcon Installation Manual - PowerGate Plus 100; Satcon 2. Commission the System • Turn on system Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting; J.P. Dunlop; A Guide to Photovoltaic (PV) Design and Installation, June 2001, California Energy Commission (CEC) ; Section 4: Solar Electric (PV) System Installation Checklist; SUNNY BOY 8000TL- US / 9000TL-US / 10000TL-US - Installation Guide version 1.1; SMA Section 7 • Initiate startup procedures per manufacturer instructions Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14; Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting; J.P. Dunlop; Satcon Installation Manual - PowerGate Plus 100; Satcon; SUNNY BOY 8000TL-US / 9000TL-US / 10000TL- US - Installation Guide version 1.1; SMA; Section 7 • Program variable set points Inverter Manufacturer’s Instructional Manual; Outback Power GTFX and GVFX Inverter/Charger Programming Manual • Measure all electrical parameters Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010, Chapter 14, Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Measured Parameters; J.P. Dunlop; SP2.6-34 PV System Commissioning, Blake Gleason; Section: Expected Performance; “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system; documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Section: 5.4 • Compare measured values to expected values SP2.6-34 PV System Commissioning; Section: Performance Verificaiton “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; Blake Gleason; IEC; Section: 5.4.5.3 • Monitor startup process SUNNY BOY 8000TL-US / 9000TL-US / 10000TL-US - Installation Guide version 1.1, SMA, Section 7 • Record anomalous conditions SP2.6-34 PV System Commissioning; Section: Commissioning Tasks; Blake Gleason • Document design changes Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems; Section 1-a; SP2.6-34 PV System Commissioning; Section: Commissioning Tasks; Blake Gleason • Verify as-built documentation Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems; Section 1-a; SP2.6-34 PV System Commissioning; Section: Commissioning Tasks; Blake Gleason Complete System Installation
  • 144. References key: topic / name / detail / author 144 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 • Verify labeling accuracy NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 690 and 705; Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems Section 3; Brooks Engineering • Note data and time of system startup Maintenance and Operation of Stand-Alone Photovoltaic Systems, December 1991 Section: 3.0 Inspection; SolarPro_2009_PV_Commissioning_Form; SolarPro • Repair anomalous conditions • Record environmental conditions Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Measured Parameters; J.P. Dunlop; SP2.6-34; PV System Commissioning; Section: Expected Performance; Blake Gleason • Record prior values on inverter • Measure voltage of energy storage system Maintenance and Operation of Stand-Alone Photovoltaic Systems, December 1991; Section: 3.0 Inspection • Verify calculation of Total Solar Resource Fraction http://energytrust.org/trade-ally/programs/solar/resources/; Energy Trust of Oregon Solar Resource Tools; Solar Site Assessment: http://www.oregon.gov/ ENERGY/RENEW/Solar/docs/SunChart.pdf?ga=t; State of Oregon • Verify polarity of energy storage system Maintenance and Operation of Stand-Alone Photovoltaic Systems, December 1991 Section: 3.0 Inspection; Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010 Chapter 14, Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting; J.P. Dunlop • Verify anti-islanding performance “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Annex C, Model PV array test report • Record voltage of energy storage system Maintenance and Operation of Stand-Alone Photovoltaic Systems, December 1991 Section: 3.0 Inspection 3. Complete System Documentation • File project photographs SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Section: Process Management; Darlene McCalmont • Record component serial numbers SolarPro_2009_PV_Commissioning_Form; SolarPro; SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Section: Process Management; Darlene McCalmont • Deliver as-built documents “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection; Edition 1.0, 2009-05” IEC; Section 4, SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Darlene McCalmont; Section: Process Management • File permits Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 13, Permitting and Inspection; J.P. Dunlop; SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Section: Process Management; Darlene McCalmont • Record certificates of inspection • File inspection forms SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Section: Process Management; Darlene McCalmont • File commissioning forms SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Section: Process Management; Darlene McCalmont • File data sheets “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Section 4.4 • File proof of system test results “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system; documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Section 4.7 Complete System Installation
  • 145. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 145 References key: topic / name / detail / author • Complete equipment warranty registration Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop • Complete installation warranty registration Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010, Chapter 14, Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop Additional useful references • Complete O&M documentation Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Maintenance; J.P. Dunlop; “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Section 4.6; SP3.4-48 Large-Scale PV Operations & Maintenance • Compile customer operations manual “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Section 4.6; SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Section: Process Management; Darlene McCalmont 4. Orient Customer to System • Explain startup and shutdown procedures Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop • Answer customer questions • Explain safety procedures to customer Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop • Explain maintenance procedures Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop • Address customer concerns • Train customer on maintenance and Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning, operation procedures Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop • Explain equipment clearance requirements NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110; Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 13, Permitting and Inspeciton - Inspection; J.P. Dunlop • Perform customer walk-through Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop • Provide contact information to customer • Explain normal operational performance Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop Additional useful references • Deliver O&M documentation to customer Photovoltaic Systems, Second Edition, 2010; Chapter 14, Commissioning, Maintenance, and Troubleshooting - Commissioning; J.P. Dunlop; “Grid connected photovoltaic systems – Minimum requirements for system documentation, commissioning tests and inspection, Edition 1.0, 2009-05”; IEC; Section 4.6; SP3.6-82 Operations Management for Solar Integrators; Section: Process Management; Darlene McCalmont Complete System Installation
  • 146. References key: topic / name / detail / author 146 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 1. Perform Visual Inspection • Verify equipment grounding NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690.43; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed., Chapter 11 pgs. 311-313; J.P. Dunlop; IAEI NEWS; “Connecting to Mother Earth, May/June 2010”; John Wiles • Inspect module mounting system Mounting System Safety and Installation Instructions; Unique to each manufacturer; Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems v1.1 June 2010; Section 1e, 2a,2d IREC/ B. Brooks • Identify hazards NFPA 70E NEC; Chapter 1; OSHA • Inspect weatherproofing systems Weatherproofing/Flashing System Safety and Installation Instructions; Unique to each manufacturer; Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems v1.1 June 2010; Section 1e, 2d; IREC/ B. Brooks; The NRCA Waterproofing Manual; http://www.nrca.net • Inspect for wiring damage NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250; Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems v1.1 June 2010; Section 1b; IREC/ B. Brooks • Inspect module integrity NFPA 70E NEC; Chapter 1; PV Module listed Safety and Installation Instructions Unique to each manufacturer; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 374-6; J.P. Dunlop • Check inverter status Inverter Installation and Operation Manual; Unique to each manufacturer Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 385; J.P. Dunlop • Inspect electrical equipment NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 1-4, Article 690; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 13; J.P. Dunlop; NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250 • Identify damage due to corrosion Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed., Chapter 14 pg. 374; J.P. Dunlop • Identify array shading Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 3 pg. 69-77; J.P. Dunlop Home Power Magazine; Issue# 121 / Pgs# 88-90: Solmetric Suneye Solar Site Evaluation tool; J. Schwartz • Identify array soiling PV Module listed Safety and Installation Instructions; Unique to each manufacturer; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 373; J.P. Dunlop • Inspect cells for discoloration Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 374-6; J.P. Dunlop PV Module datasheet; Unique to each manufacturer • Verify grounding system integrity NFPA 70 NEC; Article 690.41; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Chapter 6; Mike Holt; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 13 pg. 362-363; J.P. Dunlop • Look for unsupported wiring NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 110, 300, 310, 338, 690; Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems v1.1 June 2010; Section 1b; IREC/ B. Brooks; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems; Mike Holt • Identify damage to module glazing Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed., Chapter 14 pg. 374-6, J.P. Dunlop • Document findings Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 390; J.P. Dunlop • Identify mismatched equipment System Labels, Manuals, As-built documents; Equipment and Job specific Field Inspection Guidelines for PV Systems v1.1 June 2010; Section 4; IREC/ B. Brooks; Solar Pro Magazine; “Array to Inverter Matching: Mastering Manual Design Calculations, Dec/Jan 2009 (Issue 2.1)”; J. Berdner • Inspect for working clearances NFPA 70 NEC; Article 110.26; Understanding NEC Requirements for PV Systems Chapter 1; Inverter Installation and Operation Manual; Unique to each manufacturer; Mike Holt Maintenance & Troubleshooting
  • 147. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 147 References key: topic / name / detail / author • Identify electrical connections damage due to overheating “Tests and measurements for electrical fire prevention”; Fluke “Application Note http://www.fluke.com/fluke/usen/community/fluke-news-plus/ articlecategories/safety/electrical+fire+prevention.htm” • Confirm equipment serial numbers As-built Documents; Job specific • Inspect module back skin PV Module listed Safety and Installation Instructions; Unique to each manufacturer • Check conduit fitting tightness NFPA 70 NEC; Chapter 3 • Inspect for evidence of animals Solar Pro Magazine, J. Berdner, P. Mync, PV System Ground Faults, Aug/Sep 2009 (Issue 2.5) • Identify vegetation growth • Identify water ponding • Identify ice damage 2. Verify System Operation • Measure system electrical parameters NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250; Solar Pro Magazine; “PV System Commissioning” Oct/Nov 2009; B. Gleason • Document found electrical parameters Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 390; J.P. Dunlop • Calculate expected electrical parameters Solar Pro Magazine; “PV System Commissioning” Oct/Nov 2009; B. Gleason • Compare expected parameters with as-found parameters Solar Pro Magazine; “PV System Commissioning” Oct/Nov 2009; B. Gleason • Note anomalous conditions • Test system electrical equipment operations Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 372; J.P. Dunlop • Recommend corrective actions • Verify source circuits are connected Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 372; J.P. Dunlop • Interview customer Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 372; J.P. Dunlop • Document customer’s concerns • Compare historical kWh performance Solar Pro Magazine; “PV System Commissioning” Oct/Nov 2009; B. Gleason against expected kWh performance • Measure equipment temperatures Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 372; J.P. Dunlop • Note inter-annual weather variability • Measure terminal temperatures NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250; Standard for Infrared Inspection of Electrical Systems & Rotating Equipment; Infraspection Institute, 425 Ellis Street, Burlington, NJ 08016 http://www.infraspection.com/useful_guidelines.html Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 372; J.P. Dunlop • Verify operation of battery venting systems Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 372; J.P. Dunlop • Verify battery auxiliary systems Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14; J.P. Dunlop 3. Perform Corrective Actions • Replace defective modules • Check equipment variable set points Original System Labels, O&M Manual, As-built documents; Job Specific Equipment Installation and Operation Manuals; Unique to each manufacturer • Perform scheduled maintenance Owners and Operations Manual; Job Specific • Replace frayed wires NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250; American Electricians’ Handbook, Division 2, 8, 9 • Replace blown fuses NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-130, 225; Equipment Installation and Operation Manual; Unique to each manufacturer Maintenance & Troubleshooting
  • 148. References key: topic / name / detail / author 148 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 • Replace faulty components NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250; Equipment Installation and Operation Manual Unique to each manufacturer • Locate ground faults NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250; Solar Pro Magazine; PV System Ground Faults, Aug/Sep 2009 (Issue 2.5); J. Berdner, P. Mync • Repair ground faults NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250; Solar Pro Magazine; The Bakersfield Fire: A Lesson in Ground-Fault Protection, Feb/Mar 2011 (Issue 4.2); B. Brooks • Locate line to line faults NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250 • Repair line to line faults NFPA 70E NEC; Article 100-250 • Document corrective actions Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 390; J.P. Dunlop • Clean arrays PV Module listed Safety and Installation Instructions; Unique to each manufacturer • Service ventilation systems NFPA 70E NEC; Article 240, 300-320; Home Power Magazine; John Meyer, Joe Schwartz; Battery Box Basics, John Meyer, Joe Schwartz, Jun/Jul 2007 (#119) pp. 50-55; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14; J.P. Dunlop • Clean batteries NFPA 70E NEC; Article 240, 300-320; Home Power Magazine; Flooded Lead-Acid Battery Maintenance, Dec/Jan 2004 (#98) pp. 76-79; Richard Perez • Recalibrate equipment variable set points Equipment Installation and Operation Manuals; Unique to each manufacturer Original System Labels, O&M Manual, As-built documents; Job Specific • Wipe down power conditioning equipment • Clean heat sinks Inverter Installation and Operation Manual; Unique to each manufacturer • Schedule manufacturer onsite service call • Seal compromised weatherproofing systems The NRCA Waterproofing Manual; NRCA; http://www.nrca.net; Roof manufacturer’s maintenance and warranty requirements; Manufacturer specific • Perform battery maintenance NFPA 70E NEC; Article 240, 300-320; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 376-380; J.P. Dunlop • Perform controlled overcharge Home Power Magazine; Flooded Lead-Acid Battery Maintenance, Dec/Jan 2004 (#98) pp. 76-79; Richard Perez • Clean system labeling • Replace system labeling NFPA 70 NEC; Articles 690 and 705; Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 13 pg. 363-366; J.P. Dunlop; Original System Labels, Manuals, As-built documents Equipment and Job specific 4. Verify Effectiveness of Corrective Actions • Retest system operations Solar Pro Magazine; “PV System Commissioning” Oct/Nov 2009; B. Gleason • Retest electrical parameters Solar Pro Magazine; “PV System Commissioning” Oct/Nov 2009; B. Gleason • Retest environmental conditions Solar Pro Magazine; “PV System Commissioning” Oct/Nov 2009; B. Gleason • Compare pre-maintenance values to post-maintenance values • Retest weatherproofing system The NRCA Waterproofing Manual; NRCA http://www.nrca.net; Roofing/ flashing system installation and maintenance manuals; Manufacturer specific • Reorient customer to system Photovoltaic Systems 2nd ed.; Chapter 14 pg. 372; J.P. Dunlop Maintenance & Troubleshooting
  • 149. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 149 References key: topic / name / detail / author NABCEP PV Installer Resource GuideP a g e | 171 9 CASE STUDY EXAMPLES 9.1 Example 1: Grid-Direct String Inverter PV System Connected to Load Side of Service Panel. Module Ratings: Inverter Ratings: Location: Newark, New Jersey Design questions: 1. What does the NEC consider the maximum voltage of this PV module at this location? Temperature Coefficient for VOC = αVOC = -0.37%/C = -0.0037/C Temperature Correction Factor = 1 + α VOC(%) x (TempLOW– TempRATING) = 1 + (-0.0037/C) x (-15C – 25C) = 1 + 0.148 = 1.148 Answer: Voc x Temp. Corr. Factor = 37.3V x 1.148 = 42.8V 2. What is the maximum number of modules that may be installed in series where all dc equipment is rated for 600Vdc? MAX POWER-POINT CURRENT (IMP) MAX POWER-POINT VOLTAGE (VMP) OPEN-CIRCUIT VOLTAGE (VOC) SHORT-CIRCUIT CURRENT (ISC) MAX SERIES FUSE (OCPD) MAXIMUM POWER (PMAX) MAX VOLTAGE (TYP 600VDC) VOC TEMP COEFF (mV/o C or %/o C ) IF COEFF SUPPLIED, CIRCLE UNITS 7.79 A 29.5 V 37.3 V 8.41 A 15 A 230 W 600 V -0.37 MODULE MAKE MODULE MODEL AMERICAN SOLAR AS 230 1.) LOWEST EXPECT AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE MINIMUM MEAN EXTREME DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO INSTALLATION LOCATION. LOWEST EXPECTED AMBIENT TEMP ___-15_o C 2.) HIGHEST CONTINUOUS AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE HIGHEST MONTH 2% DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO INSTALLATION LOCATION. HIGHEST CONTINUOUS TEMPERATURE __34_o C Case Study Examples Example 1: Grid-Direct String Inverter PV System Connected to Load Side of Service Panel.
  • 150. References key: topic / name / detail / author 150 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 = 1 + (-0.0037/C) x (-15C – 25C) = 1 + 0.148 = 1.148 Answer: Voc x Temp. Corr. Factor = 37.3V x 1.148 = 42.8V 2. What is the maximum number of modules that may be installed in series where all dc equipment is rated for 600Vdc? NABCEP PV Installer Resource GuideP a g e | 172 Answer: Max. Number of Modules = 600V ÷ 42.8 = 14.0214 modules 3. What is the Maximum System Voltage as defined by NEC 690.7? Answer: Vmax(module) x # of modules in Series = 42.8V x 14 = 599.2 Volts 4. If the module degradation is -0.5%/year, minimum voltage of the inverter is 300 Vdc, and the module Vmp temperature coefficient is -0.5%/°C, what is the minimum number of modules in series that will keep the Vmp above 300Vdc in 20 years at a module temperature of 65°C? Step 1: What is the adjustment factor for Vmp after 20 years of degradation? 20 years of voltage loss @ -0.5%/year = 1+ (20 x (-0.5%)) = (1-0.1) = 0.9 Step 2: What is the adjustment factorfor Vmp from STC to 65°C? Vmp Loss due to temperature @ 65°C = 1 +[(65°C - TSTC) x (-0.5%/°C)] = 1 + [(65°C-25°C) x (-0.5%/°C)] = 1+ [40°C x (-0.5%/°C)] = 1 – 0.2 = 0.8. Step 3: Apply both adjustment factors to Vmp Vmp @ 20 years and 65°C = Vmp x 0.9 x 0.8 = 29.5V x 0.9 x 0.8 = 21.24V Step 4: Divide adjusted Vmp into 300V to determine minimum number of modules. Min. # of Modules = 300V ÷ 21.24V = 14.1214 modules (min & max the same) 5. The inverter recommend maximum STC Watts of modules is 9600 WSTC, what is the maximum number of modules that can be installed on this inverter? Answer: 9600W ÷ 230W = 41.74 42 modules Note: the recommended max is not a hard limit—for low altitude coastal climates like New Jersey, the amount of power loss from the array is small. Also, as the array degrades, the amount of power limiting will be small. 6. What array configuration provides for the best utilization of the array and inverter power? Answer: 3 strings of 14, which is 42 modules9660 WattsSTC of modules Note: This is right at the recommended limit of array size for the inverter. Since the inverter should only be configured with strings of 14 modules, an array with 2 strings of 14 modules only has a 6440 Watt array that would be more suited to between a 5kW and 6 kW inverter. A location at higher elevation would favor a 6kW inverter with 2 strings of 14 modules. 7. The PV array is on detached garage structure so it is decided that a combiner box and disconnect be mounted outside the garage accessible at ground level before proceeding to the house where the inverter is mounted next to the main panel. What is maximum current of the photovoltaic power source and what size wire should be run underground to the inverter? Answer: Imax = Isc x 3 x 1.25 = 8.41 A x 3 x 1.25 = 31.54 AmpsMinimum conductor ampacity according to NEC 690.8(B)(2)(a) is Imax x 1.25 = 31.54 A x 1.25 = 39.4 A Since the circuit is run underground  8 AWG will work for all terminal types. 8. At what distance does the wire run voltage drop equal 2% for maximum operating current so that a larger size conductor should be considered for the wire run?
  • 151. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 151 References key: topic / name / detail / author to the inverter? Answer: Imax = Isc x 3 x 1.25 = 8.41 A x 3 x 1.25 = 31.54 AmpsMinimum conductor ampacity according to NEC 690.8(B)(2)(a) is Imax x 1.25 = 31.54 A x 1.25 = 39.4 A Since the circuit is run underground  8 AWG will work for all terminal types. 8. At what distance does the wire run voltage drop equal 2% for maximum operating current so that a larger size conductor should be considered for the wire run? NABCEP PV Installer Resource GuideP a g e | 173 The maximum operating current = Imp x 3 = 7.79 Amps x 3 = 23.37 Amps = I in equation. Solve for “d” in the equation below.   feetd ftA V ftAdV kftkftft Id Vnom V kftkftft Id V V V nomnom d drop 132 /778.037.232 24020 /778.037.23224020 /1000 2 02.0 %100 /1000 2 %100%2%                               9. What is the minimum ac breaker allowed for this inverter? Answer: Min. Breaker = Inverter Max AC Current x 1.25 = 32 A x 1.25 = 40 A 10. What is the minimum size conductor before considering ambient temperature or voltage drop issues? Answer: Table 310.15(B)(16) 8 AWG has 40 Amp ampacity at 60°C and 50 Amp ampacity at 75°C depending on the temperature rating of the circuit breaker. 10 AWG will not work in either case. 11. How much annual energy is the PV system expected to produce if the system factor is 0.77, the average daily irradiation is 4.21 kWh/m2 /day? Answer: Annual PV system production = Peak Sun Hours x Total Module STC rating x System Factor Annual solar irradiation = average daily irradiation x 365 days = 4.21 kWh/m2 /day x 365 days/year = 1536.65 kWh/m2 /year  equivalent to 1536.65 Peak Sun Hours @ 1000W/m2 Total Module STC rating (in kilowatts) = (230WSTC x 42)÷(1000W/kW) = 9.66 kWSTC = 1536.65 hours x 9.66 kWSTC x 0.77 = 11,430 kWh (check answer using PVWatts)
  • 152. References key: topic / name / detail / author 152 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installer Resource GuideP a g e | 174 Contractor Name, Address and Phone: Bill and Jim’s Solar 456 Joslin Drive Cocoa, CA 800-555-1212 Bill Jim One-Line Standard Electrical Diagram for Small-Scale, Single-Phase PV Systems Site Name: Antonio & Maria Andretti Site Address: 123 Sunny St, Newark, NJ System AC Size: 7.68 kW Solar Array SIZE FSCM NO DWG NO REV E1.1 0 SCALE NTS Date: SHEET Drawn By: Checked By: DESCRIPTION OR CONDUCTOR TYPE USE-2 or PV WIRE BARE COPPER EQ. GRD. COND. (EGC) THWN-2 or XHHW-2 or RHW-2 THWN-2 or XHHW-2 or RHW-2 INSULATED EGC DC GROUNDING ELECTRODE COND. THWN-2 or XHHW-2 or RHW-2 INSULATED EGC TAG 1 2 3 4 5 CONDUIT AND CONDUCTOR SCHEDULE COND. GAUGE 10 AWG 10 AWG 10 AWG N/A N/A 6 AWG 8 AWG 10 AWG NUMBER OF CONDUCTORS 8 BLACK 1 BARE CU 4-R, 4-W, 1-G N/A N/A 1 BARE CU 1-R, 1-B, 1-W 1 GREEN CONDUIT TYPE N/A N/A EMT N/A N/A EMT CONDUIT SIZE N/A N/A ¾" N/A N/A ¾" DESCRIPTION SOLAR PV MODULE PV ARRAY J-BOX (IF USED) COMBINER (IF USED) DC DISCONNECT DC/AC INVERTER GEN METER (IF USED) AC DISCONNECT (IF USED) SERVICE PANEL TAG 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 PART NUMBER AS 230 N/A MFR-supplied MFR-supplied AI-7000 FORM 2S D222NRB SD200SL NOTES AMERICAN SOLAR, QUANTITY - 42 (SEE NOTES SHEET FOR DETAILS) ARRAY IS 3 STRINGS WITH 14 MODULES PER SERIES STRING 6"x6"x4" NEMA 4, PVC JUNCTION BOX 15-A MAX FUSE W/15-A FUSES, 600VDC, 4-STRING MAX LISTED WITH INVERTER, 600VDC, 60-AMP (SEE GUIDE APPENDIX C) 7000 WATT, SINGLE PHASE (SEE NOTES SHEET FOR DETAILS) 4-JAW, 240V CYCLOMETER REGISTER KWH METER IN 100-A BASE 240VAC, 60-AMP FUSED W/ 40-A FUSES (SEE GUIDE APPENDIX C) 240VAC, 200-A MAIN, 200-A BUS, 40-A INVERTER OCPD (SEE NOTE 5 FOR INVERTER OCPDs, ALSO SEE GUIDE SECTION 9) FOR UNUSED SERIES STRINGS PUT "N/A” in BLANK ABOVE SEE GUIDE APPENDIX C FOR INFORMATION ON MODULE AND ARRAY GROUNDING ___14___ MODULES IN SERIES SOURCE-CIRCUIT ___14___ MODULES IN SERIES SOURCE-CIRCUIT ___14___ MODULES IN SERIES SOURCE-CIRCUIT ___N/A___ MODULES IN SERIES SOURCE-CIRCUIT DC DISCO INVERTER AC DISCO AC DC M BUILDING GROUNDING ELECTRODE G Disregard if provided with inverter COMBINER M UTILITY SERVICE MAIN SERVICE PANEL MAIN OCPD INVERTER OCPD J‐BOX 1 1 3 4 5 6 7 9 2 3 4 5 82 EQUIPMENT SCHEDULE Contractor Name, Address and Phone: Bill and Jim’s Solar 456 Joslin Drive Cocoa, CA 800-555-1212 Bill Jim Notes for One-Line Standard Electrical Diagram for Single-Phase PV Systems Site Name: Antonio & Maria Andretti Site Address: 123 Sunny St, Newark, NJ System AC Size: 7.68 kW Solar Array SIZE FSCM NO DWG NO REV E1.2 0 SCALE NTS Date: SHEET Drawn By: Checked By: MAX POWER-POINT CURRENT (IMP) MAX POWER-POINT VOLTAGE (VMP) OPEN-CIRCUIT VOLTAGE (VOC) SHORT-CIRCUIT CURRENT (ISC) MAX SERIES FUSE (OCPD) MAXIMUM POWER (PMAX) MAX VOLTAGE (TYP 600VDC) VOC TEMP COEFF (mV/o C or %/o C ) IF COEFF SUPPLIED, CIRCLE UNITS 7.79 A 29.5 V 37.3 V 8.41 A 15 A 230 W 600 V -0.37 MODULE MAKE MODULE MODEL AMERICAN SOLAR AS 230 PV MODULE RATINGS @ STC (Guide Section 5) MAX DC VOLT RATING MAX POWER @ 40o C NOMINAL AC VOLTAGE MAX AC CURRENT MAX OCPD RATING 600 V 7680 W 240 V 32 A 50 A INVERTER MAKE INVERTER MODEL AMERICAN INVERTER AI‐7000 INVERTER RATINGS (Guide Section 4) 1) IF UTILITY REQUIRES A VISIBLE-BREAK SWITCH, DOES THIS SWITCH MEET THE REQUIREMENT? YES NO N/A 2) IF GENERATION METER REQUIRED, DOES THIS METER SOCKET MEET THE REQUIREMENT? YES NO N/A 3) SIZE PHOTOVOLTAIC POWER SOURCE (DC) CONDUCTORS BASED ON MAX CURRENT ON NEC 690.53 SIGN OR OCPD RATING AT DISCONNECT 4) SIZE INVERTER OUTPUT CIRCUIT (AC) CONDUCTORS ACCORDING TO INVERTER OCPD AMPERE RATING. (See Guide Section 9) 5) TOTAL OF ___1___ INVERTER OCPD(s), ONE FOR EACH INVERTER. DOES TOTAL SUPPLY BREAKERS COMPLY WITH 120% BUSBAR EXCEPTION IN 690.64(B)(2)(a)? YES NO NOTES FOR INVERTER CIRCUITS (Guide Section 8 and 9): 1.) LOWEST EXPECT AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE MINIMUM MEAN EXTREME DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO INSTALLATION LOCATION. LOWEST EXPECTED AMBIENT TEMP ___-15_o C 2.) HIGHEST CONTINUOUS AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE HIGHEST MONTH 2% DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO INSTALLATION LOCATION. HIGHEST CONTINUOUS TEMPERATURE __34_o C 2.) 2005 ASHRAE FUNDAMENTALS 2% DESIGN TEMPERATURES DO NOT EXCEED 47o C IN THE UNITED STATES (PALM SPRINGS, CA IS 44.1o C). FOR LESS THAN 9 CURRENT-CARRYING CONDUCTORS IN ROOF-MOUNTED SUNLIT CONDUIT AT LEAST 0.5" ABOVE ROOF AND USING THE OUTDOOR DESIGN TEMPERATURE OF 47o C OR LESS (ALL OF UNITED STATES), a) 12 AWG, 90o C CONDUCTORS ARE GENERALLY ACCEPTABLE FOR MODULES WITH Isc OF 7.68 AMPS OR LESS WHEN PROTECTED BY A 12-AMP OR SMALLER FUSE. b) 10 AWG, 90o C CONDUCTORS ARE GENERALLY ACCEPTABLE FOR MODULES WITH Isc OF 9.6 AMPS OR LESS WHEN PROTECTED BY A 15-AMP OR SMALLER FUSE. NOTES FOR ARRAY CIRCUIT WIRING (Guide Section 6 and 8 and Appendix E): OCPD = OVERCURRENT PROTECTION DEVICE NATIONAL ELECTRICAL CODE® REFERENCES SHOWN AS (NEC XXX.XX) NOTES FOR ALL DRAWINGS: SIGNS–SEE GUIDE SECTION 7 SIGN FOR DC DISCONNECT SIGN FOR INVERTER OCPD AND AC DISCONNECT (IF USED) RATED MPP CURRENT RATED MPP VOLTAGE MAX SYSTEM VOLTAGE MAX CIRCUIT CURRENT 19.6 A 430 V 599 V 26.5 A PHOTOVOLTAIC POWER SOURCE WARNING: ELECTRICAL SHOCK HAZARD–LINE AND LOAD MAY BE ENERGIZED IN OPEN POSITION AC OUTPUT CURRENT NOMINAL AC VOLTAGE 29 A 240 V SOLAR PV SYSTEM AC POINT OF CONNECTION THIS PANEL FED BY MULTIPLE SOURCES (UTILITY AND SOLAR)
  • 153. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 153 References key: topic / name / detail / author NABCEP PV Installer Resource GuideP a g e | 175 9.2 Example 2: Grid-Direct Micro-Inverter PV System Connected to Load Side of Service Panel. Module Ratings: Inverter Ratings: Location: Chattanooga, Tennessee Design questions: 1. What does the NEC consider the maximum voltage of this PV module at this location? Temperature Coefficient for VOC = αVOC = -0.37%/C = -0.0037/C Temperature Correction Factor = 1 + α VOC(%) x (TempLOW– TempRATING) = 1 + (-0.0037/C) x (-12C – 25C) = 1 + 0.1369 = 1.1369 Answer: Voc x Temp. Corr. Factor = 37.3V x 1.1369 = 42.4V 2. What is the maximum number of modules that may be installed in series where all dc equipment is rated for 60Vdc? Answer: Max. Number of Modules = 60V ÷ 42.4 = 1.411 module (microinverter) 3. What is the Maximum System Voltage as defined by NEC 690.7? Answer to #1 Answer: Vmax(module) x # of modules in Series = 42.4V x 1 = 42.4 Volts 4. What is the maximum number of microinverters per 20-amp ac breaker allowed? MAX POWER-POINT CURRENT (IMP) MAX POWER-POINT VOLTAGE (VMP) OPEN-CIRCUIT VOLTAGE (VOC) SHORT-CIRCUIT CURRENT (ISC) MAX SERIES FUSE (OCPD) MAXIMUM POWER (PMAX) MAX VOLTAGE (TYP 600VDC) VOC TEMP COEFF (mV/o C or %/o C ) IF COEFF SUPPLIED, CIRCLE UNITS 7.79 A 29.5 V 37.3 V 8.41 A 15 A 230 W 600 V -0.37 MODULE MAKE MODULE MODEL AMERICAN SOLAR AS 230 1.) LOWEST EXPECT AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE MINIMUM MEAN EXTREME DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO INSTALLATION LOCATION. LOWEST EXPECTED AMBIENT TEMP ___-12_o C 2.) HIGHEST CONTINUOUS AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE HIGHEST MONTH 2% DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO INSTALLATION LOCATION. HIGHEST CONTINUOUS TEMPERATURE __34_o C Example 2: Grid-Direct Micro-Inverter PV System Connected to Load Side of Service Panel.
  • 154. References key: topic / name / detail / author 154 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installer Resource GuideP a g e | 176 Answer: 20 Amp circuit breaker Maximum continuous current = 20A x 0.8 = 16A Number of inverters = 16A ÷ Imax = 16A ÷ 0.83 A = 19 inverters 5. What is the minimum size ac conductor for 19 inverters where an 11-foot length of conduit from the array contains 4 current carrying conductors, is mounted 1½” above the roof, and is in direct sunlight? Answer: Conduit fill adjustment factor: Table 310.15(B)(3)(a)  4-6 conductors  0.8 Sunlit conduit temperature adder: Table 310.15(B)(3)(c)  ½” to 3½”  22°C Temperature adjustment basis: 34°C (2% ASHRAE value) + 22°C = 56°C ambient temp. Temperature adjustment factor: Table 310.15(B)(2)(a)  0.71 (90°C Column) Table 310.15(B)(16) 12 AWG has 30 Amp ampacity at 90°C: With correction factors, the ampacity of 12 AWG is: 30A x 0.8(conduit fill) x 0.71(ambient temp) = 17.04 Amps It is permissible to protect this conductor with a 20-amp circuit breaker according to NEC 240.4(B). A larger conductor should be considered unless the run is extremely short. 6. At what distance does the wire run voltage drop equal 1% for maximum operating current so that a larger size conductor should be considered for the wire run? The maximum operating current = Imp x 19 = 0.83 Amps x 19 = 15.83 Amps = I in equation. Solve for “d” in the equation below.   feetd ftA V ftAdV kftkftft Id Vnom V kftkftft Id V V V nomnom d drop 38 /98.183.152 24010 /98.183.15224010 /1000 2 01.0 %100 /1000 2 %100%1%                               38 feet for 12 AWG; 61 feet for 10 AWG; and 97.4 feet for 8 AWG 7. If the house can handle 38 modules, two full branch circuits, how much annual energy is the PV system expected to produce if the system factor is 0.8, the average daily irradiation is 4.75 kWh/m2 /day? Answer: Annual PV system production = Peak Sun Hours x Total Module STC rating x System Factor Annual solar irradiation = average daily irradiation x 365 days = 4.75 kWh/m2 /day x 365 days/year = 1733.75 kWh/m2 /year  equivalent to 1733.75 Peak Sun Hours @ 1000W/m2 Total Module STC rating (in kilowatts) = (230WSTC x 38)÷(1000W/kW) = 8.74 kWSTC = 1733.75 hours x 8.74 kWSTC x 0.8 = 12,122 kWh (check answer using PVWatts)
  • 155. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 155 References key: topic / name / detail / author NABCEP PV Installer Resource GuideP a g e | 177 Contractor Name, Address and Phone: Bill and Ted’s Solar 456 Excellent Drive Knoxville, TN 800-555-1212 Bill Ted One-Line Standard Electrical Diagram for Micro-Inverter or AC Module PV Systems Site Name: John and Jane Homeowner Site Address: 123 Solar Dr., Chattanooga, TN System AC Size: 7.6 KW SIZE FSCM NO DWG NO REV E1.1a 0 SCALE NTS Date: SHEET Drawn By: Checked By: DESCRIPTION OR CONDUCTOR TYPE USE-2 or PV WIRE GEC EGC X ALL THAT APPLY EXTERIOR CABLE LISTED W/ INV. THWN-2 or XHHW-2 or RHW-2 GEC EGC X ALL THAT APPLY NO DC GEC IF 690.35 SYSTEM THWN-2 or XHHW-2 or RHW-2 GEC EGC X ALL THAT APPLY TAG 1 2 3 4 5 CONDUIT AND CONDUCTOR SCHEDULE COND. GAUGE MFG 6 AWG MFG 10 AWG 8 AWG 8 AWG 8 AWG NUMBER OF CONDUCTORS MFG Cable 1 BARE CU MFG Cable 2-B, 2-R, 2-W 1 GREEN 1-R, 1-B, 1-W 1 GREEN CONDUIT TYPE N/A N/A N/A EMT SAME EMT SAME CONDUIT SIZE N/A N/A N/A ¾" SAME ¾" SAME DESCRIPTION PV DC or AC MODULE DC/AC INVERTER (MICRO) J-BOX (IF USED) PV ARRAY AC COMB. PANEL (IF USED) GEN METER (IF USED) AC DISCONNECT (IF USED) SERVICE PANEL TAG 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 PART NUMBER AS 230 AI-200 N/A SD125SL FORM 2S D222NRB SD200SL NOTES AMERICAN SOLAR, QUANTITY - 20 (SEE NOTES SHEET FOR DETAILS) 200 WATT, SINGLE PHASE (SEE NOTES SHEET FOR DETAILS) 6"x6"x4" NEMA 4, PVC JUNCTION BOX 2,20-A AC CIRCUITS WITH 19 MICRO-INVERTERS PER CIRCUIT 240VAC, 125-A MAIN LUG PANEL W/ 30-A BREAKER AS MAIN 4-JAW, 240V CYCLOMETER REGISTER KWH METER IN 100-A BASE 240VAC, 30-AMP UNFUSED (SEE GUIDE APPENDIX C) 240VAC, 200-A MAIN, 200-A BUS, 30-A INVERTER OCPD (SEE NOTE 5 FOR INVERTER OCPDs, ALSO SEE GUIDE SECTION 9) FOR UNUSED MODULES PUT "N/A” in BLANK ABOVE 1 1 3 2 3 EQUIPMENT SCHEDULE 2 __10__ MICRO-iNVERTERS IN BRANCH- CIRCUIT MOD __1__ DC AC MOD __1__ DC AC MOD __1__ DC AC MOD __1__ DC AC MOD __1__ DC AC MOD __1__ DC AC J‐BOX 4 AC DISCO M BUILDING GROUNDING ELECTRODE G M UTILITY SERVICE MAIN SERVICE PANEL MAIN OCPD INVERTER OCPD 6 7 8 5 4 5 G SEE GUIDE APPENDIX D FOR INFORMATION ON MODULE AND ARRAY GROUNDING AC COMBINER PANEL G __19__ MICRO-iNVERTERS IN BRANCH- CIRCUIT __19__ MICRO-iNVERTERS IN BRANCH- CIRCUIT Contractor Name, Address and Phone: Bill and Ted’s Solar 456 Excellent Drive Knoxville, TN 800-555-1212 Bill Ted Notes for One-Line Standard Electrical Diagram for Single-Phase PV Systems Site Name: Joe and Jane Homeowner Site Address: 123 Solar Dr., Chattanooga, TN System AC Size: 7.6 kW Solar Array SIZE FSCM NO DWG NO REV E1.2a 0 SCALE NTS Date: SHEET Drawn By: Checked By: MAX POWER-POINT CURRENT (IMP) MAX POWER-POINT VOLTAGE (VMP) OPEN-CIRCUIT VOLTAGE (VOC) SHORT-CIRCUIT CURRENT (ISC) MAX SERIES FUSE (OCPD) MAXIMUM POWER (PMAX) MAX VOLTAGE (TYP 600VDC) VOC TEMP COEFF (mV/o C or %/o C ) IF COEFF SUPPLIED, CIRCLE UNITS 7.79 A 29.5 V 37.3 V 8.41 A 15 A 230 W 600 V -0.37 MODULE MAKE MODULE MODEL AMERICAN SOLAR AS 230 PV MODULE RATINGS @ STC (Guide Section 5) MAX DC VOLT RATING MAX POWER @ 40o C NOMINAL AC VOLTAGE MAX AC CURRENT MAX OCPD RATING 60 V 200 W 240 V 0.83 A 20 A INVERTER MAKE INVERTER MODEL AMERICAN INVERTER AI‐200 INVERTER RATINGS (Guide Section 4) 1) IF UTILITY REQUIRES A VISIBLE-BREAK SWITCH, DOES THIS SWITCH MEET THE REQUIREMENT? YES NO N/A 2) IF GENERATION METER REQUIRED, DOES THIS METER SOCKET MEET THE REQUIREMENT? YES NO N/A 3) SIZE PHOTOVOLTAIC POWER SOURCE (DC) CONDUCTORS BASED ON MAX CURRENT ON NEC 690.53 SIGN OR OCPD RATING AT DISCONNECT 4) SIZE INVERTER OUTPUT CIRCUIT (AC) CONDUCTORS ACCORDING TO INVERTER OCPD AMPERE RATING. (See Guide Section 9) 5) TOTAL OF ___2___ INVERTER OUTPUT CIRCUIT OCPD(s), ONE FOR EACH MICRO- INVERTER CIRCUIT. DOES TOTAL SUPPLY BREAKERS COMPLY WITH 120% BUSBAR EXCEPTION IN 690.64(B)(2)(a)? YES NO NOTES FOR INVERTER CIRCUITS (Guide Section 8 and 9): 1.) LOWEST EXPECT AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE MINIMUM MEAN EXTREME DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO INSTALLATION LOCATION. LOWEST EXPECTED AMBIENT TEMP ___-12_o C 2.) HIGHEST CONTINUOUS AMBIENT TEMPERATURE BASED ON ASHRAE HIGHEST MONTH 2% DRY BULB TEMPERATURE FOR ASHRAE LOCATION MOST SIMILAR TO INSTALLATION LOCATION. HIGHEST CONTINUOUS TEMPERATURE __34_o C NOTES FOR ARRAY CIRCUIT WIRING (Guide Section 6 and 8 and Appendix E): OCPD = OVERCURRENT PROTECTION DEVICE NATIONAL ELECTRICAL CODE® REFERENCES SHOWN AS (NEC XXX.XX) NOTES FOR ALL DRAWINGS: SIGNS–SEE GUIDE SECTION 7 SIGN FOR DC DISCONNECT SIGN FOR INVERTER OCPD AND AC DISCONNECT (IF USED) No sign necessary since 690.51 marking on PV module covers needed information AC OUTPUT CURRENT NOMINAL AC VOLTAGE 31.7 A 240 V SOLAR PV SYSTEM AC POINT OF CONNECTION THIS PANEL FED BY MULTIPLE SOURCES (UTILITY AND SOLAR)
  • 156. References key: topic / name / detail / author 156 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Sample NABCEP Exam Questions The following questions are representative of the difficulty and scope of the type of questions that are on the NABCEP PV Installer Exam. These questions are provided to give those preparing for the exam an understanding of the type of questions that are on the exam. There is no guaranty that any problems on the NABCEP exam will match these questions. 1. A family of four is purchasing a 5 kW net-metered utility interactive PV system for their house which is located at 30°N latitude. The family members are out of the home regularly during the following hours: Father: 9 am - 5 pm Mother: 8:30 am - 12:00 pm Children: 8:00 am - 3:00 pm While the home is unoccupied, the energy use goes to near zero. There are no shade issues at the property; competing installation costs are equal, and the year round utility rate remains constant. Which of the following orientations will produce the most annual utility savings? a.) true south b.) true southeast c.) true southwest d.) magnetic south 2. A PV array for a utility-interactive system is to be ground mounted on a hill 1,000 feet from the point of utility connection. The single string of PV modules operates between 300 and 550 volts dc. The inverter is a 240 V inverter. There is a small building halfway between the array location and the utility point of connection. To minimize wire size, increase performance, and ensure consistent operation, where should the inverter be installed? a.) At the PV array b.) At the midpoint building c.) At the utility point of connection d.) Midway between the PV array and the building 3. Of the following site assessment tools, which are MOST OFTEN NEEDED to determine optimal array placement? a.) compass, level, and anemometer b.) compass, inclinometer, and irradiance meter c.) compass, digital camera, and multimeter d.) compass, inclinometer, and sun path analyzer
  • 157. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 157 References key: topic / name / detail / author 4. What is the MOST IMPORTANT consideration for mounting PV arrays on residential rooftops with regard to energy production? a.) Cooling b.) Shading c.) Tilt angle d.) Stand-off height 5. A homeowner wants a roof mounted solar array that produces 90% of the annual household energy consumption of 6900 kWh. The roof has a pitch of 26° and is facing true south. The array is mounted parallel to the roof. Given an 80% system efficiency, and the information contained in the table below, what is the array STC rating required to achieve 90% of the annual energy needs? a.) 4.25 kW b.) 4.43 kW c.) 4.92 kW d.) 5.15 kW 6. Which characteristic of a 500 V dc PV array gives it an advantage over a 48 V dc array of the same wattage? a.) Only one device is required for GFDI protection. b.) Under low light conditions, the single source circuit configuration produces more power. c.) Smaller conductors can be used between the array and inverter. d.) The maximum power tracking capability of the inverter is increased. a.) 6.0 feet b.) 7.8 feet c.) 9.6 feet d.) 15.6 feet 5. What is the MOST IMPORTANT consideration for mounting PV arrays on residential rooftops with regard toenergy production? a.) Cooling b.) Shading c.) Tilt angle d.) Stand-off height 6. A homeowner wants a roof mounted solar array that produces 90% of the annual household energy consumption of 6900 kWh. The roof has a pitch of 26° and is facing true south. The array is mounted parallel to the roof. Given an 80% system efficiency, and the information contained in the table below, what is the array STC rating required toachieve 90% of the annual energy needs? a.) 4.25 kW b.) 4.43 kW c.) 4.92.kW d.) 5.15 kW 7. Which characteristic of a 500Vdc PV array gives it an advantage over a 48Vdc array of the same wattage? a.) Only one device is required for GFDI protection. b.) Under low light conditions, the single source circuit configuration produces more power. c.) Smaller conductors can be used between the array and inverter.
  • 158. References key: topic / name / detail / author 158 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 7. The battery bank for a battery backup utility-interactive PV system is located in a harsh environment with temperature and humidity extremes. The system charge controller has a provision for temperature compensation, but it is not connected. What is the MOST LIKELY result on the battery state of charge? a.) Overcharged in both hot and cold weather. b.) Undercharged in both hot and cold weather. c.) Overcharged in cold weather and undercharged in hot weather. d.) Undercharged in cold weather and overcharged in hot weather. 8. What is the required minimum working space width in front of a 48 V lead acid battery bank? a.) 24” where all live exposed parts are less than 60 V dc. b.) 30” inches or the width of the battery bank, whichever is greater. c.) 36” from the right and left edges of the battery bank. d.) 36” from the top of the ungrounded battery terminal. 9. A single inverter system requires 9 or 10 modules in series and one or two series strings in parallel. If the southeast roof is large enough for 8 modules and the southwest roof is large enough for 15 modules, which of the following array configurations results in the MOST EFFICIENT use of the PV modules installed? a.) 15 modules on southwest roof and 5 modules on southeast roof b.) 12 modules on southwest roof and 8 modules on southeast roof c.) 10 modules on southwest roof and 5 modules on southeast roof d.) 10 modules on southwest roof and 0 modules on southeast roof NABCEP Sample Questions: (1) a, (2) c, (3) d, (4) b, (5) b, (6) c, (7) d, (8) b, (9) d
  • 159. Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide • 159 References key: topic / name / detail / author One size dOesn’t fit all. UsUally One size fits terrible. Ever wonder why the other guys keep telling you their product is right for every application? It’s because they only make one product. Trust the only company who can tailor the right solution for any size project. SMA. A perfect fit every time.
  • 160. References key: topic / name / detail / author 160 • NABCEP PV Installation Professional Resource Guide Copyright © 2013 NABCEP v. 6 Looking for High-Quality Technical Solar Content? SolarPro sets the standard in technical publishing for the North American solar industry. Each issue delivers a comprehensive perspective on utility, commercial and residential system design and installation best practices. Join our community of over 30,000 industry professionals. Subscribe for free at solarprofessional.com/subscribe